SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA EX-Series Installation and

SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA EX-Series Installation and
|
0
SonicWALL / Aventail Secure Remote Access 10.5.4 Installation and Administration Guide
1
|
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
i
Table of Contents
Chapter 1
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Features of Your SonicWALL Aventail Appliance . . . . . . . .
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Appliance Models . .
Administrator Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
User Access Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
What’s New in This Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
System Requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Server Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Client Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
About the Documentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Document Conventions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
............................................ 1
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Chapter 2
Installation and Initial Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Network Architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Preparing for the Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Gathering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Verifying Your Firewall Policies. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Helpful Management Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Installation and Deployment Process . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Specifications and Rack Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Front Panel Controls and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Connecting the Appliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Powering Up and Configuring Basic Network Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Web-Based Configuration Using Setup Wizard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Configuring the Appliance Using the Management Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Moving the Appliance into Production . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Powering Down and Restarting the Appliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Next Steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Chapter 3
Working with AMC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Accessing AMC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Logging In to AMC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Logging Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
AMC Basics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
A Quick Tour of the AMC Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Adding, Editing, Copying, and Deleting Objects in AMC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Getting Help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Administrator Accounts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Managing Administrator Accounts and Roles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Avoiding Configuration File Conflicts with Multiple Administrators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Managing Multiple SonicWALL Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Configuring an Appliance for GMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Configuring an Appliance for ViewPoint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Working with Configuration Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Saving Configuration Changes to Disk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Applying Configuration Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Discarding Pending Configuration Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Deleting Referenced Objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Chapter 4
Network and Authentication Configuration . . . . . . .
Configuring Basic Network Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Specifying System Identity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Network Interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring ICMP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
ii
|
Table of Contents
Viewing Fully Qualified Domain Names and Custom Ports . . . . . . .
Configuring Fallback Servers for Connect Tunnel . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Network Gateways . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Choosing a Network Gateway Option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Network Gateways in a Dual-Homed Environment . . .
Configuring Network Gateways in a Single-Homed Environment . .
Enabling a Route to the Internet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Static Routes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Name Resolution. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Domain Name Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Windows Network Name Resolution . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Server Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
CA Certificates. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Certificate FAQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Managing User Authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
About Intermediate Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Authentication Servers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Microsoft Active Directory Servers . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring LDAP and LDAPS Authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring RADIUS Authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring RSA Server Authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring a PKI Authentication Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring a Single Sign-On Authentication Server . . . . . . . . . . .
Using RSA ClearTrust Authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Local User Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Testing LDAP and AD Authentication Configurations . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Chained Authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Enabling Group Affinity Checking in a Realm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using One-Time Passwords for Added Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Next Steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . 58
. . 58
. . 59
. . 59
. . 59
. . 62
. . 62
. . 63
. . 63
. . 65
. . 65
. . 66
. . 66
. . 66
. . 73
. . 79
. . 80
. . 80
. . 80
. . 83
. . 94
. . 99
. 102
. 103
. 104
. 106
. 107
. 108
. 109
. 112
. 112
. 114
Chapter 5
Security Administration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Creating and Managing Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Resource Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Resources and Resource Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Using Variables in Resource and WorkPlace Shortcut Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Creating and Managing Resource Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Web Application Profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Creating Forms-Based Single Sign-On Profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Access Control Rules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Configuring Access Control Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Resolving Deny Rule Incompatibilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Resolving Invalid Destination Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Chapter 6
User Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Overview: Users, Groups, Communities, and Realms . .
Using Realms and Communities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Viewing Realms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Default, Visible, and Hidden Realms . . . . . . . . . . .
Specifying the Default Realm. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Enabling and Disabling Realms . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Best Practices for Defining Realms . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Realms and Communities. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Creating Realms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Adding Communities to a Realm . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Creating and Configuring Communities . . . . . . . . .
Network Tunnel Client Configuration . . . . . . . . . .
Using the Default Community . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
Changing the Order of Communities Listed in a Realm . . . . . .
Configuring RADIUS Accounting in a Realm. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Editing, Copying and Deleting Communities . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Managing Users and Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Viewing Users and Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Managing Users and Groups Mapped to External Repositories .
Managing Local User Accounts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
|
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
iii
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 179
. 180
. 181
. 181
. 181
. 182
. 191
Chapter 7
System Administration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Optional Network Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Enabling SSH Access from Remote Hosts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Enabling ICMP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Configuring Time Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
System Logging and Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Overview: System Logging and Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Log Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Monitoring the Appliance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
SNMP Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
Managing Configuration Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
Exporting the Current Configuration to a Local Machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
Saving the Current Configuration on the Appliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Importing Configuration Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Restoring or Exporting Configuration Data Stored on the Appliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Replicating Configuration Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Requirements for Replication. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Getting Started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Defining a Collection of Appliances to Receive Configuration Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
Beginning Replication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Viewing Configuration Data Recipients . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Upgrading, Rolling Back, or Resetting the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Updating the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Rolling Back to a Previous Version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Resetting the Appliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
SSL Encryption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Configuring SSL Encryption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
FIPS Certification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Requirements for FIPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Managing FIPS-Compliant Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
FIPS Violations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Enabling FIPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Exporting and Importing FIPS-Compliant Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Disabling FIPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Zeroization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Software Licenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
How Licenses Are Calculated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
Viewing License Details. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Managing Licenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Chapter 8
End Point Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Overview: End Point Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
How the Appliance Uses Zones and Device Profiles for End
End Point Control Scenarios . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Managing EPC with Zones and Device Profiles . . . . . . . . . . . .
Enabling and Disabling End Point Control . . . . . . . . . . . .
Zones and Device Profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Creating Zones for Special Situations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using the Virtual Keyboard to Enter Credentials. . . . . . . .
Configuring Data Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Point Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
iv
|
Table of Contents
Chapter 9
The Aventail WorkPlace Portal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
A Quick Tour of Aventail WorkPlace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Home Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Intranet Address Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bookmarks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Network Explorer Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Web Shortcut Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring WorkPlace General Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Working with WorkPlace Shortcuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Viewing Shortcuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Adding Web Shortcuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Creating a Group of Shortcuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Adding Network Shortcuts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Editing Shortcuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
WorkPlace Sites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Adding WorkPlace Sites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Modifying the Appearance of WorkPlace . . . . . . . . . . . .
WorkPlace and Small Form Factor Devices . . . . . . . . . .
Fully Customizing WorkPlace Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
WorkPlace Style Customization: Manual Edits . . . . . . . .
Overview: Custom WorkPlace Templates . . . . . . . . . . .
How Template Files are Matched . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Customizing WorkPlace Templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Giving Users Access to Aventail WorkPlace . . . . . . . . . . . . .
End Point Control and the User Experience . . . . . . . . . . . . .
How OPSWAT Secure Desktop Emulator Works . . . . . . .
How Cache Cleaner Works . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315
Chapter 10
User Access Components and Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
User Access Agents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
Client and Agent Provisioning (Windows) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
Aventail WorkPlace. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
The Tunnel Clients . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322
The Proxy Clients . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
Web Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
Client Installation Packages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326
Downloading the SonicWALL Client Installation Packages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326
Customizing the Configuration for the Connect Tunnel Client. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
Command Line Access to Connect Tunnel with NGDIAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330
Command Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
Customizing the Configuration for the Connect Mobile Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333
Running Connect as a Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335
Distributing SonicWALL Client Setup Packages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
The OnDemand Proxy Agent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
Overview: OnDemand Proxy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340
How OnDemand Redirects Network Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341
Configuring OnDemand to Access Specific Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
Configuring Advanced OnDemand Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
Client Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
Managing the SonicWALL Access Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346
Overview: Access Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346
Stopping and Starting the SonicWALL Access Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
Configuring the Network Tunnel Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
Configuring IP Address Pools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
Configuring Web Resource Filtering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355
Configuring Fallback Servers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
Configuring the Web Proxy Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
Terminal Server Access. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357
Providing Access to Terminal Server Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357
Citrix Server Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
Defining an Access Control Rule and Resource for Terminal Server Access . . . . . . .
Managing Graphical Terminal Agents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Graphical Terminal Shortcuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Aventail Connect for Android . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing Aventail Connect for Android . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring and Using Aventail Connect for Android . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Chapter 11
Virtual Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
What is Virtual Assist? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
How Does Virtual Assist Work? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Virtual Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Enabling Virtual Assist Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Virtual Assist Ticket Queue. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Virtual Assist Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Enabling Virtual Assist on a Layout. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring Virtual Assist Invitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using the Virtual Assist Ticket Queue . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using Virtual Assist from the Technician View . . . . . . . . . . .
Installing the Virtual Assist Technician Console . . . . . . .
Managing the Virtual Assist Queue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Emailing an Invitation to a Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Assisting a Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Virtual Assist Technician Console Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using Chat in Virtual Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using Virtual Assist from the Customer View . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using Virtual Assist from the Customer View (Windows) .
Using Virtual Assist from the Customer View (Mac) . . . .
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
|
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
v
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 360
. 361
. 362
. 367
. 367
. 367
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 379
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 379
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390
Chapter 12
Administering a High-Availability Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
Overview: High-Availability Cluster. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
Cluster Architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
The Load Balancing Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396
Stateful Failover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397
Synchronized Cluster Administration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397
Installing and Configuring a Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
Step 1: Connect the Cluster Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399
Step 2: Run Setup Tool on All Nodes of the Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399
Step 3: Configure the Cluster’s External Virtual IP Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
Final Steps: Network Configuration and Licensing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
Managing the Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
Viewing and Configuring Network Information for Each Node . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
Powering up a Cluster. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
Starting and Stopping Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
Monitoring a Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
Backing up a Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402
Performing Maintenance on a Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402
Upgrading a Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403
Upgrading a Single Appliance to a Cluster Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403
Troubleshooting a Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403
Cluster Scenarios . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404
Normal Flow of Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404
Node Failure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404
Appendix A
Appliance Command-Line Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Configuring a New Appliance Using Setup Tool. . . . . . . .
Tips for Working with Setup Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using Setup Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Saving and Restoring Configuration Data . . . . . . . . . . .
Saving Configuration Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 407
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
vi
|
Table of Contents
Restoring Configuration Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Upgrading or Rolling Back System Software . . . . . . . . .
Installing System Upgrades (Command Line Tool) . .
Reverting to a Previous Version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Performing a Factory Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Validating Hosts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
...
...
...
...
...
...
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
..
...
...
...
...
...
...
..
..
..
..
..
..
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
..
..
..
..
..
..
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. 410
. 411
. 412
. 412
. 413
. 413
Appendix B
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
General Networking Issues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Verify a Downloaded Upgrade File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Troubleshooting Agent Provisioning (Windows) . . . . . . . . . .
AMC Issues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Authentication Issues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using Personal Firewalls with Aventail Agents . . . . . . . . . . .
Aventail Services Issues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tunnel Issues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
OnDemand Issues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
General OnDemand Issues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Specific OnDemand Issues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Client Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Windows Client Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Macintosh and Linux Tunnel Client Troubleshooting . . . .
Troubleshooting Tools in AMC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ping Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Traceroute Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
DNS Lookup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Viewing the Current Routing Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Capturing Network Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Logging Tools for Network Tunnel Clients . . . . . . . . . . .
Snapshot Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 428
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 431
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 434
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 434
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 437
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438
Appendix C
Best Practices for Securing the Appliance . . . . . . . .
Network Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Appliance Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Appliance Sessions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Administrator Accounts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Access Policy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Set Up Zones of Trust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SSL Ciphers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Client Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Appendix D
Log File Output Formats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
File Locations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
System Message Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Auditing Access Policy Decisions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Viewing Client Certificate Errors in the Log . . . . . . . . . .
End Point Control Interrogation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Unregistered Device Log Messages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Network Tunnel Audit Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Auditing Connection Status Messages. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Web Proxy Audit Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Management Console Audit Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
WorkPlace Logs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
WorkPlace Shortcut Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 441
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 441
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 443
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 443
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 444
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 450
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 451
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 452
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 454
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 454
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 454
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
Appendix E
Internationalization Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Support for Native Character Sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RADIUS Policy Server Character Sets . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Selected RADIUS Character Sets . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Other Supported RADIUS Character Sets . . . . . . .
Appendix F
Configuring a High-Capacity Cluster
Overview of Clustering . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cluster Management. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Performing Initial Appliance Setup . . . .
Configuring the Appliance . . . . . . . . . .
Attaching the Appliance to the Switch . .
Configuring the Load Balancer . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
|
vii
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 457
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 457
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 457
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 458
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 459
............
............
............
............
............
............
............
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 461
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 461
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 461
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 461
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 462
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 462
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 462
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 463
viii
|
Table of Contents
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
1
Chapter 1
Introduction
The SonicWALL SSL VPN appliance provides secure access—including clientless access to Web
applications, access to client/server applications, and file sharing—to employees, business
partners, and customers. All traffic is encrypted using Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) to protect it from
unauthorized users.
The appliance makes applications available from a range of access methods—including a standard
Web browser, a Windows client, or a mobile device—on a wide range of platforms including
Windows, Macintosh, and Linux.
Aventail WorkPlace
Kiosk
users
PDA
Business Teleworkers
smartphone
partners
users
Windows Mobile-powered devices
Web-based
applications
File shares
Internal
users
Windows
servers
Wireless
LANs
Windows
desktops
IT-managed
devices
Branch office
applications
Thin client/server
applications
Traditional client/
server applications
You might use the appliance to:
z
Create a remote access VPN that enables remote employees to securely access private company
applications such as email over the Internet.
z
Create a business partner VPN that provides designated suppliers with access to an internal
supply chain application over the Internet.
2
|
Chapter 1 - Introduction
The appliance’s granular access control lets you define policy and control access down to the user
and resource level. Managing policy and configuring the appliance is quick and easy with the Webbased management console.
For an overview of planning your SonicWALL SSL VPN appliance configuration and deployment, see
the Getting Started Guide.
Features of Your SonicWALL Aventail Appliance
This section highlights the key components provided with your appliance.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Appliance Models
SonicWALL offers the following SSL VPN appliance models, all of which are documented in this
manual. Most of them can be clustered: a cluster of two appliances with internal load balancing is
intended for high availability (it provides system redundancy in case one of the nodes fails), and
clusters of up to eight can be used to increase capacity:
z
SonicWALL Aventail SRA E-Class EX7000: Supports up to 5,000 concurrent users, and
provides for clustering two identical appliances behind one virtual IP address with internal load
balancing, or up to eight appliances using an external load balancer.
z
SonicWALL Aventail SRA E-Class EX-2500: Supports up to 2,000 concurrent users, and
provides for clustering two identical appliances behind one virtual IP address with internal load
balancing, or up to eight appliances using an external load balancer.
z
SonicWALL Aventail SRA E-Class EX6000 and EX-1600: Supports up to 250 concurrent
users and provides for clustering two identical appliances behind one virtual IP address with
internal load balancing, or up to eight appliances using an external load balancer.
z
SonicWALL Aventail SRA E-Class EX-750: Supports up to 50 concurrent users.
Administrator Components
These are the key components for managing the SonicWALL appliance and services:
z
Aventail Management Console (AMC) is a Web-based administrative tool used to manage
the appliance. It provides centralized access for managing security policies, configuring the
system (including networking and certificate configuration), and monitoring. AMC is accessible
from a Web browser.
z
The Web proxy service provides users with secure access to Web-based applications, Web
servers, and network file servers from a Web browser. The Web proxy service is a secure HTTP
reverse proxy that brokers and encrypts access to Web-based resources. It also manages
TCP/IP connections for the Connect Mobile client.
z
The network tunnel service is a network routing technology that provides secure network
tunnel access to a wide range of applications, including those that use non-TCP protocols such
as Voice Over IP (VoIP) and ICMP, reverse-connection protocols, and bi-directional protocols
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
3
such as FTP. It works in conjunction with the Connect Tunnel client and the OnDemand Tunnel
agent to provide authenticated and encrypted access. The network tunnel service can traverse
firewalls, NAT devices, and other proxy servers that can interfere with traditional VPN devices.
User Access Components
The appliance includes several components that provide users with access to resources on your
network.
Aventail WorkPlace
The WorkPlace portal provides users with quick access to resources on your network. It is accessible
from any Web browser that supports SSL and has JavaScript enabled. WorkPlace provides a range
of access methods for you to choose from:
z
Basic Web (HTTP) resources are accessible using the Web translation engine, a reverse proxy
that provides single sign-on and fine-grained access control.
z
Web resources are also accessible through custom port mapped and custom FQDN mapped Web
access. This type of proxy handles Web programming technologies such as AJAX without the
limitations of URL rewriting used in translation.
z
File system resources are accessible from the Web-based Network Explorer that is integrated
in WorkPlace.
z
Client/server traffic (TCP/IP) is accessible using one of the network redirection clients,
OnDemand Tunnel. The client is automatically provisioned or activated when the user logs in to
WorkPlace.
4
|
Chapter 1 - Introduction
The access method you choose will be based on several factors, including the network protocols
used by your applications, your security requirements, end-user convenience, and the target
platforms. Here’s what your company’s WorkPlace portal might look like:
Connect and OnDemand Tunnel clients
Tunnel clients provide network-level access to all resources, effectively making each user device a
virtual node on your network.
z
The Connect Tunnel client provides full network and application access from a Web-deployed
Windows client for computers running a Windows 7, Windows Vista, Windows XP, Macintosh, or
Linux operating system. The client can be provisioned either transparently using a link from the
WorkPlace portal or through an executable installation package. The Connect Tunnel client
provides split-tunneling control, granular access controls, and automatic proxy detection and
authentication.
z
The OnDemand Tunnel agent provides the same features as the Connect Tunnel, except that it
can’t be used as a dial-up adapter for domain logins, and is integrated into WorkPlace.
OnDemand can operate in either split-tunnel mode or redirect all traffic mode.
Connect Mobile client
Connect Mobile provides remote TCP/IP access to Windows Mobile-powered devices. The Connect
Mobile client is installed by a stand-alone installer package, and is managed by the Web proxy
service.
Aventail Connect for Android
Aventail Connect for Android provides secure network access to client/server applications that are
available for Android devices. The Android client provides application layer proxy redirection similar
to OnDemand Mapped mode.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
5
End Point Control (EPC)
EPC components ensure that your network is not compromised when accessed from PCs in
untrusted environments by enabling you to “interrogate” devices and determine whether they are
running the programs that you require. Advanced EPC simplifies granular end point protection by
allowing you to set up device profiles (for clients running on Microsoft Windows) using a
comprehensive predefined checklist that includes security solutions from leading vendors like
OPSWAT, McAfee, Computer Associates, Sophos, and Kaspersky. Advanced EPC is included with the
EX7000 and EX-2500 appliances and licensed separately for the other appliances in the EX-series.
Note
z
Prior to version 10 of the SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA EX-Series firmware, there was an
OnDemand proxy agent that provided access to resources protected by the Web proxy service.
This agent and its settings are still available to you if you are upgrading from a previous version
of the firmware; new customers will not have this agent and will use OnDemand Tunnel instead.
What’s New in This Release
Version 10.5 of the SonicWALL E-Class Secure Remote Access software includes the following new
and enhanced features:
z
Firefox 3.5 Support—Full support for Mozilla Firefox 3.5.
z
Internet Explorer 8 and 9 Support—Full support for Microsoft Internet Explorer 8 and 9.
z
Safari 5.1 Support—Full support for Apple Safari 5.1.
z
Mac OS X Snow Leopard Support—Full support for Mac OS X Snow Leopard (10.6).
z
Windows 7 Support—Full support for Microsoft Windows 7.
z
Vista SP2 Support—Full support for Microsoft Vista SP2.
z
Vista 64-bit Support—Full support for Microsoft Vista 64-bit.
z
Persistent Desktop Device Identity—Available for Windows, Mac, Linux, Windows Mobile 6,
and Active Sync (iPhone, Android, Symbian) devices. Limits the set of devices that any given
user may use to access protected resources. Each client device must be registered with the VPN
system. Device ID is used in conjunction with EPC Device Profiles to classify end point devices
into Zones of trust to bind devices to an authenticated user and grant proper access when the
user is using a registered device.
See “Collecting Equipment IDs from Unregistered Devices” on page 277 for more information.
z
Virtual Assist Remote Helpdesk Support—Allows remote helpdesk technicians to see and
configure user’s desktops. SonicWALL Virtual Assist is a remote support tool that enables an
administrator or help desk technician to assume control of a user’s PC or laptop in order to
provide remote technical assistance. With the user’s permission, the technician gains instant
access to the computer using a Web browser and can then diagnose and fix a problem remotely.
See “Virtual Assist” on page 377 for more information.
z
Tunnel URL Filtering for Web Policy and SSO Tunnel Support—Enforces the URL-based
rules that administrators define for ExtraWeb within VPN tunnel sessions. This feature not only
provides more effective security, but also leverages single sign-on logic for Web applications.
See “Configuring Web Resource Filtering” on page 355
z
OPSWAT Cache Cleaner—Provides VPN administrators with an end-point data protection tool
to ensure data downloaded or accessed during a session is functionally wiped from the user’s
system. This feature removes Web browser information, such as cookies, browsing history, and
stored passwords upon termination of the session. The OPSWAT Cache Cleaner is supported on
Windows and Mac platforms.
z
OPSWAT Secure Desktop Emulator—Provides VPN administrators with an additional endpoint data protection tool that prevents end users from copying or moving data from an endpoint system to other locations that have not been qualified for security clearance. When a client
device is classified into a zone that requires the desktop emulator, the emulator will
automatically deploy for the user. The Secure Desktop Emulator is available for Windows
platforms.
See “How OPSWAT Secure Desktop Emulator Works” on page 314 and “Zones and Device
Profiles” on page 257.
z
Apple iPhone and Symbian Support with ActiveSync for Exchange—Extends SonicWALL’s
clientless ActiveSync support for Exchange email to Apple iPhones, iPads, Google Android
mobile operating system, and devices running the popular Symbian operating system. Symbian
6
|
Chapter 1 - Introduction
runs on many Nokia and Samsung devices that are popular choices for corporate mail. This
feature also leverages the device’s ID capability to link the device to a single user, providing a
first layer of end-point control.
See “Integration with Third-Party Components” on page 13 for support information, “Exchange
ActiveSync Web Access” on page 324 for general information, and “Example: Supporting
Exchange on iPhones” on page 126 for an example configuration.
z
Aventail Connect for Android—Provides secure network access to client/server applications
that are available for Android smartphones or other devices. The Android client provides
application layer proxy redirection similar to OnDemand Mapped mode. For information, see
“Aventail Connect for Android” on page 367.
z
Password Management for Sun and Novell Directory Servers—Provides support to Novell
and Sun LDAP servers for improved password management. This new feature calls upon the
Policy server to probe and predetermine the directory server and the applicable version. End
users will be able to enter LDAP credentials and be notified through the appliance when their
password needs to be changed due to expiration or backend policies, and will then allow users
to change the password.
z
Extension Configurations in Management UI—A new page has been added to the
Maintenance section of the AMC management interface to allow simple configurations to be
completed for extensions. This new feature assists administrators in making configuration
adjustments that appear in maintenance releases or hotfixes, and allows for the configuration
of arbitrary key-value pairs.
z
Zero-client Web Access Capabilities Extended—Custom port mapped and custom FQDN
mapped Web access support for modern Web applications such as AJAX without installation of
a client agent.
See “Web Access” on page 323 for more information.
z
UDP Tunnel Mode—Use of Encapsulating Security Payload (ESP) improves the performance of
UDP streaming applications like VoIP.
See “UDP Tunnel Mode” on page 172 for more information.
z
FIPS Certification—EX-Series 6000 and 7000 appliances are being certified as FIPScompliant.
See “FIPS Certification” on page 240 for more information.
z
Control Session Termination for Tunnel Clients—Improves security and license usage by
providing an option to terminate OnDemand Tunnel or Connect Tunnel sessions when the
credentials for the community expire.
See “Session Termination” on page 174.
z
Intermediate CA Support—Certificate authority management is now more flexible with
support for wildcard server and client certificates signed by intermediate certificate authorities.
z
Option to Disable Authorization Checks—Prevents authorization check errors by providing
an option not to query directory servers for group information. Typically used for secondary
authentication servers, this option can also increase the speed of the authentication process for
users.
See “Disabling Authorization Checks” on page 83 for more information.
z
Enforce Single User Name in Chained Authentication—Improves security. The
administrator has the option of requiring that the same user identifier is used for each step of
chained authentication.
See “Configuring Chained Authentication” on page 109 for more information.
z
Enhance Terminal Services and Citrix Shortcut Configuration Options—New Web client
options for administrator include the ability to choose whether to allow copy and paste, user
screen size control, and other options during shortcut creation. A new check box for terminal
services shortcuts allows the option of automatically reconnecting when the session is
interrupted. Workplace users can control screen resolution when accessing shortcuts.
See “Adding Graphical Terminal Shortcuts to Individual Hosts” on page 362 for more
information.
z
AMC Navigation Improvements for Resources and Rules—Filtering drop boxes have been
added on a number of AMC pages to provide for more efficient searching.
See “Filters” on page 40 for more information.
z
Simplified OPSWAT Configuration in AMC—A new Any product from this vendor check
box is available for antivirus, antispyware, and personal firewall program vendors in Windows
device profiles during End Point Control configuration. Selecting this option allows the
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
7
administrator to create a profile that does not require updating everytime the vendor releases
a new version. When this option is selected, the administrator can still specify additional
criteria, such as signatures updated, file system scanned, and real-time protection enabled, as
long as all the versions of all the products in the list support that functionality.
See “Advanced EPC: Extended Lists of Security Programs” on page 272 for configuration
information.
z
Deployment of EPC Using Browser on Windows Mobile—End Point Control can be
performed on mobile devices without requiring Connect Mobile installation. The device must be
running Windows Mobile 6.5 or 6.1 with the corresponding version of Pocket Internet Explorer.
No configuration or separate device profile is necessary in the AMC. When logging into a
community that requires EPC, the user is prompted to install or upgrade the Aventail
Interrogator client. Interrogator communicates the EPC classification of the device to the
appliance.
z
Suspend and Resume a Spike License—Instead of having a fixed expiration date once it is
activated, a Spike License can now be suspended and later resumed. Once it is activated, you
will see the total number of allowed users, the activation date, and the number of days
remaining on the license. A Spike License enables you to temporarily increase the number of
remote users you can support.
See “Managing a Spike License” on page 248 for more information.
System Requirements
This section describes the system requirements for the administrator (server) and client
components for the SonicWALL SSL VPN.
Server Components
The system requirements for the administrator components and authentication servers are listed in
the following tables.
System Administration
Operating system
Browser
Aventail Management Console (AMC)
z
Windows Vista SP2
z
Internet Explorer 8.0
z
Windows Vista x64
z
Internet Explorer 7.0
z
Windows XP Professional SP3
z
Mozilla Firefox 3.0
z
Linux kernel 2.4.20 or later
z
Mozilla Firefox 3.0
8
|
Chapter 1 - Introduction
Authentication Servers
Operating system/Version
Notes
Active Directory
Windows Server platform:
z
Windows 2008 Server
z
Windows 2003 Server
z
General support, including password change
LDAP servers
z
LDAP version 3 compatible servers
z
No LDAP password change support
z
IBM Directory Server, versions 5 and 6
z
LDAP password change supported on IDS
z
Supports IP address assignment
RADIUS
z
Version 5.2
RSA
z
RSA Authentication Manager, version 7.1
z
RSA Authentication Manager, version 6.1
Single sign-on
z
RSA ClearTrust, version 4.6
Citrix Server Farms
Servers
z
Citrix XenApp 5.0
z
Citrix XenApp 4.5
z
Citrix Presentation Server 4
Notes
z
EOL has been announced for Citrix MetaFrame XP and
Citrix MetaFrame 1.8
Compatible Server Components
Server platforms, browsers, and third-party applications that are compatible with the appliance are
shown in the following table. There are no known issues with compatible configurations, and we
continue to offer technical support for them, but they have not been specifically tested in the
current release and future product changes will not take them into account.
The following platforms and browsers remain compatible with this release, but will be deprecated
in a future release:
Operating Systems
Authentication and Citrix Servers
z
Windows XP Professional SP2
z
Active Directory on Windows 2000 Server
z
Windows Vista (32-bit/64-bit) No
Service Pack
z
RADIUS v5.0
z
RSA Authentication Manager v5.2
z
Citrix MetaFrame XP
Citrix XML service must be running on the
MetaFrame server.
z
Citrix MetaFrame v1.8
MetaFrame 1.8 must have a license for Service Pack
2 and Feature Release 1 (SP2/FR1)
z
Windows Vista (32-bit/64-bit)
SP1
z
Windows 2000 Server
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
Client Components
The system requirements for client components are listed in the following tables:
z
“Tunnel Clients” on page 10
z
“Web-Based Clients” on page 10
z
“Proxy Clients” on page 12
z
“Virtual Assist Clients” on page 11
z
“End Point Control” on page 12
z
“Integration with Third-Party Components” on page 13
z
“Compatible Client Components” on page 14
|
9
10
|
Chapter 1 - Introduction
Tunnel Clients
Operating system
Browser
Notes
Connect Tunnel Client
z
Windows 7 (32-bit/64-bit)
z
Windows Vista SP2
(32-bit/64-bit)
z
Windows XP Pro, SP3
z
n/a
z
ActiveX, or JRE 1.6.0
update 14 or later is
required
z
Administrator rights
required for installation
Windows Server platform:
z
Windows 2003 Server
z
Mac OS X 10.6
(32-bit/64-bit)
z
Mac OS X 10.5
z
Linux kernel 2.4.20 or later
(32-bit)
z
Linux kernel 2.6.0 or later
(64-bit)
z
n/a
z
Administrator rights
required for installation
z
Mozilla Firefox 3.5
z
Administrator rights
required for installation
z
Browser required only for
proxy detection
Connect Tunnel Service
Windows Server platform:
z
Windows Server 2008 SP1
(32-bit/64-bit)
z
Windows Server 2003 SP2
z
n/a
z
No support for End Point
Control
z
ActiveX, or JRE 1.6.0
update 14 or later is
required
z
Administrator rights
required for installation
z
JRE 1.6.0 update 14 or
later
z
Administrator rights
required for installation
z
JRE 1.6.0 update 14 or
later
z
Administrator rights
required for installation
OnDemand Tunnel Agent
z
Windows 7 (32-bit/64-bit)
z
z
Windows Vista SP2
(32-bit/64-bit)
Internet Explorer 8.0
(32-bit only)
z
z
Windows XP Pro, SP3
Internet Explorer 7.0
(32-bit only)
z
Mozilla Firefox 3.5
z
Mac OS X 10.6
z
Safari 4.0
z
Mac OS X 10.5
z
Safari 3.0
z
Linux kernel 2.4.20 or later
z
Linux kernel 2.6.0 or later
(64-bit)
z
Mozilla Firefox 3.5
Web-Based Clients
Operating system
Browser
WorkPlace Portal, Translated/Custom Port Mapped/Custom FQDN Mapped Web access
z
Windows 7 (32-bit/64-bit)
z
z
Windows Vista SP2
(32-bit/64-bit)
Internet Explorer 8.0
(32-bit only)
z
z
Windows XP Pro, SP3
Internet Explorer 7.0
(32-bit only)
z
Mozilla Firefox 3.5
z
Mac OS X 10.6
z
Safari 4.0
z
Mac OS X 10.5
z
Safari 3.0
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
Operating system
|
11
Browser
z
Linux kernel 2.4.20 or later
z
Mozilla Firefox 3.5
z
Web-enabled mobile devices
z
The browser appropriate for your device
The following table shows Web-based applications that are supported and tested for different types
of custom access:
Custom Access Type
z
Supported and Tested Web Applications
Translation
z
Outlook Web Access 2003
z
Outlook Web Access 2007
z
Sharepoint 2003
z
Sharepoint 2007
z
Custom Port Mapped
z
Outlook Web Access 2003
z
Custom FQDN Mapped
z
Outlook Web Access 2007
z
Sharepoint 2003
z
Sharepoint 2007
z
Domino Web Access 8.0
z
Domino Web Access 8.5.x
Virtual Assist Clients
Operating system
Browser
Notes
Customer Application
z
Windows 7 (32-bit/64-bit)
z
z
Windows Vista SP2
(32-bit/64-bit)
Internet Explorer 8.0
(32-bit only)
z
z
Windows XP Pro, SP3
Internet Explorer 7.0
(32-bit only)
z
Mozilla Firefox 3.5
z
Mac OS X 10.6 (32-bit/64-bit)
z
Safari 4.0
z
Mac OS X 10.5
z
Safari 3.0
z
ActiveX, or JRE 1.6.0
update 14 or later is
required
z
JRE 1.6.0 update 14 or
later
z
Standalone application
Technician Application
z
Windows 7 (32-bit/64-bit)
z
Windows Vista SP2
(32-bit/64-bit)
z
Windows XP Pro, SP3
12
|
Chapter 1 - Introduction
Proxy Clients
Operating system
Browser
Notes
OnDemand Proxy Agent
z
Windows 7 (32-bit/64-bit)
z
z
Windows Vista SP2
(32-bit/64-bit)
Internet Explorer 8.0
(32-bit only)
z
z
Windows XP Pro, SP3
Internet Explorer 7.0
(32-bit only)
z
Mozilla Firefox 3.5
z
Mac OS X 10.6
(32-bit/64-bit)
z
Mac OS X 10.5
z
Linux kernel 2.4.20 or later
z
Linux kernel 2.6.0 or later
(64-bit)
z
ActiveX, or JRE 1.6.0
update 14 or later is
required
z
Port-mapped mode
requires ActiveX or Java;
for users who can’t run
ActiveX, JRE is used.
z
64-bit support on Windows
7 and Windows Vista is
only supported for
OnDemand Mapped Mode
z
JRE 1.6.0 update 14 or
later
z
Safari 4.0
z
Safari 3.0
z
Mozilla Firefox 3.5
z
JRE 1.6.0 update 14 or
later
z
ActiveX, or JRE 1.6.0
update 14 or later is
required
z
Includes Mobile2Market
certification
z
Supports Pocket PC
devices and smartphones
z
Does not support some
legacy devices, such as
Audiovox SMT5600,
Motorola MPx200 and
MPx220, Sierra Wireless
Voq, Samsung i600, iMate
SP2, and so on.
Web Proxy Agent
z
Windows 7 (32-bit/64-bit)
z
z
Windows Vista SP2
(32-bit/64-bit)
Internet Explorer 8.0
(32-bit only)
z
z
Windows XP Pro, SP3
Internet Explorer 7.0
(32-bit only)
z
n/a
Connect Mobile Client
z
Windows Mobile 6.5
z
Windows Mobile 6.1
End Point Control
Operating system
Browser
Notes
Interrogator and Installer
z
Windows 7 (32-bit/64-bit)
z
z
Windows Vista SP2
(32-bit/64-bit)
Internet Explorer 8.0
(32-bit only)
z
z
Windows XP Pro, SP3
Internet Explorer 7.0
(32-bit only)
z
Mozilla Firefox 3.5
z
ActiveX, or JRE 1.6.0
update 14 or later is
required
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
Operating system
z
Windows Mobile 6.5
z
Windows Mobile 6.1
Browser
z
Pocket Internet Explorer
6.1
z
Pocket Internet Explorer
6.0
|
13
Notes
z
Interrogator only; both
Windows Mobile
Workplace (with Pocket
IE) and Connect Mobile
are supported, and can
coexist on the device
z
Windows Mobile 2003
z
n/a
z
Interrogator only;
Connect Mobile is
required
z
Mac OS X 10.6 (32-bit/64bit)
z
Safari 4.0
z
z
Safari 3.0
JRE 1.6.0 update 14 or
later
z
Mozilla Firefox 3.5
z
JRE 1.6.0 update 14 or
later
Windows 7 SP1
(32-bit/64-bit)
z
Internet Explorer 8.0
z
Internet Explorer 7.0
z
Windows 7
(32-bit/64-bit)
z
Mozilla Firefox 3.5
z
Windows Vista SP2
(32-bit/64-bit)
z
Windows XP SP3
(32-bit)
z
Mac OS X 10.6.x
z
Safari 5.0
Mac OS X 10.5.x
z
Safari 4.0
z
Mac OS X 10.5
z
Linux kernel 2.4.20 or later
z
Linux kernel 2.6.0 or later
(64-bit)
Cache Cleaner
z
z
Advanced EPC / Secure Desktop Emulator
Windows 7 SP1
(32-bit/64-bit)
z
Internet Explorer 8.0
z
Internet Explorer 7.0
z
Windows 7
(32-bit/64-bit)
z
Mozilla Firefox 3.5
z
Windows Vista SP2
(32-bit/64-bit)
z
Windows XP SP3
(32-bit)
z
Integration with Third-Party Components
ActiveSync
SonicWALL supports clientless ActiveSync support for Exchange email to Apple iPhones, iPads,
Google Android mobile operating system, and devices running the popular Symbian operating
system. Symbian runs on many Nokia and Samsung devices that are popular choices for corporate
mail. ActiveSync support also leverages the device’s ID capability to link the device to a single user,
providing a first layer of end-point control.
ActiveSync - Certified With ActiveSync - Compatible With Mobile Operating System
Apple iPhone
Symbian
Google Android 2.x
z
Windows Mobile 6.5
Apple iPad (with valid
certificates)
z
Windows Mobile 6.1
14
|
Chapter 1 - Introduction
Terminal Services and Citrix
The SonicWALL appliance integrates with several popular security programs. In some cases, the
files necessary for integration are already on the appliance, and in other cases they must be copied
to the appliance.
Description
Notes
Windows Terminal Services agent
z
Version 6.0
z
Version 5.2
z
Version 8.6
z
Requires JRE 1.5 or later
Windows (ActiveX control)
z
Versions 9.x and 10.x. Version 11 is also
supported, but only if the agent is
downloaded separately and installed using
Microsoft Windows Installer (MSI).
Cross-platform (Java applet)
z
Version 9.x and later
z
Requires JRE 1.5 or later
Windows (ActiveX control)
Cross-platform (Java applet)
Citrix agent
Compatible Client Components
Client platforms, browsers, and Java versions that are compatible with the appliance are shown in
the following table. There are no known issues with compatible components, and we continue to
offer technical support for them, but they have not been specifically tested in the current release
and future product changes will not take them into account.
The following platforms and browsers remain compatible with this release, but will be deprecated
in a future release:
Operating Systems
Browsers
z
Windows XP Professional SP2
z
Firefox 3.0 (Windows)
z
Windows Vista (32-bit/64-bit)
No Service Pack
z
Firefox 3.0 (Linux)
z
Safari 2.0
z
Windows Vista (32-bit/64-bit)
SP1
z
Windows 2000 Server, SP4
z
Mac OS X 10.4
z
Windows Mobile 6.0
z
Windows Mobile 5.0
The following browsers are deprecated in this release:
Browsers
z
Internet Explorer 6.0
z
Firefox 2.0 (Windows)
z
Firefox 2.0 (Linux)
Java Versions
z
JRE 1.6.0 updates previous
to 14
z
JRE 1.5.0
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
15
About the Documentation
This document contains detailed information about installing, configuring, and maintaining the
appliance. Its contents are also available as context-sensitive Help from AMC; see “Getting Help”
on page 45 for more information.
Your SonicWALL appliance also comes with a printed Getting Started Guide that explains important
VPN concepts and components and will aid in planning to deploy your VPN. For access to electronic
copies of all of the product documentation, log in to your mySonicWALL.com account and register
your appliance. See “Registering Your SonicWALL E-Class SRA Appliance” on page 247 for more
information.
Document Conventions
Throughout this document, “external” refers to the network interface connected to the Internet.
“Internal” refers to the network interface connected to your internal corporate network. This
document uses the following typographical conventions:
Typographical convention Usage
Bold
User interface components (such as text boxes or buttons on a
Web page).
Monospace font
Information you are supposed to type.
Italic
File names and directories, examples, and selections from dropdown lists.
commandname -x [-y]
In command-line syntax, square brackets indicate optional
parameters.
16
|
Chapter 1 - Introduction
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
17
Chapter 2
Installation and Initial Setup
This section shows where the appliance fits into your network environment, provides installation
and cabling instructions, and explains how to use the Web-based Setup Wizard (or alternatively use
the command-line Setup Tool) to perform basic network configuration.
Network Architecture
All of the SonicWALL appliances can be set up in either a dual interface or single interface
configuration, both of which are discussed in this section.
z
The EX7000, EX6000, EX-2500, and EX-1600 appliances include three physical network
interfaces and can be set up in a cluster for high availability (see “Installing and Configuring a
Cluster” on page 398 for more information), or one that uses an external load balancer (see
“Configuring a High-Capacity Cluster” on page 461).
z
The EX-750 appliance includes two physical network interfaces.
Dual-homed configuration (internal and external interfaces)
One network interface is used for external traffic (that is, to and from the Internet), and the other
interface is used for internal traffic (to and from your corporate network).
Corporate network
Internal
interface
Internet
External
interface
Firewall
Firewall
SonicWALL Aventail Appliance
File
Server
Application
Web
Server
Server
18
|
Chapter 2 - Installation and Initial Setup
Single-homed interface configuration (internal interface)
A single network interface is used for both internal and external traffic. In this configuration, the
appliance is usually installed in the demilitarized zone (or DMZ, also known as a perimeter network).
DMZ
Corporate network
Internet
Internal interface
Firewall
Firewall
File
Server
Application
Web
Server
Server
SonicWALL Aventail Appliance
In both configurations, incoming requests to the SonicWALL services—including HTTP/S traffic for
the Web proxy service—are sent over port 80 (HTTP) and port 443 (HTTPS). Traffic from the
OnDemand agent is always sent over port 443. Because most networks are configured to enable
traffic over these ports, you shouldn’t need to reconfigure firewalls on your network.
You should install the appliance in a location where it can connect to resources on your network,
including:
z
Application servers and file servers, including Web servers, client/server applications, and
Windows file servers.
z
External authentication repositories (such as an LDAP, Microsoft Active Directory, or RADIUS
server).
z
One or more Domain Name System (DNS) servers.
z
Optionally, a Windows Internet Name Service (WINS) server. This is required for browsing
Windows networks using WorkPlace.
!
CAUTION The SonicWALL appliance does not provide full firewall capabilities and should be
secured behind a firewall. Running without a firewall makes the appliance vulnerable to
attacks that can compromise security and degrade performance.
Although not required, enabling the appliance to communicate with these additional resources
provides greater functionality and ease of use:
z
Network Time Protocol (NTP) server for synchronizing the time on the appliance.
z
External server for storing syslog output.
z
Administrator’s workstation for secure shell (SSH) access.
You can configure the appliance to use a self-signed server certificate, or, for enhanced security,
you can obtain a certificate from a commercial certificate authority (CA). For more information, see
“Obtaining a Certificate from a Commercial CA” on page 67.
Preparing for the Installation
Before beginning the installation, you need to gather information about your networking
environment and verify that your firewalls are properly configured to permit traffic to and from the
appliance.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
19
Gathering Information
Before configuring the appliance, you need to gather the following information. You are prompted
for some of this information when running Setup Wizard (see “Web-Based Configuration Using
Setup Wizard” on page 32) or Setup Tool (see “Configuring a New Appliance Using Setup Tool” on
page 408), but most of it will be used when you configure the appliance in AMC (see “Network and
Authentication Configuration” on page 55).
If you are installing a cluster, you need some additional information. See “Installing and Configuring
a Cluster” on page 398 and “Configuring a High-Capacity Cluster” on page 461.
Settings required in order to start Aventail Management Console
z
The root password for administering the appliance
z
The name for the appliance (because this name is used only in log files, you don’t need to add
it to DNS)
z
The internal IP address and, optionally, an external IP address
z
Select a routing mode and supply IP addresses for the network gateways to the Internet, and
your corporate network.
Certificate information
Several pieces of information are used to generate the server and AMC certificates:
z
A fully qualified domain name (FQDN) for the appliance and for any WorkPlace sites that use a
unique name. These names should be added to your public DNS; they are also visible to users
when they connect to Web-based resources.
z
A FQDN for the Aventail Management Console (AMC) server. The AMC server name is used to
access AMC, which is a Web-based tool for administering the appliance.
Name lookup information
z
Internal DNS domain name of the network to which the appliance is connected
z
Primary internal DNS server address (additional DNS servers are optional)
z
IP address for an internal WINS server and the name of your Windows domain (required to
browse files on a Windows network using WorkPlace, but are otherwise optional)
Authentication information
z
Server name and login information for your authentication servers (LDAP, Active Directory, or
RADIUS)
Virtual Address pool information
z
If you are planning to deploy either network tunnel client (Connect Tunnel or OnDemand
Tunnel), you must allocate IP addresses for one or more address pools. For more information,
see “Configuring IP Address Pools” on page 349.
Optional configuration information
z
To enable SSH access from a remote machine, you need to know the remote host’s IP address.
z
To synchronize with an NTP server, you need to know the IP addresses for one or more NTP
servers.
z
To send data to a syslog server, you need to know the IP address and port number for one or
more syslog servers.
Verifying Your Firewall Policies
For the appliance to function correctly, you must open ports on your external (Internet-facing) and
internal firewalls.
20
|
Chapter 2 - Installation and Initial Setup
External firewall
For secure access to the appliance from a Web browser or OnDemand, you must make sure that
ports 80 and 443 are open on firewalls at your site. Opening your firewall to permit SSH access is
optional, but can be useful for performing administrative tasks from a remote system.
Traffic type
Port/protocol
Usage
Required?
HTTP
80/tcp
Unencrypted network access
x
HTTPS
443/tcp
Encrypted network access
x
SSH
22/tcp
Administrative access to the appliance
Internal firewall
If you have a firewall on the internal network, you may need to adjust its policy to open ports for
back-end applications with which the appliance must communicate. In addition to opening ports for
standard network services such as DNS and email, you may need to modify your firewall policy in
order for the appliance to access the following services.
Traffic type
Microsoft networking
Port/protocol
z
138/tcp and 138/udp
z
137/tcp and 137/udp
z
139/udp
z
162/snmp
z
445/smb
Usage
Used by WorkPlace to perform WINS name
resolution, browse requests, and access
file shares
LDAP (unencrypted)
389/tcp
Communicate with an LDAP directory or
Microsoft Active Directory
LDAP over SSL
(encrypted)
636/tcp
Communicate with an LDAP directory or
Microsoft Active Directory over SSL
RADIUS
1645/udp or 1812/udp
Communicate with a RADIUS
authentication server
NTP
123/udp
Synchronize the appliance clock with an
NTP server
Syslog
514/tcp
Send system log information to a syslog
server
SNMP
161/udp
Monitor the appliance from an SNMP
management tool
Helpful Management Tools
To manage the appliance from a remote system running Microsoft Windows, you may find the
following management tools useful. Both of these tools use encryption to protect information from
eavesdropping, unlike standard FTP or Telnet utilities:
z
A Secure Shell (SSH) client enables you to securely log in to the appliance and configure it
from the command line. This is useful for backing up the system, viewing log files, and
configuring advanced network settings. A popular SSH client for Windows is VanDyke Software’s
SecureCRT. A trial download is available at http://www.vandyke.com/products/securecrt/.
Another popular client is PuTTY, a free implementation of Telnet and SSH for Windows
platforms. PuTTY is recommended by Cisco.
To connect to the appliance using SSH, you type root as the username and type the password
you created using Setup Wizard.
z
A Secure Copy (scp) client makes it easy to securely transfer files from a PC running
Windows to the appliance. This is useful for copying certificates and other data to the appliance.
A popular Windows client is WinSCP, available at http://winscp.sourceforge.net/eng/.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
21
Most of the configuration management tasks that you need to perform—backing up and restoring
your appliance configuration, applying upgrades, and so on—can be done on the Maintenance
page in AMC, as described in “Managing Configuration Data” on page 224. If you prefer to handle
these tasks on the command line, see “Appliance Command-Line Tools” on page 407.
Installation and Deployment Process
This section outlines the process of installing, configuring, and testing the appliance, and then
deploying it in a production environment. Here’s an overview of the steps:
Installation step
Description
Make a note of your appliance serial
number and authentication code
You’ll need this information when you register your
product on MySonicWALL. It is displayed in one or
two places, depending on your appliance model:
z
EX7000 and EX6000: The serial number and
authentication code are printed on your appliance
label; they are also displayed on the General
Settings page in AMC.
z
EX-2500, EX-1600 and EX-750: The serial
number is printed on your appliance label; the
General Settings page in AMC displays both the
serial number and authentication code.
Rack-mount the appliance and connect the
cables
See “Specifications and Rack Installation” on
page 22 and “Connecting the Appliance” on page 29.
Turn on the appliance and begin
configuration
To connect to your appliance on your internal
network you must specify an internal IP address, the
subnet mask, and indicate whether your appliance is
part of a cluster. How you do this depends on your
appliance model:
z
For all appliance models except the EX-750: Use
the controls on the front of the appliance. See
“Powering Up and Configuring Basic Network
Settings” on page 31.
z
EX-750: Use a command-line tool on the
appliance; see “Configuring a New Appliance
Using Setup Tool” on page 408.
Run Setup Wizard
The wizard guides you through the process of initial
setup for your SonicWALL SRA appliance. See “WebBased Configuration Using Setup Wizard” on
page 32.
Register your appliance on MySonicWALL
Register your appliance on MySonicWALL. Product
registration gives you access to essential resources,
such as your license file and updates. In order to
register, you need both the serial number for your
appliance and its authentication code.
22
|
Chapter 2 - Installation and Initial Setup
The SonicWALL appliance uses a few different types of licenses. All license files must be retrieved
from www.mysonicwall.com and imported to the appliance, as described in “Software Licenses” on
page 243:
z
Administration test license: To begin setting up your SonicWALL appliance, log in to
MySonicWALL to retrieve your initial user license, which is valid for one user (the administrator
plus one end user) for an unlimited number of days. To become familiar with the Aventail
Management Console (AMC) and test it in your environment with additional users, either
retrieve an appliance license, or request a lab license to add a few more users.
z
Appliance licenses: The number of concurrent users supported with the appliance license
varies, depending on the appliance model you have:
z
{
EX7000: up to 5,000 users
{
EX-2500: up to 2,000 users
{
EX6000 or EX-1600: up to 250 users
{
EX-750: up to 50 users
Component licenses: If the license for an appliance component (such as OnDemand) has
expired, users attempting to use that component see an error message in Aventail WorkPlace.
In the case of a Spike License, the date on which it was activated and how many days still
remain is displayed in AMC.
If a license is about to expire, the Aventail Management Console (AMC) displays a license warning
message in the status area that links to the Licensing page.
Notes
z
Both Setup Wizard and Aventail Management Console (AMC) are Web-based applications for
configuring the appliance. PCs running these applications must have JavaScript enabled.
JavaScript must also be enabled on the browsers used for accessing WorkPlace.
z
If you are installing a cluster, see “Installing and Configuring a Cluster” on page 398 and
“Overview of Clustering” on page 461.
Specifications and Rack Installation
After you’ve unpacked the box, you’re ready to install the appliance on your network and prepare
for the configuration process. The appliances are designed to fit on a standard, 19-inch telecom
rack. Before connecting the appliance, make sure that you have sufficient space and adequate
power. The specifications for each appliance model are listed below.
SRA E-Class SRA EX-Series Hardware
The SRA E-Class EX7000 and EX6000 include the following:
z
Rails (in kit, not attached)
z
Standard IEC 60320 C13 to NEMA 15 USA only power cords
z
Crossover cable (a network cable that crosses the transmit and receive lines)
z
1 GB Ethernet ports
z
2 USB ports
z
80 GB SATA hard drive
z
Serial connection to appliance (115,200 baud)
The models differ from each other most in terms of processor power, RAM, network ports, and
power supply:
SRA EX7000
SRA EX6000
Regulatory Model/Type
1RK15-059
1RK20-05A
Intel processor
Core2 Duo 2.1GHz CPU
Celeron 2.0GHz CPU
RAM
2Gig DDR533
1Gig DDR533
PCIe Gig network ports
6 (5 + 1 HA)
4 (3 + 1 HA)
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
23
SRA EX7000
SRA EX6000
Power supply
Dual hot swappable
Fixed
Front panel (illustration)
See “EX7000 Appliance Front
Panel Controls” on page 24
See “EX6000 Appliance Front
Panel Controls” on page 25
Aventail EX-Series
The Aventail EX-2500, EX-1600, and EX-750 differ from each other as follows:
EX-2500
EX-1600
EX-750
AC power supply
300W PFC
185W PFC
200W PFC
AC voltage
6 amp at 120 V, or
3 amp at 240 V
4 amp at 120 V, or
2 amp at 240 V
5 amp at 100 V, or
3 amp at 240 V
Front panel
(illustration)
See “EX-2500 Appliance
Front Panel Controls” on
page 26
See “EX-1600
Appliance Front Panel
Controls” on page 27
See “EX-750
Appliance Front Panel
Controls” on page 28
Best Practices for Rack Installation of the Appliance
To mount the appliance in an equipment rack, you must install the rack hardware. The product
packaging for all models of the appliance contains a slide rail kit for mounting the appliance in a
four-post cabinet.
z
Avoid elevated operating ambient temperature: If installed in a closed or multi-unit rack
assembly, the operating ambient temperature of the rack environment may be greater than
room ambient. Therefore, consideration should be given to installing the equipment in an
environment compatible with the maximum ambient temperature (Tma) specified by the
manufacturer.
z
Avoid reduced air flow: Installation of the equipment in a rack should be such that the
amount of air flow required for safe operation of the equipment is not compromised.
z
Provide even mechanical loading: Mounting of the equipment in the rack should be such
that a hazardous condition is not achieved due to uneven mechanical loading.
z
Avoid circuit overloading: Consideration should be given to the connection of the equipment
to the supply circuit and the effect that overloading of the circuits might have on overcurrent
protection and supply wiring. Appropriate consideration of equipment nameplate ratings should
be used when addressing this concern.
z
Maintain reliable earthing: Reliable earthing of rack-mounted equipment should be
maintained. Particular attention should be given to supply connections other than direct
connections to the branch circuit (for example, use of power strips).
Front Panel Controls and Indicators
Before powering up the appliance, you should familiarize yourself with the front panel controls.
24
|
Chapter 2 - Installation and Initial Setup
EX7000 Appliance Front Panel Controls
This section describes the front panel controls for the EX7000 appliance. The power switch is located
on the rear panel.
PW1
PW2
LCD
controls
USB
ports
X5
X3
X1
X4
X2
X0
HD
Alarm
Test
Console
The following table describes the controls and indicators on the front panel.
Item
Description
LCD display screen
and controls
Displays status and configuration about the appliance. Keypad
buttons are used to display appliance status and configure initial
settings:
z
For more information on displaying appliance status and using
the keypad to shut down or reboot the appliance, see “LCD
Controls for the EX7000, EX6000, EX-2500 and EX-1600” on
page 28.
z
For information on using the LCD controls during initial
configuration (so that you can run Setup Wizard), see
“Configuring an EX7000, EX6000, EX-2500, or EX-1600
Appliance” on page 32.
Console
Connects the appliance to a personal computer with a
DB-9 serial cable.
USB ports
There are two USB ports.
LED indicators
From left to right, the LED indicators are:
z
Power 1 and 2
z
Test
z
Alarm
z
Hard disk drive—red indicates disk activity.
X0: Internal network
Connects the appliance to your internal network.
X1: External network
Connects the appliance to your external network.
X2: Cluster interface
Connect the appliance to another appliance in a high-availability
cluster.
X3-X5
Not used.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
25
EX6000 Appliance Front Panel Controls
This section describes the front panel controls for the EX6000 appliance. The power switch is located
on the rear panel.
PWR
LCD
controls
USB
ports
X3
X1
X2
X0
HD
Alarm
Test
Console
The following table describes the controls and indicators on the front panel.
Item
Description
LCD display screen
and controls
Displays status and configuration about the appliance. Keypad
buttons are used to display appliance status and configure initial
settings:
z
For more information on displaying appliance status and using
the keypad to shut down or reboot the appliance, see “LCD
Controls for the EX7000, EX6000, EX-2500 and EX-1600” on
page 28.
z
For information on using the LCD controls during initial
configuration (so that you can run Setup Wizard), see
“Configuring an EX7000, EX6000, EX-2500, or EX-1600
Appliance” on page 32.
Console
Connects the appliance to a personal computer with a
DB-9 serial cable.
USB ports
There are two USB ports.
LED indicators
From left to right, the LED indicators are:
z
Power
z
Test
z
Alarm
z
Hard disk drive
X0: Internal network
Connects the appliance to your internal network.
X1: External network
Connects the appliance to your external network.
X2: Cluster interface
Connect the appliance to another appliance in a high-availability
cluster.
X3
Not used.
26
|
Chapter 2 - Installation and Initial Setup
EX-2500 Appliance Front Panel Controls
This section describes the front panel controls for the EX-2500 appliance. The power switch is
located on the rear panel.
The following table describes the controls and indicators on the front panel.
Letter
Item
Description
A and E
LCD display screen
and controls
Displays status and configuration about the appliance.
Keypad buttons are used to display appliance status and
configure initial settings:
z
For more information on displaying appliance status
and using the keypad to shut down or reboot the
appliance, see “LCD Controls for the EX7000,
EX6000, EX-2500 and EX-1600” on page 28.
z
For information on using the LCD controls during
initial configuration (so that you can run Setup
Wizard), see “Configuring an EX7000, EX6000, EX2500, or EX-1600 Appliance” on page 32.
B
Console serial port
Connects the appliance to a personal computer with a
DB-9 serial cable.
C
USB port
There is one USB port.
D
LED indicators
From left to right, the LED indicators are:
z
Status (not used by this appliance)
z
Hard disk drive—red indicates disk activity.
z
Power LED—green indicates power is on.
F
Internal network
Connects the appliance to your internal network.
G
External network
Connects the appliance to your external network.
H
Reserved connectors
The first three Ethernet connectors are not used by the
appliance.
I
Cluster interface
Connect the appliance to another appliance in a highavailability cluster.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
27
EX-1600 Appliance Front Panel Controls
This section describes the front panel controls for the EX-1600 appliance. The power switch is
located on the rear panel.
This section describes the front panel controls for the EX-1600 appliance. The power switch is
located on the rear panel.
The following table describes the controls and indicators on the front panel.
Letter
Item
Description
A and B
LCD display screen
and controls
Displays status and configuration about the appliance.
Keypad buttons are used to display appliance status and
configure initial settings:
z
For more information on displaying appliance status
and using the keypad to shut down or reboot the
appliance, see “LCD Controls for the EX7000,
EX6000, EX-2500 and EX-1600” on page 28.
z
For information on using the LCD controls during
initial configuration (so that you can run Setup
Wizard), see “Configuring an EX7000, EX6000, EX2500, or EX-1600 Appliance” on page 32.
C
Power
Green LED indicates that the power is on.
D
LED indicators
From left to right, these three LED indicators show the
status for the following:
z
Internal network
z
External network
z
High availability cluster
E
Console serial port
Connects the appliance to a personal computer over a
DB-9 serial cable.
F
USB ports
There are two USB ports.
G
Internal network
Connects the appliance to your internal network.
H
External network
Connects the appliance to your external network.
I
Cluster interface
Connects the appliance to another appliance in a highavailability cluster.
28
|
Chapter 2 - Installation and Initial Setup
EX-750 Appliance Front Panel Controls
This section describes the front panel controls for the EX-750 appliance.
The following table describes the controls and indicators on the front panel of the EX-750 appliance.
Letter
Item
Description
A
Reset button
Reboots the system.
B
Power button
Toggles the system power on/off.
LCD Controls for the EX7000, EX6000, EX-2500 and EX-1600
The four-button keypad to the right of the LCD display on the E-Class SRA EX-Series appliances
(with the exception of the EX-750) can be used to display status and configuration information
about the appliance, and to shut down or reboot the appliance.
!
CAUTION — EX7000 and EX6000 appliances: Remove any USB devices from the
appliance before you reboot it. If a USB device is plugged in to your appliance when it is
rebooted, the appliance tries to use it as a boot device. As a result, the boot information stored
in the BIOS on the appliance is overwritten, and the EX7000 or EX6000 becomes unusable.
The following table describes the keypad functions:
Keypad Function
Description
Left button
Press the Left button once to reboot the appliance. The following
prompt is displayed:
Restart appliance?
<Yes No>
Press the Left button again to reboot the appliance, or press the
Right button to cancel the reboot.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
Keypad Function
Description
Up button
Press the Up button once to display the configuration of the
appliance’s network settings. Each time you press it, the display
shows another network setting:
Right button
z
Internal address
z
External address
z
Default gateway
z
Host name
z
Domain name
z
IP address
z
Netmask
|
29
Press the Right button once to shut down the appliance. The
following prompt is displayed:
Shut down now?
<Yes No>
Press the Left button again to shut down the appliance, or press
the Right button to cancel the shutdown.
Down button
To return to the default view at any time, or to refresh the
display, press the Down button once.
Connecting the Appliance
Follow the appropriate instructions for your appliance model to connect the appliance to your
network.
Connecting the EX7000 Appliance
For a diagram of the appliance, see “EX7000 Appliance Front Panel Controls” on page 24.
X
To connect the EX7000 appliance
1. Connect a network cable from your internal network to the internal interface on the appliance
(X0).
2. Optionally, connect a cable from your external network to the external interface on the
appliance (X1).
3. If you are setting up a cluster, connect one end of the supplied network crossover cable to the
cluster interface adapter (X2). Connect the other end to the X2 port on the other appliance in
the cluster.
4. Connect a standard AC power cord to the power supply.
Connecting the EX6000 Appliance
For a diagram of the appliance, see “EX6000 Appliance Front Panel Controls” on page 25.
X
To connect the EX6000 appliance
1. Connect a network cable from your internal network to the internal interface on the appliance
(X0).
2. Optionally, connect a cable from your external network to the external interface on the
appliance (X1).
3. If you are setting up a cluster, connect one end of the supplied network crossover cable to the
cluster interface adapter (X2). Connect the other end to the X2 port on the other appliance in
the cluster.
4. Connect a standard AC power cord to the power supply.
30
|
Chapter 2 - Installation and Initial Setup
Connecting the EX-2500 Appliance
The EX-2500 appliance uses up to five connections, as shown in the following illustration.
X
To connect the EX-2500 appliance
1. Connect a network cable from your internal network into the Ethernet adapter labeled “1” in
the illustration.
2. Optionally, connect a cable from your external network into the Ethernet adapter labeled “2”.
3. If you are setting up a cluster, connect one end of the supplied network crossover cable into
the cluster interface adapter. Connect the other end to the cluster interface adapter on the
other appliance in the cluster.
4. Connect a standard AC power cord to the power supply.
Connecting the EX-1600 Appliance
The EX-1600 appliance uses up to five connections, as shown in the following illustration.
X
To connect the EX-1600 appliance
1. Connect a network cable from your internal network into the Ethernet adapter labeled “1” in
the illustration.
2. Optionally, connect a cable from your external network into the Ethernet adapter labeled “2”.
3. If you are setting up a cluster, connect one end of the supplied network crossover cable into
the cluster interface adapter. Connect the other end to the cluster interface adapter on the
other appliance in the cluster.
4. Connect a standard AC power cord to the power supply.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
31
Connecting the EX-750 Appliance
The EX-750 appliance uses up to three connections, as shown in the following illustration.
X
To connect the EX-750 appliance
1. Connect a network cable from your internal network into the internal Ethernet adapter
(marked INT 2) and labeled “1” in the illustration.
2. Optionally, connect a cable from your external network into the external Ethernet adapter
(marked EXT 1) and labeled “2”.
3. Connect the supplied DB9 cable from a laptop computer or terminal to the rear serial port. This
provides full console access to the appliance; see “Powering Up and Configuring Basic Network
Settings” on page 31 for more information.
4. Connect a standard AC power cord to the power supply.
Powering Up and Configuring Basic Network Settings
After you’ve connected the appliance, you’re ready to power up for the first time and begin the
configuration process. You’ll use a Web-based Setup Wizard to configure the settings needed to get
the appliance up and running quickly, but in order to start the wizard you must first enter
information that will enable a Web browser to connect to your appliance.
Once your appliance is configured you can control its configuration and operation from AMC, the
Aventail Management Console. On the LCD screen of the appliance (which is present on all of the
appliance models except for the EX-750) you can also see basic information about the appliance (its
name and internal address, for example) or restart it, which is useful if your appliance is not in the
same area as the browser you use to run AMC.
Notes
z
You cannot run Setup Wizard on an appliance that has already been configured unless you first
restore the appliance’s factory default configuration settings. This applies whether you initially
configured the appliance using Setup Wizard, or by running setup_tool from the command
line. See “Re-Running Setup Wizard” on page 33.
Configuring Basic Network Settings
In order to start Setup Wizard you must first enter information that will enable a Web browser to
connect to your appliance. There are a couple of ways to do this, depending on your appliance
model:
z
EX7000, EX6000, EX-2500, and EX-1600: The recommended procedure for initial setup is to
use the LCD controls (to the right of the LCD screen on the front of your appliance) to enter
minimal settings and then run Setup Wizard. Alternatively, you have the option of using Setup
Tool on the command-line. Both procedures are outlined below.
z
EX-750: You must establish a serial connection to the appliance using a laptop computer or
terminal and then use Setup Tool before you can run Setup Wizard, explained below.
Once your basic settings are entered you’ll be able to run the Web-based Setup Wizard, as described
in “Web-Based Configuration Using Setup Wizard” on page 32.
32
|
Chapter 2 - Installation and Initial Setup
Configuring an EX7000, EX6000, EX-2500, or EX-1600 Appliance
To the right of the LCD screen on the front of your appliance are four buttons you'll use to enter
your settings.
X
Configuring basic network settings using the LCD controls
1. Press the Up and Down controls to read the welcome screen, and press Right to continue past
it.
2. Set the IP address for your internal interface: To change the IP address that appears, use the
Left and Right buttons to position your cursor over the number you want to change, and then
use Up and Down to change the number. Press Right to continue to the next screen.
3. Enter your subnet mask: Again, use the four buttons to change the IP address displayed on
the LCD screen. Press Right to continue to the next screen.
4. Cluster configuration: Specify whether the appliance you are configuring will be part of a
cluster (a high-availability pair of appliances), and which node it is (the master is “1” and the
slave node is “2”). Press Right to continue to the next screen.
5. Confirm your settings: Review your settings and confirm them. In a few moments your
settings are saved and you’ll see instructions on browsing to a URL on your desktop computer.
This is the URL for continuing your appliance configuration with Setup Wizard. For instance,
the LCD display might read as follows:
Please browse to: https://172.31.0.140:8443
For a description of configuring your appliance using Setup Wizard, see “Web-Based Configuration
Using Setup Wizard” on page 32.
Configuring an Appliance Using Setup Tool on the Command Line
To set the minimum configuration items necessary for running Setup Wizard, you must use Setup
Tool. Below is an overview of your steps; see “Configuring a New Appliance Using Setup Tool” on
page 408 for detailed instructions.
X
Overview of configuring basic network settings using Setup Tool
1. Use a terminal emulation program to establish a serial connection with the appliance from a
laptop computer or terminal.
2. Turn the appliance on. The first time you start the system from a serial connection, Setup Tool
automatically runs. When prompted to log in, type root for the username.
3. To configure the appliance, you are prompted to provide the following information:
{
IP address and subnet mask for the internal interface
{
Default gateway used to access the internal interface (optional)
{
In the case of a cluster, identify whether the appliance is the master node (1) or slave
node (2); a clustered deployment is possible on all appliances except the EX-750
For a description of configuring your appliance using Setup Wizard, see “Web-Based Configuration
Using Setup Wizard” on page 32.
Web-Based Configuration Using Setup Wizard
Setup Wizard guides you through a series of required and optional steps for configuring the
appliance. The AMC home page includes a Setup Checklist that indicates which items you have
completed.
Running Setup Wizard requires the same system configuration as AMC (see “System Requirements”
on page 7 for details); in addition, JavaScript must be enabled in the browser.
1. License agreement: Read the terms of the End User License Agreement.
2. Basic Settings:
{
Specify the password you'll use to access the Aventail Management Console (AMC). Your
password must be at least eight characters long, but no longer than 20 characters.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
{
|
33
(Optional) Select a time zone, and then click Change to set the current time. If you wish
to synchronize the time with an NTP server, that can be configured later in the AMC; for
more information, see “Configuring Time Settings” on page 195. It’s important to ensure
that the appliance’s date and time settings are correct for your time zone before you
import your license file.
3. Network Settings:
{
Enter a name for the appliance (the default is AventailSSLVPN). Because this name will be
used only in log files, you don’t need to add it to DNS.
{
The IP address and subnet mask for the internal interface (connected to your private
network) is shown here. For a dual-homed configuration, enter the IP address and subnet
mask for the external interface.
4. Routing: To leverage an existing router, select the dual gateway option to reach your
resources. To restrict incoming appliance traffic to just a few routes or subnets, select a single
gateway option and enter the routes or subnets as static routes later in the AMC.
If the appliance is on a different network than the computer you will use to access AMC, you
must set up routing in order to maintain access to AMC.
5. Name Resolution: The appliance must be able to perform name resolution in order to reach
resources on your internal network. Enter a default domain, which is the domain in which the
appliance is located (such as yourcompany.com).
6. User access: You can give users full network access by provisioning the OnDemand Tunnel
access agent. If you do, you’ll also need to specify the Source NAT address that will appear to
back-end servers as the source of client traffic. This must be an IP address that is on the same
subnet as the internal interface, and is not in use elsewhere.
Decide on an initial access policy for users (you can refine it later in AMC). This can be
completely permissive (granting access to the entire network protected by the SSL VPN), very
strict (deny all access), or in-between (give users access to all resources as you define them in
AMC).
At the end of the Setup Wizard process you’ll see your settings and then proceed to AMC, the
management console, for the last steps in the configuration process. See “Configuring the Appliance
Using the Management Console” on page 33 for details.
Re-Running Setup Wizard
After you run Setup Wizard to initially configure the appliance, you can’t re-run it unless you first
restore the appliance to its factory default configuration settings. Before you can re-run Setup
Wizard, you must run Config Reset Tool from the command line; this will delete all of your existing
system configuration data. For more information, see “Restoring Factory Default Configuration
Settings” on page 411.
Configuring the Appliance Using the Management Console
The final installation and deployment settings are done in AMC. The following is a checklist of
configuration items and pointers to detailed information.
1. Log in to AMC.
Log in to AMC, the Web-based application used to administer the appliance, and look at the
setup checklist on the right.
2. Register the appliance on MySonicWALL and retrieve your license file.
When you register your appliance on www.mysonicwall.com, you must enter both your serial
number and your authentication code, which is the hardware identifier for the appliance you
purchased:
{
The serial number is printed on a label on the outside of your appliance.
{
The authentication code is displayed in AMC: click General Settings from the main
navigation menu, and then look in the Licensing area.
When you receive your SonicWALL appliance there is a single user license on it, valid for an
unlimited number of days. To become familiar with the Aventail Management Console (AMC)
and test it in your environment with additional users, request a lab license. After initial setup
34
|
Chapter 2 - Installation and Initial Setup
and testing, download your license file from www.mysonicwall.com and then import it to the
appliance.
See “Managing Licenses” on page 246.
3. Define one or more authentication servers.
Authentication is used to verify the identity of users. When configuring an authentication
server, you are prompted to specify a directory type (LDAP, Microsoft Active Directory,
RADIUS, or local users) and a credential type (username/password, token, or digital
certificate).
See “Managing User Authentication” on page 80.
4. Configure a server certificate.
The appliance encrypts information using the Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) protocol. You can
create a self-signed certificate using AMC, or optionally obtain a certificate from a commercial
certificate authority (CA).
See “Certificates” on page 66.
5. Define application resources and groups.
Application resources include TCP/IP-based resources (such as client/server applications, file
servers, or databases), Web-based resources (including Web applications or Web sites) that
run over HTTP, and Windows network share resources (to be accessed in WorkPlace). Resource
definitions can include variables, so that a single resource can, for example, that derive its
network name or address based on each user.
See “Creating and Managing Resources” on page 115.
6. Define users and groups.
User and group definitions are used in access control rules to control access to application
resources.
See “Managing Users and Groups” on page 181.
7. Define realms and communities.
Realms enable the appliance to directly integrate with authentication servers, eliminating the
need to create and manage accounts for each user who needs access to your network.
Communities aggregate users with similar access needs and End Point Control requirements.
See “Managing User Authentication” on page 80.
8. Create access control rules.
Access control rules determine what resources are available to users and groups.
See “Access Control Rules” on page 144.
9. Configure shortcuts for WorkPlace.
To provide your users with easy access to a Web, file system, or graphical terminal resource
from within WorkPlace, you may want to create shortcuts in WorkPlace.
See “Working with WorkPlace Shortcuts” on page 292.
10. (Optional) Configure the network tunnel service.
If you plan to deploy the network tunnel clients, you must configure the network tunnel
service and allocate IP address pools for the clients.
See “Configuring the Network Tunnel Service” on page 348.
11. (Optional) Enable and configure End Point Control.
End Point Control optionally deploys data protection components designed to safeguard
sensitive data and ensure that your network is not compromised when accessed from PCs in
untrusted environments. End Point Control is deployed through communities.
See “End Point Control” on page 249 and “Using End Point Control Restrictions in a
Community” on page 168.
12. Apply your changes.
To activate your configuration changes, you must apply them.
See “Applying Configuration Changes” on page 52.
13. Test system accessibility.
Now you can verify that the appliance can access your external user repositories, and make
sure that the resources on your network are accessible.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
35
See “Troubleshooting” on page 415.
Moving the Appliance into Production
After you have tested the appliance sufficiently in your network environment and determined how
you want it to work, you’re ready to move it into its permanent home. This section describes steps
you may need to perform when moving the appliance into production.
1. Reconfigure the appliance with new address information.
If the network environment changed when you moved the appliance into production, you must
reconfigure the basic network settings and adjust any of the following values if they have
changed:
{
IP addresses for the internal and external interfaces
{
Default gateway IP addresses
{
Static routes
{
Default DNS domain and DNS server IP address
If you have a large number of configuration changes to make, you may find it convenient to
restore the appliance to its default settings and start over from scratch. This can be done using
Config Reset Tool; see “Restoring Factory Default Configuration Settings” on page 411 for
more information.
2. Register the appliance with DNS.
If you haven’t already registered the appliance with your company’s DNS, do this now. This
ensures that external users can access your network resources using a fully qualified domain
name instead of an IP address. Edit your DNS server’s database to include the fully qualified
domain name contained in the appliance’s certificate, and any WorkPlace sites.
3. Obtain a commercial SSL certificate.
You may want to obtain a commercial certificate for the appliance to assure users of its
identity. (Generally, a self-signed certificate is adequate for AMC.) For more information on
generating server certificates, see “Obtaining a Certificate from a Commercial CA” on page 67.
4. Adjust your firewall policies.
If you have an Internet-facing firewall, you may need to adjust its policy to open ports
required by the appliance. By default, the Web proxy service communicates using port 443/tcp
(it uses port 443/tcp for HTTPS and port 80/tcp for HTTP). If you want to use SSH to connect
to the appliance from outside the network, you'll need to open port 22/tcp.
If you have a firewall that faces the internal network, you may need to adjust the policy for
that firewall to open ports for any back-end applications with which the appliance must
communicate (if these ports are not already open). For instance, if you use an LDAP or
Microsoft Active Directory server for authentication, you must open port 389/tcp on your
internal firewall. For RADIUS, open ports 1645/ucp and 1812/udp.
If you’re using WorkPlace to access Windows network shares, you must also open internal
ports on your internal firewall so that WorkPlace can perform name resolution, make browse
requests, and connect to file shares. For more information, see “Gathering Information” on
page 19.
5. Create shortcuts and deploy WorkPlace.
If you use WorkPlace as an interface to Web-based resources and to provide Web-based
access to Windows network share and graphical terminal resources, you must create shortcuts
(see “Working with WorkPlace Shortcuts” on page 292). You should also publish the WorkPlace
URLs so your users know how to access resources through your VPN.
You may want to customize the appearance of WorkPlace for your environment. See
“Configuring WorkPlace General Settings” on page 291 for more information.
Powering Down and Restarting the Appliance
When it’s time to power down or restart the appliance, be sure to follow the proper procedure. The
appliance stores important data in memory while it is running, and that data must be written to the
hard disk before you turn off the power.
36
|
Chapter 2 - Installation and Initial Setup
!
X
CAUTION Powering down the appliance improperly can result in loss of data and leave the
system’s files in an inconsistent state. EX7000 and EX6000 appliances: Remove any USB
devices from the appliance before you reboot it. If a USB device is plugged in to your appliance
when it is rebooted, the appliance tries to use it as a boot device. As a result, the boot
information stored in the BIOS on the appliance is overwritten, and the EX7000 or EX6000
becomes unusable.
To power down or restart the appliance in AMC
1. From the main navigation menu, click Maintenance.
2. On the Maintenance page, click the appropriate button:
{
To restart the appliance, click Restart. AMC stops responding. After the appliance
restarts, you can log in to AMC again.
{
To shut down the appliance, click Shutdown. AMC stops responding and the appliance
automatically powers down. You do not need to press the power button on the front panel.
Notes
z
All appliance models, with the exception of the EX-750, s can be shut down or restarted at the
appliance:
a. On the front of the appliance, press the Down button on the four-button keypad to get to
the main LCD menu.
b. Scroll down until you reach the option you want, Restart or Shutdown.
c. Both options display a confirmation message; press the Left button to continue.
The results are the same as restarting or shutting down in AMC:
{
AMC stops responding; after the appliance restarts, you can log in to AMC again.
{
AMC stops responding and the appliance automatically powers down. You do not need to
press the power button on the front panel.
Next Steps
After you have completed the initial network setup, use AMC to continue configuring the appliance.
AMC is accessible using a Web browser:
z
If you’re new to AMC, you might want to read “Working with AMC” on page 37.
z
If you’re ready to continue configuring the appliance, see “Network and Authentication
Configuration” on page 55.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
37
Chapter 3
Working with AMC
This section introduces the Aventail Management Console (AMC), a Web-based interface for
managing the appliance.
Accessing AMC
This section explains how to access AMC using your Web browser and how to log out.
Logging In to AMC
Before logging in to AMC, you need the host name or IP address you typed for the internal interface
during the initial setup with Setup Tool.
X
To log in to AMC
1. Start your Web browser and type the URL https://<ipaddress>:8443/console, where
<ipaddress> matches the address you specified for the internal interface when you ran Setup
Tool or Setup Wizard. Press Enter.
2. On the login screen, type admin in the Username box.
3. In the Password box, type the root password you created using Setup Tool.
4. Click Login. The AMC home page appears.
5. There’s a Setup Checklist in the lower-right corner of the home page to help guide you
through initial configuration:
{
Click each link and perform the required configuration.
{
When you return to the AMC home page, the item is checked off the list and you’re ready
for the next one.
{
Click Help on any page for more information.
38
|
Chapter 3 - Working with AMC
For information on changing the AMC password, see “Editing Administrator Accounts” on page 47.
Notes
z
You should avoid having multiple administrators making changes to AMC at the same time. For
more information, see “Avoiding Configuration File Conflicts with Multiple Administrators” on
page 49.
Logging Out
It is important to preserve the security of your AMC administrator account. When you’re finished
working in AMC, click Log out in the upper-right portion of the screen. If you terminate a session
by simply closing your Web browser, your session remains active until it times out (after 15 minutes
of inactivity). There is an exception to this rule that you should be aware of; see “Appliance
Sessions” on page 440 for details.
AMC Basics
This section describes the basics of working with AMC. All configuration data is encrypted using SSL
as it’s transferred between AMC and your browser, ensuring that it remains secure. To increase
security, AMC should be used within a trusted network (on an internal network that is behind a
firewall). See “Certificate FAQ” on page 79 for more details.
A Quick Tour of the AMC Interface
The AMC interface will be familiar to anyone who has worked with similar Web-based security
management applications. Here are some basic notes about working with AMC.
Summary pages
Several top-level pages in AMC are summary pages that provide quick access to subordinate
configuration pages and display summaries of key configuration settings and other status
information. These summary pages are:
z
Agent Configuration
z
General Settings
z
Network Settings
z
SSL Settings
z
Authentication Servers
z
Services
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
39
For example, the Agent Configuration page provides links to pages for configuring End Point Control,
Aventail access, and other agents. You can see right away on this summary page whether a specific
agent is enabled or disabled.
Tables and tabs
Many AMC pages use a tabular layout to present the objects you’ll be managing. The tables include
scroll bars, which make it easier for you to keep the main elements on the page (including the
navigation bar, header, and footer) in view when working with long lists. You can also sort the data
displayed in some tables by clicking the underlined column headings.
40
|
Chapter 3 - Working with AMC
In some cases, you’ll use tabs to switch between modes. For example, you’ll use tabs to switch
between managing resources, groups of resources, and variables used in defining resources.
Filters
On pages in AMC that contain a list of items that can grow to many pages in a large configuration,
filtering is available to make it easier for you to find what you are looking for. Filters are available
on the following pages in AMC:
z
Resources
z
Resource Groups
z
Access Control
z
Users
z
Groups
z
Shortcuts
z
Shortcut Groups
z
Browse for Users (creating an access rule)
z
Browse for Resources (creating an access rule)
The exact filters vary slightly with each page, but the following functionality is consistent across all
pages:
z
There is a reset link that resets the filter fields to their default values.
z
There is a red active indicator that indicates that the page was loaded using filters, meaning
that the list may not be displaying all the configured items.
z
There is a Refresh button that reloads the page with the specified filters applied.
z
The filters are stored so that the next time you loads the page, it uses the same filters that were
last applied. The filters are stored across sessions, so even if you log out and log back in, the
same filters will be used.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
z
|
41
There is a footer at the bottom of the list that shows the number of items displayed and the
total number of items in the list. If filtering is active, there is a (filtered) indicator and a Show
all link that will reset the filters to the defaults and refresh the page to display all items in the
list.
In general, the available filters map to the displayed columns in the list. In some cases, such as
Resource Groups or Shortcut Groups, you can filter the list based on the members of the group,
which is not a column in the list. As another example, on the Resources page you could filter the
list based on something in the Value attribute, which is not a column but is visible when an item
in the list is expanded.
One way that you could use this feature for custom filtering is to create your own “tags” by adding
a custom string to the Description field of related items. For example, if a certain set of resources
are all used by one department or for one customer, you could add a keyword or tag to the
description of those resources, and then use the filtering capability to quickly display only the
resources that contain the special keyword or tag.
Page links
To save space, some AMC pages use a multi-page format with links at the top of the pages to access
the related configuration settings. The Configure Community page is an example of this:
Editing an object
In most of the tables used to display lists of objects, notice that the name field (or in the case of
the Access Control page, the rule number) is hyperlinked. To edit an object, click its hyperlink.
42
|
Chapter 3 - Working with AMC
Changing the page view
Some of the longer, more complex pages in AMC hide the edit controls used to configure advanced
features. This makes it easier for you to focus on the most important configuration options. To view
hidden options, click the down arrow button (click the up arrow to hide them again):
Expanded view of list details
AMC pages that display lists of objects, such as the Access Control page, let you view details about
an object by clicking the plus sign (+) to the left of it. To return to the one-line view, click the minus
sign (-).
Required fields and errors
Required fields are indicated in AMC with an asterisk. If you omit a value for a required field and
click Save, a red message appears beneath the field indicating that it is required. A red message
is also used to indicate an error (for example, if you type an invalid value).
Assigning names and descriptions
Most of your time in AMC will be spent managing three types of objects:
z
Access control rules
z
Resources
z
Users and groups
When you create these objects, AMC requires that you type a name. AMC also has a space for you
to type an optional description.
Although not required, meaningful descriptions can help you remember critical details about the
objects you’re managing, such as the purpose of an access rule or what resources are in a subnet
range. A good description is especially helpful when managing a group of objects; when you return
to AMC later to manage a large group of network resources, for example, you’ll be glad to have a
description reminding you of what’s in the group.
Saving changes on a page
On some AMC pages you can Save or Cancel the changes you make. If you click Cancel, or use
the Back button in your browser, your changes are not saved.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
43
The AMC status area
A status area just beneath the AMC header displays important information:
Status area link
Description
If your appliance license or a component license has expired, click License
warning to review and manage software licenses.
If more than one administrator is logged into AMC, click Multiple
administrators and check the list on the Administrator Sessions page.
If this appliance is configured to receive policy updates, click
Configuration recipient to see the appliances with which it will be
synchronized.
If you’ve made configuration changes but have not applied them, click
Pending changes. On the Apply Changes page you can activate or
discard the pending changes.
The SonicWALL version number and product serial number
The version of the current system software and the product serial number are displayed at the
bottom of the left-hand navigation bar on every page in AMC. If the appliance is configured to send
or receive configuration data, its replication name is shown here.
In addition to the version number, the System Status and Maintenance pages display a list of
any hotfixes that have been applied. The version number and hotfix information is useful for
planning system updates, and you need to have it when contacting SonicWALL Technical Support.
Adding, Editing, Copying, and Deleting Objects in AMC
AMC features a standardized user interface for managing most objects, such as resources, access
control rules, users, communities, End Point Control zones and device profiles, and other items used
to organize and operate your VPN.
Following are the basic procedures for adding, editing, copying, and deleting objects in AMC,
although there may be some minor variations depending on the object and AMC page you’re
working on. The examples provided here use the End Point Control Zones page.
X
To add a new object in AMC
1. On the page listing the type of object you want to create, click New.
44
|
Chapter 3 - Working with AMC
2. Complete the relevant information for the object, and then click Save.
X
To edit an object in AMC
1. On the page that lists the object you want to edit, click the link for the name (or in some
cases, the number) of the object you want to modify. For a quick description of the object, an
expand (+) button is available on most lists.
2. Make any changes to the information for the object, and then click Save.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
45
To copy an object in AMC
1. On the page that lists the object you want to copy, select the check box to the left of the
object, and then click Copy.
2. Make any changes to the information about the source object, and be certain to assign the
object a new name, and then click Save.
X
To delete an object in AMC
z
On the page that lists the object you want to delete, select the check box to the left of the
object, and then click Delete.
Notes
z
You cannot delete an object that is still associated with other objects. For information, see
“Deleting Referenced Objects” on page 54.
Getting Help
Every AMC page includes a Help button (in the upper right portion of the screen) that displays
context-sensitive online Help.
Help appears in a new browser window; its navigation bar includes the following buttons:
Button
Description
Displays the Help navigation pane, containing Contents, Index, and Search
buttons. (This button appears when the Help navigation pane is closed.)
Synchronizes the table of contents to display the current topic. (This button
appears when the Help navigation pane is in view.)
Displays the next or previous Help topic.
Displays a list of related Help topics.
46
|
Chapter 3 - Working with AMC
Button
Description
Prints the current Help topic.
The Help navigation includes the following tabs, which change the content in the left frame:
z
Contents displays a hierarchical list of Help topics.
z
Index displays an alphabetical list of keywords in Help.
z
Search displays a full text search engine for Help. Type a word or short phrase in the box, click
Go!, and then choose a topic from the list of results.
z
Favorites allows you to create a custom list of help topics to which you frequently refer.
Administrator Accounts
This section describes how to manage AMC administrator accounts and how to avoid problems if
more than one administrator is managing the appliance.
Managing Administrator Accounts and Roles
AMC enables you to create multiple administrator accounts, each with a separate username and
password. You can then assign roles to administrators, specifying which features in AMC they can
use, and their levels of access.
By default, AMC is configured with a primary administrator role that has full access to all areas of
AMC. Only the primary administrator can add, edit, or delete other administrator accounts.
Adding Administrator Accounts
You can create additional administrator accounts if more than one person is responsible for
managing policy and you want each person to have individual login credentials. Only the “primary”
administrator—whose default name of admin cannot be changed—can create, modify, and delete
secondary administrator accounts.
X
To add an administrator account
1. From the main navigation menu, click General Settings.
2. In the Administrator accounts area, click Edit. The Manage Administrator Accounts
page appears.
3. Click New. The Add/Edit Administrator page appears.
4. In the Username box, type the secondary administrator’s username.
5. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the administrator (for example, his
full name or title). This field is optional, but a description can be helpful when viewing the list
of administrators later.
6. In the Password box, type a password for the administrator. Be sure to share the password
with the administrator. The administrator can change this password at any time.
{
Your password must contain at least eight characters, and is case-sensitive. A password
containing a combination of uppercase and lowercase letters and numbers is
recommended, and it should not consist of words found in a dictionary.
{
If the password for the primary administrator (whose username is admin) is changed, the
password for logging in to the appliance directly (as root) is also changed.
7. In the Confirm password box, type the password again to confirm it.
8. In the Role list, select a role for the secondary administrator. AMC provides the following
preconfigured roles, which are defined on the Add/Edit Administrator Role page. You can
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
47
modify these preconfigred roles, or create new roles (see “Defining Administrator Roles” on
page 47):
Preconfigured role
Description
Super Admin
Has read/write access to all pages in AMC
Security Admin
Has read/write access to security administration
and monitoring pages in AMC, and view access
to system settings
System Admin
Has read/write access to system and monitoring
pages, and view access to security pages
9. Click Save.
Notes
z
For information on deleting administrator accounts, see “Adding, Editing, Copying, and Deleting
Objects in AMC” on page 43.
z
By default, the preconfigured roles include the ability to view all forms of session data and to
terminate sessions. See “Viewing User Sessions” on page 209 and “Ending User Sessions” on
page 211 for more information.
Editing Administrator Accounts
To help keep your AMC password secure, you should change it from time to time. Each administrator
can edit his or her own account to change the password or update the description. The primary AMC
administrator (whose username is “admin”) can edit the account settings for any other
administrator.
Your password must contain between eight and 20 characters, and is case-sensitive. A “strong”
password—with a combination of uppercase and lowercase letters, and numbers—is recommended.
You should also avoid using words found in a dictionary.
After you change your password, record it somewhere and keep it secure. If you change a
secondary administrator’s password, be sure to share the password with the appropriate
administrator.
X
To edit an administrator account
1. From the main navigation menu, click General Settings.
2. On the General Settings page, in the Administrator accounts area, click Edit.
3. In the Name column on the Manage Administrator Accounts page, click the name of the
administrator whose account you want to edit.
4. On the Add/Edit Administrator page, change the textual description, login password, or
role.
Notes
z
The username and role of the primary administrator cannot be changed.
z
If the password for the primary administrator (whose username is “admin”) is changed, the
password for logging in to the appliance directly (as “root”) is also changed.
Defining Administrator Roles
AMC’s role-based administration enables the primary administrator to grant limited administrative
control to secondary AMC administrators.
48
|
Chapter 3 - Working with AMC
For defining administrator roles, AMC’s features are grouped into four categories. For each category,
you must specify the permissions you want to grant a role. The four categories of administrator
permissions in AMC are described in the following table:
Category
Administrator permissions
Security administration
Controls administrator access to pages for access control rules,
resources, users and groups, WorkPlace, OnDemand, and End
Point Control.
System configuration
Controls administrator access to pages for network settings,
general appliance settings, SSL settings, access and network
services, authentication servers, and realms.
System maintenance
Controls administrator permission to shut down or restart the
appliance, update or roll back the system software, and import
or export configuration data.
System monitoring
View access permits the administrator to view system logs and
graphs, view active users, and run troubleshooting tools (such
as starting, stopping, downloading, and deleting network
traces). Modify provides additional permissions to terminate
user sessions and modify log settings.
The permission level for each category can be set as follows:
Permission level
Description
Modify
Permits read/write access within a category.
View
Provides read-only access within a category.
None
Disables access to the relevant AMC pages within a category.
When you select None as the permission level for a category,
AMC will not display either the pages within that category, or
the main navigation menu commands that lead to those pages.
X
To create an administrator role
1. From the main navigation menu, click General Settings.
2. On the General Settings page, click Edit in the Administrator roles area. The Manage
Administrator Roles page appears and displays an overview of administrators’ roles and
permission levels.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
49
3. Click New. The Add Administrator Role page appears.
4. In the Name box, type a meaningful name for the administrator role.
5. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the role.
6. In the Administrator permissions area, select one or more categories of permissions that
will be granted to the role.
7. Click Save.
Editing Administrator Roles
The primary AMC administrator can modify any secondary administrator role to change permission
levels, and can also delete secondary roles. For more information, see “Defining Administrator
Roles” on page 47.
Avoiding Configuration File Conflicts with Multiple Administrators
If more than one administrator is managing your appliance, you should avoid working in AMC at the
same time. If multiple administrators make changes to the same object, AMC saves the most recent
one. This can cause unintentional results, and potentially cause security problems if conflicting
changes are made to access control rules.
50
|
Chapter 3 - Working with AMC
If more than one administrator is logged into AMC, you are alerted by a link in the upper-right
corner of AMC:
To see a list of the usernames and IP addresses of all administrators who are logged into AMC, click
this link: the Administrator Sessions page appears in a separate window. If an administrator has
multiple instances of the Web browser logged into AMC, the administrator’s user name and IP
address is listed more than once.
You should contact the other administrators and coordinate your activities to avoid configuration
file conflicts.
X
To view the complete list of AMC administrators
1. Click General Settings in the main AMC navigation menu.
2. Click Edit in the Administrator accounts area. The Manage Administrator Accounts page
lists all of the administrators, and shows which ones are currently logged in.
Notes
z
The management console audit log tracks any AMC configuration changes made by
administrators. See “Management Audit Log” on page 202.
z
To end an AMC session you must click Log Out; if you terminate a session by closing your Web
browser, the session appears in the list of active sessions until it times out (by default, in 15
minutes).
Managing Multiple SonicWALL Devices
You can configure a SonicWALL SRA EX-Series appliance to be managed by Global Management
System (GMS), to be included in ViewPoint reports, or both.
z
The Global Management System (GMS) gives you a single management interface for centrally
managing and deploying SonicWALL appliances and security policy configurations. GMS also
provides centralized real-time monitoring, and policy and compliance reporting.
z
The ViewPoint Reporting Module is a separate Web-based reporting tool that gives you detailed
reports for individual SonicWALL appliances. You can track network utilization, monitor critical
network events and activity—such as security threats, inappropriate Web use, and bandwidth
levels—using a customizable dashboard and a variety of historical reports.
To configure centralized management in AMC, you must specify the settings for these servers, such
as the server address and port, and supply a password that will be used by GMS and the ViewPoint
server to gain access to the SRA EX-Series appliance.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
51
Configuring an Appliance for GMS
The Global Management System (GMS) gives you a single management interface for centrally
managing and deploying SonicWALL appliances and security policy configurations. GMS also
provides centralized real-time monitoring, and policy and compliance reporting. You can schedule
appliance reports to be automatically sent by email on a regular basis. These reports currently
contain the following:
z
User authentication-related events: The user login report shows the user name, source host IP
address, and time of login for users who have logged in to the appliance during the specified
day; the failed login report shows unsuccessful login attempts, which is useful for identifying
unauthorized access attempts and potentially malicious activity.
z
Status information: The GMS can log in to the Aventail appliance automatically and request its
up/down status and appliance details, such as its model and serial numbers, language, up-time,
and firmware version.
z
Resource access events: The aggregated data on GMS is summarized by access method and
user/realm name; you can also go into further detail and see individual access items. If a user
has logged in to WorkPlace, for example, and clicked on various links, that information is
relayed to GMS and can be viewed in summary or detailed reports.
You can also configure the SonicWALL appliance to be included in ViewPoint reporting.
X
To configure your SRA EX-Series appliance for GMS or ViewPoint
1. Click General Settings in the main AMC navigation menu.
2. Click Edit in the Centralized management area.
3. Select the Enable GMS/ViewPoint check box, and then enter the host name or IP address of
the GMS or ViewPoint server, and its port number.
4. In the Heartbeat interval text box, set the interval (in seconds) at which the appliance
indicates its readiness to send a report on authentication-related events, in addition to status
information (status.xml). An interval of 60 seconds is typical.
5. Select Send only heartbeat status messages if you want to just manage the appliance, and
not generate any reports.
6. If needed, enable an additional server in the Additional ViewPoint server area.
7. In the GMS/ViewPoint credentials area, enter and confirm the password that will be used
to add the SRA E-Class appliance. On the GMS/ViewPoint Add Unit screen, you will add this
SonicWALL Aventail appliance by entering GMS as the login name and the credentials you
specified in the Password box.
8. Select Enable single sign-on for AMC configuration if you want to be able to open the
Aventail Management Console and make changes to its configuration from within GMS. If this
setting is cleared, you can still open AMC, but you must first enter your AMC login credentials;
this is less convenient, but more secure.
9. Click Save.
Notes
z
Refer to the documentation for the SonicWALL Global Management System on
www.mysonicwall.com for further information.
Configuring an Appliance for ViewPoint
The ViewPoint Reporting Module is a separate Web-based reporting tool that gives you detailed
reports for individual SonicWALL appliances. You can track network utilization, monitor critical
network events and activity—such as security threats, inappropriate Web use, and bandwidth
levels—using a customizable dashboard and a variety of historical reports. Information is sent from
the appliance as a stream of syslog data and stored in the ViewPoint database or as files on the
hard disk.
X
To configure your SRA EX-Series appliance for ViewPoint
1. Click General Settings in the main AMC navigation menu.
52
|
Chapter 3 - Working with AMC
2. Click Edit in the Centralized management area.
3. Select the Enable ViewPoint reporting check box, and then enter the host name or IP
address of the ViewPoint server, and its port number.
4. In the GMS/ViewPoint credentials area, enter and confirm the password that will be used
on the ViewPoint server to add the SRA E-Class appliance (the login name is GMS).
5. Select Enable single sign-on for AMC configuration if you want to be able to open the
Aventail Management Console and make changes to its configuration from the ViewPoint
server. If this setting is cleared, you can still open AMC, but you must first enter your AMC
login credentials; this is less convenient, but more secure.
6. Click Save.
Working with Configuration Data
This section explains how to save and activate configuration changes in AMC.
Saving Configuration Changes to Disk
When you’re finished making changes on a page in AMC and you click Save, your changes are saved
to disk. If you click Cancel or use the Back button in your browser, your changes are not saved.
X
To save configuration changes to disk
1. Make any changes on a page in AMC.
2. Click Save at the bottom of the page.
Configuration changes are saved to disk, but are not applied to the active configuration. The status
area in AMC changes to indicate that you have pending changes that need to be applied to the
appliance.
See “Applying Configuration Changes” on page 52 for more information.
Notes
z
There are several options for managing configuration data—exporting it or saving it on the
appliance, or restoring it, for example. See “Managing Configuration Data” on page 224 for
more information.
Applying Configuration Changes
As you make configuration changes to the appliance, they are saved to disk but are not immediately
applied. These changes can either be activated (described in this section) or discarded (see
“Discarding Pending Configuration Changes” on page 53 for more information).
To activate your changes, you must apply them. You can apply most changes without interrupting
service to users, and new connections will use the new configuration. Low-level configuration
changes (for example, an IP address change) are a bit more disruptive: network services are
automatically restarted and user connections are terminated, forcing users to reauthenticate. If
possible, you should apply these sorts of configuration changes during off-peak hours (perhaps
during a maintenance window) and notify your users beforehand.
If you need to restart services manually, see “Stopping and Starting the SonicWALL Access
Services” on page 348.
X
To apply your changes
1. From the main navigation menu, click Maintenance.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
53
2. On the Maintenance page, click Apply changes. (You can also click the Pending changes
link in the upper-right corner of AMC.)
3. Assess the impact of applying your changes by looking at the message on the Apply Changes
page:
Warning message
Description
z
Applying changes will restart all services
and terminate all user connections.
Applying any of these changes terminates
existing user connections.
z
Applying changes will terminate existing
TCP/IP user connections.
z
Applying changes will terminate existing
HTTP user connections.
CAUTION: This requires users to
reauthenticate, and may cause them to lose
data.
Your changes will require AMC to restart, which
will end your current administrative session.
When the request is complete, open a new
browser and log in to AMC again.
AMC will be unavailable after your current
session ends. Close your browser and then
log in to AMC again.
No authentication realms are enabled. This will
prevent users from accessing any resources.
At least one authentication realm must be
enabled for users to have access to
resources. Otherwise, users cannot
authenticate to the appliance.
4. Click Apply Changes to apply configuration changes.
Notes
z
When you apply configuration changes to WorkPlace, AMC performs a restart of the services.
Users do not need to reauthenticate to WorkPlace, but if they provided Windows login
credentials to access a network share, they are prompted to re-enter them when WorkPlace
restarts.
z
Any connections that exist when you apply changes continue to use the old configuration until
the connection terminates. Because Web connections are short-lived, most users accessing Web
resources pick up configuration changes fairly quickly. On the other hand, client/server
connections can survive for a long period of time.
z
If the new configuration fails to load, existing connections remain in effect but new connection
attempts will fail. For details on what to do in this situation, see “AMC Issues” on page 419.
Discarding Pending Configuration Changes
Configuration changes you make in AMC are saved to disk, but they are not in effect until you apply
them, as described in “Applying Configuration Changes” on page 52. You can use the AMC log file
to find out what changes are pending, and go to the Apply changes page in AMC to discard them.
Pending changes can only be discarded as a group: you cannot discard them selectively.
X
To discard pending changes
1. (Optional) You can review the list of pending changes in the management console audit log
file.
a. From the main navigation menu, click Logging, and then select Management Console
audit log in the Log file list.
54
|
Chapter 3 - Working with AMC
b. Any Info level item added since the last Applied configuration changes message appears is
a change that can be discarded.
See “Management Audit Log” on page 202 for more information.
2. From the main navigation menu, click Maintenance, and then click Apply changes.
3. On the Apply Changes page, click Discard. The time- and date-stamp of the configuration
that will be restored when you discard pending changes is displayed.
4. Click OK to confirm that you want to discard changes.
Deleting Referenced Objects
You cannot delete an object (such as a resource or a user) if it is still referenced by another object
(the check box next to it in AMC cannot be selected). In this example, the resource ahsiple cannot
be deleted:
In order to delete an object that is in use by anther object—such as a Web shortcut, a WorkPlace
layout, or an access rule—you must first out what objects are using it. To do this, expand the list
item by clicking on the plus (+) sign next to it. In this example the resource is used by a WorkPlace
shortcut named DFS; it can be deleted only after the WorkPlace shortcut is removed. (The resource
is also part of a resource group named Default Resources, but it can be deleted if that is the only
reference.)
The following table lists the object types that cannot be deleted if they are referenced by other
objects.
This object type...
Can be referenced by this object type
Resource
Access control rules, resource groups, WorkPlace Web shortcuts
Resource groups
Access control rules
Users
Access control rules
User groups
Access control rules
Realms
Users, user groups
Authentication servers
Realms
Communities
Realms
Web application profiles
Resources
End Point Control zones
Access control rules, communities
Device profiles
End Point Control zones
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
55
Chapter 4
Network and Authentication Configuration
This section provides information about essential network configuration tasks, including configuring
network interfaces, selecting a routing mode, configuring network gateways, defining static routes,
and name resolution. It also explains how to manage SSL and CA certificates, and configure user
authentication.
This is the minimal network configuration required to get the appliance up and running. For
information on configuring additional services—including NTP, SSH, ICMP, and syslog—see “System
Administration” on page 193.
56
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
Configuring Basic Network Settings
All basic network settings—including IP interfaces, routing, and name resolution—are configurable
in AMC. The starting point in AMC for configuring network options is the Network Settings page.
Specifying System Identity
You must name the appliance and specify the domain name in which it is located.
X
To specify system identity
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Network Settings.
2. In the Basic area, click Edit. The Configure Basic Network Settings page appears.
3. The Appliance name helps you differentiate appliances in several contexts (especially if more
than one appliance is running). The name is not visible to users:
{
It sets the command prompt for the SonicWALL appliance.
{
It is saved to a log file, so you can identify the appliance to which a particular log message
applies.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
{
|
57
When you export a configuration file for the appliance (on the Maintenance page in
AMC), the Appliance name is prepended to the file name.
4. In the Default Domain box, type the name of the domain in which the appliance is located
(for example, yourcompany.com). This name defines the DNS namespace used to identify
hosts accessed by the appliance.
Configuring Network Interfaces
To configure the network interfaces, specify the IP address, subnet mask, and interface speed. You
can run the appliance using both the internal and the external interfaces (a dual-homed
configuration), or optionally just the internal interface (a single-homed configuration). For more
information on the interface configuration options, see “Network Architecture” on page 17.
X
To configure network interfaces
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Network Settings.
2. In the Basic area, click Edit. The Configure Basic Network Settings page appears.
3. In the Network interfaces area, configure the settings for the internal interface connected to
your internal (or private) network. Click the link for Internal and then configure these
settings:
a. Type an Address and Netmask for the interface.
b. Select the appropriate interface Speed from the list (the default is Auto).
c. Click OK.
4. To configure the settings for the interface connected to the external network (or Internet) do
the following:
a. Click the link for External.
b. Select the Enabled check box.
c. Type the Address and Netmask settings used to access the SonicWALL appliance from
the Internet. The external IP address must be publicly accessible.
d. Select the appropriate interface Speed from the list (the default is Auto).
e. Click OK.
5. Click Save.
6. Click Pending changes and then apply the changes. (For more information, see “Applying
Configuration Changes” on page 52.)
Notes
z
If you configure the appliance to use both the internal and external interfaces, verify your
routing settings to make sure that you have a network route to the internal interface. If the
appliance is on a different network than the computer you’re using to access AMC, you must
set up routing (configure an internal default network gateway that will pass traffic to an internal
router, or define a static route to the network on which the appliance is installed) to maintain
access to AMC after you apply your network configuration changes. For more information, see
“Configuring Routing” on page 59.
Configuring ICMP
Enabling ICMP (Internet Control Messaging Protocol) will let you use the ping command to test
network connectivity on any interface.
To enable pings, select the Enable ICMP pings check box. To disable pings, clear the check box.
58
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
Viewing Fully Qualified Domain Names and Custom Ports
The Fully qualified domain names section of the page provides a table of the IP addresses,
FQDNs, and the WorkPlace sites and URL resources they are used by. You can sort the list forward
or backward by any column heading by clicking the column heading link. Under Used by, click a
WorkPlace site name or URL resource name that appears as a link to go to that page in AMC where
you can edit the settings for it.
The Custom ports section provides a table showing the custom port number and the URL resource
that uses that port for all URL resources configured to use custom ports. Under Used by resource,
click a URL resource name that appears as a link to go to the Resources > Edit Resource page to
edit the resource settings.
Configuring Fallback Servers for Connect Tunnel
You can set up one or more fallback servers for Connect Tunnel users in case their primary appliance
becomes unavailable due to a planned outage, for example, or a natural disaster. Users do not need
to know the names of the fallback servers you set up: any time a client successfully connects to an
appliance that has any fallback servers specified, the list of fallback servers is transmitted to the
client and stored there.
X
To specify a fallback server for Connect Tunnel users
1. From the main navigation menu, click Network Settings.
2. In the Tunnel service area, click Edit. The Configure Network Tunnel Service page
appears.
3. In the Fallback servers area, click New.
4. Specify the fallback Server by host name or IP address.
5. In the Realm box you have two choices:
{
Leave it blank: Whatever realm the user was logged in to before the primary server
became unavailable is the same realm name that will be used on this particular fallback
server.
{
Specify a realm: Force users to log in to a particular realm when they connect to this
server.
Notes
z
Fallback server settings are not replicated as part of policy replication. In a group of servers
that have designated fallback servers, each appliance has a unique list that should not be
replicated on the other servers.
Fallback Servers and the User Experience
If an attempted connection to the primary server fails, the Connect Tunnel client automatically
attempts a connection to any fallback servers that are specified. This feature is available to Connect
Tunnel clients running on a Windows, Macintosh, or Linux operating system. Users will not be aware
that a fallback server is being contacted, except for an initial pause of about 20 seconds as the
connection is attempted, and a status message indicating that a backup host is being contacted.
A fallback server is used only when the user manually initiates a new connection to the primary
appliance (which is down). If the primary server becomes unavailable during an active session, the
session will exit and the user must start a new session.
Session Limits
If the login credentials for users include a PIN or other parameter that is valid for only a limited
period of time, you should be aware of what your session limits are. For example, if Credential
lifetime is set to only 30 seconds and the client works through several fallback servers while
attempting to make a connection, the user’s PIN or other parameter may time out before the list of
possible servers is exhausted.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
59
There are a few settings that govern how long a session can be resumed without requiring
reauthentication:
z
Credential lifetime is a global setting that is specified on the Configure General Appliance
Options page (click General Settings in the main navigation menu, and then click Edit in the
Appliance options area).
z
Limit session length to credential lifetime is a setting that is configured on a percommunity basis. When selected, tunnel client sessions in a given community terminate and
require reauthentication after the length of time specified by Credential lifetime.
Notes
z
If the client connects to a fallback server and the requested realm (as configured in AMC) is
unavailable, the connection fails with an authentication error.
z
Users connecting to a high-availability pair of appliances operate with the same fallback
information, regardless of which member of the pair they initially connect to.
z
Once a server has been contacted, fallback will not continue even if the login attempt fails.
z
If a user manually changes from one appliance that has a fallback list of servers to another, the
second server will display the last known realm the user selected for that host.
Configuring Routing
The SonicWALL SSL VPN appliance can be configured to route traffic using network gateways or
static routes. These routing methods can be used separately or in combination with each other.
Configuring Network Gateways
A network gateway is the address of a router that serves as point of access to another network.
Network gateway options are based on your network architecture and depend on whether you have
configured the appliance as dual-homed (both internal and external interfaces are enabled) or
single-homed (only the internal interface is enabled). See “Network Architecture” on page 17 for
more information.
Choosing a Network Gateway Option
When configuring network gateways in a dual-homed environment, you can choose among four
routing mode options:
z
Dual gateway
z
Single gateway, restricted
z
Single gateway, unrestricted
z
No gateway
Use the following scenarios to help you decide which option is best for your needs.
Scenario 1: Using an Internal and Internet Router
If you have an internal router as well as an Internet router, use the Dual gateway option. You can
leverage your internal router to access your internal resources.
60
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
Sample scenario—Company A has resources and a number of subnets on their internal network,
and they already have a robust routing system in place. With the dual gateway routing mode on
the appliance, client requests destined for internal resources on the corporate network can be
delivered to an internal router.
Scenario 2: Managing Client Requests with Static Routes
If you’re not using an internal router, or prefer managing routing on the appliance, use the Single
gateway, restricted option. In this scenario you must define static routes for all of your client
requests. Client requests without a static route will be discarded by the appliance. This option
requires more effort, but allows greater control over in-bound traffic.
Sample scenario—Company B does not use a lot of internal resources, and prefers to manage its
routing information on the appliance. They create a static route for each resource to which their
VPN users should have access. If a VPN user attempts to reach an address that is not defined within
the appliance’s routing table, then the traffic is discarded.
Scenario 3: Returning Client Requests to a Specified Gateway
With the Single gateway, unrestricted option, the appliance delivers all client requests that do not
match a static route to the gateway that you specify (on either the internal or external interface of
the appliance). This option is less secure because it could allow traffic to pass to your Internet router
and out of your network, depending on the filtering and routing policies of your infrastructure. This
configuration is also more difficult to maintain.
Sample scenario—Like company B, company C prefers to manage its routing information on the
appliance and has created static routes for each resource to which VPN users need access. However,
some users in this organization also need access to Internet resources, and this traffic must be
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
61
redirected from the appliance. For example, a company’s users might need to access a public Web
server that requires pre-registered IP addresses. A user must first establish a VPN session with the
appliance; the request is then redirected to the external gateway of the appliance.
Scenario 4: Evaluating the Appliance in a Lab Setting
Use the No gateway option during evaluation if you will have the interfaces connected to your
testing networks without the need for routing.
Scenario 5: Deploying Network Tunnel Clients in “Redirect All” Mode
If you are planning to deploy network tunnel clients in “redirect all” mode, you may need to give
your network tunnel users access to both your internal network and the Internet (for more
information, see “Redirection Modes” on page 171). This can be accomplished by either of these
options:
z
Use the Dual gateway option, and make certain that your internal gateway router has been
configured with a route to the Internet.
z
Use the Single gateway, unrestricted option, and then configure the appliance to use a route to
the Internet; see “Enabling a Route to the Internet” on page 63.
62
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
Configuring Network Gateways in a Dual-Homed Environment
The following steps guide you through the setup of network gateways in a dual-homed
environment, where both the internal and external interfaces are enabled.
X
To configure network gateways in a dual-homed environment
1. From the main navigation menu, click Network Settings.
2. In the Routing area, click Edit. The Configure Routing page appears.
3. To route traffic to your network gateways, select a routing mode from the following options:
{
Dual gateway—Specify an IP address for both the external and the internal gateways.
Network traffic generated in response to client requests will be sent to the external
gateway. All other traffic that does not have a static route defined will be sent to the
internal gateway.
{
Single gateway, restricted—Specify an IP address for just the external gateway. All other
traffic that does not have a static route defined will be discarded.
{
Single gateway, unrestricted—Specify an IP address to be used as both the external and
internal gateway. Network traffic not matching a static route will be sent to the external
gateway.
{
No gateway—Network traffic received by the appliance but not matching a static route is
discarded.
4. Click Save.
Notes
z
For users upgrading to version 8.9.0: If your previous configuration used the Enable route
to Internet setting, you can simplify your configuration in version 8.9.0 by specifying a dual
gateway system, where an internal gateway offers a path to the Internet for all access methods.
Configuring Network Gateways in a Single-Homed Environment
The following steps guide you through the setup of network gateways in a single-homed
environment, where only the internal interface is enabled. This configuration is less common than
one that is dual-homed.
X
To configure a network gateway in a single-homed environment
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Network Settings.
2. In the Routing area, click Edit. The Configure Routing page appears.
3. To route traffic to your network gateway, select one of these routing modes:
{
Default gateway—Specify an IP address for the default gateway. Network traffic received
by the appliance, but not matching a static route will be sent to this address.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
{
|
63
No gateway—Network traffic received by the appliance, but not matching a static route is
discarded.
4. Click Save.
Enabling a Route to the Internet
If Routing mode is set to Single gateway, unrestricted you can still enable a route to the Internet
for your network tunnel clients, provided your appliance is dual-homed (both internal and external
interfaces are enabled). When Enable route to Internet is set, all tunnel traffic originating from
the client and destined for the Internet (running in “redirect all” mode) will be routed to the
specified IP address instead of being discarded.
X
To enable a route to the Internet
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Network Settings.
2. In the Routing area, click Edit. The Configure Routing page appears.
3. Expand the Advanced area. The Connect Tunnel area appears.
4. Select the Enable route to Internet check box, and then type the IP address of your
Internet router.
5. Click Save.
Configuring Static Routes
Static routes are added as entries to the routing table for networks reached from the internal
interface. Managing static route tables can be cumbersome, especially at a large site: you may want
to create and edit the routing information in a comma-separated value (CSV) text file outside of
AMC and then import it. Static route information that you import into AMC must be in an ASCII text
file, with each entry on a new line (separated from the previous entry by a CR/LF), and three values
separated by commas: IP address, netmask, and gateway. When you import a file, its contents
entirely replace any static routes currently specified in AMC.
X
To configure static routing information
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Network Settings.
2. In the Routing area, click Edit. The Configure Routing page appears.
3. In the Static routes area, you can add or modify list entries one by one or as a group:
64
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
{
Add a single entry by clicking New and then typing the route information in the IP
address, Netmask, and Gateway boxes. To modify a list entry, click its link, and then
make your changes. After you add or modify an entry, click OK.
{
Click Import to select the static route table you want to import. The static route
information must be in an ASCII text file in CSV format. Each entry must be on a new line
(separated from the previous entry by a CR/LF), and must have three values separated by
commas: IP address, netmask, and gateway. When you import a file, its contents entirely
replace any static routes currently specified in AMC.
{
In order to modify an existing list of routes, you must either click the list item that you
want to change, or export the entire list, modify its contents, and then import it.
4. Click Save when you are finished making changes.
X
To delete a static route
1. On the Configure Routing page, select the check box to the left of any static routes you want
to remove, and then click Delete.
2. Click Save.
Notes
z
If you configure the appliance to use both the internal and external interfaces, verify the routing
settings to make sure that you have a network route to the internal interface. If the appliance
is on a different network than the computer you’re using to access AMC, you must set up routing
(configure an internal default network gateway that will pass traffic to an internal router, or
define a static route to the network on which the appliance is installed) to maintain access to
AMC after you apply your network configuration changes. For more information, see
“Configuring Routing” on page 59.
z
The routing information in AMC is sorted as follows:
z
{
The primary key is the Netmask, with entries sorted in descending order (from largest to
smallest)
{
The secondary key is IP address, with entries sorted in ascending order (from smallest to
largest)
If your internal network has a contiguous address space, you can combine multiple static routes
into one entry by specifying the proper subnet mask when you create the static route. The
following table provides two examples of using a subnet mask to route internal traffic to multiple
networks from a single static route entry:
To route traffic to these networks:
Type this IP address
Type this subnet mask
192.168.0.0
192.168.1.0
192.168.2.0
192.168.3.0
192.168.0.0
255.255.252.0
192.168.*.*
(all networks in 192.168 range)
192.168.0.0
255.255.0.0
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
65
If necessary, you can explicitly create additional static routes for other subnets; the routing
table searches netmasks from most to least specific.
Configuring Name Resolution
The appliance needs access to DNS servers to resolve host names to IP addresses. If you use
WorkPlace to browse Windows networks, you also need to specify a WINS (Windows Internet Name
Service) server and Windows domain name.
Configuring Domain Name Service
Configuring a DNS server enables the appliance to correctly resolve host names. Properly
configuring DNS ensures that the appliance can provide access to your network resources.
X
To configure DNS name resolution
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Network Settings.
2. In the Name resolution area, click Edit. The Configure Name Resolution page appears.
3. In the Search domains box, type the default DNS domain name for your company (such as
example.com). This domain name will be appended to unqualified host names to resolve
them. You can enter a maximum of six domain names, separated by semicolons.
4. In the DNS server boxes, type the IP addresses of your primary and (if applicable) two
backup DNS servers. The backup servers are used if the primary server is unavailable.
5. Click Save.
66
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
Configuring Windows Network Name Resolution
If you want to browse files on a Windows network using WorkPlace, you must specify a WINS
(Windows Internet Name Service) server and a Windows domain name. WorkPlace uses this
information to perform name resolution and build a list of resources for users to browse.
X
To configure Windows network name resolution
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Network Settings.
2. In the Name resolution area, click Edit. The Configure Name Resolution page appears.
3. In the Windows networking area, type:
{
The IP address of your primary and (if applicable) secondary WINS server.
{
Your Windows domain name using NetBIOS syntax (for example, mycompany).
4. Click Save.
Certificates
The SonicWALL appliance uses SSL certificates to secure information that the client computer sends
to the server, and to validate the appliance’s identity to connecting users. It requires at least two
SSL certificates:
z
The SonicWALL services use a certificate to secure user traffic from a Web browser to
WorkPlace, and from the Connect clients to the appliance. (If you want to provide several
WorkPlace sites, you can use a wildcard certificate for multiple sites, or associate a different
certificate with each one. In either case, the sites can have different host and domain names;
for more information, see “Adding WorkPlace Sites” on page 299.)
z
AMC uses a separate certificate to secure management traffic. This is usually a self-signed
certificate.
CA certificates are also used for securing connections to back-end servers and authentication using
client certificates. See “Importing CA Certificates” on page 74 for more details.
Server Certificates
To manage the SSL server certificates used to access WorkPlace and AMC, click SSL Settings in
the main navigation menu in AMC. This is where you view, import, and delete SSL and CA
certificates.
Certificate Strategy
There are two types of certificates: commercial and self-signed.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
67
z
A commercial CA verifies your company’s identity, vouching for your identity by providing you
with a certificate that the CA signs. A CA need not be commercial or third-party—a company
can be its own CA. Commercial certificates are purchased from a CA such as VeriSign
(http://www.verisign.com), and are usually valid for one year.
z
With a self-signed SSL certificate, you are verifying your own identity. The associated private
key data is encrypted using a password. A self-signed certificate can also be a wildcard
certificate, allowing it to be used by multiple servers which share the same IP address and
certificate, but have different FQDNs. Although this kind of certificate is secure, a self-signed
certificate is not in the browser’s built-in list of CAs, so the user is prompted to accept it before
each connection. There are a few ways to avoid this prompting:
{
Configure the SonicWALL clients to use the certificate root file.
{
Add the self-signed certificate to the user’s list of Trusted Root Certificate Authorities in the
Web browser.
{
Use a commercial CA, which is widely trusted by default.
When deciding which type of certificate to use for the servers, consider who will be connecting to
the appliance and how they will use resources on your network:
z
If business partners are connecting to Web resources through the appliance, they will likely
want some assurance of your identity before performing a transaction or providing confidential
information. In this case, you would probably want to obtain a certificate from a commercial CA
for the appliance.
On the other hand, employees connecting to Web resources may trust a self-signed certificate.
Even then, you may want to obtain a third-party certificate so that users are not prompted to
accept a self-signed certificate each time they connect.
z
!
To accommodate users who connect to the appliance from small form factor devices, configure
the appliance with a certificate from a leading CA (such as VeriSign), or import the root
certificate from your CA to your users’ small form factor devices.
CAUTION: When the appliance is configured with a certificate from a CA that is not well
known, or one that is self-signed, small form factor device users may see an error message
and be unable to log in. Windows Mobile-powered devices, for example, are configured with
the root files for only VeriSign, CyberTrust, Thawte, and Entrust. For more information on
small form factor devices, see “WorkPlace and Small Form Factor Devices” on page 305.
Obtaining a Certificate from a Commercial CA
Obtaining a certificate from a commercial CA provides verification of your identity for people who
connect to your network through the appliance. You must perform several steps to obtain and
configure a certificate from a commercial CA:
Submit the CSR
to a CA
Add CA's root file
to CSR response
Submit the CSR to a
commercial certificate
authority (CA)
(Optional) If the CA didn't
include a trusted root file in
the CSR response, add it
Configure
Aventail clients
Apply
your changes
Import the CSR
response
Configure Aventail Connect
client to use the trusted
root file
This restarts the services to
activate the certificates
Import the CSR response into
AMC to create a certificate
Generate a CSR
Create a certificate
signing request (CSR)
68
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
These six steps describe how to obtain a commercial certificate.
Step 1: Generate a Certificate Signing Request
Using AMC, you can generate a certificate signing request (CSR). This process creates an RSA key
pair that will be used to secure server information, and a CSR containing your public key and
identity information. The information you provide is used by the commercial CA to generate your
certificate, and may be visible to users who connect to the appliance.
X
To generate a CSR
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click SSL Settings.
2. In the SSL certificates area, click Edit.
3. In the Certificate signing requests list, click New. The Create Certificate Signing
Request page appears.
4. The Certificate information you fill out is stored in the CSR and used by the commercial CA
when generating your certificate; it may be visible to users who connect to the appliance.
a. In the Fully qualified domain name box, type the server name as you want it to appear
in the certificate. Also known as a “common name” (or CN), this is usually composed of a
host and a domain name; for example, you might type vpn.example.com.
Users with a Web-based client will use this name to access the appliance (in other words,
to access WorkPlace), so it’s best to use a name that is easily remembered. You’ll also
reference this name when configuring the Connect or OnDemand components to provide
access to TCP/IP resources. You must add this name to your external DNS to make the
appliance accessible to users.
b. In the Organizational unit box, type your division or department name (for example, IT
Department).
c. In the Organization box, type your company or organization name as you want it to
appear in your SSL certificate.
d. In the Locality box, type the name of your city or town. Spell out the name in full (don’t
use an abbreviation).
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
69
e. In the State box, type the name of your state or province. Spell out the name in full (don’t
use an abbreviation).
f. In the Country box, type the two-letter abbreviation for your country. For a list of valid
country codes, see the International Organization for Standardization (ISO) Web site at
http://www.iso.org and search for ISO 3166-1.
g. In the Key length list, select the key length you want to use for the key: 512, 768, 1024
(the default), 1280, or 1536. Larger keys increase security, but make the appliance run
more slowly. A key length of 1024 or 1280 is recommended for most installations.
5. Review the information to verify that you’ve typed it correctly, and then click Save to generate
the CSR. The Create Certificate Signing Request page appears.
6. Copy the contents of the CSR text from AMC to the clipboard or into a text file, and then click
OK.
Notes
z
Some commercial CAs may have problems reading CSRs that contain characters produced by
pressing the SHIFT key, such as “&” or “!”. For example, when specifying your company name
or other information, you may want to spell out “&” (if used) as “and”.
Step 2: Submit the CSR to a Commercial CA
The process of submitting a CSR will vary, depending on which commercial CA you choose. VeriSign
is a popular commercial CA that provides SSL certificates through their Secure Site Services; for
information see http://www.verisign.com.
X
To submit a CSR to a commercial CA
1. Copy the contents of your certificate signing request from the Create Certificate Signing
Request page in AMC.
2. Submit it to the CA using the method they request (usually you either copy and paste the CSR
text into a form on the CA’s Web site, or attach it to an email message).
Depending on what is specified by the CA, you may need to paste all the text, or only the text
between the BEGIN NEW CERTIFICATE REQUEST and END NEW CERTIFICATE REQUEST banners
(including the banners themselves). If you’re not sure, contact the CA.
70
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
3. Wait for the commercial CA to verify your identity. You may be asked to produce one or more
documents attesting to your corporate identity (such as a business license or article of
incorporation).
Notes
z
Submit your CSR only once; you may otherwise be billed twice by the CA. This would also
change the internal private key, making the response from the CA unusable.
Step 3: Review CSR Response and Add CA’s Root Certificate
After you’ve submitted your CSR, you must wait for the CA to verify your identity. After they
complete this process, the CA will send you the certificate reply. It is usually in one of two formats:
z
A file attached to an email message. In this case, you can save the file to your local file
system (the one from which you’ll access AMC) and then import it into AMC.
z
Text embedded within an email message. In this case, you copy the text and paste it into
a text box provided in AMC. Be sure to include the BEGIN CERTIFICATE and END CERTIFICATE
banners.
If the CA does not provide a full certificate chain in the CSR response (a common practice), AMC
will try to complete the certificate chain when you import the CSR response. If it is unable to
complete the chain, AMC displays an error message. If this occurs, you must upload the CA’s root
certificate or any intermediary public certificates to the appliance. If you are acting as your own CA,
you will probably need to perform this step.
X
To complete a certificate chain
1. Obtain the trusted root certificate or intermediary public certificate from the CA. Most external
commercial CAs provide the certificates on their Web site; if the CA is run by your company,
check with the server administrator.
2. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click SSL Settings.
3. In the SSL certificates area, click Edit.
4. In the Certificate signing requests list, click the Process CSR response link for the
appropriate certificate. The Import CSR Certificate page appears.
5. Upload the certificate:
{
If the certificate is in binary format, click Browse and then upload the certificate reply
from your local file system (that is, the computer from which you’ve logged in to AMC).
{
If the certificate is in base-64 encoded (PEM) text format, click Certificate text and then
paste the certificate into the text box. Be sure to include the BEGIN CERTIFICATE and END
CERTIFICATE banners.
6. Click Import to return to the CA Certificates page.
7. To verify that the certificate was properly uploaded, click CA Certificate. The new certificate
should appear on the CA Certificates page.
Step 4: Import the CSR Response Into AMC
To create a certificate, import the CSR response into AMC.
X
To import a certificate reply
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click SSL Settings.
2. In the SSL certificates area, click Edit.
3. In the Certificate signing requests list, click the Process CSR response link for the
appropriate certificate.
4. Upload the certificate on the Import CSR Certificate page:
{
If the certificate is in binary format, click Browse and then upload the certificate reply
from your local file system (that is, the computer from which you have logged in to AMC).
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
{
|
71
If the certificate is in base-64 encoded (PEM) text format, select Certificate text and
paste the certificate into the text box. Be sure to include the BEGIN CERTIFICATE and END
CERTIFICATE banners.
5. In the Used by list, select AMC or WorkPlace/access methods (select None if you want to build
a list of certificates from which to choose later). If you defined additional WorkPlace sites (in
addition to the default WorkPlace site), their names are included in this list.
6. Click Save.
7. To verify that the certificate was properly uploaded, click the plus sign (+) next to it on the
SSL Certificates page.
Step 5: Apply Your Changes
To start using a new certificate, you need to apply your configuration changes. For more
information, see “Applying Configuration Changes” on page 52.
After applying the change, the appliance examines the new certificate and begins using it for all
new connections. If the appliance fails to correctly process the certificate, you see a failure message
and the event log records information about the failure. Typically, this occurs if there is no
certificate, the certificate has expired (or is not yet valid), or the cached password in the encrypted
password file is incorrect.
Notes
z
If your users authenticate using digital certificates, you must configure a trusted root file on the
server as well as on the clients. See “Configuring Client Certificate Revocation” on page 75.
Creating a Self-Signed Certificate
If you plan to use a self-signed SSL certificate (instead of obtaining a certificate from a commercial
CA), you can create one using AMC. A host is not selected for the certificate, because there is no
one to one mapping of certificates to hosts. Wildcard certificates allow one certificate to map to
multiple hosts.
X
To create a self-signed certificate
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click SSL Settings.
2. In the SSL certificates area, click Edit.
3. Click New and then select Create self-signed certificate from the menu.
4. In the Fully qualified domain name box, type a wildcard domain name such as
*.sonicwall.com, or type the individual server name as you want it to appear in the certificate:
{
The main appliance certificate can be a wildcard certificate, or you might type something
like vpn.example.com. You must add this name to your external DNS to make the
appliance accessible to users.
This is the name users will enter for access to Web-based resources on your network. For
a wildcard certificate, the “*” matches any string of characters up to the dot, such as
specific server names. You will also reference this name when configuring the Connect
clients to provide access to TCP/IP resources.
{
If this certificate will be used by AMC (as opposed to WorkPlace), you might type
something like amc.example.com. In most cases, you should add this name to your
internal DNS to simplify access to AMC.
5. In the Organization box, type the company or organization name as you want it to appear in
your SSL certificate.
6. In the Country box, type the two-letter abbreviation for your country. For a list of valid
country codes, go to the International Organization for Standardization (ISO) Web site at
http://www.iso.org and look for information on ISO 3166-1.
7. Click Save.
8. Click Pending changes and then apply the changes. (For more information, see “Applying
Configuration Changes” on page 52.)
72
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
Creating the Trusted Root File for a Self-Signed Certificate
If you use a self-signed certificate, you will probably want to provide your users with a trusted root
file (otherwise they will see a security prompt at every login).
X
To create a trusted root file for a self-signed certificate
1. Log in to the appliance.
2. Make a copy of the server.cert file, which is located in /usr/local/extranet/etc.
3. Open the copied file in a text editor and remove everything except the root certificate. The file
will contain one or more certificates as well as the private key. The root certificate is the last
certificate block in the file, including the banners. In the following example, you would delete
the first certificate block and the private key block:
Certificate 1
Root certificate
Private key
The resulting file looks like this:
4. Distribute this file to your users. This increases security and prevents users from being
prompted to accept the SSL certificate each time they connect. See “Importing CA
Certificates” on page 74.
{
If you want increased security for your Web-based users, this file should be imported into
the browsers for these users.
Notes
z
Setup Tool creates a self-signed certificate for AMC. For most deployments, this self-signed
certificate is sufficient and there is no need to obtain a certificate from a commercial CA. It is
important, however, to use AMC within a trusted network. Self-signed certificates protect
against passive eavesdroppers but not against active attackers.
z
If you’re deploying OnDemand for Microsoft Internet Explorer users on Apple Macintosh
systems, you must obtain a commercial SSL certificate. A self-signed certificate will not work
because the Macintosh Java Virtual Machine (JVM) won’t accept a certificate signed from an
unknown CA.
Managing Server Certificates
This section describes tasks related to managing SSL certificates in AMC.
Importing an Existing Certificate from Another Computer
If you already have a certificate from a commercial CA, you may want to transfer it and its private
key to the appliance. After you import the certificate, it will be used by the servers to secure user
traffic on the appliance.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
73
A host is not selected for the certificate, because there is no one to one mapping of certificates to
hosts. Wildcard certificates allow one certificate to map to multiple hosts.
The appliance stores certificates in the PKCS #12 format. If your certificate is stored in a different
format, convert it to PKCS #12 before importing. After performing the conversion, confirm that the
PKCS #12 file contains the complete certificate chain.
X
To transfer an existing certificate to the appliance
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click SSL Settings.
2. In the SSL certificates area, click Edit.
3. Click New, and then select Import certificate from the menu.
4. On the Import Certificate page, click Browse and then upload the certificate from your local
file system (that is, the computer from which you have logged in to AMC).
5. In the Password box, type the password that was used to encrypt the private key.
6. Click Save.
The appliance uses the previous certificate until you apply your configuration changes.
Exporting an SSL Certificate
You can export the SSL certificate used to secure user traffic on the appliance. It will include the
private key and be saved in PKCS #12 format.
X
To export the SSL certificate from the appliance
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click SSL Settings.
2. In the SSL certificates area, click Edit.
3. Select the check box next to the certificate you want to export, and then click Export. The
Export Certificate page appears.
4. In the Password box, type the password that you want to use to encrypt the private key.
5. Click Save, and then download the certificate file to your local file system (that is, the
computer from which you’ve logged into AMC).
6. Click OK.
CA Certificates
Every CA requires a certificate so that it can be “trusted” by entities that request digital certificates
from it. If a client trusts a CA certificate, it automatically trusts any other certificates that are issued
by that CA. CA certificates thus form one of the foundations of public key cryptography. The CA
certificate is either signed by the CA itself (a “root certificate”), or by a higher authority in a
hierarchy of CAs in a public key infrastructure (an “intermediate CA certificate”).
The appliance uses CA certificates to secure the following:
z
Connections to a back-end LDAP or AD authentication server
z
Connections to a back-end HTTPS Web server
z
Device profiling (End Point Control), to verify the validity of certificates submitted by users who
connect to the appliance. See Client certificate in “Device Profile Attributes” on page 267 for
more information.
74
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
The appliance includes over 100 public root certificates from leading commercial CAs. If you’ve
obtained a certificate from a commercial CA, its root certificate or intermediary public certificate is
probably already installed on the appliance. However, if you are acting as your own CA you must
import a root or intermediary public certificate to the appliance. To view the list of certificates, click
Edit in the CA Certificates area of the SSL Settings page. This is also where you delete CA
certificates.
Importing CA Certificates
If the appliance is not configured with the necessary CA certificate, you must obtain a copy and
import it to the appliance using AMC. The procedure is the same, whether the certificate will be used
to secure connections to back-end resources, or to authenticate users by means of a client
certificate.
X
To import a CA certificate to the appliance
1. Obtain the trusted root certificate or intermediary public certificate from the CA. Most external
commercial CAs provide the certificates on their Web sites; if the CA is run by your company,
check with the server administrator.
2. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click SSL Settings.
3. In the CA Certificates area, click Edit.
4. Click New. The Import CA Certificate page appears.
5. Do one of the following:
{
If the certificate is in binary format, click Browse and then upload the certificate reply
from your local file system (that is, the computer from which you’ve logged in to AMC).
{
If the certificate is in base-64 encoded (PEM) text format, click Certificate text and then
paste the certificate into the text box. Be sure to include the BEGIN CERTIFICATE and END
CERTIFICATE banners.
6. Specify the connection types this certificate will be used to secure:
Connection type
Description
Authentication server
connections (LDAPS)
Securing your LDAP or Active Directory (AD) connection with SSL
enhances security by preventing attempts to impersonate the LDAP
or AD server. To configure LDAP or AD over SSL, you must add the
root certificate for the CA that granted your LDAP or AD certificate
to the SSL trusted roots file.
Web server connections If you have a back-end Web resource that is secured with SSL (that
(HTTPS)
is, it uses HTTPS instead of HTTP), configure the Web proxy service
to verify the root certificate presented by the back-end server. This
important security check will help ensure that you can trust the
identity of the back-end server. See “Configuring the Web Proxy
Service” on page 356 for details.
If the back-end server’s root certificate is not pre-installed on the
appliance, you must obtain a copy and import it in AMC.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
75
Connection type
Description
Device profiling
(End Point Control)
EPC can be used to verify the validity of certificates submitted by
users who connect to the appliance. If a client certificate is used in
a device profile to classify users into an EPC zone, the appliance
must be configured with the root or intermediary certificates for the
CA that issued the client certificate to your users.
When the appliance interrogates the user’s computer to determine
if the specified certificate is present, it can be configured to search
just the system store
(HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\SystemCertificates), or also include
the user store (HKCU\Software\Microsoft\SystemCertificates).
7. Click Import. The CA Certificates page appears and displays a confirmation message.
8. The new certificate appears in the alphabetical list on the CA Certificates page. When you
upload a CA certificate for use with client certificate authentication (and you apply the
change), network services are automatically restarted and user connections are terminated,
forcing users to reauthenticate. You may want to schedule the change during off-peak hours.
Notes
z
If the certificate is being used to secure authentication server connections, check to see that
the appropriate LDAP over SSL or Active Directory over SSL settings are enabled on the
Configure Authentication Server page in AMC.
z
By default, the Web proxy service is configured to verify the root certificate presented by backend HTTPS Web servers. This important security check helps ensure that you can trust the
identity of the back-end server. See “Configuring the Web Proxy Service” on page 356.
z
If you do not want to trust a CA listed on the CA Certificates page, select the check box next
to it, and then click Delete.
z
When setting up devices profiles, avoid checking for client certificates within the same zone
more than three times. If there are multiple EPC checks for client certificates within the same
zone, users may see an error message (“An error was encountered encoding data to be sent to
the Logon Server”).
Configuring Client Certificate Revocation
Certificates installed on client devices can be used to authenticate users or devices, giving them
access to a particular realm. A certificate is usually valid until it expires, but it is possible for it to
be compromised before it expires. For example, a CA may decide that a certificate was improperly
issued, or its private key may have been compromised. You can consult a certificate revocation list
(CRL) to check a certificate’s validity (its location—the CRL distribution point, or CDP—is typically
included in the X.509 certificate). If a certificate is no longer valid, the user is denied access.
Use the Manage CA Certificate page in AMC to configure certificate revocation checking for
individual certificates, and determine the connection types the certificate is used to secure.
X
To verify the validity of a client certificate and configure certificate revocation
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click SSL Settings.
2. Under CA Certificates, click Edit.
76
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
3. To see details about a certificate, click the plus sign (+) next to it in the Issued To list. To edit
a certificate, click its link. For example, click the plus sign next to “Thawte Server CA” to see
details about this certificate from Thawte Consulting, and click the link to edit it.
4. In the Used for area, specify the connection types this certificate is used to secure.
{
Authentication server connections (LDAPS)—See “Configuring a PKI Authentication
Server” on page 103.
{
Web server connections (HTTPS)—See “CA Certificates” on page 73.
{
Device profiling (End Point Control)—See Client certificate in “Device Profile
Attributes” on page 267.
5. To specify CRL settings, click Certificate revocation list (CRL) in the Certificate
revocation checking area. The format for the CRL must be DER-based (.crl); the appliance
cannot use a CRL that's been created in PEM format.
6. The appliance retrieves lists (using LDAP or HTTP) of revoked certificates from a CRL
distribution point (CDP). Specify the location of this CDP:
{
The CDP is usually specified in the certificate itself. In this case, click Use CDP from
client certificate.
{
Alternatively you can specify a URL for it. Click Use remote CDP; if a login is required for
it, type the credentials.
7. If Use remote CDP is selected, you can specify how often the CRL should be retrieved using
the Download CRL every <n> hours option. If you don’t specify a download interval, a new
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
77
CRL is retrieved when the old one expires. (CRLs are updated frequently so that when a
certificate is revoked, that information is distributed in a timely manner.)
8. The appliance checks client certificates against this list. To perform CRL checking for the entire
chain of certificates, starting with the CA root certificate, select the Validate the entire chain
check box.
9. Specify whether users should be allowed or denied access if the CDP is inaccessible by
selecting Allow user access or Block user access. The remote CDP you specified might be
offline, or it may not be indicated on the certificate. (It is an optional item for the X.509
standard, not a mandatory one.)
10. Click Save.
Managing CA Certificates
This section describes tasks related to managing certificates on the appliance; importing certificates
is described in “Importing CA Certificates” on page 74.
Viewing CA Certificate Details
You can view the details for the appliance certificate, such as the subject, issuer, start and end time,
serial number, and MD5 checksum. Details of a newly imported certificate are not available until you
have applied the configuration change.
X
To view CA certificate details
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click SSL Settings.
2. In the CA Certificates area, click Edit.
3. Click the plus sign (+) to the left of the certificate you want to see details about.
Mapping Certificates to Hosts
Since multiple hosts on the appliance may use a single wildcard certificate, the Certificate usages
table provides a mapping of a single certificate to multiple sets of hosts. A set of hosts is defined
as one or more WorkPlace sites, Exchange ActiveSync sites, or custom FQDN mapped resources
that are on the same IP address. Any given set of hosts must use the same wildcard certificate and
78
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
therefore are treated as a single item for mapping certificates in the Certificate usages table.
AMC is treated as a separate host even if it is on the same IP address as other hosts on a singlehomed appliance.
X
To map a new certificate to a host or set of hosts
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click SSL Settings.
2. In the SSL Certificates area, click Edit.
3. In the Certificates column of the Certificate usages table, click on the certificate to activate
an in-place editor with a drop-down certificate selector.
4. Select the certificate. For individual hosts, all certificates are available for selection. For a set
of multiple hosts, only wildcard certificates are available for selection.
5. Click OK.
Exporting CA Certificates
You can export a CA certificate and its private key to your local computer. The certificate is saved
in PKCS #12 format.
X
To export a CA certificate
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click SSL Settings.
2. In the CA Certificates area, click Edit.
3. Select the check box to the left of the certificate you want to export.
4. Click Export.
5. In the Password text box, type the password that will encrypt the private key.
6. Click Save. The certificate is saved (by default) to a file named server_cert.p12.
Deleting CA Certificates
To make the list of certificates more manageable, you might want to delete those that you know
you will never need.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
79
To delete a CA certificate
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click SSL Settings.
2. In the CA Certificates area, click Edit.
3. Select the check box to the left of any certificates you want to delete.
4. Click Delete.
Certificate FAQ
This section addresses frequently asked questions about working with certificates.
How do I obtain a certificate from a non-commercial CA?
The process is identical to the one for obtaining a certificate from a commercial CA, except that you
submit the CSR to a non-commercial CA (such as a Microsoft Self-Signed Certificate Authority). This
part of the process is outlined in “Step 2: Submit the CSR to a Commercial CA” on page 69.
When do certificates and CRLs expire?
Self-signed certificates are valid for five years. The expiration date for third-party certificates varies,
depending on who issued the certificate; contact the CA for more information. A Certificate
Revocation List (CRL) is valid for a much shorter period of time: days, or even hours.
When using certificates and CRLs, it is important for the clock on the appliance to be accurate, since
it is used to determine when these items expire.
Are intermediate certificates supported for end user certificate verification?
Yes, intermediate certificates are supported for end user certificate verification. This covers PKI and
LDAP certificate methods. This allows an intermediate certifying authority to be imported to validate
a certificate chain, without requiring trust of the root certifying authority.
What are the different CA certificates on the appliance and how are they used?
To see the list of CA certificates available on the appliance, click SSL Settings on the main
navigation menu, and then click Edit in the CA Certificates area. By default, any certificate in the
list can be used to secure up to three connection types (authentication server, secure Web server,
and client certificate). Click on a certificate to set the connection types you want it to secure.
How many CA certificates can be stored on the appliance?
The roots file can contain as many certificates as you want to trust. For instructions on how to
import additional CA certificates, see “Importing CA Certificates” on page 74.
Can private keys or CSRs generated from other tools be imported to the appliance?
Private keys and CSRs must be generated on the appliance using Setup Tool or the certificate
generation tool. However, you can copy private keys and CSRs from one SonicWALL appliance to
another using the procedure described in “Managing Server Certificates” on page 72. Any copied
certificates are overwritten if you make changes to them in AMC.
Where is the AMC certificate stored?
AMC’s self-signed certificate is stored on the appliance in /usr/local/app/mgmtserver/sysconf/active/.
For AMC, a self-signed certificate is sufficient for most environments. It is important, however, to
use AMC within a trusted network. Self-signed certificates protect against passive eavesdroppers
but not against active attackers.
Should I keep all of the CA certificates on the appliance, or just the ones I need?
For the sake of convenience, the appliance includes more than 100 CA certificates. To make your
deployment more secure, you may want to pare this list down so that it includes only the CA
certificates you need for client certificates, LDAPS, and HTTPS. A shorter list is also easier to
manage.
80
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
Managing User Authentication
Authentication is the process of verifying a user’s identity to ensure that the individual really is who
he or she claims to be. (Authentication differs from authorization: it verifies identity, while
authorization specifies access rights.) This section describes how to reference external
authentication servers.
To manage user authentication, you must first define one or more external authentication servers
in AMC, and then set up realms that reference those authentication servers. These are the realms
that users will log in to. For information on realms, see “Using Realms and Communities” on
page 160. You can also configure a local authentication repository on the appliance for testing, as
described in “Configuring Local User Storage” on page 107.
About Intermediate Certificates
You can configure an authentication server to trust intermediate CAs without verifying the entire
chain. This provides benefits, such as distributing certificate management among several signing
authorities, several of whom might be remote to the root CA server and therefore would otherwise
be unable to issue certificates, and adds security because the compromise of any single signing
authority does not compromise the entire network.
To configure trusted intermediate certificates, see “Configuring a PKI Authentication Server” on
page 103.
For example, you could create a root certificate signing authority on a system that is not connected
to the corporate network. You can then issue a set of trusted intermediate signing authority
certificates to be deployed in various sectors of the network (often by department or organizational
unit). For the VPN, this is most often done to distribute machine or personal certificates to client
systems.
The other alternative is to obtain a signing certificate from a certificate authority such as VeriSign
or Thawte. In this case, your main CA is actually an intermediate CA itself.
By SSL rules, the root CA certificate must be accessible in order to validate the entire chain.
However, the appliance makes no distinction between importing a CA certificate for trust and
importing a CA certificate to validate a certificate chain for the intermediate CA that you want the
appliance to trust. If no options are selected when a CA certificate is imported, the CA will only be
used to validate certificate chains. (The options are the connection types the certificate is used to
secure: Authentication server connections (LDAPS), Web server connections (HTTPS), and Device
profiling (End Point Control)). Any CA certificate used only to validate certificate chains is not
offered as a trusted signer during client certificate authentication or EPC certificate enforcement.
When an end user presents a client certificate signed by an intermediate CA, assuming the
appliance trusts the signing authority, the user is allowed to authenticate and access resources
normally.
When an end user presents a client certificate issued by a root CA of the trusted intermediate CA,
unless the administrator has also imported the root CA for trust purposes, the end user
authentication attempt fails due to lack of valid and trusted certificate.
If a client presents a certificate that is signed by a CA that exists only for chain validation, the
certificate will be rejected. This results in an authentication failure or a failure for certificate
authentication and in a failure to match the device profile for certificate EPC.
Configuring Authentication Servers
Setting up authentication involves the following: a directory (such as LDAP or Microsoft Active
Directory), an authentication method (username/password, token or smart card, or digital
certificate), and other configuration items that make the authentication process unique (for
example, an LDAP search base, or adding custom prompts and messages). The SonicWALL
appliance supports the leading authentication directories and methods.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
81
After you reference an authentication server in a realm and associate users with the realm, the
appliance checks users’ credentials against the credentials stored in the specified authentication
repository. You can also set up chained (two-factor) authentication; see “Configuring Chained
Authentication” on page 109 for details.
X
To configure an authentication server
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Authentication Servers, and then click New.
2. In the User store area, specify the directory type or authentication method you want to
configure:
Authentication directory
Microsoft Active Directory
Credential type
For more information
z
Username/password
“Configuring Microsoft Active
Directory Servers” on page 83
z
Username/password
z
Digital certificate
“Configuring LDAP and LDAPS
Authentication” on page 94
z
Username/password
z
Token-based
authentication (such as
SecurID or SoftID)
RSA Authentication Manager
Server
z
Token-based
authentication (such as
SecurID or SoftID)
“Configuring RSA Server
Authentication” on page 102
Public key infrastructure
(PKI)
z
Digital certificate (with
optional certificate
revocation checking)
“Configuring a PKI
Authentication Server” on
page 103
and
Microsoft Active Directory Tree
LDAP
RADIUS
“Configuring RADIUS
Authentication” on page 99
82
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
Authentication directory
Credential type
For more information
RSA ClearTrust
(single sign-on)
z
N/A
“Configuring a Single Sign-On
Authentication Server” on
page 104
Local users
(local user storage)
z
Username/password—
used primarily for
testing purposes and not
recommended in a
production environment
“Configuring Local User
Storage” on page 107
3. Select the Credential type of the authentication server (what types are available depends on
the User store you selected).
4. Click Continue. For information about the next step in the configuration process, follow the
link for the User store you selected in the previous step.
Defining Multiple Authentication Servers
The SonicWALL appliance supports the definition and use of multiple authentication servers. A realm
references one or two authentication servers and determines which access agents are provisioned
to your users and what End Point Control restrictions (if any) are imposed. See “Overview: Users,
Groups, Communities, and Realms” on page 159 for more about realms.
Following are examples of using multiple authentication servers referenced by realms:
z
Chained authentication (two authentication servers)
Example: RADIUS with Token/SecurID and LDAP with username/password
Users logging in to a realm are authenticated against two servers. You can configure AMC so
that users see only one prompt. See “Configuring Chained Authentication” on page 109 for
details.
z
Use different servers to handle authentication and authorization
Example: RADIUS with Token/SecurID and Active Directory (for group information)
The user authenticates against one repository, and then the user’s group information is passed
from a second one. For more information, see “Enabling Group Affinity Checking in a Realm”
on page 112.
z
Multiple credential types and a single authentication server
Example: RADIUS with username/password and RADIUS with Token/SecurID
Suppose your company employees log in with usernames and passwords, but the employees
of your call-center log in with SecurID tokens. You could create an employee realm and a
callcenter realm, each referencing the appropriate credential type and RADIUS server.
z
Multiple instances of the same directory/authentication method using different backend servers
Example: Two RADIUS/password instances using different RADIUS servers
In this case you would define two authentication servers, each with the appropriate server
information.
z
Multiple instances of the same directory/authentication method on the same server,
configured differently
Example: Two instances of LDAP with username/password on the same server but using
different search bases
In this case each realm would search a different subtree within the directory. For example,
suppose Partner A is in one LDAP subtree and Partner B is in another. You could define a
partnerA realm and a partnerB realm, each configured with the appropriate search base.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
83
Disabling Authorization Checks
You can optionally disable the querying of group information used for authorization when
configuring an authentication server. A Use this authentication server to check group
membership check box is available for each server type that can contain group information used
for authorization, including Active Directory, Active Directory Tree, and LDAP servers.
Usually, when you use a directory server as part of authentication, you also want the group
information stored there to be used in policy authorization. However, in some cases a directory
server is used for secondary authentication and does not contain group information. In other cases,
the secondary authentication server does not use the same identifier for the user.
If a group query is made on both a primary and a secondary server, the authentication process takes
longer. However, if the user name is different on the two servers, a group query using the name
from the primary server will result in an error from the secondary server. Since the appliance policy
always defaults to closed, such an error will result in any deny rule being applied to the end user.
By disabling group authorization checks on the secondary server, you can avoid these problems.
If group checking is disabled for an authentication server, the server will not be available in the list
of available affinity servers on the realm configuration page. Conversely, if an authentication server
is in use as an affinity server for any realm, group checking cannot be disabled for that
authentication server. See “Enabling Group Affinity Checking in a Realm” on page 112 for more
information.
Configuring Microsoft Active Directory Servers
The appliance can validate username/password credentials against Microsoft Active Directory (AD)
configured with either a single root domain, or one or more subordinate (child) domains. The
following illustration shows typical Active Directory configuration options:
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class
SRA Appliance
Credentials
SSL (port 443)
Username
Password
LDAP (port 389)
LDAPS (port 636)
Internet
Firewall
Microsoft Active
Directory
To specify a single root domain with one or more
subordinate (or “child”) child domains, select Microsoft
Active Directory Tree as the authentication directory.
The AD tree choice uses additional ports that facilitate
searching and logons:
Subordinate
or child domain
Subordinate
or child domain
Е‚ Global catalog (3268/tcp)
Е‚ Global catalog, using SSL to secure the
directory server connection (3269/tcp)
Е‚ Kerberos (88/tcp)
You must modify your firewall or router to allow the appliance to communicate with your AD server.
The appliance uses standard LDAP and LDAPS ports to communicate with Active Directory:
z
LDAP (389/tcp)
z
LDAP over SSL (636/tcp)
With Microsoft Active Directory Tree there are additional ports, which facilitate searches and logons:
z
Global catalog (3268/tcp)
z
Global catalog using SSL (3269/tcp)
z
Kerberos (88/tcp)
84
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
After configuring an AD server, you can validate the realm configuration settings by establishing a
test connection. For more information, see “Testing LDAP and AD Authentication Configurations” on
page 108.
Configuring Active Directory with Username and Password
Perform the following steps to configure an Active Directory authentication server with
username/password validation.
Notes
z
If you are using Active Directory with digital certificates, you must configure AD as an LDAP
realm. See “Configuring LDAP to Authenticate Against Active Directory” on page 92.
z
If your AD authentication server has subordinate (child) domains, see “Configuring Active
Directory with Subordinate Domains” on page 88 for more information.
X
To configure Active Directory
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Authentication Servers, and then click New.
2. Under User store, click Microsoft Active Directory.
3. The only Credential type that is available for AD is Username/Password. Click Continue.
The Configure Authentication Server page appears.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
85
4. In the Name box, type a name for the authentication server.
5. In the Primary domain controller box, type the IP address or host name of the AD domain
controller. If you are using a failover server (optional), specify its address in the Secondary
domain controller box.
If the AD server is listening on a something other than the well-known port (389 for
unencrypted connections, or 636 for SSL connections), specify a port number as a colondelimited suffix (for example, ad.example.com:1300).
6. To specify a particular AD domain, type it in the Active Directory domain name box. This
should be the domain that you want to use as the search base (in other words, the domain
that contains the appropriate cn=users container). For example, if you want to search a single
domain such as marketing, type marketing.example.com. If you want to search your entire
company’s domain, type example.com. If you do not specify a domain, the appliance searches
the first available default naming context on the domain controller.
7. To perform AD searches, the appliance must log in to Active Directory (unless you have
configured AD to allow anonymous searches). In the Login name box, type the username or
sAMAccountname attribute used to log in to the Windows domain (such as jdoe or
[email protected]).
The login should be for a user who has privileges to perform searches and view user records,
such as the administrator on that domain controller. You may also specify a non-administrator
user who has these privileges.
If you specify an AD domain, the appliance searches that domain for users. If you do not
specify a domain, the appliance searches the first available default naming context on the
domain controller. If the user information is not stored in either of these locations, you need to
configure this realm as an LDAP realm. See “Configuring LDAP to Authenticate Against Active
Directory” on page 92.
8. Type the Password that corresponds to the Login name. After you’ve entered credentials,
you can click the Test button for each server you specified in order to test the connection.
9. Complete the information listed under Group lookup:
{
To enable group checking on this server, select the Use this authentication server to
check group membership check box. When this box is unchecked, the nested controls
are disabled because they apply only to group checking behavior. This check box, when
unselected, allows an authentication server for LDAP, AD, or AD-Tree to be configured
without enabling it for authorization checks. This improves efficiency by allowing better
stacked/affinity authentication support.
{
To specify the depth of the search (how many sub-groups to include in it), enter a number
in the Nested group lookup check box. Be aware that this type of search can take some
time because it requires searching the entire Active Directory tree; enabling Cache group
checking is highly recommended.
{
To reduce the load on your directory and get better performance, cache the attribute
group or static group search results. Select the Cache group checking check box and
then specify a Cache lifetime, in seconds. The default value is 1800 seconds (30
minutes).
10. To secure the AD connection with SSL, expand the Active Directory over SSL area, and the
configure the following settings:
a. Select the Use SSL to secure Active Directory connection check box.
86
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
b. To view your certificate details and to verify that the root certificate can be used by the
appliance, click the SSL Settings link. This list should show the name of the CA (or CAs)
that issued the client certificates and the SSL certificates. If your AD server’s CA is not
listed in the file, or if you use a self-signed certificate, you must add your certificate to this
file. See “Importing CA Certificates” on page 74 for details.
c. To have the appliance verify that the AD domain controller host name is the same as the
name in the certificate presented by the Active Directory server, select the Match
certificate CN against Active Directory domain controller check box. Typically, your
server name will match the name specified in its digital certificate. If this is the case with
your server, SonicWALL recommends enabling this option in a production environment.
This makes it more difficult for an unauthorized server to masquerade as your AD server if
your digital certificate or DNS server is compromised.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
87
11. In the Advanced area, you can specify a username attribute, set up custom prompts, enable
users to be notified of expiring Active Directory passwords, configure NTLM authentication
forwarding options, and set up one-time passwords.
12. Type the Username attribute you want to use to match usernames. In most AD
implementations, sAMAccountName matches the user ID (for example, jdoe). You can use cn
instead, but that would require the user to authenticate with his full name (John Doe) instead
of his user ID (jdoe).
13. To change the prompts and other text that Windows users see when they log in to the
authentication server, select the Customize authentication server prompts check box. If
users should log in using an employee ID, for example, you could change the text for the
Identity prompt from Username: to Employee ID:. (If you plan to use chained authentication,
customized password prompts are especially useful so that users can differentiate between
them.)
88
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
14. If the connection between the appliance and the authentication server is secured with SSL
(Use SSL to secure Active Directory connection is enabled), you can allow users to
change their passwords in WorkPlace by selecting Enable user-initiated password change.
15. To allow the Active Directory server to notify users that their passwords are going to expire,
select the Notify user before password expires check box. Indicate when the advance
notice should begin (the default is 14 days, and the maximum is 30 days). The password
prompt users see is controlled by the AD server.
To allow users to manage their own passwords, select the Allow user to change password
when notified check box. This setting can be changed only if the Use SSL to secure Active
Directory connection check box in the Active Directory over SSL area is selected.
Password management is available only to users with Web access and those who are using
Connect Tunnel.
16. To enable NTLM authentication forwarding, click one of the NTLM authentication
forwarding options. For more information, see “NTLM Authentication Forwarding” on
page 105.
17. To configure authentication that includes an OTP, enable Use one-time passwords with
this authentication server. You must also configure your mail server: if OTPs are going to
be delivered to external domains (for example, an SMS address or external webmail address),
you may have to configure the SMTP server to allow passwords to be sent from the appliance
to the external domain.
{
In the Primary email address attribute box, enter the directory attribute for the email
address to which one-time passwords will be sent. If the primary attribute exists on the
authentication server, it is used.
{
The Secondary email address attribute, if specified, is used if the primary email
address attribute cannot be found.
To have OTPs sent as a text message (instead of an email message), enter the corresponding
attribute name (for example, SMSphone instead of Mail). See “Configuring the AD or LDAP
Directory Server” on page 113 for more information.
18. Click Save.
Notes
z
The Login name and Password fields are not always required to connect to an Active
Directory server. However, if they are not provided (or you don’t specify a password) the
appliance will bind anonymously. In this case, if you have not configured Active Directory to
allow anonymous searches, the search will fail.
z
Users must have permission on the AD server to change their passwords during the password
notification period, and the administrator must have permission to change user passwords after
they expire. For security reasons, both of these operations replace passwords rather than reset
them.
z
If you define multiple Active Directory with SSL servers, you should specify the same Match
certificate CN against Active Directory domain controller setting for each server.
(SonicWALL recommends enabling this option for a production environment.) Although AMC
allows you to configure this setting on a per-realm basis, the appliance actually uses the setting
specified in the last loaded ADS realm. For example, if you select this check box for three ADS
realms, but clear it for a fourth, the functionality would be disabled for all four realms.
!
CAUTION If Active Directory over SSL is not enabled, passwords are transmitted in the
clear to the AD server. If the internal network is not trusted, you should enable SSL. Your AD
server must also be enabled to use SSL. See the Microsoft AD documentation for details.
Configuring Active Directory with Subordinate Domains
Perform the following steps to configure authentication settings for a Microsoft Active Directory
server that has a single root domain and one or more child domains in the AD tree. In a given
deployment, only one AD authentication server with subordinate domains can be specified. In
addition, a domain name server must be configured before the appliance can support an AD tree
authentication server; see “Configuring Domain Name Service” on page 65.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
89
Notes
z
If you are using Active Directory with digital certificates, you must configure AD as an LDAP
realm. See “Configuring LDAP to Authenticate Against Active Directory” on page 92.
z
If your AD authentication server does not have any subordinate (child) domains, see
“Configuring Active Directory with Username and Password” on page 84 for information on
configuring it in AMC.
X
To configure Active Directory Tree
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Authentication Servers, and then click New.
2. Under User store, click Microsoft Active Directory Tree.
3. The only Credential type that is available for AD tree is Username/Password. Click
Continue. The Configure Authentication Server page appears.
4. In the Name box, type a name for the authentication server.
5. In the Root domain box, type the fully qualified name of the AD root domain. For example,
company.com.
90
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
6. In the Login name box, type a fully-qualified Windows domain username (for example,
[email protected]). The login should be for a user who has read access to the entire
domain tree, such as the administrator on that domain controller. You may also specify a nonadministrator user who has these privileges.
7. Type the Password that corresponds to the Login name. After you’ve entered credentials,
you can click the Test button for the root domain controller to test the connection.
8. Specify a combination of user authentication options:
{
Users can enter a domain name
If this is the only option you specify, users must type a domain name during
authentication; for example, [email protected]
{
Specify a default domain
To allow users to log in without entering or specifying a domain, select this option. The
VPN will assume the domain you specify here and try to authenticate the user.
{
Users can choose from a list of domains
To display all of the domains that belong to this root domain, click Load all domains. You
can select all or some of the domains users will be able to choose from, and rearrange the
order of the list.
9. Complete the information listed under Group lookup:
{
To enable group checking on this server, select the Use this authentication server to
check group membership check box. When this box is unchecked, the nested controls
are disabled because they apply only to group checking behavior. This check box, when
unselected, allows an authentication server for LDAP, AD, or AD-Tree to be configured
without enabling it for authorization checks. This improves efficiency by allowing better
stacked/affinity authentication support.
{
To reduce the load on your directory and get better performance, cache the attribute
group or static group search results. Select the Cache group checking check box and
then specify a Cache lifetime, in seconds. The default value is 1800 seconds (30
minutes).
10. To secure the AD connection with SSL, expand the Active Directory over SSL area, and the
configure the following settings:
a. Select the Use SSL to secure Active Directory connection check box.
b. Every domain in the AD tree must have a certificate. To view your certificate details and to
verify that the root certificate can be used by the appliance, click the SSL Settings link.
This list should show the name of the CA (or CAs) that issued the client certificates and the
SSL certificates. If your AD server’s CA is not listed in the file, or if you use a self-signed
certificate, you must add your certificate to this file. See “Importing CA Certificates” on
page 74 for details.
c. To have the appliance verify that the AD domain controller host name is the same as the
name in the certificate presented by the Active Directory server, select the Match
certificate CN against Active Directory domain controller check box. Typically, your
server name will match the name specified in its digital certificate. If this is the case with
your server, SonicWALL recommends enabling this option in a production environment.
This makes it more difficult for an unauthorized server to masquerade as your AD server if
your digital certificate or DNS server is compromised.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
91
11. In the Advanced area, you can specify a username attribute, set up custom prompts, enable
users to be notified of expiring Active Directory passwords, configure NTLM authentication
forwarding options, and set up one-time passwords.
12. Type the Username attribute you want to use to match usernames. In most AD
implementations, sAMAccountName matches the user ID (for example, jdoe). You can use cn
instead, but that would require the user to authenticate with his full name (John Doe) instead
of his user ID (jdoe).
13. To change the prompts and other text that Windows users see when they log in to the
authentication server, select the Customize authentication server prompts check box. If
users should log in using an employee ID, for example, you could change the text for the
Identity prompt from Username: to Employee ID:. (If you plan to use chained authentication,
customized password prompts are especially useful so that users can differentiate between
them.)
92
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
14. If you want to allow users to change their passwords in WorkPlace, select Enable userinitiated password change.
15. To allow the Active Directory server to notify users that their passwords are going to expire,
select the Notify user before password expires check box. Indicate when the advance
notice should begin (the default is 14 days, and the maximum is 30 days). The password
prompt users see is controlled by the AD server. Password management is available only to
users with Web access and those who are using Connect Tunnel.
16. To enable NTLM authentication forwarding, click one of the NTLM authentication
forwarding options. For more information, see “NTLM Authentication Forwarding” on
page 105.
17. To configure authentication that includes an OTP, enable Use one-time passwords with
this authentication server. You must also configure your mail server: if OTPs are going to
be delivered to external domains (for example, an SMS address or external webmail address),
you may have to configure the SMTP server to allow passwords to be sent from the appliance
to the external domain.
{
In the Primary email address attribute box, enter the directory attribute for the email
address to which one-time passwords will be sent. If the primary attribute exists on the
authentication server, it is used.
{
The Secondary email address attribute, if specified, is used if the primary email
address attribute cannot be found.
To have OTPs sent as a text message (instead of an email message), enter the corresponding
attribute name (for example, SMSphone instead of Mail). See “Configuring the AD or LDAP
Directory Server” on page 113 for more information.
18. Click Save.
Notes
z
The Login name and Password fields are not always required to connect to an Active
Directory server. However, if they are not provided (or you don’t specify a password) the
appliance will bind anonymously. In this case, if you have not configured Active Directory to
allow anonymous searches, the search will fail.
z
Users must have permission on the AD server to change their passwords during the password
notification period, and the administrator must have permission to change user passwords after
they expire. For security reasons, both of these operations replace passwords rather than reset
them.
z
If you define multiple Active Directory with SSL servers, you should specify the same Match
certificate CN against Active Directory domain controller setting for each server.
(SonicWALL recommends enabling this option for a production environment.) Although AMC
allows you to configure this setting on a per-realm basis, the appliance actually uses the setting
specified in the last loaded ADS realm. For example, if you select this check box for three ADS
realms, but clear it for a fourth, the functionality would be disabled for all four realms.
Configuring LDAP to Authenticate Against Active Directory
If you have customized Active Directory (by, for example, specifying a search base instead of using
the AD default), you need to authenticate to Active Directory using LDAP. The procedure for
configuring an LDAP server is defined in “Configuring LDAP and LDAPS Authentication” on page 94.
When configuring LDAP, you should pay special attention to the attributes you’re using to query the
directory. Because every implementation of AD is different, you must know how the object classes
and related attributes are configured in your Active Directory schema.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
93
The following table describes the key AD attributes used to validate username and password
credentials. The attributes are not case-sensitive.
Field
Description
Login DN
The DN used to establish a connection with your Active Directory server. In
a generic AD configuration located in the example.com domain, the DN for
a user named “John Doe” would be:
cn=John Doe,cn=users,dc=example,dc=com
Search base
The point in the AD directory from which you want to search for user
information. Usually, this is the lowest point in the directory tree that
contains user information. The user binding to AD must have permissions
to view the directory at this level.
For a generic installation, a search base of cn=users,dc=example,dc=com
will find most users. You may want to search from a higher level (such as
dc=example,dc=com) if some users are stored in a different branch.
Username attribute
The attribute used to match usernames. In most AD implementations,
sAMAccountName matches the user ID (for example, jdoe). You can use
cn instead, but that would require the user to authenticate with his full
name (John Doe) instead of his user ID (jdoe).
Notes
z
If you create an access control rule that references a group, a user must be an explicit member
of that group for his or her request to match the rule. To include nested groups when evaluating
group membership, make sure that Nested group lookup is set accordingly when you
configure the authentication server in AMC.
For example, assume that the SeattleCampus group contains a group called Marketing.
Employee John Doe is a member of the Marketing group, but is not explicitly a member of
SeattleCampus. If Nested group lookup is set to 0, the appliance will not recognize John Doe
as a member of the SeattleCampus group; if it is set to 1, he is recognized.
z
Microsoft provides a graphical tool that makes it easy to perform LDAP operations, including
connecting, browsing, and modifying a directory. The tool—called LDP (ldp.exe)—is available
with the Support Tools for the Windows Server platform; see the Microsoft Product Support site
for more information.
LDAP Examples for Active Directory Authentication
Here are a few LDAP configuration examples.
Example 1—Active Directory
Login DN
CN=AVtest,CN=Users,DC=testusrs,DC=example,DC=com
Search base
DC=testusrs,DC=example,DC=com
Username attribute
sAMAccountName
Example 2—Active Directory
Login DN
CN=johnDoe,CN=Users,DC=na,DC=example,DC=com
Search base
CN=Users,DC=na,DC=example,DC=com
Username attribute
sAMAccountname
Example 3—LDAP with Domino Server
Login DN
CN=SonicWALL,O=peoplesoft
94
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
Search base
o=peoplesoft
Username attribute
cn
Configuring LDAP and LDAPS Authentication
The SonicWALL appliance supports authentication using the LDAP or LDAPS (LDAP over SSL)
protocols. Either protocol can be used to validate username and password credentials. The following
illustration shows typical LDAP configuration options:
Credentials
SSL (port 443)
Username
Password
Digital
Certificate
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class
SRA Appliance
LDAP (port 389)
LDAPS (port 636)
Internet
Firewall
LDAP Directory
Securing your LDAP connection with SSL requires additional configuration. You must add the root
certificate of the CA that granted your LDAP certificate to the SSL trusted root file. This enhances
security by preventing attempts to impersonate your LDAP server. For more information, see
“Importing CA Certificates” on page 74.
After configuring an LDAP or LDAPS server, you can validate the realm configuration settings by
establishing a test connection. For more information, see “Testing LDAP and AD Authentication
Configurations” on page 108.
Notes
z
You must configure your firewall or router to allow the appliance to communicate with your
LDAP server. Standard LDAP uses port 389/tcp; LDAPS communicates over port 636/tcp.
z
Configuring an LDAP authentication server with digital certificate validation is offered for legacy
customers. New users should use the standard method described in “Configuring a PKI
Authentication Server” on page 103. The Trust intermediate CAs without verifying the
entire chain option is offered on the configuration pages for both the LDAP with Digital
Certificate option and the Public key infrastructure (PKI) option.
Configuring LDAP with Username and Password
Perform the following steps to configure an LDAP authentication server with username and
password validation.
X
To configure LDAP for username/password validation
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Authentication Servers, and then click New.
2. Under Authentication directory, click LDAP.
3. Under Credential type, click Username/Password, and then click Continue. The
Configure Authentication Server page appears.
4. In the Name box, type a name for the authentication server.
5. Complete the information listed under General:
{
In the Primary LDAP server box, type the host name or IP address of your LDAP server.
If you are using a failover server (optional), specify its address in the Secondary LDAP
server box.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
95
If the LDAP server is listening on a something other than the well-known port (389 for
unencrypted LDAP connections, or 636 for SSL connections), specify a port number as a
colon-delimited suffix (for example, myldap.example.com:1300).
{
In the Login DN box, type the distinguished name (DN) used to establish a connection
with the LDAP server.
{
In the Password box, type the password used to establish a connection with the LDAP
server.
{
In the Search base box, type the point in the LDAP directory from which you want to
begin searching for user information. This will usually be the lowest point in the directory
tree that contains user information. For example, you might type ou=Users,o=xyz.com.
The user binding to the LDAP directory must have permissions to view the directory at this
level.
{
In the Username attribute box, type the attribute used to match usernames. This is
usually cn or uid.
{
Click the Test button for each server you specified in order to test the connection.
6. Complete the information listed under Group lookup:
{
To enable group checking on this server, select the Use this authentication server to
check group membership check box. When this box is unchecked, the nested controls
are disabled because they apply only to group checking behavior. This check box, when
unselected, allows an authentication server for LDAP, AD, or AD-Tree to be configured
without enabling it for authorization checks. This improves efficiency by allowing better
stacked/affinity authentication support.
{
If you want the LDAP search to determine a user’s group membership by searching the
group attribute in the user container, select the Find groups in which a user is a
member check box and then type the Group attribute. This attribute is most often
memberOf. Do not select this check box unless attribute-based groups are supported by
and enabled on your LDAP server.
{
If your LDAP server does not support attribute-based groups or you have not enabled this
functionality, you can select the Look in static groups for user members check box; to
specify the depth of the search (how many sub-groups to include in the search), enter a
number in the Nested group lookup check box. Be aware that this type of search can
take some time because it requires searching the entire LDAP tree; enabling Cache group
checking is highly recommended.
{
To reduce the load on your directory and get better performance, cache the attribute
group or static group search results. Select the Cache group checking check box and
then specify a Cache lifetime, in seconds. The default value is 1800 seconds (30
minutes).
96
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
7. To secure the LDAP connection with SSL, complete the information under LDAP over SSL:
{
To secure the LDAP connection with SSL, select the Use SSL to secure LDAP
connection check box.
{
View your certificate details and verify that the root certificate can be used by the
appliance. See “Importing CA Certificates” on page 74 for details.
{
To configure the appliance to verify that the LDAP host name is the same as the name in
the certificate presented by the LDAP server, select the Match certificate CN against
LDAP server name check box. Typically, your server name will match the name specified
in its digital certificate. If this is the case with your server, SonicWALL recommends
enabling this option in a production environment. This makes it more difficult for an
unauthorized server to masquerade as your LDAP server if your digital certificate or DNS
server is compromised.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
97
8. Optionally, complete the information listed under Advanced.
{
When an LDAP server cannot answer a client’s query, you can refer it to other LDAP
servers by selecting the Enable LDAP referrals check box. Use caution when enabling
this feature because it can slow down the authentication process. If you are configuring
LDAP to authenticate against Microsoft Active Directory, you may want to disable this
feature.
{
In the Server timeout box, type the number of seconds to wait for a reply from the LDAP
server. The default value is 60 (one minute).
{
To change the prompts and other text that Windows users see when they log in to the
authentication server, select the Customize authentication server prompts check box.
98
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
The page title, message, and login prompts can all be customized. If users log in using a
PIN as a password, for example, change the text for the Proof prompt from Password: to
PIN: (a customized Message could explain how to retrieve a forgotten PIN).
{
You can allow users to change their passwords (in WorkPlace only) by selecting Enable
user-initiated password change. If a realm is configured with stacked authentication
and requires two sets of username/password credentials, a user who changes his or her
password will be changing the credentials for just the first of the two authentication
servers.
{
To allow the LDAP server to notify users that their passwords are going to expire, select
the Notify user before password expires check box. To also permit them to change
their passwords when prompted by the LDAP server, select the Allow user to change
password when notified check box. The password prompt users see is controlled by the
LDAP server.
{
To enable NTLM authentication forwarding, click one of the NTLM authentication
forwarding options. For more information, see “NTLM Authentication Forwarding” on
page 105.
9. To configure authentication that includes an OTP, enable Use one-time passwords with
this authentication server. You must also configure your mail server: if OTPs are going to
be delivered to external domains (for example, an SMS address or external webmail address),
you may have to configure the SMTP server to allow passwords to be sent from the appliance
to the external domain.
{
In the Primary email address attribute box, enter the directory attribute for the email
address to which one-time passwords will be sent. If the primary attribute exists on the
authentication server, it is used.
{
The Secondary email address attribute, if specified, is used if the primary email
address attribute cannot be found.
To have OTPs sent as a text message (instead of an email message), enter the corresponding
attribute name (for example, SMSphone instead of Mail). See “Configuring the AD or LDAP
Directory Server” on page 113 for more information.
10. Click Save.
Notes
z
The Notify user before password expires and Allow user to change password when
notified settings in the Password management area have some constraints:
{
They are supported only on IBM Directory Server.
{
They are available only for users who connect to the appliance using Web access (the Web
proxy agent or translated, custom port mapped, or custom FQDN mapped Web access), or
using Connect Tunnel.
{
Users must have permission on the LDAP server to change their passwords.
z
The Login DN and Password fields are not always required in order to connect to an LDAP
server. However, if they are not provided (or you do not specify a password), the appliance binds
to LDAP anonymously, which does not usually provide the appropriate permissions for
performing user and group information searches.
z
If you define multiple LDAPS servers, you should also configure the Match certificate CN
against LDAP server name setting to be the same for each realm. (Enabling this option is
recommended in a production environment.) Although AMC allows you to configure this setting
per realm, the appliance actually uses the setting configured in the last loaded LDAPS realm.
In other words, if you selected this check box for three LDAPS servers, but cleared it for a fourth
LDAPS realm, the functionality would be disabled for all four servers.
z
Configuring an LDAP authentication server with digital certificate validation is offered for legacy
customers. New users should use the standard method described in “Configuring a PKI
Authentication Server” on page 103.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
99
Configuring RADIUS Authentication
The appliance can validate username/password or token-based credentials against a RADIUS
database. The following illustration shows typical RADIUS configuration options:
Credentials
Username
Password
Token
SSL (port 443)
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class
SRA Appliance
Internet
RADIUS
(port 1645)
Firewall
RADIUS Server
Notes
z
You must modify your firewall or router to allow the appliance to communicate with your
RADIUS server. The RADIUS authentication protocol typically uses port 1645/udp. In addition,
you must configure your RADIUS server to include the IP address of the appliance as a RADIUS
client (most often referred to as a Network Access Server).
Configuring RADIUS with User or Token-Based Credentials
The appliance supports two different types of credentials for RADIUS: username and password, and
token-based user credentials, such as SecurID or SoftID, which are validated against a database
on a RADIUS server. Perform the following steps to configure the RADIUS authentication method to
use either type of credential.
X
To configure RADIUS for user- or token-based credentials
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Authentication Servers, and then click New.
2. Under Authentication directory, click RADIUS.
100
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
3. Under Credential type, click Username/Password or Token/SecurID, and then click
Continue.
4. In the Name box, type a name for the authentication server.
5. In the Primary RADIUS server box, type the host name or IP address of your primary
RADIUS server. If your RADIUS server is listening on a port other than 1645 (the well-known
port for RADIUS), you can specify a port number as a colon-delimited suffix.
6. In the Secondary RADIUS server box, type the host name or IP address of your secondary
RADIUS server. You can also add a port number (:<port number>) if necessary.
7. In the Shared secret box, type the password used to secure communication with the RADIUS
server. This must be the same secret that is specified on the designated RADIUS server.
8. In the Match RADIUS groups by list, select the attribute containing the groups of which the
user is a member. The value returned from RADIUS will be used in the group portion of the
appliance access rule. There are three possible values:
Match RADIUS groups by
Description
None
Ignores the group attribute
filterid attribute (11)
Matches against the FilterID attribute
class attribute (25)
Matches against the Class attribute
9. In the Retry interval box, type the number of seconds to wait for a reply from the RADIUS
server before retrying the connection. The default is 5 seconds.
10. Expand the Advanced button to see additional, optional settings; these are described in
“Configuring Advanced RADIUS Settings” on page 100.
11. Click Save.
Configuring Advanced RADIUS Settings
For further customizing and configuring, use these advanced RADIUS settings.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
101
To configure additional (optional) RADIUS settings
1. Click the Advanced button to display additional (optional) RADIUS settings.
2. In the Service type box, type a RADIUS Service-Type integer indicating the type of service
being requested. For most RADIUS servers, type 1 (for Login) or 8 (for Authenticate Only).
3. When a user’s credentials are accepted, the RADIUS server normally sends a confirmation
message (for example, “Passcode accepted”). If you do not want this message displayed,
select the Suppress RADIUS success message check box.
4. The appliance normally identifies itself using its host name. If the RADIUS server is unable to
accept that name, specify a NAS-Identifier or NAS-IP-Address (specifying both is allowed
but not typically necessary).
5. To change the prompts and other text that Windows users see when they log in to the
authentication server, select Customize authentication server prompts. The page title,
message, and login prompts can all be customized. For example, if a user logs in using his
employee ID, you could change the text for the Identity prompt from Username: to Employee
ID:.
6. If the RADIUS server uses an older version of the RADIUS protocol that does not support
UTF-8 character encoding, select a Local encoding scheme from the Selected list, or type
102
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
one in the Other box. For more information, see “RADIUS Policy Server Character Sets” on
page 457.
7. (RADIUS with a Credential type of Username/Password only) To enable NTLM
authentication forwarding, click one of the NTLM authentication forwarding options. For
more information, see “NTLM Authentication Forwarding” on page 105.
Configuring RSA Server Authentication
The appliance supports SecurID, token-based user credentials that are validated against a database
on an RSA Authentication Manager server. Configuring this type of authentication involves changes
on both the RSA server and the SonicWALL Aventail appliance, which are outlined below. For stepby-step instructions for RSA Authentication Manager 7.1, see Knowledge Base article 6571:
http://www.sonicwall.com/us/support/kb.asp
X
To configure RSA Authentication Manager for token-based credentials
1. Create an agent host on the RSA server with the IP address for the internal interface of the
SonicWALL Aventail appliance.
2. Make the configuration changes necessary to resolve the names of both the RSA server and
the SonicWALL Aventail appliance:
{
DNS must be able to resolve the RSA server’s name; simply adding the appliance and its
IP address to your /etc/hosts file will not work.
{
The appliance’s name (as configured on the RSA server) must resolve to the internal IP
address of the appliance.
3. DNS must be able to resolve the RSA server’s name in both directions:
{
The appliance’s name (as configured on the RSA server) must resolve to the internal IP
address of the appliance; simply adding the appliance and its IP address to your /etc/hosts
file will not work.
{
The RSA server requires a reverse DNS entry for the internal interface of the SonicWALL
Aventail appliance.
4. After adding the agent host on the RSA server, make sure that you generate the configuration
file (sdconf.rec) for the correct agent host.
If the appliance is part of an HA pair, generate a single sdconf.rec for both servers. When you
generate the configuration file you are prompted to specify the agent host: choose all or range
(range should contain both of the HA appliances). Choose individual only if you are setting up
a single appliance.
5. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Authentication Servers, and then click New.
6. Under Authentication directory, choose RSA; the Credential type is automatically set to
Token/ SecurID. Click Continue.
7. In the Name box, type a name for the authentication server.
8. Specify the location of your RSA Authentication Manager server SecurID configuration file,
sdconf.rec, and then click Save to upload it to the appliance.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
103
This configuration file is in binary format and contains the ports and processes associated with
the RSA authentication service. Once in place, this file is used by the RSA libraries to
communicate over the network to an RSA server.
9. The node secret is negotiated when the first authentication request is made from the agent
host. Make sure that the “node secret created” flag is cleared on the RSA server.
Notes
z
If you make any changes to the RSA server (for example, change its IP address, host name, or
re-install it), the sdconf.rec file must be uploaded to the appliance again.
Configuring a PKI Authentication Server
You can set up a certificate server so that a user authenticates using a client certificate on his or
her device. Digital certificate authentication can be used alone or in conjunction with another
authentication method, such as RADIUS. (If you set up chained authentication and a digital
certificate is one of the methods you use, it must be the first method; for more information, see
“Configuring Chained Authentication” on page 109.)
X
To configure a PKI authentication server
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Authentication Servers, and then click New.
2. Under Authentication directory, click Public key infrastructure (PKI). The only possible
Credential type is Digital certificate.
3. Click Continue. The Configure Authentication Server page appears.
4. In the Name box, type a name for the authentication server.
5. Under Trusted CA certificates, optionally select the Trust intermediate CAs without
verifying the entire chain check box. This allows a set of trusted intermediate signing
authority certificates to be deployed in various sectors of the network (often by department or
organizational unit). For more information, see “About Intermediate Certificates” on
page 80.
104
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
6. On the left you’ll see a list of All CA certificates used by the appliance. Specify one or more
root certificates for establishing a trust relationship with the client device by selecting the
check box to the left of a certificate and then clicking the >> button (a root certificate is one
where the Subject and Issuer are the same). A client’s certificate will be trusted if it matches a
root certificate listed in the Trusted CA certificates list.
7. In the Username attribute box, type the attribute used for single sign-on (for example, cn
or uid).
8. Click Save.
Notes
z
If the CA certificate that you trust for this method of user authentication is not shown in the list,
you may need to add it. See “Importing CA Certificates” on page 74.
z
When using Internet Explorer 8 and higher to authenticate using PKI with X.509 certificates
from WorkPlace, if the certificate is not found on the endpoint, it results in an IE error page.
The certificate selection dialog appears only if a valid certificate exists in the client end point;
otherwise IE does not prompt for certificate selection.
Connect Tunnel Users Only
z
Authentication using client certificates is not supported on the Windows 2003 operating system
or the Windows Server platform.
Configuring a Single Sign-On Authentication Server
Single sign-on (SSO) allows you to configure the appliance to forward user credentials to back-end
Web resources. It also means that the user does not need to log in multiple times (once to get to
the appliance, and again to access an application resource).
The appliance supports various types of Web SSO (as a security measure, SSO is disabled by
default).
Notes
z
To use SSO functionality when accessing Web applications during tunnel sessions, you can
enable Web resource filtering. See “Configuring Web Resource Filtering” on page 355 for
more information.
z
The Web proxy agent does not support single sign-on to back-end Web servers secured with
SSL. Links to these resources accessed through the Web proxy agent will not provide single
sign-on. To provide either basic authentication or NTLM authentication forwarding to an HTTPS
resource, create an alias for the Web resource and then add it as a link in WorkPlace. This forces
the appliance to provide translated, custom port mapped, or custom FQDN mapped Web access.
z
By default, Web content is proxied directly through the appliance for users running OnDemand
Tunnel. Select Use Web content translation in the Web shortcut access area of the
Configure WorkPlace page in AMC.
z
CA eTrust SiteMinder is not supported in version 10.5. Equivalent functionality is planned for a
future release.
Forms-Based Single Sign-On
Many Web applications use forms-based authentication, where the user interface for authentication
is a Web form. You can use AMC to set up a single sign-on profile that will forward a user's appliance
credentials to a Web application that uses forms-based authentication. There are some built-in
profiles that you can modify for your environment:
z
OWA 2003
z
Citrix Nfuse 1.7
z
Citrix MetaFrame XP
See “Creating Forms-Based Single Sign-On Profiles” on page 143 for more information.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
105
Basic Authentication Forwarding
This form of authentication forwarding is supported on a wide variety of platforms, but is not very
secure because it sends passwords in the clear across the network. The appliance can be configured
to send each user’s authentication credentials, or “static” credentials (that is, the same credentials
for all users).
X
To configure basic authentication forwarding
1. Configure a Web application profile to use SSO and specify which user credentials to use.
2. Attach the Web application profile to any Web resources for which you want to use SSO.
Basic authentication forwarding is configured within a Web application profile. For more information,
see “Adding Web Application Profiles” on page 140.
NTLM Authentication Forwarding
NTLM (Windows NT LAN Manager) uses a challenge/response mechanism to securely authenticate
users without sending passwords in the clear across the network. It provides a secure method for
sending Windows network credentials to a Microsoft IIS (Internet Information Services) Web server.
NTLM authentication forwarding passes a Windows domain name along with the user’s
authentication credentials. This enables users accessing Web resources on Windows networks to be
securely authenticated without sending their passwords in the clear.
X
To configure NTLM authentication forwarding
1. Enable the SSO options in a Web application profile, and then attach the profile to any Web
resources to which you want to forward user credentials.
2. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Authentication Servers.
3. Click the Edit link for the server you want to configure. The Configure Authentication
Server page appears.
4. Expand the Advanced settings. Specify the domain name you want to forward in the NTLM
authentication forwarding area:
{
You can type a custom name in the Domain name box, but it is not required. If you do
not specify a name, an empty (null) domain name is forwarded, along with the user
credentials.
{
To forward the authentication server name (as specified in the Name box at the top of the
page) along with the user credentials, click Forward the authentication server name
as domain name.
Notes
z
To use NTLM authentication forwarding in situations in which the credentials do not match,
users must be running a Web browser that supports NTLM.
z
When single sign-on is enabled, the Web proxy service and the back-end server determine
which authentication method is used. If only one authentication method (basic authentication
or NTLM authentication) is enabled in AMC, that method is used. However, if both methods are
enabled in AMC, NTLM authentication is used because it is the more secure of the two.
106
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
Using RSA ClearTrust
With single sign-on, user authentication credentials are forwarded to the appliance from an RSA
ClearTrust server, and the appliance then forwards the credentials to any back-end resource that
requires them for authentication. See “RSA ClearTrust Configuration” on page 106 for information
on setting up the appliance in this authentication environment.
Using RSA ClearTrust Authentication
The SonicWALL appliance appliance supports authentication by accepting credentials in an RSA
ClearTrust authentication environment. Users can authenticate through the RSA ClearTrust server
only when connecting using a Web browser.
The following illustration shows the typical sequence of events as a user logs in to authenticate in
an RSA ClearTrust environment:
User accesses WorkPlace
and selects an RSA
ClearTrust realm
Request forwarded to web agent
Appliance
ClearTrust-enabled
Web server
ClearTrust
URL
(The Web server must
be on the network that
is accessed through the
appliance.)
User credentials
submitted and validated
ClearTrust
login page presented to
user
Credentials saved in cookie and
access granted to VPN resources
1. The user enters the URL for WorkPlace and picks a ClearTrust realm from the drop-down list. If
you’ve configured only one realm for users, it is automatically selected.
2. The SonicWALL appliance forwards the request to the appropriate Web agent. The ClearTrust
Web agent is on a separate ClearTrust-enabled Web server that you specified in AMC.
3. The Web agent checks with the ClearTrust policy server and displays the corresponding
authentication page, prompting the user for credentials.
4. The user's credentials are forwarded to the Web agent, which validates them against its policy
server.
5. The user is either authenticated or denied access. If authentication is successful, the
credentials are saved in a cookie and the user has access to VPN resources during the
WorkPlace session.
RSA ClearTrust Configuration
To configure RSA ClearTrust to authenticate users, you must specify the URL of the external server
because the appliance does not host the ClearTrust agent. Configuration also requires using AMC to
export a .zip file containing a private key and CGI script, both of which must be installed on the
ClearTrust-enabled Web server.
X
To configure the RSA ClearTrust authentication
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Authentication Servers, and then click New.
2. Under Single sign-on server, click RSA ClearTrust (only one ClearTrust server can be
specified; if one has already been configured, this option is dimmed).
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
107
3. Click Continue. The Configure Authentication Server page appears.
4. In the Name box, type a name for the authentication server.
5. In the ClearTrust server URL box, type the URL of the Web server that hosts the ClearTrust
agent. If the ClearTrust-enabled Web server is listening on a port other than the default of
636, you can specify a port number as a colon-delimited suffix. If you want to use a secure
SSL connection, include the https:// protocol identifier in this box.
6. A private key and CGI script must be installed on the RSA ClearTrust server, or the computer
on which the RSA ClearTrust Web agent is installed. Click Export to save these items in a .zip
file (with a default name of ctAgent.zip), then install them as follows:
{
The private key file (named webagent.key) must be available on the RSA ClearTrust server
in the /usr/local/webagent directory. The computer on which the RSA ClearTrust Web
agent is installed should have openssl libraries in the /usr/lib directory. Or, at a minimum,
the libraries libssl.so.0.9.7 and libcrypto.so.0.9.7 should be available in the same
directory.
{
The CGI script must be placed in the /cgi-bin directory of the RSA ClearTrust server.
7. Click Save.
Notes
z
When installing the CGI script file on an RSA ClearTrust-enabled Web server, you must ensure
that the file’s owner, group, and permissions are set appropriately for that server.
Configuring Local User Storage
You can create local user accounts in AMC and then map them to a local authentication repository.
The appliance checks username and password credentials against users stored locally in
/etc/passwd. For information on creating local user accounts, see “Managing Local User Accounts”
on page 191.
Local user authentication is intended for testing purposes and is not recommended in a production
environment. Only one local user store can be created on the appliance.
X
To configure local user authentication
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Authentication Servers, and then click New.
2. Under Local user storage, click Local users (if a local store already exists, this option is
dimmed).
108
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
3. Click Continue. The Configure Authentication Server page appears.
4. In the Name box, type a name for the authentication server.
5. To change the prompts and other text that Windows users see when they log in, select the
Customize authentication server prompts check box. The page title, message, and login
prompts can all be customized. For example, if an employee ID number is used to identify a
user, you could change the text for the Identity prompt from Username: to Employee ID:.
Because this configuration is normally used for testing, a customized Message could point to
test procedures or other instructions.
6. Click Save.
Testing LDAP and AD Authentication Configurations
To help you validate your authentication configuration settings, the AMC pages used to configure
Microsoft Active Directory and LDAP servers include a Test Connection button. Clicking this button
establishes a connection with your external user repository and provides status information.
If you have correctly configured the appliance, a message reading “Valid connection!” appears. If
there is an error in the configuration settings, the message provides a description of the problem.
Notes
z
The test connection feature is intended only for testing whether the appliance can bind to an
external directory. If you enter login credentials, the appliance will use them, but it will
otherwise attempt to bind to the directory anonymously. Because it does not actually search
the directory, testing a connection will not validate that your login credentials provide access to
the configured domain.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
109
Configuring Chained Authentication
For increased security, you can require users to authenticate to a single realm using two different
authentication methods. For example, you could set up RADIUS or a digital certificate as the first
authentication method, and LDAP or Active Directory as the second one. You can require that the
user names are the same on the primary and secondary authentication servers. To make the login
experience for your users a one-step process you can configure AMC such that users see only one
set of prompts.
X
To configure chained authentication
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Realms.
2. Click the name of the realm you want to modify, or click New and then select an entry in the
Authentication server drop-down list. This is your primary authentication server.
If one of your credential types for chained authentication is a digital certificate, the
corresponding authentication server must be the primary one: you can’t configure a PKI server
as your secondary authentication server.
3. Click Advanced, and then select a Secondary authentication server (if none is defined,
click New; see “Configuring Authentication Servers” on page 80 for the steps involved in
setting up an authentication server).
4. The remaining (optional) settings can provide more security, help with troubleshooting, and
simplify the login process:
Setting
Description
Audit username from this server
Show the username from the secondary server in the
audit and accounting logs (instead of the username
from the primary authentication server).
Forward credentials from this server For single sign-on, one set of credentials must be
forwarded to back-end Web resources. Select this
check box to forward the credentials from this (the
secondary) authentication server.
Usernames must match
When this check box is selected, authentication will fail
if the user ID submitted for the first authentication step
differs from the user ID submitted in the second step.
This option is available when the authentication
methods use either a username/password or a token or
certificate.
One use case for this option is when the primary
authentication server uses a certificate and the
secondary uses a username/password. Without this
option enabled, an end user could log in with another
user's certificate if the first user had valid credentials.
When this setting is turned on, that authentication
attempt would fail because the username in the
certificate would not match the username in the
username/password credentials.
Combine authentication prompts on
one screen
When this check box is selected, the appliance verifies
that the username is the same on both authentication
servers. If it is, the prompts for a user’s credentials are
combined on a single screen; if the usernames differ,
the login is rejected and (for security reasons) there is
no error message explaining why.
Authentication prompts cannot be combined if user
credentials involve a digital certificate, though the
system still ensures that the username is the same on
both servers.
110
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
Setting
Description
Customize authentication server
prompts
(Available only when Combine authentication
prompts on one screen is selected, and only for
Windows clients.)
When configuring an authentication server, you have
the option of customizing the prompts that users see.
When two such servers are chained together, you can
present the user with a combined authentication
prompt that includes customized Title, Message, and
Identity fields. The name for the password fields is
picked up from each authentication server
configuration.
If this customization setting is not selected, the user
sees the prompts that are configured for the two
authentication servers.
Chained Authentication Login Example
In this example, the system administrator has set up two authentication methods for a realm
named Employees:
z
The primary authentication server uses RADIUS; the Proof prompt (on the Configure
Authentication Server page, under Advanced settings) was customized to read Passcode.
z
The secondary authentication server uses LDAP; the Proof prompt was customized to read
Remote access password.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
111
The Advanced settings on the Configure Realm - Employees page look like this, with customized
Title, Message, and Identity prompts:
Based on these AMC settings, the login screen that users see would look like this:
Because the usernames on both authentication servers are the same, the user types his or her
username only once.
112
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
Notes
z
If the user makes an error while entering username or password information, an error message
appears (“The credentials provided were invalid”) and only the prompts for the secondary
authentication server are displayed. To re-enter his or her credentials, the user must first go to
the original login page by clicking the browser’s Back button.
Enabling Group Affinity Checking in a Realm
The appliance supports “group affinity checking,” a network environment in which a user
authenticates against one server, and a second directory provides information on what groups (if
any) a user belongs to. This is a common requirement when RADIUS SecurID tokens are used for
authentication but the user’s group information comes from an LDAP or Active Directory server. (In
contrast, chained authentication requires users to authenticate against two authentication servers.
See “Configuring Chained Authentication” on page 109 for more information.)
Group membership is an important part of access control: you can set up the appliance to reference
user groups stored in your directory, and then reference those groups in access control rules.
X
To enable group affinity checking
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Realms.
2. Click the name of the realm you want to modify.
3. Click Advanced. In the Group authorization area, select the Enable group affinity
checking check box.
4. in the Server list, select the name of the LDAP or Active Directory server that stores the group
information. You can also click New to define a new group affinity server.
If group authorization checking is disabled for an authentication server, the server will not
appear in the list of available affinity servers. See “Disabling Authorization Checks” on page 83
for more information.
5. Click Save.
If you are enabling group affinity checking during the process of creating the realm, the available
buttons are different:
z
Click Next to display the Communities tab on the Configure Realms page.
z
Click Finish to return to the Authentication page.
Using One-Time Passwords for Added Security
A one-time password (OTP) is a randomly generated password that is used only once. Using an OTP
as the second factor for authentication provides additional security for users: after standard user
name and password credentials are submitted, the system generates a one-time password, which
is sent to the user at a predefined SMS or email address. The user then logs in to that email account
to retrieve the OTP and enters it when prompted. The likelihood of the password being compromised
is reduced because a new OTP is generated after each successful, cancelled, or failed login, or when
a login attempt has timed out.
In order to configure authentication that includes an OTP, you must do the following:
z
Configure your mail server. If one-time passwords are going to be delivered to external domains
(for example, an SMS address or external webmail address), you may have to configure the
SMTP server to allow passwords to be sent from the appliance to the external domain.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
z
|
113
Configure an OTP in the Advanced area of the authentication server configuration. Specify the
directory attributes that store the email addresses to which OTPs are sent.
Configuring SMTP to Deliver One-Time Passwords
If the email addresses to which you want to deliver one-time passwords are in an external domain
(such as SMS addresses or external webmail addresses), you must configure your SMTP server to
allow passwords to be sent from the appliance to the external domain.
X
To configure Microsoft Exchange to support one-time passwords
1. Navigate to Exchange System Manager and expand Servers > Protocols > SMTP.
2. Right-click on Default SMTP Virtual Server, or the appropriate SMTP server instance.
3. Click Properties, and then select the Access tab.
4. Click Relay in the Relay Restrictions area.
5. Select Only the list below, and then click Add.
6. Enter the IP address of your SRA E-Class appliance (for example, 10.50.165.5), and then
click OK. Your appliance should be listed with a status of Access Granted.
7. Click OK.
Configuring an Authentication Server for One-Time Passwords
If the email addresses to which you want to deliver one-time passwords are in an external domain
(such as SMS addresses or external webmail addresses), you must configure your SMTP server to
allow passwords to be sent from the appliance to the external domain, as described in “Configuring
SMTP to Deliver One-Time Passwords” on page 113.
For each authentication server, you must also specify the directory attribute that stores the email
addresses to which OTPs are sent. You must specify a primary attribute; alternatively, you can
specify a secondary attribute that is queried when the first one cannot be found.
X
To configure an authentication server to support one-time passwords
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Authentication Servers, and then click Edit
next to the AD (Microsoft Active Directory or Microsoft Active Directory Tree), or LDAP
authentication server you want to reconfigure.
2. Select a Credential type, if applicable, and then click Continue.
3. Expand the Advanced area, and then select Use one-time passwords with this
authentication server.
4. Enter the directory attribute for the email address to which one-time passwords will be sent. If
the primary attribute exists on the authentication server, it is used, otherwise the secondary
attribute, if specified, is queried.
Configuring the AD or LDAP Directory Server
The schema for your AD or LDAP directory server must include an attribute that contains the email
address to which an OTP will be sent. This address is not necessarily the user’s corporate email
address. In order to complete authentication, a user has to be able to open the email containing
the OTP; if it is sent to a corporate address the user may not yet have access to the account.
One-time passwords can be configured to be sent in an email message directly to SMS-capable
phones. Contact your cell phone service provider for further information about enabling SMS.
The schema for your directory server (AD or LDAP) must be changed to accommodate an attribute
(for example, SMSphone) that contains the SMS address for a given user. The address that you use
depends on the user’s number and service provider. The attribute value for a Verizon phone with a
U.S. domestic number, for example, looks like this: <10-digit number>@vtext.com.
114
|
Chapter 4 - Network and Authentication Configuration
Next Steps
After you have performed the basic network setup, obtained an SSL certificate for the appliance,
and configured authentication settings, you are ready to start managing users and user groups,
defining resources, and configuring access control rules.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
115
Chapter 5
Security Administration
Managing security is perhaps your most important job as an administrator. The Aventail
Management Console (AMC) makes it easy for you to manage the fundamental elements of security
administration: resources and access control rules.
Creating and Managing Resources
This section explains how to create and manage individual resources, resource groups, and
configuration settings for resources. You can define a resource before referencing it in an access
control rule, or define it directly from the access control rule interface. (For more information about
the latter, see “Adding Users and Resources From Within Access Control Rules” on page 155.)
There’s a tool you can use on the appliance command line to see whether you reference any hosts
that cannot be resolved in DNS, or whether your access control rules contain any unreferenced
resources. See “Validating Hosts” on page 413 for more information.
Resource Types
The SonicWALL appliance provides access to a wide variety of corporate resources, which fall into
three categories: Web, client/server, and file share resources.
Built-In Resources
There are several resources that are built into your appliance to help you get a WorkPlace portal set
up quickly. These built-in resources cannot be deleted—access to some of them is granted through
WorkPlace shortcuts:
Aventail WorkPlace (Resource Type: URL)
The WorkPlace portal gives users access to Web-based resources. This particular resource is used
by another built-in item, which you can modify: an access “permit all” rule that allows any user from
any zone to have access to the default WorkPlace portal.
Value: http://127.0.0.1:8085/workplace/
Connect Tunnel (Resource Type: URL)
Connect Tunnel is an application that provides broad access to network resources. You determine
how users access the Connect Tunnel client:
z
Allow users to download the Connect Tunnel client and activate it from a link (shortcut) in
WorkPlace. Keep in mind that when you give users access to this resource, you allow them to
both install and use the client: a user without access to this resource cannot use Connect Tunnel
for access to network resources. The WorkPlace shortcut for this resource (Install Connect
Tunnel) can be modified or deleted; the resource itself cannot.
116
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
z
Deploy the Connect Tunnel client setup package without requiring users to log in to Aventail
WorkPlace.
Value: http://127.0.0.1:8085/ctdownload/
Network Explorer (Resource Type: Network Share)
Network Explorer is a Web-based extension, accessible from WorkPlace, that provides access to any
Windows file system resources that the user has permission to use (even from desktop browsers
on non-Windows platforms). These resources can include servers, computers, workgroups, folders,
and files. The WorkPlace shortcut for this resource (Network Explorer) can be modified or deleted;
the resource itself cannot.
Value: smb://127.0.0.1/networkexplorer/
Web Resources
Web resources include Web-based applications or services that are accessed using HTTP or HTTPS.
Examples include Microsoft Outlook Web Access and other Web-based email programs, Web portals,
corporate intranets, and standard Web servers.
Web traffic is proxied through the Web proxy service, a secure gateway through which users can
access private Web resources from the Internet. When you define a Web resource as a destination
in an access control rule, make sure that Web browser is among the client software agents
available for the rule. For more information, see “Resolving Invalid Destination Resources” on
page 157.
A Web resource can be defined in various ways:
URL Type
Example
Standard URL
http://host.example.com/index.html
Standard URL with port
number
http://host.example.com:8445/index.html
URL for secure site
https://host.example.com/index.html
URL containing IP address
http://192.0.34.0/index.html
Matching URL
Use wildcards to refer to a group of Web resources:
http://mailserver*.company.com/
URL with path and query
string matching
Block email attachments, or prevent a Web-based application
from displaying restricted data by matching a path element or
query string value to a particular URL:
http://www.patient-records.com/reports.aspx?last_name=
Notes
z
Some Web-based applications use Java applets or other browser extensions using protocols
other than HTTP. Although these applications are accessed using a Web browser, they must be
defined as client/server (not Web resources), and they must be accessed using either a network
tunnel client or client/server proxy agent. Examples of such applications include Citrix NFuse,
Oracle J-Initiator, and certain versions of SAP and PeopleSoft.
Client/Server Resources
Client/server resources are enterprise applications that run over TCP/IP (including applications that
use UDP). Examples include thin-client applications such as Citrix; full client/server applications
such as Microsoft Outlook; Lotus Notes; SAP; and terminal servers.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
117
You define these types of client/server applications by specifying a host name, an IP address or IP
range, a subnet IP address, or a DNS domain. These resources can also be used to define a network
object containing multiple Web resources (such as a domain), or to define a network object that
can be used to control access based on the source of a connection request.
The following table explains the syntax used to define each of these resource types. Host names
can be fully qualified or unqualified.
Resource type
Example
Domain
private.example.com
Host name
bart.private.example.com
Host IP address
192.0.34.72
IP range
192.0.34.72 - 192.0.34.74
Subnet
192.0.34.0 / 255.255.255.0
Example
In this example, a Web development team has a single Web server with three virtual Web servers,
one for each stage in their development process. Each virtual Web server listens on a different port.
Rather than creating three different URL resources, the Web development team can define the Web
server, which proxies traffic on all ports, as a resource type of Host name or IP (for example,
webdev.yourcompany.com). In addition, they attach a single sign-on Web application profile to it,
and now all three of the virtual Web servers are defined at once, and they share the same SSO
profile:
webdev.yourcompany.com
webdev.yourcompany.com:8080
webdev.yourcompany.com:8443
Notes
z
Microsoft Outlook connects to Microsoft Exchange using an unqualified host name. When
defining a Microsoft Exchange server as a resource, define it as an unqualified name (for
example, CorpMail).
z
To use Exchange on Symbian, Android, iPad and iPhone devices, create a URL resource of the
type ActiveSync for Exchange.
File Share Resources
When users log in to WorkPlace, they have access to file system resources that you set up. These
can include computers containing shared folders and files and Windows network servers.
You can define a specific file system share by typing a UNC path, or you can define an entire
Windows domain:
z
A specific file system resource can be an entire server (for example, \\ginkgo), a shared folder
(\\john\public), or a network folder (\\ginkgo\news).
z
Defining an entire Windows domain gives authorized users access to all the network file
resources within the domain. These resources are the same ones you would see if you were to
browse the network using Windows Explorer (My Network Places > Entire Network > Microsoft
Windows Network).
You can use resource variables to dynamically reference multiple folders on the network. For
example, to give each user access to a personal folder, create a resource using a variable for the
user name, and then use that variable when you create a shortcut on WorkPlace. See the example
in “Using Session Property Variables” on page 131 for more information.
Resources and Resource Groups
This section describes how to work with resources and resource groups.
118
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
Viewing Resources and Resource Groups
You can view and define individual resources or groups of them in AMC.
X
To view the list of available resources and resource groups
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
2. On the Resources tab, review the list of available individual resources. (The Resource
Groups tab displays collections of resources.)
3. Use the Filters settings at the top of the page to filter the resources that are displayed here.
For information about using filters, see the “Filters” section under “A Quick Tour of the AMC
Interface” on page 38.
The Type column displays the type of each resource (Domain name, Host name, etc.).
Remember that a client/server resource can contain both Web and client/server applications.
The Used column indicates whether a resource has been specified in a shortcut on WorkPlace.
4. For an overview of a particular resource, click the plus sign (+) next to it. This shows the
resource type, its value, and whether it is used by a WorkPlace shortcut or access rule.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
119
5. To edit a resource, click its link in the resource list.
Notes
z
By default, there are some read-only resource definitions included with the appliance, for
example, Aventail WorkPlace and Connect Tunnel Download. These definitions are required by
the appliance services and cannot be deleted (a read-only resource has no check box next to it).
Adding Resources
Creating application resources—Web, client/server, and file share resources—is the first step in
forming access policies for your users.
X
To add a resource
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
2. Click New and then choose a resource type from the drop-down list:
3. The options you see on the Add Resource page depend on the resource type you selected.
The following options are shared across the specified resource types:
Option
Description
Resource type
Name
Resource name
All
Description
Resource description
All
120
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
Option
Description
Variable
Use a variable to define dynamic
resources; see “Using Variables in
Resource and WorkPlace Shortcut
Definitions” on page 130.
Create shortcut in
WorkPlace
Web application profile
(Web proxy options or
Advanced area)
Resource type
z
Citrix server farm
z
Domain
z
Host name or IP
z
Matching URL
z
Network share
z
URL
Add a shortcut to a Web resource in
WorkPlace. The name you assign to
the resource will appear in the list of
Shortcuts on the Aventail
WorkPlace page. You can add the
shortcut to a new or existing shortcut
group in order to keep shortcuts with
similar usage requirements together
on the WorkPlace portal page.
z
Domain
z
Network share
z
URL
This list contains preconfigured Web
profiles that are recommended for
several popular Web applications,
custom Web profiles, and a default
Web profile. If you are unsure about
which profile to select, choose
Default. To see a profile, click View
selected profile. Also see “Adding
Web Application Profiles” on
page 140.
z
Domain
z
Host name or IP
z
IP range
z
Matching URL
z
Subnet
z
URL
The following options are unique to the URL resource type:
Option
Description
URL
If you do not enter a protocol identifier, AMC automatically
inserts http:// before the URL. If this is a URL for a secure site,
you must include the https:// protocol identifier. For example,
type https://example.domain.com.
Custom access area
You can choose to Translate this resource or Access this
resource on a custom port or Access this resource using
a custom FQDN.
Translation uses URL rewriting, but the other alternatives
provide clientless Web application access and do not incur the
limitations of URL rewriting. URL rewriting can have problems
with Web programming technologies such as AJAX.
The options below will vary according to your choice.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
121
Option
Description
Alias name
(Web proxy)
Specify a public alias to represent a private URL. The alias
name is visible to users—make it short and descriptive so that
it is easy to remember. You should specify an Alias name if:
z
You want to obscure the internal host name for this
resource.
z
The URL resource is not contained within a search domain
configured for Name resolution on the Network
Settings page.
z
You normally redirect traffic through a network agent, but
in this case you want to force the resource to be proxied
using translated Web access. See “Adding Web Shortcuts”
on page 294 for more information.
Notes
z
The private URL that you are representing with the alias
must point to a directory on the back-end server, not a
particular file.
z
Use ASCII characters when specifying an alias. Users who
connect to WorkPlace using translated Web access will see
an error message if non-ASCII characters are used.
z
Creating an alias works only for URLs (addresses with an
http or https prefix); you cannot specify an alias for a UNC
path or FTP resource (ftp://), for example.
Also see “Example: Specifying a URL Alias” on page 124 for a
detailed description of how an alias is used.
Port
(Web proxy)
The Port option is available when you select Access this
resource on a custom port under Custom access. Enter the
custom port number. The resource becomes available at that
port on each WorkPlace site. The port must be open on any
firewalls and must not be already in use on the external side of
the appliance. Actual delivery of Web content depends on policy
checks in accordance with normal appliance operation.
Custom FQDN
(Web proxy)
The Custom FQDN option is available when you select Access
this resource using a custom FQDN under Custom access.
Enter a fully qualified domain name (such as
custom.mydomain.com) to be hosted by an externally
accessible Web server on the appliance. The host name cannot
be relative to any WorkPlace site. A maximum of 32 IP
addresses for externally defined host names are allowed
between independently hosted Web application names and
WorkPlace sites, supporting up to 64 total host names.
Custom FQDN mapped Web access provides single sign-on
support.
IP address
(Web proxy)
Select an existing IP address or select (New) to add an IP
address in the New IP address field .
New IP address
(Web proxy)
Type in the IP address of the resource in dotted decimal form
(w.x.y.z). This address must be on the same subnet as the
appliance interface.
SSL certificate
(Web proxy)
Select an existing SSL certificate or select (New) to add a new
SSL certificate for this resource. If a certificate that matches
the name is already available on the appliance, it is selected.
Otherwise, select one from the SSL certificate list or import a
certificate.
122
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
Option
Description
Organization
(Web proxy)
Type in your company or organization name.
Country
(Web proxy)
Type in the 2-letter abbreviation for your country (such as US
or AU).
Synonyms
(Web proxy)
Define alternative names for the URL resource name. This is
convenient for users if they access the server using a different
name (perhaps an unqualified or condensed name), or if a Web
page contains links pointing to a DNS alias and the name is not
properly translated by the Web proxy service. Separate
multiple synonyms with semicolons.
The appliance automatically defines a shortened name for the
resource as a synonym. For example, if the URL is
http://mail.example.com, the appliance adds the synonym
mail. This synonym does not, however, appear in the
Synonyms box.
When Translate this resource is selected and you specify
Synonyms, there must be something in the Alias name field.
For the other Custom access options, the Synonyms field is
independent of other fields.
Provide Exchange
ActiveSync access to this
resource
(Exchange ActiveSync)
Select this check box to allow Exchange ActiveSync access to
this resource.
For more information, see “Exchange ActiveSync Web Access”
on page 324. For an example use case, see “Example:
Supporting Exchange on iPhones” on page 126.
Custom FQDN
(Exchange ActiveSync)
Enter the fully qualified domain name (such as
custom.mydomain.com).
IP address
(Exchange ActiveSync)
Select an existing IP address or select (New) to add an IP
address in the New IP address field.
New IP address
(Exchange ActiveSync)
Type in the IP address of the resource in dotted decimal form
(w.x.y.z). This address must be on the same subnet as the
appliance interface.
SSL certificate
(Exchange ActiveSync)
Select an existing SSL certificate or select (New) to import a
new SSL certificate for this resource.
Organization
(Exchange ActiveSync)
Type in your company or organization name.
Country
(Exchange ActiveSync)
Type in the 2-letter abbreviation for your country (such as US
or AU).
Realm
(Exchange ActiveSync)
Select the realm from the drop-down list. ActiveSync access
requires the use of a realm that uses a single Active Directory
authentication server. The realm must be already configured.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
123
The following options are unique to the Matching URL resource type:
Option
Description
URL
If you do not enter a protocol identifier, AMC automatically
inserts http:// before the URL. If this is a URL for a secure
site, you must include the https:// protocol identifier. For
example, type https://example.domain.com.
The wildcard characters “*” and “?” can be used within
address segments (between periods) of a Matching URL
resource. Do not use the “?” character after the domain
name—it indicates a URL query string.
Use wildcard characters in the following situations:
z
Type www.yourcompany*.com to reference several
domains that begin with yourcompany and end with
.com, or type www.yourcompany.* to reference both
http://www.yourcompany.com and
http://www.yourcompany.de.
z
Create an entry, such as mail*.yourcompany.com, that
gives the user access to anything in the yourcompany
domain that begins with mail. This example provides
access to mail.yourcompany.com and
mail2.yourcompany.com, but not to
mail3.wemmet.yourcompany.com.
The URL is not case-sensitive.
Path and query string
matching
These options allow you to block email attachments, or
prevent a Web-based application from displaying restricted
data by matching a path element or query string value to a
particular URL. See “Example: Blocking Email Attachments”
on page 125 and “Example: Restricting Access to Sensitive
Data” on page 127 for more information.
The Query string value is case-sensitive, while the Path
element is not.
The following options are unique to the Host name or IP resource type:
Option
Description
Host name or IP
A host can include any computer on your network; for
example, bart.private.example.com or 192.0.34.72.
When you specify a host name, the wildcard characters “*”
and “?” can be used within an address segment (between
periods). For example, the entry mail*.yourcompany.com
gives the user access to anything in the yourcompany
domain that begins with mail (for example,
(mail.yourcompany.com and mail2.yourcompany.com), but
not to mail3.wemmet.yourcompany.com. The host name is
not case-sensitive.
The following options are unique to the Network share resource type:
Option
Description
Network share
Type a UNC path. This can be an entire server (for example,
\\ginkgo), a shared folder (\\john\public), or a network
folder (\\ginkgo\news).
124
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
The following options are unique to the IP range resource type:
Option
Description
IP range
An IP range typically identifies a partial range of computers
within a subnet; for example, 192.0.34.72-192.0.34.74.
The following options are unique to the Subnet resource type:
Option
Description
Subnet IP
A subnet is a portion of a network that shares a common
address component. For example, 192.26.34.0.
Subnet mask
For example, 255.255.255.0.
The following options are unique to the Domain resource type:
Option
Domain
Description
A domain encompasses one or more hosts.
If the Windows domain check box is cleared, the domain
name must be in DNS syntax. For example,
sampledomain.com.
Windows domain
To define an entire Windows domain, select the Windows
domain check box, and then type the name of the Domain
in either NetBIOS or DNS syntax (such as example or
example.com). Defining a domain gives authorized users
access to all the network file resources within the domain.
The following options are unique to the Citrix server farm resource type:
Option
Description
Citrix XML servers list
Specify the Host name or IP address and service Port of
up to six Citrix servers running the XML service. For more
information, see “Adding Citrix Server Farm Resources” on
page 359.
4. After you’ve finished defining a resource, click Save.
Example: Specifying a URL Alias
Any Web resource—such as a Web application, a Web portal, or a Web server—can be defined as a
“URL resource.” Defining a Web resource as a URL provides several advantages:
z
You can create a Web shortcut for WorkPlace to give users quick access to a URL resource.
z
You can define very specific access rules to control which users can access the URL.
z
You have the option of obscuring (or “aliasing”) the internal host name so it is not publicly
exposed. When a user accesses an alias, the request is proxied to the downstream Web
resource and its private URL is translated using the alias you specify. The user sees only the
public (or “aliased”) URL.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
125
The following figure illustrates how the private address for an inventory application might be
translated into a public URL.
The private URL for this resource is http://inventory.example.com, and the administrator has
created an alias for it named supplier.
Instead of using the private URL (which would publicly expose a sensitive host name), suppliers
access a public URL: https://vpn.example.com/supplier.
A public URL consists of the following:
z
An https:// prefix rather than http://: this is because all traffic to and from the SonicWALL
appliance is secured using SSL
z
The appliance’s fully qualified domain name (in this example vpn.example.com)
z
The resource’s alias name (in this example supplier)
Notes
z
Some Web-based applications use Java applets or other browser extensions that submit traffic
using protocols other than HTTP. Examples of such applications include Citrix NFuse and certain
versions of SAP. Although accessed using a Web browser, these applications may need to be
defined as a client/server resource and proxied through OnDemand using the client/server
access service.
z
The private URL for which you create an alias must be a directory on the back-end server; it
cannot be a file, and it must begin with either http:// or https://.
z
Use ASCII characters when specifying an alias. Users who connect to WorkPlace using
translated Web access will see an error message if non-ASCII characters are used.
z
For information on defining URL resources, see “Adding Resources” on page 119.
Example: Blocking Email Attachments
Your organization may need to restrict access to sensitive data for users working from an
unmanaged or untrusted public system. For example, you may want to allow users to view email
messages, but prevent them from downloading email attachments that could be left behind on the
computer and accessible to unauthorized users.
The following example demonstrates how to use an access control rule, together with a Matching
URL resource and End Point Control zone, to block attachments from being downloaded to untrusted
devices.
z
For an overview of access control, see “Access Control Rules” on page 144.
z
The example assumes that you have an EPC zone configured (named Untrusted in this example)
into which devices that are not IT-managed are classified; see “Managing EPC with Zones and
Device Profiles” on page 256 for information about configuring and using zones.
126
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
X
To block email attachments using a Matching URL resource
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Access Control.
2. Click New. The Add/Edit Access Rule page appears.
3. In the Number box, type a number to specify the rule’s position in the access rule list.
4. Use the Action buttons to specify Deny. This will deny users access to any resource that
matches the pattern you specify in the next step.
5. Complete the information under Basic settings:
a. Leave User selected (so that the rule applies to users trying to access a resource).
b. The From box specifies the users to whom the rule applies. For this example, leave the
value as Any user.
c. In the To box, click Edit to specify the target resource for this rule. A Resources window
appears.
d. Click New and then select Matching URL. The Add Resource - Matching URL page
appears.
e. Type a name for the resource. For example, Block email attachments.
f. In the URL box, type the URL address of your mail server.
g. In the Path and query string matching area, select Exchange/OWA attachments from
the Type of match list.
h. Click Save. The Add Resource - Matching URL window closes.
6. In the End Point Control zones area, click Edit to select the zone from which you will deny
access to the resource (Untrusted).
7. When you create a rule that specifies a Matching URL resource type, the user must be allowed
to use a browser as an access method. On the Advanced tab, in the Access method
restrictions area, make sure that the Client software agents are either set to Any, or that
Web browser is among the selected agents.
8. Click Finish.
Notes
z
Some Web-based applications automatically redirect users to other Web pages. Be certain to
use the target URL address (the Web page to which users are redirected) when configuring the
appliance to block email attachments. See “Example: Working with a URL Redirect” on page 138
for more information.
z
You cannot configure a Matching URL resource to block attachments for users who connect to
the appliance using OnDemand Tunnel or Connect Tunnel.
Example: Supporting Exchange on iPhones
Exchange ActiveSync is supported for Symbian OS, Android, iPads, and iPhones. Symbian is a
popular platform for smart phones such as Nokia or Samsung, and provides email notification, mail,
calendar, contacts, tasks, and out of office functions. Android, Google’s mobile OS, and Apple’s iPad
and iPhone also support email and related functions via Exchange ActiveSync.
The following example describes configuring a URL resource to support iPhone users who wish to
access Microsoft Exchange.
z
This example assumes you have a realm which uses single Active Directory authentication.
X
Allow iPhone users to access corporate Exchange server
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
2. Click New. Select URL. The Add Resource URL page appears.
3. Enter the name, description, and externally-facing URL. Enter only the server name without a
starting or index page. In this example, we will use internalexchangeserver.sonicwall.com.
4. Choose a group to add this resource to. In this example, we have left this in the default group.
5. Click Exchange ActiveSync Options. The Exchange ActiveSync Options section appears.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
127
6. Select the Provide Exchange ActiveSync access to this resource check box.
7. In the Host and domain name field, type the external host name and domain that will be
accessed by iPhone users.
8. Select the host address from the IP address drop-down list or select (New) and then type
the host address into the New IP address field.
9. Select the certificate from the SSL certificate drop-down list or select (New) and then type
the certificate information into the Organization and Country fields. If you own a wildcard
certificate on this domain, you may use it here. For example, if you own a certificate for
*.mycompany.com, you could use it for iPhone access at iphonemail.mycompany.com and for
VPN access at vpnaccess.mycompany.com.
10. Select the realm from the Realm drop-down list. Only realms that use Active Directory for
authentication are available as choices.
11. Click Save.
12. To configure an ActiveSync device profile for iPhones, click End Point Control in the main
navigation menu in AMC.
13. On the Device Profiles tab, click New and select Exchange ActiveSync.
14. Enter a name and description for the device profile in the Name and Description fields.
15. In the Add attribute(s) section, select Equipment ID for the Type.
16. In the Device identifier field, enter the user attribute variable that contains the device
identifier. For iPhone, the identifier is the serial number of the device. For details, see the
Equipment ID table under “Device Profile Attributes” on page 267.
17. Click Save.
18. Notify your iPhone users of the externally-facing URL and instruct them to log in using their
Active Directory credentials. Users must configure ActiveSync for Exchange on the device:
a. On the iPhone, navigate to Settings > Mail > Contacts and Calendars > Add Account
> User’s account info.
b. Set the server name to the URL (external host name and domain) provided by the
administrator.
Notes
z
To ensure that your Exchange server is correctly configured to work with iPhones, it is
recommended that you test iPhone access with the Exchange server directly. After confirming
iPhone access to email, then add the SRA appliance between the iPhone and the Exchange
server. If your Exchange server is not accessible from the Internet, you can set up a WiFi access
point to test iPhone access to it.
For details about setting up an Exchange server for iPhone access, refer to the iPhone
Enterprise Deployment Guide, available at:
http://manuals.info.apple.com/en_US/Enterprise_Deployment_Guide.pdf.
Example: Restricting Access to Sensitive Data
The following example demonstrates how to use an access control rule, together with a Matching
URL resource and End Point Control zone, to prevent a Web-based application from displaying
restricted data to untrusted devices.
z
For an overview of access control, see “Access Control Rules” on page 144.
z
The example assumes that you have an EPC zone configured (named Untrusted in this example)
into which devices that are not IT-managed are classified; see “Managing EPC with Zones and
Device Profiles” on page 256 for information about configuring and using zones.
X
Prevent a Web-based application from retrieving data using a Matching URL resource
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Access Control.
2. Click New. The Add/Edit Access Rule page appears.
3. In the Number box, type a number to specify the rule’s position in the access rule list.
128
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
4. Use the Action buttons to specify Deny. This will deny users access to any resource that
matches the pattern you specify in the next step.
5. Complete the information under Basic settings:
a. Leave User selected (so that the rule applies to users trying to access a resource).
b. The From box specifies the users to whom the rule applies. For this example, leave the
value as Any user.
c. In the To box, click Edit to specify the target resource for this rule. A Resources window
appears.
d. Click New and then select Matching URL. The Add Resource - Matching URL page
appears.
e. Type a name for the resource. For example, Patient Records.
f. In the URL box, type the URL address of your Web-based application. For example,
www.patient-records.com.
g. In the Path and query string matching area, select Custom from the Type of match
list.
h. Click New and then select Path element. Type reports.aspx and then click OK (the path
is not case-sensitive).
i. Click New again and select Query string. Type last_name= and then click OK (the query
string is case-sensitive).
j. Click Save. The Add Resource - Matching URL window closes.
6. In the End Point Control zones area, click Edit to select the zone from which you will deny
access to the resource (Untrusted).
7. When you create a rule that specifies a Matching URL resource type, the user must be allowed
to use a browser as an access method. On the Advanced tab, in the Access method
restrictions area, make sure that the Client software agents are either set to Any, or that
Web browser is among the selected agents.
8. Click Finish.
Once you save and apply your changes, users who attempt to open the Patient Records resource
(using a URL that matches http://www.patient-records.com/reports.aspx?last_name=) and
who are classified into the Untrusted zone will be denied access.
Notes
z
Some Web-based applications automatically redirect users to other Web pages. Be certain to
use the target URL address (the Web page to which users are redirected) when configuring the
appliance to block email attachments. See “Example: Working with a URL Redirect” on page 138
for more information.
z
You cannot configure a Matching URL resource to restrict access to sensitive data for users who
connect to the appliance using OnDemand Tunnel or Connect Tunnel.
Editing Resources
Before modifying a resource, carefully examine any Access Control rules associated with it to
understand how your changes will affect your security policy.
X
To edit a resource
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
2. Click the name of the resource that you want to edit.
3. On the Add/Edit Resource page, make your edits as needed.
4. Click Save.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
129
Notes
z
You cannot change an existing client/server resource’s definition setting (for example, change
a host name to an IP range); instead, you must create a new resource and apply the appropriate
definition setting.
Deleting Resources
You cannot delete a resource that is referenced in an access control rule, resource group, or
WorkPlace shortcut. Before deleting a resource, you must first remove it from any rules in which it
is referenced. See “Deleting Referenced Objects” on page 54 for more details.
X
To delete a resource
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
2. On the Resources page, select the check box to the left of any resources that you want to
delete.
3. Click the Delete button. If this resource is still referenced by an access control rule, resource
group, or WorkPlace shortcut, AMC displays an error message. Click the link in the error
message to see a list of all references to this resource.
Using the Resource Exclusion List
By default, access agents and Web browsers redirect connections through the appliance for
destination resources that you’ve defined in AMC. This redirection is a little different, depending on
the user’s means of access:
z
The tunnel access agent redirects connections through the appliance for any destination
resource that the user is permitted to access.
z
A Web browser redirects to the appliance all destination resources that have been defined in
AMC; if the user does not have access, a “permission denied” Web page is displayed.
There may, however, be resources that you don’t want redirected through the appliance. For
example, a user starts Outlook Web Access through the appliance and reads an email message with
a link to a public site that is within a domain resource configured on the appliance. The traffic
generated by following that link would be sent through the appliance. You can prevent this by
specifying the public resource in the exclusion list.
Use the resource exclusion list to specify any resources (including host names, IP addresses, or
domains) from being redirected through the appliance. When specifying a domain, you can also use
the wildcard characters asterisk (*) and question mark (?). This list is global and applies to all
access services.
The resource exclusion list does not affect access control or security. If you want to prevent access
to particular resources, add a Deny rule to the access control list.
X
To add a resource to the resource exclusion list
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
2. Click the Resource exclusion list link at the bottom of the page.
3. In the Exclusion list box, click New, and then type the host name, IP address, or domain
that you want to exclude from being redirected through the appliance. Wildcard characters (*
and ?) are permitted.
For example, if you have three public web servers (www.YourCompany.com,
www2.YourCompany.com, and www3.YourCompany.com), you can allow the network traffic
associated with them to avoid the appliance, which will improve performance. Add all three
public sites to the Exclusion list by using a wildcard character: www*.YourCompany.com.
130
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
Resources in this list can also contain variables; see “Using Variables in Resource and
WorkPlace Shortcut Definitions” on page 130 for more information.
4. Click OK after each addition to the Exclusion list.
5. Click Save.
Notes
z
To see which resources are configured to be redirected through the appliance, click the Show
network redirection list link. This displays the Redirection List page.
z
To delete a resource from the exclusion list, select its check box and then click Delete.
z
If you exclude a resource by specifying its fully qualified domain name (FQDN), users who
connect to WorkPlace from a realm that provides access using translated Web mode can still
access the resource if they type its unqualified domain name in the WorkPlace Intranet
Address box.
!
CAUTION If you create a Domain resource in AMC (for example, win.yourcompany.com),
and you exclude a resource from that domain using its IP address (10.20.30.40), the resource
can still be accessed using its FQDN (server.win.yourcompany.com). This note of caution
applies only to agents that use the Web proxy service, not the tunnel clients.
Using Variables in Resource and WorkPlace Shortcut Definitions
Using variables, you can define a single resource or WorkPlace shortcut that derives its value from
a property that is unique for each user. Variables can be defined by a property associated with the
session a user has started (the user name, for example, or the name of the zone to which he or she
has been assigned), or by querying an external LDAP store for a specific set of attributes, such as
a group or computer name.
Notes
z
Variables can be used for all resource types except IP range and Subnet.
z
If a variable resolves to nothing, any configuration item using it will be undefined. For example,
you might query an LDAP store for a user’s IMEI number (the built-in ID number on a mobile
device). In the case of a user who does not have an IMEI number, the variable would not resolve
to anything during that user session. A WorkPlace shortcut that uses the variable would not be
displayed, for example, and a policy rule that uses it will also fail.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
131
Using Session Property Variables
Once a user has started a WorkPlace session by logging in, there are several session properties that
are known, such as the name of the community to which the user has been assigned. You can use
these properties to create dynamic resources.
For example, you might want mobile users to have access to a different network share than users
with desktop computers. The way you would do this is as roughly as follows:
z
Define two communities (Mobile and Desktop).
z
Set up two file shares on your network. For example, \\company\Mobile and
\\company\Desktop.
z
Define a resource for WorkPlace: \\company\{Session.communityName}.
A single resource can in this manner present both kinds of users with the link that’s appropriate for
their devices.
Built-in variables
Description
{Session.activeDirectoryDomain}
The FQDN or IP address of the AD domain to use as a
search base.
{Session.activeDirectoryDomain2}
The FQDN or IP address of a second AD domain to use as
a search base (if you’re using chained authentication).
{Session.communityName}
The name of the community to which the user was
assigned when he or she logged in. The community
controls which access agents are available and the end
point.
{Session.ntDomain}
The login domain. For example, server3 in this FQDN:
server3.uk.company.com.
{Session.password}
The password from the first authentication method.
{Session.password2}
The password from the second authentication method, if
used.
{Session.qualifiedName}
For your primary (or only) authentication method, this is
the fully qualified user name
([email protected]).
{Session.qualifiedName2}
For your secondary authentication method, this is the fully
qualified user name.
{Session.realmName}
The name of the realm the user is logged in to.
{Session.remoteAddress}
The IP address of the user's host as seen by the appliance.
{Session.userName}
The short name for the user from the first authentication
method. The short name is usually used for both the
user’s email address and home folder.
{Session.userName2}
The user’s short name from the second authentication
method, if used.
{Session.zoneName}
The name of the zone to which the user has been
assigned, based on the profile of his or her device.
X
To create a WorkPlace shortcut to a network share based on user name
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
2. Click New, and then select Network share.
3. Give this resource a name (for example, Personal Folder), and then type the UNC path for
the user folders on your network in the Network share box. For example,
\\marine_lab\users\.
132
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
4. Click {variable} and select Session.userName to add a variable that represents the short
login name for the user. When you click Insert, the entry for Network share looks like this:
\\marine_lab\users\{Session.userName}
5. Select the Create shortcut on Aventail WorkPlace check box, and then click Save. By
default, the resource you created will be displayed as a link in WorkPlace titled Personal Folder.
If you want to change the link text, go to the Aventail WorkPlace page in AMC, and then
click the link for the new shortcut.
When the user jdoe connects to WorkPlace, the variable is automatically replaced with the name
entered during login and provides access to a folder named \\marine_lab\users\jdoe. When user
rsmith follows the same link, he has access to the \\marine_lab\users\rsmith folder.
Notes
z
For instructions on defining a new variable based on an LDAP query, see “Using Query-Based
Variables” on page 132.
z
There is an additional built-in variable named {URL_REF_VALUE}, which is the value of the first
variable in the URL of a shortcut. See “Displaying a Series of Shortcuts Using a Single Definition”
on page 135 for an example of how to use this.
Using Query-Based Variables
When you configure a realm to use an Active Directory or LDAP authentication server, resources can
be defined by querying the external LDAP store for a specific attribute or set of attributes. For
example, you can use an LDAP query to create a single resource offering each user a WorkPlace link
to his or her personal desktop from home or elsewhere, using the remote desktop protocol (RDP)
that is built into Windows.
X
To create a resource variable that points to users’ remote desktops
1. Modify your LDAP store and add an attribute named rdp.
2. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
3. Click the Variables tab, and then click New.
4. Enter a name for the variable (for example, Desktop), and then select User attribute as the
Type.
5. Enter rdp in the Attribute text box.
6. In the Output list, leave Single result selected if each user has only one computer associated
with him or her in the LDAP store.
7. Select the realm to which this new variable applies, and then enter the username of someone
who has access to that realm in the User text box.
8. Click Test to make sure that the user attribute you specified returns a value for this user.
9. Click Save.
10. On the Resources tab, click New, and then select Host name or IP.
11. Give a name to this resource (for example, Personal computer).
12. In the Host name or IP address text box, click {variable}, and then select {Desktop}, the
variable you created earlier. Click Insert.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
133
13. Edit the entry for Host name or IP address to add the portion of the address that the
personal computers on your network share. The completed entry might look something like
this:
{Desktop}.dept.company.com
As each user logs in, {Desktop} is replaced by the machine name associated with him or her
in the LDAP store using the rdp attribute.
14. Click Save.
X
To create a WorkPlace link to give users access to their remote desktops
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Aventail WorkPlace.
2. Click New, and then select Graphical terminal shortcut.
3. In the Resource list, select Personal computer, and then specify what the link text will be in
WorkPlace. For example, My remote desktop.
4. Click Save. By default, the resource you created will be displayed as a link in WorkPlace titled
My remote desktop.
When the user John Doe connects to WorkPlace from home or on the road, {Desktop} is replaced
by the contents of the rdp attribute associated with him in the LDAP store, and he sees a WorkPlace
link (My remote desktop) that points to his office computer (john_doe-340.dept.company.com).
When Paula Smith follows the same link, she has access to paula_smith-452.dept.company.com. If
the rdp attribute is empty for a given user, then that user will not see a WorkPlace shortcut when
he or she logs in.
X
To create a variable that contains a variable
You can simplify the creation of user-specific links or shortcuts by using one or more variables to
define another one. For example, in the procedure above, a Host name or IP address resource
was defined as follows, using a variable named {Desktop} followed by a string, in this case the
path:
{Desktop}.dept.company.com
You could instead create a variable named {Desktop_path} that resolves to the entire path above.
In another example of using multiple variables to create a single variable, you could replace dept
in the path above with the user’s ou (organizational unit) attribute in the LDAP store. This table
summarizes the possibilities in the examples outlined here:
AMC variable name
Resolves to...
Based on...
{Desktop}
john_doe-340
rdp (LDAP attribute)
{dept}
Sales
ou (LDAP attribute)
{Desktop_path}
john_doe-340.dept.company.com
AMC variable defined as follows:
{Desktop}.dept.company.com
{Desktop_by_dept}
john_doe-340.Sales.company.com
AMC variable defined as follows:
{Desktop}.{ou}.company.com
Notes
z
Variables cannot be nested more than two deep: you cannot create a variable that refers to a
variable that in turn refers to another variable.
Modifying Query Results
You can create a variable by querying an external AD/LDAP store for a specific attribute or set of
attributes. To make the query results more useful, you can automatically extract data from them:
after the query is sent and the full variable string has been determined, you can perform search
and replace operations on its value.
134
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
For example, let’s say you have a company with offices in multiple locations, and each office uses
a different Exchange server for e-mail. Using some editing options, you can define a single variable
that represents both Exchange servers, regardless of location.
X
To define a variable by automatically editing the results of a query
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
2. Click the Variables tab, and then click New.
3. Enter a name for your variable. For example, Exchange_server.
4. In the Type list, select User attribute.
5. Select the appropriate realm from the list: it should point to the AD/LDAP store that you will
query.
6. In the Attribute list, select msExchHomeServerName.
7. Query the directory server for two different employees—for example, one at headquarters in
London, and one in California—by entering the user name and clicking Test for each one. In
this example the only difference is in the server name at the end of the resulting strings:
/o=Your Company, Inc./ou=UK/cn=Configuration/cn=Servers/cn=LN0EXL09
/o=Your Company, Inc./ou=UK/cn=Configuration/cn=Servers/cn=CA0EXV08
8. Now modify the query results by clicking New in the Editing options area:
a. In the Search box, enter the following:
/o=Your Company, Inc./ou=UK/cn=Configuration/cn=Servers/cn=
b. Leave the Replace box empty, and then click OK.
For an employee in the London office or one in California, the variable named Exchange_server will
contain the appropriate name, either LN0EXL09 or CA0EXV08, depending on the user.
Using the same query, you can create an additional variable that indicates where an employee is
based. For example, create a new variable named Location and replace the name of each directory
server with its location:
The Location variable will resolve to London or California, depending on the user.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
135
For example, when you enter a London employee’s name in the User box and click Test, you’ll
see the following results:
Displaying a Series of Shortcuts Using a Single Definition
When you create a variable based on a user’s session properties or the results of a query, the
variable can resolve to one value per user attribute (for example, sAMAccountName and lastLogon),
or multiple values (such as a list of groups to which a user belongs, or the workstations a user is
permitted to log in to). When a variable can have multiple values, you have the option of creating
one shortcut for it that is automatically displayed as a series of shortcuts in WorkPlace.
In this example, we’ll create a single shortcut that will result in a series of WorkPlace shortcuts, one
for each workstation the user is allowed to access. Here’s an overview of the process:
Step
Description
A
Create a variable named User_workstations that points to a multi-valued attribute in
an AD or LDAP server named userWorkstations. In the directory store, this attribute
lists the workstations a user is allowed to access. For example, a user might have a
personal workstation at work, and another workstation that’s used for order inventory.
B
Create a host resource named Workstation_list that points to the User_workstations
variable. For the user in this example, the resource has two possible values.
C
Create a WorkPlace graphical terminal shortcut that points to the Workstation_list
resource. The link for this shortcut will refer to a special, built-in variable named
{URL_REF_VALUE}, which will automatically result in separate links in WorkPlace for
each of the workstations a user is permitted to use.
D
Test WorkPlace. If the shortcut does not appear, it may be because the directory store
query is not returning any results. Testing it will also help you see whether you need
to adjust the location of the shortcuts in your WorkPlace layout.
X
A: Create a variable that points to a user attribute in the AD server
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources, and then go to the Variables page.
2. Click New, and then enter a name for the variable: User_workstations.
3. Select User attribute in the Type list, and then specify the realm that uses the directory store
you want to query.
4. In the drop-down list of attributes returned from the AD store, select userWorkstations.
5. In the Output list, select Multiple results.
6. In the User text box, enter the name of a representative user (someone who is likely to use
this shortcut), and then query the AD/LDAP store for the values of userWorkstations by
clicking Test.
136
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
7. The test results will indicate what character (for example, a comma or a semicolon) you should
enter in the Delimiter box.
8. Click Save. The new variable ({User_workstations}) appears in the list and can now be used
to define or describe other variables, resources, or WorkPlace shortcuts.
X
B: Create a host resource that points to the {User_workstations} variable
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
2. Click New, and then select Host Name or IP Address.
3. Enter Workstation_list as the resource name.
4. In the Host name or IP address box, click {variable}, and then select
{User_workstations}, the variable you created in step A.
5. Click Insert, and then click {variable} again to close the list.
6. Edit the entry for Host name or IP address to add the portion of the address that the
computers on your network share. The completed entry might look something like this:
{User_Workstations}.dept.company.com
X
C: Create a WorkPlace shortcut that points to the Workstation_list resource
1. From the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace.
2. On the Shortcuts page, click New, and then select Graphical terminal shortcut from the list.
The General tab of the Add Graphical Terminal Shortcut page appears.
3. In the Position box, specify the shortcut’s position in the list. (It’s possible to change its
position later in your WorkPlace layout.)
4. In the Resource list, select the resource to which this shortcut will be linked:
Workstation_list.
5. In the Link text box, type the first part of the hyperlink users will see. For example, enter My
workstation(s): followed by a space.
6. Using a variable you can have the link end in each succeeding value for Workstation_list; if
there is more than one, then more than one shortcut will be displayed in WorkPlace. Click
{variable}, and then select {URL_REF_VALUE} from the list. Click Insert to add the variable
to the link text, and then close the list by clicking {variable} again. The entry for Link now
looks like this:
My workstation(s): {URL_REF_VALUE}
7. Click Finish to save the shortcut. (For a description of the settings on the Advanced page,
see “Adding Graphical Terminal Shortcuts to Individual Hosts” on page 362.)
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
137
This shortcut will automatically result in separate links in WorkPlace for each of the workstations a
user is permitted to use. The two WorkPlace links in our example—one to a personal workstation
and one to a workstation for entering orders—would look like this for the user “ageorge”:
X
D: Troubleshooting WorkPlace
1. If users log in to WorkPlace and do not see the shortcut you created, check the following:
a. Is the user in the right community? In the main navigation menu in AMC, click User
Sessions, and then click the user’s name to get session details. The user may not be
assigned to the right community, or there may be a rule preventing him or her from
accessing the resource.
b. Does the variable return a result for this user? In the main navigation menu in AMC, click
Resources, and then go to the Variables page. Click the variable named
User_workstations, enter the name of the person who is not seeing the shortcut, and then
click Test. If no result is returned, the shortcut will not be displayed.
2. Check your WorkPlace layout. When you create a shortcut, you have the opportunity to add it
to a group of shortcuts or to the default group (Standalone shortcuts). To change the position
of the shortcut, click Realms, and then click the name of the community to which this user
belongs. The WorkPlace Appearance page indicates which layout is being used. To modify
page content, click Manage layouts.
Creating and Managing Resource Groups
You can define individual resources or manage them in resource groups, which are collections of
individual resources. Grouping resources provides a convenient way to manage access to a set of
resources with similar characteristics. For example, you might define a resource group containing
applications that are important only to your remote employee, simplifying the process of managing
access to those resources.
There is no limit to the number of resources that a resource group can contain. When you create a
new resource group, it is added to your list of available resources and groups; you can then use the
resource group in access control rules.
Adding Resource Groups
When you create a new resource group, it is added to the list of available groups on the Resource
Groups tab of the Resources page.
X
To add a resource group
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
2. Click the Resource Groups tab, and then click New.
3. Type a Name for the resource group.
4. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the group.
138
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
5. Select the check box for each resource you want to include in the group, or leave the group
empty and add resources to it later. There is no limit to the number of resources that a group
can contain.
6. After you have finished, click Save.
Example: Working with a URL Redirect
Some Web-based applications automatically redirect users to other Web pages. A user accessing
the application may browse to a particular Web address, but then be redirected to a different
address.
For example, an organization has a mail server with the following URL:
http://domino.example.com/dwa.nsf
A user who accesses this site is then automatically redirected to a different URL:
http://domino.example.com/mail/dwa1.nsf
To give users access to the application using the SonicWALL SSL VPN appliance, you need to add
both the original and the redirected URLs as resources.
The following example demonstrates how to add your Web-based application as a pair of URL
resources, how to group the resources together, and then how to define an access control rule so
that your users have access to the application.
X
Configure URL resources for your Web-based application
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
2. Click New and then select URL from the drop-down list. The Add/Edit Resource – URL page
appears.
3. In the Name box, type a name for the resource. For example, Mail Web App.
4. In the URL box, type the address of the mail server. For example,
http://domino.example.com/dwa.nsf.
5. Click Save.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
139
6. Repeat the previous steps to create a second Web resource specifying the redirected URL
address. If your application uses more than one redirected URL, create an additional URL
resource for each address; this example assumes there are only two URLs involved.
X
Create a resource group for both URL resources
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
2. Click the Resource Group tab, and then click New. The Add/Edit Resource Group page
appears.
3. In the Name box, type a name for the group resource. For example, Mail Web App Group.
4. Select the check boxes for each of the Web resources previously created.
5. Click Save.
X
Define an access control rule for the resource group
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Access Control.
2. Click New. The Add/Edit Access Rule page appears.
3. In the Number box, type a number to specify the rule’s position in the access rule list.
4. Use the Action buttons to specify Permit. This will allow users to access the group resource
that you specify in the next step.
5. Complete the information under Basic settings:
a. Leave User selected (so that the rule applies to users trying to access a resource).
b. The From box specifies the users to whom the rule applies. For this example, leave the
value as Any user.
c. In the To box, click Edit to specify the target resource for this rule. A Resources window
appears.
d. Select the resource group previously created. In this example, Mail Web App Group.
6. Click Save.
Notes
z
For an overview of access control, see “Access Control Rules” on page 144.
Editing and Deleting Resource Groups
Before modifying a resource group, carefully examine the associated rules to understand how your
changes will affect your security policy. You cannot delete a resource group that is referenced in an
access control rule. Before deleting a resource group, you must first remove it from any rules in
which it is referenced. See “Deleting Referenced Objects” on page 54 for more details.
Web Application Profiles
Web application profiles provide single sign-on and translation control for Web applications that use
Windows NTLM authentication (v1 and v2 are both supported), or basic authentication.
z
With a Web application that uses Windows NTLM authentication, access is granted only to users
whose Windows credentials can be verified. Support for NTLM is built into Microsoft IIS
(Internet-based services for Windows machines) and supported in Internet Explorer.
z
Basic authentication is supported on a wide variety of platforms (note, however, that it sends
passwords in the clear across the network).
You can also configure the Web proxy service in AMC to support forms-based authentication, in
which users authenticate by filling out a standard HTML form Web using any combination of browser
and Web server. See “Creating Forms-Based Single Sign-On Profiles” on page 143 for more
information.
Viewing Web Application Profiles
Web application profiles are listed on the Configure Web Proxy Service page.
140
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
X
To view your list of available Web application profiles
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Services.
2. In the Access Services area, click the Configure link for Web proxy service.
3. To view your available Web profiles, click the Web Application Profiles tab. The Configure
Web Proxy Service page appears.
4. The list includes preconfigured Web application profiles that are recommended for several
popular Web applications, any custom Web profiles you created, and a default Web profile. To
view the settings for a Web application profile, click its name.
Adding Web Application Profiles
Web application profiles control single sign-on characteristics, as well as content translation options
for a particular Web resource. Each Web resource should have a Web application profile associated
with it.
z
Single sign-on options control whether and how a user’s login credentials are forwarded to
downstream Web applications. These options are disabled by default. In addition, one of the
following is required in order to configure single sign-on:
{
Click Use Web content translation on the Configure WorkPlace page in AMC.
{
Define a WorkPlace link as an aliased URL. This is the approach you should take if you
normally redirect traffic through a network agent, but in this case you want to force the
resource to be proxied using translated, custom port mapped, or custom FQDN mapped
Web access for single sign-on.
For more information, see “Web Shortcut Access” on page 291 and “Configuring WorkPlace
General Settings” on page 291.
z
Content translation options control whether hyperlinks in JavaScript code, in cookie bodies,
and in cookie paths are translated by the Web proxy service. The options are used only by the
translated Web access agent: they are ignored by standard Web access.
Web application profiles are not used if Web shortcut access is set to Redirect through network
agent on the Configure WorkPlace page in AMC. See “Configuring WorkPlace General Settings”
on page 291.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
141
To add a Web application profile
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Services.
2. In the Access Services area, click the Configure link for Web proxy service. The
Configure Web Proxy Service page appears.
3. Click the Web Application Profiles tab, and then click New. The Add Web Application
Profile page appears.
4. In the Name box, type a name for the profile. If you are creating a profile to associate with a
specific application, you might want to give it a name similar to that of the application.
5. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the profile.
6. In the Single Sign-On area, specify if and how you want user credentials to be passed along
to the Web resource. Forwarding user credentials prevents the user from having to log in
multiple times (once to get to the appliance, and again to access an application resource).
{
If you select the Forward each user’s individual username and password check box,
the username and password used to authenticate to WorkPlace are forwarded to the backend Web server.
{
If you select the Forward static credentials check box, the appliance forwards the same
username and password for all users. This is useful for Web sites that require HTTP basic
authentication, but don’t provide personalized content for each user based on the login
name. It’s also useful for users who authenticate with a client certificate or token.
{
If you do not select either option, single sign-on functionality is disabled. If you select both
options, the individual username and password option takes precedence. For example, if
the user provides a username/password pair, it is forwarded, but if username/password is
not provided, the Web proxy service forwards the static credentials.
7. In the Content translation area, select the items that you want the Web proxy service to
translate.
{
Select the Translate JavaScript code check box if you want the Web proxy service to
translate links embedded in JavaScript code used by the Web resource. This is useful for
JavaScript that contains absolute URLs or absolute references (/to/path/xyz), or that
142
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
dynamically generates URLs (for example, location=“http://” + host name +
“/index.html”). This improves compatibility with Microsoft Outlook Web Access and other
applications that rely on JavaScript. This option is enabled by default.
{
Select the Translate content based on file extension check box if you want the Web
proxy service to determine content type by examining the file extension, not the MIME
type. Normally, the Web proxy service translates certain content types (including text and
HTML). It determines the content type from the MIME type in the HTTP header. If a Web
resource is sending the incorrect MIME type, select this option and the Web proxy service
will decide whether or not to translate a file based on its file extension. This option is
disabled by default.
{
Select the Translate cookie body check box if you want the Web proxy service to
translate URLs embedded in the body of a cookie. If a Web resource uses embedded URLs
in the body of a cookie (which is not common practice), and you do not have this option
enabled, users can experience problems. A common symptom is being unexpectedly
redirected to another URL. This option is enabled by default.
{
Select the Translate cookie path check box if you want the Web proxy service to
translate the path attribute of cookies sent by back-end resources. The browser uses
cookie paths to determine when to send a cookie back to the server. The appliance
changes the path that the browser sees, so if the cookie path is not translated, the
browser will never send the cookie. A common symptom of this situation is a user being
prompted repeatedly for login credentials after already entering valid ones. If this occurs,
you should enable this option. This option is enabled by default.
8. Click Save.
Notes
z
You can configure single sign-on when you create a WorkPlace shortcut for accessing a Windows
Terminal Services or Citrix host. See “Adding Graphical Terminal Shortcuts to Individual Hosts”
on page 362.
z
The Web translation that AMC performs is more complete and robust in recent versions of the
appliance software. Beginning in version 10.x, it is no longer possible to revert to the legacy
translation for Web application profiles that worked in version 8.6.x.
Preconfigured Web Application Profiles
Several preconfigured Web application profiles are included with the appliance and are
recommended for certain commonly used Web applications. (More can be added; see “Adding Web
Application Profiles” on page 140.) Preconfigured profiles include:
Web application profile
Description
Default
A default profile that you can use for most Web applications or
sites that don’t use NTLM or basic authentication single sign-on
Domino Web Access 6.x
A profile for Lotus Domino Web Access (versions 6.x only)
iNotes 5.x
A profile for Lotus iNotes (versions 5.x only)
Onyx CRM
A profile for the Onyx CRM Employee Portal (versions 4 and later)
OWA/Single Sign-On
A profile for Microsoft Outlook Web Access and other sites that use
NTLM or basic authentication single sign-on
WorkPlaceCfg
A read-only profile for WorkPlace
Web Application Profile Examples
The following explains how the appliance determines which Web application profile to apply to an
incoming request, and demonstrates the flexibility of using profiles when specifying resources.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
143
How requests for Web resources are evaluated
Because Web resources can be defined quite broadly, the appliance follows a rule for determining
which Web application profile to apply to an incoming request: it chooses the profile associated with
the most specific resource.
For example, suppose you’ve defined these two resources:
z
A DNS domain (xyz.com) with Web application profile A attached
z
A specific Web server (web1.xyz.com) with Web application profile B attached
If a user request comes in for https://web1.xyz.com/timesheet.html, the appliance uses Web
application profile B because it is associated with a more specific resource (the Web server) than
Web application profile A (the domain). The actual order that the appliance uses is as follows:
URL —> Host name —> IP address —> Subnet/IP range —> DNS domain
Associating one profile with an entire domain
If you want to associate the same Web application profile to all resources within a single domain,
associate a profile with that domain, and then select None as the profile for any individual resources
you define that are within that domain. The individual resource will inherit the domain’s profile. If
there is no profile associated with a particular resource, and there is no profile to inherit, the
appliance uses the system defaults for the profile.
Editing and Deleting Web Application Profiles
Before modifying a profile, confirm that the changes will be compatible with its associated
applications.
If a profile is still associated with one or more resources, AMC prevents you from deleting it. You
must remove all associations before you can delete the profile. See “Deleting Referenced Objects”
on page 54 for more details.
Creating Forms-Based Single Sign-On Profiles
Many Web applications use forms-based authentication, in which the user enters a set of credentials
into HTML form fields, and a session token is stored in a browser cookie. This type of authentication
is popular because it is supported on any combination of browser and Web server. The other benefit
is that you can customize the login page.
Use AMC to set up a single sign-on profile that will forward a user’s appliance credentials to a Web
application that uses forms-based authentication. This process is not automated and may require
help from SonicWALL Technical Support; you should be familiar with the HTML code and know things
like the form element names and the name of the cookie that stores user credentials.
There are also some built-in profiles that you can modify for your environment:
z
OWA 2003
z
Citrix Nfuse 1.7
z
Citrix MetaFrame XP
X
To modify the built-in single sign-on profile for Outlook Web Access
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Services.
2. In the Access services area, under Web proxy service, click Configure.
3. Click the Single Sign-On Profiles tab, and then click New. The Configure Single Sign-On
Profile page appears.
144
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
4. Type a Name and Description, and then select OWA 2003 (Outlook Web Access) from the
Application list. (To start from scratch and specify elements from a custom form, select
Other.)
5. In the Application URL box, type the URL for the Microsoft Exchange OWA form-based
authentication DLL. This is usually the FQDN of your Exchange server followed by
/exchweb/bin/auth/owaauth.dll. For example:
https://owaserver.domain.com/exchweb/bin/auth/owaauth.dll
6. In the Cookie name text box, type the file name of the cookie used to store user credentials.
7. Make changes to the form elements by clicking a link. (At a minimum, you must change the
destination element to match the Application URL.)
8. Click Save.
Notes
z
After a profile is set up, a user’s credentials are automatically sent to the back-end server every
time the user logs in, regardless whether the WorkPlace link is clicked. This can be a problem
where there is a limit to the number of allowed licenses.
z
When a user logs in, his or her credentials are sent to all of the Web applications for which an
a single sign-on profile is configured. Unlike a Web application profile, a single sign-on profile
is not associated with a resource in AMC—the application resource is defined within the profile.
z
For information on configuring SSO for a Web application that uses Windows NTLM or basic
authentication, see “Web Application Profiles” on page 139.
Access Control Rules
Access control rules determine which resources are available to users or groups. Rules can be
defined broadly to provide access using any method, or defined narrowly so that only a specific
access method—Web browser, Connect and OnDemand, or Network Explorer—is permitted.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
145
In addition to evaluating whether users can access resources based on who they are, access control
rules can also factor in the trustworthiness of users’ access points using End Point Control zones
and device profiles, which are described in “Managing EPC with Zones and Device Profiles” on
page 256.
Configuring Access Control Rules
As your network changes over time, you will need to configure the access control rules that
determine what application resources are available to your various users and groups.
Before adding an access control rule, carefully examine your existing rules; you might find that you
can modify a rule instead of creating a new one. You can also copy an existing rule and then modify
its parameters.
If you decide to add a new rule, review your current configuration to determine where the new rule
should fit in the rule order. New rules are added to the top of the list by default; you can then move
them to their proper positions.
Viewing Access Control Rules
Access control rules are displayed in numerical order on the Access Control page. The appliance
evaluates the rules in numbered order. All access control rules are displayed by default, but you can
use the Filters settings to filter them by resource type or other criteria.
X
To view access control rules
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Access Control.
2. By default, all of the rules that you have created, regardless of resource type, are displayed.
Use the Filters section to display a subset of rules. For information about using filters, see the
“Filters” section under “A Quick Tour of the AMC Interface” on page 38. To see a particular rule
set, select one of the following from the Method drop-down list in Filters:
Method
Description
Web browser
Display rules controlling access to Web-based (HTTP and
HTTPS) resources.
146
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
Method
Description
Aventail Connect/OnDemand
Display rules controlling access to client/server (TCP/IP)
resources.
Network Explorer
Display rules controlling access to Windows file system
resources using WorkPlace.
3. Review the data shown in the access control rule list:
{
Use the check-box column to select one or more rules to delete, copy, or reorder (using
the Move Up and Move Down buttons).
{
The number column indicates the order in which the rule will be evaluated. To edit a rule,
click its corresponding number.
{
To display configuration details and the objects referenced in a rule, click the plus sign (+)
next to it.
{
The Action column indicates whether a rule permits or denies access, or is ignored:
Indicator
Description
Green
Access is permitted.
Red
Access is denied.
Gray
The rule is not evaluated. (Disabling a rule is a convenient way to
temporarily stop using a rule without deleting it.)
{
The Description column lists the descriptive text you typed when creating the rule.
{
The From column indicates the users to whom the rule applies (Any applies to all users).
In the case of a reverse connection, this column indicates the resource that is connecting
to a user or group. See “Access Control Rules for Bi-Directional Connections” on page 146.
{
The To column lists the destination resources to which the rule applies (Any applies to all
users). In the case of a reverse connection, this column can also indicate the user or group
that is connecting back to a resource. See “Access Control Rules for Bi-Directional
Connections” on page 146.
{
The Method column indicates whether a specific access method is associated with a rule.
A globe icon signifies Web browser-based HTTP access; a globe icon with a folder
represents Network Explorer, which provides Web access to file system resources; the
Aventail logo indicates access using the Connect Tunnel or proxy clients, or the OnDemand
Tunnel or proxy agents. Any indicates that the rule applies to all access methods.
{
The Zone column indicates whether an access rule is associated with a particular End
Point Control zone. EPC zones are used to classify a connection request based on the
attributes of the client device. Any indicates the rule applies to all EPC zones; a red
“restricted” icon indicates that the rule controls access for one or more specific zones.
Access Control Rules for Bi-Directional Connections
VPN connections typically involve “forward connections,” which are initiated by a user to a
client/server resource. However, if you deploy SonicWALL’s network tunnel clients (Connect Tunnel
or OnDemand Tunnel) to your users, bi-directional connections are enabled.
With the SonicWALL VPN, bi-directional connections encompass the following:
z
Forward connections from a VPN user to a client/server resource. See “Adding Access Control
Rules for a Forward Connection” on page 147.
z
Reverse connections from a client/server resource to a VPN user. An example of a reverse
connection is an SMS server that “pushes” a software update to a user’s machine. See “Adding
Access Control Rules for a Reverse Connection” on page 151.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
z
|
147
Cross-connections refer specifically to VoIP (Voice over Internet Protocol) applications that
enable one VPN user to telephone another VPN user. Cross-connections require a pair of access
control rules: one for the forward connection and one for the reverse connection. See “Adding
a Pair of Access Control Rules for a Cross-Connection” on page 152.
Other examples of bi-directional connections include an FTP server that downloads files to or
uploads files from a VPN user, and remote Help Desk applications.
Requirements for Reverse and Cross-Connections
Before you can configure access control rules for reverse connections and cross-connections, the
following requirements must be met:
z
The network tunnel service must be running on the appliance. On the Services page in AMC,
check the status for Network tunnel service; it should be Running.
z
An IP address pool for the network tunnel clients must be configured. See “Configuring IP
Address Pools” on page 349 for information on how to set one up.
z
Users who have access to a VoIP application must belong to a community that is configured to
deploy the network tunnel clients (Connect Tunnel or OnDemand Tunnel) to their computers.
See “Creating and Configuring Communities” on page 166.
Securing Application Ports for Reverse Connections
By default, reverse connections from resources to users have access to all ports on users’
computers. For enhanced security, create access control rules for reverse connections that confine
access to the ports that an application specifically uses. Consult the application’s documentation for
information about which firewall ports must be open in order to use the application.
When configuring an access rule for a reverse connection, use the Destination restrictions option
to confine access to the ports required by the application making the reverse connection. See
“Configuring Advanced Access Control Rule Attributes” on page 154 for information on this option.
Adding Access Control Rules for a Forward Connection
Perform the following steps to add an access control rule for a forward connection from users to
destination resources. For information about creating an access control rule for a cross-connection
(for example, for a VoIP application), see “Adding a Pair of Access Control Rules for a CrossConnection” on page 152.
X
To add an access control rule for a forward connection
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Access Control.
2. Click New. The Edit Access Rule page appears.
3. Type a number in the Number box to specify the rule’s position in the access rule list. By
default, new rules are added to the top of the list, but you can use this box to place the rule
anywhere you want. For example, if you assign the number 3 to a new rule, the new rule will
be inserted before the current rule 3 (which will become rule 4). This field is required.
To the right of the Number box is a unique identifier for the rule, which you can use for
troubleshooting. When you add or change a rule, for example, the Management Console audit
148
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
log shows a record of the change using this ID. Logging is described in detail in “System
Logging and Monitoring” on page 196.
4. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the rule. This step is optional, but
a description can be helpful when viewing your list of rules later; it also appears in log files
where can be useful for debugging. The ID is a unique identifier automatically assigned by
AMC; it cannot be edited.
5. Use the Action buttons to specify whether the rule will be used to Permit or Deny access, or
if the rule is Disabled.
6. Complete the information listed under Basic settings.
{
Click User to configure a forward connection (from a user to a resource).
{
If you deploy a network tunnel client, click Resource to create a rule controlling a reverse
connection (resource to user) or a cross-connection (user to user). The network tunnel
service must be configured with an IP address pool before you can use reverse
connections (see “Configuring IP Address Pools” on page 349).
{
The From box specifies the users or user groups to whom the rule applies. Click Edit to
select from a list of users and groups. If no users or groups are specified, the value for this
field is Any user.
{
The To box specifies the destination resources or resource groups for the rule. Click Edit
to select from a list of resources. If no destination resources are selected, the value for
this field is Any resource.
7. In the End Point Control zones area, select the zones from which you will permit or deny
access to the resources. Click Edit to select from a list. The default for this field is Any zone.
See “Managing EPC with Zones and Device Profiles” on page 256 for information about
configuring and using zones.
8. Click Next to configure additional settings (see “Specifying Advanced Access Control Rule
Attributes” on page 148), or click Finish to save the current settings.
Specifying Advanced Access Control Rule Attributes
For most rules, a basic configuration that includes users or groups, destination resources, and
access methods is sufficient. However, additional options are available to provide even tighter
access. For example, you can control a connection based on the location of the user (by IP address).
Source networks are referenced in an access rule to permit or deny a connection to a destination
resource based on the location from which the request originates, provides even greater security.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
149
To configure advanced settings for an access control rule
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Access Control.
2. Click New. The Edit Access Rule page appears.
3. Click the Advanced tab.
4. In the Access method restrictions area, select one or more methods for access to the
resource. Any is the recommended setting in most circumstances, unless your security
environment requires you to use a particular method for access to a resource.
When you select access methods, the advanced options are enabled or disabled based on
whether they apply to the methods you specified. Click Selected to choose the access
methods this rule will require:
Access method
Description
Web browser
Manages access from HTTP or HTTPS resources for users
connecting using a Web browser.
The available Advanced settings are:
Network Explorer
z
User’s network address
z
Time and date restrictions
Manages access from Windows file system resources for
WorkPlace users connecting using Network Explorer.
The available Advanced settings are:
Connect and/or
OnDemand
z
User’s network address
z
Read/write permissions
z
Time and date restrictions
Manages access from TCP/IP resources such as client/server
applications, file servers, or databases, for users connecting with
one of the following:
z
The Connect Tunnel or proxy clients
z
The OnDemand Tunnel or proxy agents
For example, suppose you want to provide access to a network
domain for users who have Connect or OnDemand, but you don’t
want to allow browser access to Web resources within that domain.
You can do that by creating a rule that specifies Aventail Connect
and/or Aventail OnDemand as the only access method, and
specifies the network domain in the Client restrictions area.
The available Advanced settings are:
z
Protocols
z
User’s network address
z
Destination restrictions (ports)
z
Time and date restrictions
150
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
Click Selected to specify the Protocols that the network tunnel or proxy service will accept
from the client. A brief description of each command is included here, but for more details, see
http://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc1928.txt.
Protocol
Description
TCP
Enables normal TCP connections (for example, SSH, telnet, scp, and
so forth).
UDP
Allows the network tunnel or proxy service to make a UDP data
transfer. This is necessary for operations such as streaming audio and
Microsoft Outlook new-mail notification.
ICMP
(Internet Control Message protocol) Enables the ping and traceroute
network troubleshooting commands. Selecting this option will
configure the network tunnel or proxy service to allow these
operations on your behalf. This option also enables ICMP packets to
flow through the network tunnel or proxy service.
Accept bind requests
from server
Used in protocols that require the client to accept connections from the
server. FTP is a notable example: bind usually occurs with a
Connect/Bind pair of connections.
5. Under Client restrictions, in the User’s network address box, specify the names of any
source networks you want evaluated in the rule.
This is useful for controlling access based on the origin of the connection request. Click Edit to
select from the list of resources. If no source network is specified, the default value of this field
is Any. For reverse connections, this option can be used to block access requests to users’
computers that originate from specific ports or application resources.
6. Use Destination restrictions to restrict access over individual Ports or a range of ports. To
enable access on any port, click Any. To specify multiple ports, click Selected and type the
port numbers, separated by semicolons. To specify a port range, type the beginning and
ending numbers separated by a hyphen. For example, if you are building a policy to control
access to an SMTP mail server, you might allow access only over port 25 (the well-known port
for SMTP traffic). A list of the latest port number assignments is available at
http://www.iana.org/assignments/port-numbers.
Use Permissions to specify whether the rule will allow Read or Read/Write access to the
file system resources. These access privileges work in conjunction with Windows access
control rules. For a user to have certain file permissions, both entities (that is, Windows and
the appliance) must allow them. If you disable file uploads, no user can write to a file,
although users with write access will be able to move and delete files. These settings are
ignored by reverse connections.
7. Under Time and date restrictions, specify when the rule will be in effect. (The time zone for
the time restriction fields is your local time.) You can specify a Shift or a Range, or you can
specify that the rule remain in effect at all times.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
151
8. Click Save or, if you want to define another rule, click Finish and Add Another.
Notes
z
Because AMC gives you the flexibility to assign multiple access methods to resources, situations
may arise in which there is a mismatch between access methods and resources. This happens
if you create a rule that assigns an access method that is incompatible with the specified
resource. For example, designating Web browser as the method for accessing a Windows
domain resource will trigger an “Invalid destination resources” error message in AMC. For more
information, see “Resolving Invalid Destination Resources” on page 157.
z
In some cases you can create a Deny rule that contains a mix of resources and access methods
that may prevent subsequent rules from being evaluated. This could inadvertently block user
access to other resources referenced in the access policy. The logic used to determine access
method and resource compatibility is described in “Resolving Deny Rule Incompatibilities” on
page 157.
z
Reverse connections are available only when IP address pools are configured for the network
tunnel clients. AMC displays an error message if you attempt to change the rule from a forward
connection to a reverse connection and no IP address pools are configured.
Adding Access Control Rules for a Reverse Connection
Perform the following steps to add an access control rule for a reverse connection from a destination
resource to users. Examples of reverse connections include IBM’s Tivoli provisioning products, and
Microsoft’s Systems Management Server (SMS). For more information, see “Requirements for
Reverse and Cross-Connections” on page 147.
X
To add an access control rule for a reverse connection
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Access Control.
2. Click New. The Edit Access Rule page appears.
3. In the Number box, type a number to specify the rule’s position in the access rule list. By
default, new rules are added to the top of the list, but you can use this box to place the rule
anywhere you want. For example, if you have four rules and you assign the number 3 to a new
one, it is inserted before the current rule 3 (which will become rule 4). This field is required.
4. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the rule. This step is optional, but
a description can be helpful when viewing your list of rules later, and also appears in log files
where it is useful in debugging. The ID is a unique identifier automatically assigned by AMC; it
cannot be edited.
5. Use the Action buttons to specify whether the rule will be used to Permit or Deny access, or
if the rule is Disabled.
152
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
6. Complete the information listed under Basic settings:
{
Select the Resource button to create a rule controlling a reverse connection from a
resource to a user. The User and Resource buttons toggle between forward-connection
and reverse-connection rules.
Reverse connections are available only when IP address pools are configured for the
network tunnel clients. If you attempt to create a reverse connection with no IP address
pools configured, AMC displays an error message. For more information, see “Access
Control Rules for Bi-Directional Connections” on page 146.
{
The From box specifies the resources that will connect to users. Click Edit to select from a
list of resources. If no resources are specified, the default value for this field is Any
resource.
{
The To box specifies the users to which the resource will connect. Click Edit to select from
a list. If no users are selected, the default value for this field is Any user.
7. In the Access methods area, select Any to automatically manage access to all resources in
the rule regardless of the access method making the request. This ensures that either the
Connect Tunnel client or the OnDemand Tunnel agent, which is required for reverse
connections, is managed by the rule. The other access methods do not support reverse
connections and will be bypassed.
8. When you are finished creating the rule, click Save.
Adding a Pair of Access Control Rules for a Cross-Connection
Most of the steps involved in creating an access control rule for a cross-connection are the same as
those for creating a rule for a forward connection or a reverse connection. However, there are some
key differences and requirements.
For example, to permit your VPN users to call each other using a VoIP application, create one rule
for your users to connect to an IP address pool on the appliance, and a second rule for the IP
address pool to connect to the users.
You would also need to follow this procedure to create a pair of rules to permit bi-directional
connections between an FTP server and users.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
153
To add an access control rule for a cross-connection
1. Ensure that the requirements for configuring a reverse connection are met. For more
information, see “Requirements for Reverse and Cross-Connections” on page 147.
2. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Access Control.
3. Click New. The Add/Edit Access Rule page appears.
4. Type a number in the Number box to specify the rule’s position in the access rule list. By
default, new rules are added to the top of the list, but you can use this box to place the rule
anywhere you want. For example, if you have four rules and you assign the number 3 to a new
one, it is inserted before the current rule 3 (which will become rule 4). This field is required.
5. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the rule. This step is optional, but
a description can be helpful when viewing your list of rules later. The description also appears
in log files where it is useful when examining logs to determine why a connection did not
match a specific rule. The ID is a unique identifier automatically assigned by AMC; it cannot be
edited.
Since a cross-connection requires a pair of forward-connection and reverse-connection rules,
you should assign similar names to the two rules to make it easy to locate them in the list of
access control rules.
6. Use the Action buttons to specify whether the rule will be used to Permit or Deny access, or
if the rule is Disabled.
7. Under Basic settings, use the User and Resource buttons to select forward-connection or
reverse-connection rules.
{
To create a forward-connection rule from the users to the IP address pool, click User.
{
To create a reverse-connection rule from the IP address pool to the users, click Resource.
8. In the From box under Basic settings, specify the users or resources to which this rule
applies:
{
For a forward-connection rule, specify the users or user groups to whom the rule applies.
Click Edit to select from a list of users or groups. The default value is Any user.
{
For a reverse-connection rule, specify the address pool that will be used for the VoIP
application. Click Edit to select the address pool from a list of resources. The default value
is Any resource.
9. In the To box under Basic settings, specify the users or resources to which this rule applies:
{
For a forward-connection rule, specify the address pool that will be used for the VoIP
application. Click Edit to select the address pool from a list of resources. The default value
is Any resource.
{
For a reverse-connection rule, specify the users to whom the rule applies. Click Edit to
select from a list of users or groups. The default value is Any user.
10. In the Access method restrictions area, select Any. This enables the appliance’s Smart
Access feature to determine the appropriate access method for the users’ end point devices,
which for a reverse connection is either the Connect Tunnel client or the OnDemand Tunnel
agent. The other access methods do not support cross-connections or bi-directional
connections and will be bypassed.
154
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
11. In the Access method restrictions area, select Any to automatically manage access to all
resources in the rule regardless of the access method making the request. This ensures that
either the Connect Tunnel client or the OnDemand Tunnel agent, which are required for
reverse connections, are managed by the rule. The other access methods do not support
reverse connections and will be bypassed.
12. Click Finish after you have created the first rule in the pair of cross-connection rule, and then
create and save the second rule. (Alternatively, you can save the first rule in the pair, make a
copy of it, and then reverse the user and resource settings.)
Notes
z
After you have configured the forward-connection rule and the reverse-connection rule that
make up the cross-connection rule pair, you should position the two rules next to each other in
the access control list. That will make it easier to identify them as related rules.
z
AMC displays an error message if you attempt to create a cross-connection rule with no IP
address pools configured. For more information, see “Access Control Rules for Bi-Directional
Connections” on page 146.
Configuring Advanced Access Control Rule Attributes
For most rules, a basic configuration that includes users or groups, destination resources, and
access methods is sufficient. Settings that provide even tighter access are available on the
Advanced page for Add/Edit Access Rule.
For example, if you want to restrict connections to those coming from an individual IP address,
select the User’s network address option. Source networks are referenced in an access rule to
permit or deny a connection to a destination resource based on the location from which the request
originates, which provides you with even greater security.
X
To configure advanced settings for an access control rule
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Access Control.
2. Click the link for an existing rule.
3. On the Edit Access Rule page, click the Advanced tab.
4. Under Access method restrictions, permit or deny access based on the software agent or
client initializing the connection. In most cases, you can leave this set to Any.
5. To restrict the Protocols that the network tunnel or proxy service will accept from the client,
click Selected. A brief description of each command is included here, but for more details, see
http://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc1928.txt.
Protocol
Description
TCP
Enables normal TCP connections (for example, SSH, telnet, scp, and
so forth).
UDP
Allows the network tunnel or proxy service to make a UDP data
transfer. This is necessary for operations such as streaming audio and
Microsoft Outlook new-mail notification.
ICMP
(Internet Control Message protocol) Enables the ping and traceroute
network troubleshooting commands. Selecting this option will
configure the network tunnel or proxy service to allow these
operations on your behalf. This option also enables ICMP packets to
flow through the network tunnel or proxy service.
Accept bind requests
from server
Used in protocols that require the client to accept connections from the
server. FTP is a notable example: bind usually occurs with a
Connect/Bind pair of connections.
6. Specify the names of any source networks you want evaluated in the rule with the User’s
network address option. This is useful for controlling access based on the origin of the
connection request. Click Edit to select from the list of resources. If no source network is
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
155
specified, the default value of this field is Any. For reverse connections, this option can be used
to block access requests to users’ computers that originate from specific ports or the
application resources.
7. Use Destination restrictions to restrict access over individual Ports or a range of ports. For
example, if you are building a policy to control access to an SMTP mail server, you might allow
access only over port 25 (the well-known port for SMTP traffic). A list of the latest port number
assignments is available at http://www.iana.org/assignments/port-numbers.
To enable access on any port, click Any. To specify multiple ports, click Selected and type the
port numbers, separating each with a semicolon. To specify a port range, type the beginning
and ending numbers separated by a hyphen.
8. Use Permissions to specify whether the rule will allow Read or Read/Write access to the
file system resources. These access privileges work in conjunction with Windows access
control rules. For a user to have certain file permissions, both entities (that is, Windows and
the appliance) must allow them. If you disable file uploads, no user can write to a file,
although users with write access will be able to move and delete files. These settings are
ignored by reverse connections.
9. Under Time and date restrictions, specify when the rule will be in effect. (The time zone for
the time restriction fields is your local time.) You can specify a Shift or a Range, or you can
specify that the rule remain in effect at all times.
10. When you are finished creating the rule, click Save.
Access Methods and Advanced Options
When you restrict your access methods, the advanced options are enabled or disabled based on
which ones remain selected (if you select Any as the access method, all the advanced options are
available). When AMC validates the rule it prevents you from selecting rule attributes that are not
relevant to the access methods. The following table shows the advanced options that apply to each
access method.
Access method
Applicable advanced options
Web browser
(HTTP/HTTPS)
z
User’s network address
z
Time and date restrictions
Network Explorer
(Web access to file system resources)
z
User’s network address
z
Read/write permissions
z
Time and date restrictions
z
Protocols
z
User’s network address
z
Destination restrictions (ports)
z
Time and date restrictions
Aventail Connect and/or OnDemand
(TCP/IP)
Adding Users and Resources From Within Access Control Rules
Some administrators prefer to define all policy objects (users, groups, and resources) before
creating access control rules. Although this structured approach works particularly well for the initial
configuration, you may find it inconvenient for ongoing management. If so, you can define new
resources directly from the interface used to create access control rules.
X
To add a user or resource to an existing access control rule
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Access Control.
2. Click the link for an existing rule. The Edit Access Rule page appears.
156
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
3. In the Basic settings area, click Edit beside the From or To box. A separate window appears
displaying your current users and groups, or resources.
4. Click New. The page displayed next depends on the type of object you are creating.
5. Define the settings for the new user, group, or resource.
6. When you are finished creating the object, click Save.
7. Select the check box beside the object you want to add to the access rule and then click Save.
Editing, Copying, and Deleting Access Control Rules
Before modifying or deleting an access control rule, carefully examine your existing rules to
understand how your changes will affect your security policy. Use caution when deleting rules
because you are not prompted to confirm the deletion.
z
You can reorder the placement of rules in the access control list. But before you do any
reordering, carefully examine them to understand how the new order will affect your security
policy.
z
Rather than creating a new access control rule from scratch, you can save time by making a
copy of an existing rule and changing some parameters to fit the new rule. Choose a rule that
shares characteristics with the rule you plan to create.
Copying is also useful when experimenting with a new access rule: you can edit the copied rule
and disable the original rule during your testing. This way you can roll back to your original
rule if necessary.
For more information on editing, deleting, and copying access control rules, see “Deleting
Referenced Objects” on page 54.
Notes
z
When you use the Filters settings to filter the view of the access rules by a specific access
method or other criteria, you cannot use the Move Up and Move Down buttons to reorder the
list. You can move an access control rule only when Method is set to All.
z
To move a rule more than one position in the list, it’s usually faster to change the Number box
on the Add/Edit Access Rule page.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
157
Resolving Deny Rule Incompatibilities
In a Permit rule, you can safely mix and match resources and access methods. However, Deny rules
containing specific combinations of resources and access methods may prevent subsequent rules
from being evaluated. This can inadvertently block user access to resources referenced later in your
access policy.
During its policy evaluation, the appliance may in some cases be unable to determine whether a
Deny rule matches an incoming connection request. As a security precaution, it stops processing
your rule set and blocks user access.
If you attempt to define a Deny rule referencing any of the three combinations described in the
following table, AMC displays this warning message:
“Some of the resources in this rule are not supported by the selected access method(s), which
could inadvertently deny access to some resources.”
The following table lists the rule combinations that trigger this warning:
Rule action
Resource type
Deny
Windows domain
Deny
Deny
URL
File share
Access methods
z
Any
z
Connect and OnDemand
z
WorkPlace
z
Any
z
Connect and OnDemand
z
Any
z
Connect and OnDemand
Example
Suppose you create a Deny rule blocking access to a Windows domain and you leave Access
methods set to Any. A Windows domain is accessible from WorkPlace, so when the appliance
receives a connection attempt from WorkPlace, it matches the rule and denies access.
However, if the user makes a connection request from Connect or OnDemand, the appliance is
unable to determine whether the Windows domain rule matches the request (regardless of which
destination resource is requested). The appliance then stops evaluating any further rules in your
policy and immediately denies access. If the Windows domain rule is at the top of your access
control rule list, it prevents the user from accessing any VPN resources. And if the next rule in the
list is a Permit rule allowing the user to access a VPN resource, it is not evaluated.
Resolving the Problem
To resolve rule incompatibilities, modify the rule so it doesn’t reference indeterminate access
methods. In the case of a Windows domain or network share, select Network Explorer as the only
access method. For a URL, select only Web browser or Aventail Connect and/or Aventail
OnDemand.
Resolving Invalid Destination Resources
If you attempt to create a rule that assigns an access method to an incompatible destination
resource, AMC prevents the conflict and displays an “Invalid resources” warning.
158
|
Chapter 5 - Security Administration
The following table lists the access method/destination resource combinations that trigger this
warning.
Access method
Invalid destination resource
z
Windows domain
z
Network share
Network Explorer
z
URL (and Matching URL)
Connect or OnDemand
z
URL (and Matching URL)
z
Windows domain
Web browser
“Invalid Resource” Examples
AMC will not permit you to save a rule that contains a method/resource conflict: if you click Save,
AMC removes the invalid resource from the rule. If the rule contains only one mismatched resource,
it is replaced with Any. Examples of method/resource conflict are:
z
If a rule specifies Web browser as the only available access method, it cannot refer to a
Windows domain resource. (A Windows domain resource is one that has Domain as its type,
and for which the Windows domain check box is selected).
z
A rule that specifies a Matching URL resource requires Web browser as an access method; if
the allowed access methods for a rule don’t include Web browser, the “Invalid resource”
warning appears.
To resolve a destination resource error, modify the rule so that the type of access method is
compatible with the destination resource. The simplest way to avoid an access method/destination
resource conflict is to remove any Access method restrictions on the Advanced tab of the
Add/Edit Access Rule page by leaving both Client software agents and Protocols set to Any.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
159
Chapter 6
User Management
Access control rules determine which resources are available for users or groups of users.
Accordingly, you must define users and groups in AMC that map to users or groups stored in
external user directories. At a higher level, communities organize users or user groups that share
common characteristics, most notably access policy and access methods, and can also be used in
access control rules.
Overview: Users, Groups, Communities, and Realms
A user is an individual who needs access to resources on your network, and a group is a collection
of users. After you’ve created users or groups on the appliance, you can reference them in an access
control rule to permit or deny access to resources.
Users and groups
Users and groups are not actually stored on the appliance. Instead, you create references to
existing users or groups stored in an external authentication server, such as LDAP or Microsoft
Active Directory. These users or groups are referenced in access control rules to control
authorization. You can even query the external directory (looking for users who share certain
attributes, for example) and use the results to create a group to use in an access control rule. This
eliminates the need to create and manage users directly on the appliance. You can define a user or
group before referencing it in an access control rule; alternatively, you can define a new user or
group directly from the access control rule interface.
Communities
Communities are collections of users that determine which access methods and End Point Control
agents are deployed to the members of a user population when they log in to a realm. For example,
you may want to enable OnDemand for your mobile employees, but provide only Web access to
your business partners. If End Point Control is enabled, communities can also be used to determine
which “zones of trust” members belong to.
Realms
A realm references an authentication server and determines which access agents are provisioned
to your users and what End Point Control restrictions are imposed.
160
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
Using Realms and Communities
When you set up realms and user communities, AMC enables you to specify which access agents
are provisioned to members of the communities. You also have the option of classifying community
members’ devices into “zones of trust.” The following illustration shows how a realm authenticates
users, assigns them to communities to provision access agents and, with End Point Control enabled,
assigns community members to different zones based on the trustworthiness of their computers.
Authentication
Realm
CompanyXYZ
Provisioning and End Point Control
Community
Employees
Group = “Employees”
Authentication
server
AD.example.com
Community
Partners
Access Methods
OnDemand
Web proxy agent
What access methods
are available?
Access Methods
Translated Web
Zones
IT-issued PCs
Home PCs
What data protection
components are
required?
Zones
Unknown PCs
Group = “Partners”
If your network uses only one authentication server to store user information, then you probably
need to create only one realm in AMC. If your network uses multiple authentication servers, you
must create at least one realm for each of them. You can also create multiple realms in AMC that
reference separate user populations in a single external repository.
Using only one authentication realm doesn’t limit your ability to create subsets of users based on
their access needs or other security considerations, because realms must be associated with
communities of users. A community can consist of all users in a realm, or only selected users; it is
used to deploy access agents and to enforce End Point Control restrictions for members of a
community. For information on communities, see “Editing, Copying and Deleting Communities” on
page 181.
Viewing Realms
You can view the list of configured realms, including all of the “building blocks” that are associated
with each one: the authentication servers and communities. The communities, in turn, determine
who has access using what methods, what security zone to place a device in, based on its profile,
and even the appearance of WorkPlace.
X
To view configured realms
1. From the main navigation menu, click Realms.
2. The unexpanded view gives you a quick summary of each realm. Click any item to go directly
to its corresponding configuration page in AMC:
{
All realms that are enabled appear in blue, while those in gray are disabled. Users and
groups associated with a disabled realm will be unable to log in. See “Enabling and
Disabling Realms” on page 163 for more details.
{
The Authentication server area shows the name or names of the servers that are used
by a realm to verify users’ identities.
{
The (optional) descriptive text you entered when creating a realm is on the right.
{
You can use the up and down arrow icons to re-order the list of realms, or use them to
create a copy of a realm to modify, or delete a realm.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
161
3. Click the plus sign (+) next to a realm to see more detail:
{
Communities allow you to group realm members based on different security needs. For a
quick check of which members belong to a community, move the pointer over the
community name.
{
The appearance of the WorkPlace portal is governed by a style and layout that you can
configure. If you have a community of mobile device users, for example, you might want
to create a more compact look and layout for it.
{
Security zones are used to allow or deny access using device profiles. For a quick check of
which device profiles are used by a particular zone, move the pointer over the zone name.
4. There are a number of community-level configuration changes you can make on this page in
AMC. Move the pointer over a community name:
Using the controls that appear when you are positioned over a community, you can do the
following:
{
Add or delete a community.
{
Change the order in which users are grouped by moving the community left or right.
{
To see the session workflow, move the pointer over the community name and click the
icon on the far right.
Default, Visible, and Hidden Realms
To authenticate a user, the appliance must know which realm the user belongs to. If only one realm
is enabled, the appliance automatically uses it. However, if multiple realms are enabled, the
appliance needs to know which one to use.
162
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
When users log in, they typically select the appropriate realm from a list. You can make the choice
easier for them by defining a default realm in AMC (see “Specifying the Default Realm” on page 162
for more information). If a default realm is defined, the realm selection box is automatically
populated with that realm. The specific behavior of each access method is outlined in this section.
SonicWALL strongly recommends that you specify a default realm.
You can also choose which realm names are visible to users. If a realm is hidden, the user must
know its name and manually type it during login. For example, you could create realms for various
suppliers. If you’d prefer that they not know about one another, you could configure the realm
names to be hidden. Each supplier then has to type the realm name when logging in to the
appliance.
The following table describes the typical user login experience for various realm configurations.
Realms
enabled
Default
realm
configured?
Hidden
realms
configured?
One
N/A
N/A
User does not need to select a realm during the
login process. Access methods automatically
use the one enabled realm for authentication.
Multiple
Yes
None
User selects a realm from the list. Realm text
box is initially populated with the default realm.
Multiple
No
None
User selects a realm from the list. Realm text
box is initially populated with the first realm
(sorted alphabetically).
Multiple
Yes
Yes
User selects a realm from the list. Realm text
box is initially populated with the default realm.
If login requires a hidden realm, user selects
Other and then types the realm name in a
second text box.
User’s login experience
When users first access Aventail WorkPlace, they are presented with one or more login pages. If
only one realm is enabled, they see only the page requesting their user credentials. If multiple
realms are enabled, they a login page on which they select the appropriate realm from a drop-down
list. If there are one or more hidden realms, the login page prompts the user to type in the realm
name.
After clicking Next, users authenticating with username and password are presented with the page
for entering credentials.
Specifying the Default Realm
If you specify more than one authentication realm, you must designate one as the default. To
authenticate a user, the appliance must know which realm the user belongs to. If only one realm is
enabled, the appliance automatically uses it. If multiple realms are enabled, the appliance needs to
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
163
know which one to use. A user can select the appropriate one from a list, but the process is easier
for the user if you designate a default realm in AMC. (Even if you configure only one realm, you
should specify it as the default; otherwise AMC will display the warning message “There is no default
realm selected” on the Realms page.)
X
To specify a default realm
1. From the main navigation menu, click Realms.
2. In the Default realm list (at the bottom of the AMC page), select the authentication realm
that will be the default. This list shows only those realms that are enabled and configured to be
displayed.
Enabling and Disabling Realms
The appliance supports the simultaneous use of multiple realms. You can control which realms are
active by enabling and disabling them. When a realm is disabled, users and groups associated with
that realm are unable to log in. If no authentication realm is enabled, users do not have access to
the network.
X
To enable or disable an authentication realm
1. From the main navigation menu, click Realms to see the list of defined realms. If a realm is
enabled, its indicator icon in the Enabled column is green. If a realm is disabled, the indicator
is gray.
2. Click the name of the realm you want to enable or disable. This displays the Configure Realm
page for that realm.
3. In the General area, select whether the Status for the realm is Enabled or Disabled, and
then click Save.
Best Practices for Defining Realms
When defining realms, follow these best practices to simplify your users’ login experience.
z
Your users select a realm name when logging in, so define realm names that clearly describe
the user population. For example, a realm that includes all internal employees might be named
“employees,” while a realm that includes external suppliers might be named “suppliers.”
If a realm will be referenced by mobile device users, keep the name short so that all of it is
visible on the mobile device. A Pocket PC device using standard text size, for example, can
normally display a name that is about 30 characters long, but a smartphone cannot.
z
If some users will be logging in to a realm that is hidden, make sure they know the name of the
realm and how to type it in (choose Other from the realm list and then type the realm name in
the text box).
z
Enable multiple realms only if necessary. If only one realm is enabled, users do not need to
select a realm as part of the login process. When moving from a test to a production
environment, verify that all test realms have been removed.
Configuring Realms and Communities
This section describes how to configure realms and communities.
Creating Realms
Perform the following steps to create and configure an authentication realm. If you create more
than one realm, you must specify one as the default.
After you create a realm and associate it with an external authentication server, you can either add
one or more communities to the realm, or use the preconfigured Default community. If you create
and save a realm without assigning a community to it, AMC automatically assigns the Default
community to the realm. See “Using the Default Community” on page 179 and also “Adding,
Editing, Copying, and Deleting Objects in AMC” on page 43.
164
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
X
To create a realm
1. From the main navigation menu, click Realms.
2. Click New. The Configure Realm page appears with the General settings displayed.
3. In the Name text box, type a meaningful name for the realm. If users will be required to
select a realm name when logging in to the VPN, make sure the name clearly describes the
user population.
4. In the Description text box, type a descriptive comment about the realm. This is optional, but
helpful, especially if your VPN uses multiple authentication realms. The text you enter in this
box is displayed in the list of realms.
5. Enable or disable this realm by selecting the appropriate Status. See “Enabling and Disabling
Realms” on page 163 for more information.
6. If you want this realm to appear in the list seen by your users (recommended in most cases),
select the Display this realm check box.
7. Select the Authentication server that the realm will use to verify a user’s identity. This field
is required. You can also click New to configure a new authentication server and reference it
in the realm. For more information, see “Configuring Authentication Servers” on page 80.
CAUTION: Setting Authentication server to None allows unauthenticated, open access to
this realm and its resources. Do not do this unless you are sure this is what you intend.
8. If you want to send accounting information about this realm to a RADIUS server (for example,
the time and duration of connections), select the Enable RADIUS accounting check box. For
information on configuring a RADIUS accounting server, see “Configuring RADIUS Accounting
in a Realm” on page 180.
9. On the Advanced tab you can set up the appliance to use a second authentication server.
There are two ways to do this:
{
Chained authentication: Require users to provide more than one set of credentials. See
“Configuring Chained Authentication” on page 109.
{
Enable group affinity checking: Query a secondary authentication repository. See
“Enabling Group Affinity Checking in a Realm” on page 112 for more information.
10. Click Next to add user communities to the realm (see “Adding Communities to a Realm” on
page 165), or click Finish. If you create and save a realm without assigning a community to
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
165
it, AMC automatically assigns the global Default community to the realm. For more
information, see “Using the Default Community” on page 179.
Notes
z
For information on how to edit, copy, and delete communities, see “Adding, Editing, Copying,
and Deleting Objects in AMC” on page 43.
Adding Communities to a Realm
After you create a realm, the next step is to configure one or more communities that belong to it.
If all of the users in a realm should be treated the same, then only a single community needs to be
defined. Create additional communities if you want to subdivide users; you might want to give
remote employees, for example, access methods and End Point Control restrictions that differ from
those for local employees. Each community defines the following:
z
A subset of users within a realm
z
Which access methods are available to those users when they log in to a realm
z
What restrictions (if any) are placed on their end point devices
Each realm on the appliance must reference at least one community. Using multiple communities
can be an efficient way of segmenting your user population in order to provide specific access
agents to certain users, or to place End Point Control restrictions on certain types of devices used
by community members.
You can either use the preconfigured Default community (see “Using the Default Community” on
page 179), or add other communities to the realm. As your user access or security policy
requirements change over time, you can add additional communities to a realm, modify the user
communities referenced by a realm, or delete them.
X
To add a community to a realm
1. After creating a realm on the General tab of the Configure Realm page, go to the
Communities page. The Configure Realm - <name> page appears with the Communities
tab highlighted.
2. If you want to use an existing community as is (without changing it), you may need to change
the order in which the communities are listed. See “Changing the Order of Communities Listed
in a Realm” on page 179.
3. To create a new community for the realm, click New, and to edit an existing community, click
its link: the Configure Community page appears. Follow the steps described in “Creating and
Configuring Communities” on page 166.
166
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
Creating and Configuring Communities
Creating a community involves these basic steps:
z
Assign members to the community
z
Select access methods for the community
z
Optionally, specify End Point Control restrictions for the community
z
Specify a style and layout for the WorkPlace portal.
Assigning Members to a Community
The first step in creating a community involves specifying which users will be members. By default
a community is configured to include all users from the authentication realm to which it is assigned.
However, you can configure a community to permit access to only a subset of users or user groups
in a realm.
This is useful, for example, if you want to segment a realm into one community for employees and
another community for business partners. You can then provide each community with the
appropriate access agents, or impose End Point Control restrictions if users are logging in from nonsecure computers. Communities can also be referenced in access control rules in order to permit or
deny access to your resources.
X
To assign members to an existing community
1. From the main navigation menu, click Realms.
2. Within the realm, click the link for the community you want to configure. The Configure
Community page appears with the Members tab displayed.
3. The Members box specifies which users or groups belong to this community. Click Edit to
select from a list of users and groups. If no users or groups are specified, the default value of
this field is Any, meaning that any users from the authentication realm that references this
community belong to this community.
4. In the Maximum active sessions box you can limit the number of sessions each member of
this community is allowed to have active at one time. For mobile users, for example, you may
want to restrict the number of sessions to 1—each session consumes one user license, and it’s
impractical for a mobile user to have more than one active session. With other communities,
such as employees who alternate between working from home and in the office, the number of
allowed sessions should probably be higher. See “How Licenses Are Calculated” on page 244
for more information.
5. To select which access methods will be available to members of the community, click the
Access Methods tab. See “Selecting Access Methods for a Community” on page 166 for more
information.
6. To restrict user access based on the security of client devices, click the End Point Control
restrictions tab and specify which zones are available to users in this community. See “Using
End Point Control Restrictions in a Community” on page 168.
7. Click Save.
Selecting Access Methods for a Community
The second step in creating a community is to determine which access methods will be available for
community members to connect to the appliance and access your network resources. For
information on which access methods are compatible with your users’ environments, see “User
Access Components” on page 3.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
167
To specify the access methods available to community members
1. From the main navigation menu, click Realms.
2. Click the link for the community you want to configure, and then click the Access Methods
tab.
3. Select the access methods community members can use with a browser to connect to
resources on your network. Based on the capabilities of the user's system, the appliance
activates the access agents you have selected. For information on the capabilities and system
requirements of the various access agents, see “User Access Components and Services” on
page 317.
168
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
4. If you want to provide network tunnel client access to members of a community, select a
combination of the following:
{
In the tunnel access area, select Network tunnel client. You can use a built-in resource
and shortcut if you want users to download the Connect Tunnel client and activate it from
a link in WorkPlace.
{
For Web-based proxy access, select Client/server proxy agent (OnDemand), and then
click Auto-activate from Aventail WorkPlace. This will automatically provision or
activate the Web-based OnDemand Tunnel agent to users when they connect to
WorkPlace.
{
In the Web access (HTTP) area, select Web proxy agent for clientless access to most
types of Web-based resources for Windows clients. Select Translated Web access for
clientless access to Web resources that are mapped to custom ports or custom FQDNs for
improved application compatibility, or that use aliases to obscure internal host names.
Translated Web access can be used as a fallback if the default Web proxy agent cannot
run. See “Web Access” on page 323 for information about the different types of Web
access, and see “Adding Resources” on page 119 for information about adding Web-based
resources.
5. To deploy the network tunnel clients to users, you must first make one or more IP address
pools available to the community. By default, AMC makes all configured IP address pools
available to a community; however, you can select specific IP address pools if necessary. See
“Network Tunnel Client Configuration” on page 170.
6. You can require users to install a SonicWALL agent or client before granting them access to
network resources when they log in to WorkPlace. Selecting Require agent in order to
access network provides better application compatibility for applications that need an agent:
it means broader access for users, and fewer Help Desk calls for you. When this setting is
disabled, a user logging in to WorkPlace can choose not to install an agent and proceed with
translated, custom port mapped, or custom FQDN mapped Web access. In this case, the user
is placed in either the Default zone or a Quarantine zone, depending on how the community is
configured.
7. When you have finished selecting access methods for the community, click Next to proceed to
the End Point Control restrictions area, where you can restrict access to community
members based on the security of their client devices. See “Using End Point Control
Restrictions in a Community” on page 168. If you don’t want to employ End Point Control for
the community, click Finish.
Notes
z
If the network tunnel client option is not enabled for a particular community, users who
previously had access to the Connect Tunnel client are still able to use it to access the appliance.
z
If the community is configured to provide only Translated Web access, terminal resources are
unavailable because the client PC will not have the network transport required to access a
proprietary application protocol. For information on configuring graphical terminal agents, see
“Managing the SonicWALL Access Services” on page 346.
Using End Point Control Restrictions in a Community
When you’re creating a community, you have the option of restricting access to users based on the
security of their client devices. To do this, specify which End Point Control zones are available to
users in this community. There are four types of zones—Deny, Standard, Quarantine, and Default.
For more information on how to create and configure End Point Control zones, and the device
profiles they use to classify connection requests, see “Managing EPC with Zones and Device Profiles”
on page 256.
You can also set an inactivity timer, even if you don’t use End Point Control zones for a community,
if your users access the appliance using the Connect Tunnel client.
X
To apply End Point Control restrictions for a community
1. From the main navigation menu, click Realms.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
169
2. Click the link for the community you want to configure, and then click the End Point Control
restrictions tab.
3. Use a Deny zone if you have a device profile that is unacceptable in your deployment. You
might, for example, want to deny access to any user who has Google Desktop installed on the
PC with which they are trying to connect. Select (or create) an entry in the Deny zones list
and click the >> button to move it to the In use list. Deny zones are evaluated first (if there’s
a match, the user is logged off).
To create a new EPC zone and then add it to the list, click the New button. For information on
how to create a zone, see “Defining Zones” on page 251.
4. You can assign one or more End Point Control Standard zones to the community, which are
used to determine which devices are authorized to access a community. If you don’t select a
zone, community members are assigned to the default zone, which could limit or even deny
access to resources, depending on your access policy. Select the check box for a zone in the
Standard zones list and then click the >> button to move it to the In use list.
5. If the community references more than one zone, use Move Up and Move Down to arrange
their order in the list. Zones are matched in the order they are listed, so it is important to you
consider which devices are authorized in each zone. You should place your most specific zones
at the top of the list.
6. If a client device does not match a zone, use the settings in the Zone fallback options area
to place it into the default zone, or quarantine the device and (optionally) display a customized
page with text and links. See “Creating a Quarantine Zone” on page 262 for more information.
170
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
7. To set the inactivity timer (which is triggered when there is no keyboard or mouse activity) for
community members, select a time limit (ranging from After 3 mins to After 10 hours) from
the End inactive user connections list. This is a Windows-only setting that is used by the
network tunnel client.
8. Click Save to complete the configuration of the community.
Notes
z
The appliance uses EPC interrogation to check for certain device profile attributes on the client
and then classifies the device accordingly. If a Quarantine zone is your fallback option, and if
EPC interrogation somehow fails, a device that would normally be quarantined may instead end
up in the Default zone.
Configuring the Appearance of WorkPlace
Each community can be assigned a style and layout for its WorkPlace portal content pages.
A WorkPlace style determines the colors, fonts, and images used to display the pages, and a layout
determines page content, how it is arranged, and how you navigate the portal. Keep in mind that
the style for the login, error, and notification pages is specified when you set up a site.
X
To create a style and layout for a community
1. From the main navigation menu, click Realms.
2. Click the link for the community you want to configure, and then click the WorkPlace
Appearance tab.
3. Select an existing style, or click Manage styles to modify or create one. For more information
on configuring a WorkPlace style, see “Creating or Editing a WorkPlace Style” on page 303.
4. Select an existing layout, or click Manage layouts to modify or create one. For more
information on configuring a WorkPlace layout, see “Creating or Editing a WorkPlace Layout”
on page 304.
5. The layout for this community is automatically changed to accommodate smaller devices; for
example, the Intranet Address box (if it is part of the layout) will be displayed on an advanced
mobile device, but not a basic one.
If that result is not acceptable, you can specify a different layout for different classes of
devices in the Small form factor devices area. A good approach when creating a community
is to see how the WorkPlace portal for this community looks on a mobile device by default, and
then create a new layout or modify an existing one only if you need to.
Network Tunnel Client Configuration
This section describes how to configure settings for the Connect Tunnel client and the OnDemand
Tunnel agent.
IP Address Allocation
Configuring the network tunnel service to manage TCP/IP connections from the network tunnel
clients requires setting up IP address pools for the allocation of IP addresses to the clients. Setting
up the address pools is typically done when you configure the network tunnel service. For
information on how to initially set up IP address pools, see “Configuring IP Address Pools” on
page 349.
When you create communities that will deploy the network tunnel clients to users, you must specify
which of those IP address pools are available to members of that community. By default, AMC
makes all configured address pools available; however, you can select specific IP address pools if
necessary.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
171
Session Persistence
The tunnel clients and Connect Mobile automatically handle the sorts of connection interruptions
that users (and especially mobile users) are familiar with, like undocking a laptop and taking it into
a meeting, or crossing cellular network boundaries while on the road. Users can experience these
temporary interruptions and then resume their sessions without having to reauthenticate.
To allow sessions to be reestablished automatically when a user’s IP address changes (for example,
when moving from the office to home), select the Allow user to resume session from multiple
IP addresses check box when you set up EPC zones. See the steps described in “Creating a
Standard Zone” on page 259 or “Configuring the Default Zone” on page 264 for more information.
Reauthentication is, however, required if this setting is disabled, or if any of the following is true:
z
The user’s session on the appliance has expired
z
The credentials provided (such as a SmartCard) do not persist during suspend/resume
Redirection Modes
When configuring the network tunnel clients, you must specify a redirection mode, which
determines how client traffic is redirected to the appliance. The network tunnel service supports the
following redirection modes:
Split Tunnel Modes
In Split tunnel mode, traffic bound for resources defined in AMC is redirected through the tunnel,
and all other traffic is routed as normal. This is less secure than redirect all mode, but also more
convenient for users because it doesn’t interfere with Internet access.
To safeguard against unauthorized access to users’ computers through their Internet connections,
which could potentially reach network resources by re-routing through the split tunnel, consider
using End Point Control restrictions to require that users’ computers are running personal firewalls
or antivirus protection.
To also give users access to local printers and file shares, select Split tunnel, with access to local
network.
When the appliance is configured for one of the split tunnel modes, you can allow users to decide
whether to give preference to local or remote network access. For example, let’s say you have a
host resource—a Web server—with an address of 192.168.230.1. The user goes on a business trip
and it turns out that the printer he or she wants to use, on a local network at a conference center,
uses that same address. If you’ve selected the Allow users to indicate which split tunnel
redirection mode to use on the client option in AMC, you allow the traveler to indicate a
preference for local resources (in this case, the printer) when there is a network conflict. The choice
is made on the client in the Connect Tunnel Properties dialog box, on the Advanced tab.
Redirect All Mode
In Redirect all mode, traffic is redirected through the tunnel regardless of how resources are
defined in AMC. This option provides enhanced security, blocking users from being able to access
any network device during their tunnel sessions. It may also prevent Internet access, depending on
your network configuration.
Redirect all mode is more secure than split tunnel redirection; however, be aware that users may
be able to modify the routing tables on their computers to bypass the appliance and effectively
create their own split tunnel connection back to the network. For more information, see
“Configuring the Network Tunnel Service” on page 348.
To direct all traffic through the appliance, but also give users access to local printers and file shares,
select Redirect all, with access to local network. For example, if you have a community of
remote employees, working from home, you could use this redirection mode for maximum security,
yet still allow them to use resources on their home networks, such as a printer.
172
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
Proxy Server Redirection
Optionally, you can configure traffic bound for the Internet to be redirected through an internal
proxy server when the VPN connection is active. This can be useful if you want to use an HTTP proxy
server to control remote users’ access to Internet resources. This option is available only when one
of the redirect all modes is enabled. For information about configuring these settings, see
“Configuring Tunnel Client Settings” on page 174.
Notes
z
If you have selected a redirection mode of Redirect all, with access to local network, users
will have access to local file shares and printers. You should be aware, however, that if you are
using a .pac file for a remote proxy, then its redirection rules take precedence for any traffic
routed through the WinINet networking library (such as Internet Explorer, Media Player, and
Instant Messenger). For example, a user may expect to be able to reach a Web application on
a server—because it is on the local network—but find that the request has been redirected
through the remote proxy instead.
Tunnel Clients and Proxy Auto-Configuration Files (Linux Platform)
When OnDemand Tunnel or Connect Tunnel is launched on the Linux platform in an environment
where a proxy server is used for outbound access to the Internet, the SonicWALL appliance appends
redirection settings to the browser's proxy auto-configuration (.pac) file. These modifications are
made for the duration of the session only; the original browser settings are reinstated when the
user logs out. There are some known issues involving this combination of platform and client:
z
In the course of a user's session, one or more prompts may appear requesting approval for
changes to the browser's .pac file. In order to log in to WorkPlace and ensure proper
functionality, the user must accept these .pac file modifications.
z
If the server .pac file is updated, the user must either connect using the OnDemand Tunnel or
Connect Tunnel client to incorporate the changes, or manually revert to the original proxy
settings.
z
If a user has a Firefox browser window open when Connect Tunnel is started, the modifications
that the appliance needs to make to the browser's .pac file (for properly redirecting
connections) are not applied to any open browser windows.
The user must either close and then re-open Firefox, or manually reload the browser's proxy
settings.
UDP Tunnel Mode
A network address translator (NAT) allows multiple private network addresses to share a single,
public IPv4 address. But address translation also means that client-to-client networking
applications, such as VoIP and videoconferencing, will not work properly: these applications need
to know a user's IP address in order to establish and maintain a reliable connection.
ESP (Encapsulating Security Payload) is a way to encapsulate and decapsulate packets inside of a
UDP wrapper (port 4500) for traversing NATs. Using it can improve the performance of UDPstreaming applications like VoIP. For more information on ESP, see RFCs 2406 and 3948:
z
http://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc2406.txt
z
http://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc3948.txt
Although ESP encapsulation provides a performance improvement over SSL tunnel for all types of
traffic, it is not the default setting. This is mainly because UDP port 4500 must be open in network
firewalls when using it. If the external appliance traffic is subject to NAT, then NAT must be
configured for UDP port 4500. Also, in rare cases where the network environment does not properly
implement PMTU discovery (see RFC 1191), certain applications may run inefficiently or perhaps
not at all when using ESP encapsulation.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
173
When enabled, ESP use is automatically negotiated between a client and the EX-Series appliance.
You can choose to use it for all traffic, or just UDP traffic; if ESP fails or if the client does not support
it, then the SSL tunnel is automatically used instead. The User Sessions page in AMC indicates which
type of tunnel is being used.
The log files also indicate which tunnel was used: log messages will indicate UDP port 4500 packets
for ESP traffic and TCP port 443 packets for SSL tunnel packets.
Post-Connection Scripting
You can configure the client to launch an executable file or script on Windows, Mac OS X, or Linux
computers after a network tunnel connection has been established. For example, you could specify
a Windows .bat file that executes a command script that maps network drives. You can also specify
command-line options to run when the script launches.
The appliance does not provision the script to users: the client simply executes the script with any
specified command-line options. The specified script must already be present on users’ computers
before the client can execute it, and any specified scripts must be deployed and managed
separately.
For information about configuring these settings, see “Configuring Tunnel Client Settings” on
page 174 and “Configuring Tunnel Client Settings” on page 174.
Windows Tunnel Client Automatic Client Updating
For users who are running the Windows version of the Connect Tunnel or OnDemand Tunnel client
(version 8.7 and later), you can ensure that they have the most recent version of the client by
enabling automatic software updating.
Each time a user starts a Windows tunnel client and authenticates, the current client software
version is checked against the newest version available on the appliance. If a newer version is
available, the user is alerted that an update is ready for download. You can configure (on a percommunity basis) what options a user has for installing client updates:
z
Allow the user to choose when to start the update process. The update can be deferred
indefinitely; however, the user will see the update alert whenever the tunnel client is started
(once per day) until the update is installed.
z
Make updates mandatory by either requiring them (the user must accept updates in order to
access VPN resources), or enforcing them (the install process begins immediately and the user
cannot cancel it).
When a user accepts a tunnel client software update by clicking Install in the software-update
dialog box, the client software update is automatically downloaded and installed on the user’s
computer (in the case of Connect Tunnel), or activated (in the case of OnDemand Tunnel). After the
installation is complete, the tunnel client automatically restarts. Users do not need to reboot their
computers after installing the update.
For information about configuring software updating, see “Configuring Tunnel Client Settings” on
page 174.
174
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
Session Termination
By default, a tunnel client session is never terminated by the appliance once it has been
established: users can leave sessions idle and return to them later without having to reauthenticate.
If this is a security risk in your environment, there are a couple of ways to terminate sessions and
require users to re-authenticate:
z
Manually: To see a list of sessions click User Sessions in the main navigation menu in AMC,
and then choose one of the available termination options. For more information, see “Ending
User Sessions” on page 211.
z
Automatically: You can configure the tunnel client to prompt users to re-authenticate as soon
as their credentials expire. When Limit session length to credential lifetime is selected
during tunnel client configuration, sessions in a given community end and require reauthentication after the length of time specified by Credential lifetime (on the Configure
General Appliance Options page).
See “Configuring Tunnel Client Settings” on page 174 for more information about configuring
this option.
Configuring Tunnel Client Settings
Connect Tunnel is a client application that is installed on a user’s device, and OnDemand Tunnel is
a lightweight, Web-based agent that is activated each time a user logs in to WorkPlace from an
ActiveX or Java-enabled device. These two access methods differ in how they are installed or
activated, but they share the same configuration settings.
This section describes how to configure settings for the tunnel clients. For a more detailed
description of these settings, see “Network Tunnel Client Configuration” on page 170.
X
To configure tunnel client or agent settings
1. On the Access Methods page for the selected community, select one or both of these access
methods:
{
Network tunnel client (OnDemand)
{
Client/server proxy agent (OnDemand)
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
175
2. Click Configure in the Smart tunnel Access area. The Network Tunnel Client Settings
page appears.
3. By default, any configured IP address pool is available to the selected community. To select
specific IP address pools, click Edit in the IP address pools area and then select from the list
of configured pools.
4. Select the Redirection mode used to route client traffic to the appliance. The network tunnel
service supports several redirection modes. For a more detailed description of the supported
redirection modes, see “Redirection Modes” on page 171.
{
Split tunnel: Traffic bound for resources defined in AMC is redirected through the tunnel,
and all other traffic is routed as normal.
{
Split tunnel, with access to local network gives users access to local printers and file
shares.
{
Redirect all: Traffic is redirected through the tunnel regardless of how resources are
defined in AMC.
{
To direct all traffic through the appliance, but also give users access to local printers and
file shares, select Redirect all, with access to local network.
5. (Optional) If the appliance is configured for one of the split tunnel modes, you can allow users
to decide whether to give preference to local or remote network access by selecting Allow
users to indicate which split tunnel redirection mode to use on the client. For more
information and an example, see “Redirection Modes” on page 171.
176
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
6. (Optional) Click to expand the Connect Tunnel options and then, in the Caption for start
menu and icon box, type the customized text that you want to appear for the Connect Tunnel
client on the menu and beneath the Connect icon on the user’s desktop.
{
Create icon on desktop: Places the Connect Tunnel client icon on the desktop.
{
Run at system startup: Automatically runs the Connect Tunnel client when the operating
system starts on the user’s computer.
7. Use one of the Software updates options to alert users when client updates are available, or
update their software automatically. This setting is available only when the network tunnel
client is configured to provision client from Aventail WorkPlace, and only with version 8.7 and
later:
{
Manual—User must start updates manually.
{
At user's discretion—Allows users to decide when to install software updates. The
update can be deferred indefinitely; however, the user will see the software-update alert
when he or she starts the tunnel client (once per day) until the update is installed.
{
Required—User must accept updates in order to access VPN resources through the tunnel
client.
{
Forced—Updates are required in order to connect. The update program starts, and a
progress bar is visible during installation, but the user is not prompted during the process.
8. (Optional) By default, the client is configured to access the realm and appliance name from
which the client was downloaded. However, you can override this default behavior and
configure the client to access a different realm or appliance. In the Custom connection area,
select the Configure client with custom realm and appliance FQDN check box, and then
specify the following options as needed:
{
From the Realm name list, click the name of the default realm.
{
In the Appliance FQDN box, type the fully qualified domain name of the default
appliance.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
177
9. (Optional) By default, a tunnel client session is never terminated by the appliance once it has
been established: users can leave sessions idle and return to them later without having to
reauthenticate. If you want to require users to to re-authenticate after a certain period of
time, select Limit session length to credential lifetime. This requires users to reauthenticate once the amount of time specified by Credential lifetime (on the Configure
General Appliance Options page) has passed.
If you need a TCP connection or consistent UDP traffic flow between the same two
address/port tuples to live longer than eight hours, you must put the user in a community that
has this option unchecked. Even with the Limit session length to credential lifetime box
unchecked, users cannot authorize new flows within the tunnel after their credentials expire.
10. (Optional) If you enabled Redirect all in the Redirection mode area, you can configure
Internet traffic to be sent through an internal proxy server when the VPN connection is active.
In the Proxy options area, select the Redirect Internet traffic through internal proxy
server check box, and then select one of the proxy server options.
{
To specify a proxy auto-configuration (.pac) file, click Proxy auto-configuration file and
then type the URL, preceded by the http:// protocol identifier, for the .pac file. The .pac
file configures the user’s Web browser to load its proxy configuration settings from a
JavaScript file rather than from information that you manually specify; the JavaScript file
specifies which proxy servers can be used and can redirect specific URLs to specific proxy
servers. For information about formatting .pac files, see
http://wp.netscape.com/eng/mozilla/2.0/relnotes/demo/proxy-live.html.
{
To manually specify a proxy server, click Proxy server and then type the server’s host
name and port number in host:port format (for example, myhost:80). Optionally, in the
Exclusion list box, you can type the host names, IP addresses, or domain names of any
resources that you do not want redirected through the proxy server. When defining these
resources, wildcards are valid, and multiple entries must be separated by semicolons.
11. (Optional) To launch an executable file or script after the connection has been established,
click to expand the Post-connection scripts area, select the Run a post-connection script
178
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
check box that corresponds to your operating system, and then specify your settings. For
more information, see “Post-Connection Scripting” on page 173.
a. In the Run this file box, type the path and name for the script file. For example:
%Program Files%\ACME\remote_access.bat
b. (Optional) In the Command line arguments box, type any command-line arguments
that you want to execute when running the script. For example:
-user=%USERNAME% -system=%OS%
c. (Optional) In the Working directory box, type the directory in which the script will be
executed. When defining the working directory, you can specify environment variables
formatted as %VariableName%, where VariableName represents the actual environment
variable name. For example:
%USERPROFILE%\ACME
12. (Optional) ESP (Encapsulating Security Payload) is a way to encapsulate and decapsulate
packets inside of UDP packets for traversing Network Address Translators (NATs). Using it can
improve the performance of applications, especially UDP-streaming applications like VoIP. To
specify ESP for all or some of your traffic, click to expand the Advanced area, and then select
Enable ESP encapsulation of tunnel network traffic.
13. Click OK.
Notes
z
If users are running OnDemand Tunnel in “redirect all” mode, connections to translated Web
resources fail with “Page cannot be displayed” errors. To work around this issue, add an A
(Address) record to the internal DNS servers to assign the appliance VIP or external IP to the
appliance FQDN.
z
When At user’s discretion is enabled for Client software updates in the Software updates
area, the user sees an upgrade notification, and the Connect Tunnel client caches the user’s
response for 24 hours. If the setting is then changed to Required or Forced, a user who opted
to delay updating may not be prompted again until the following day because the earlier
response is still cached.
z
If you plan to run a VB script after a connection has been established, you cannot simply enter
the path and name of the .vbs script file: you must use the Windows Script Host utility in order
to invoke it. To work around this, configure the post-connection options as follows:
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
179
{
Run this file: <drive>:\windows\system32\cscript.exe
{
Command line arguments: <Path to script>. For example, c:\path\to\script.vbs
or \\path\to\script.vbs.
Leave Working directory emtpy.
z
When you specify a .pac file location, be certain that your tunnel users have access to it. You
can do this by defining a resource and creating an access rule. See “Creating and Managing
Resource Groups” on page 137 and “Configuring Access Control Rules” on page 145.
Using the Default Community
After you create a realm, you must associate one or more communities with the realm. This is
because communities are the mechanism that the appliance uses to deploy access agents and End
Point Control components to users.
The easiest way to associate a community with an authentication realm is to use the global Default
community that is preconfigured in AMC. The properties automatically assigned to the Default
community are as follows:
z
Membership in the community is set to Any, meaning all users in the authentication realm are
assigned to the community.
z
Each member of the community is allowed a maximum of 5 active sessions.
z
Web-based proxy access (TCP protocol) and Web access (HTTP) methods are made available to
community members.
z
No End Point Control restrictions are imposed on users’ computers.
Notes
z
You can modify the settings for a realm’s Default community the same as you can other
communities. See “Editing, Copying and Deleting Communities” on page 181.
z
You can also create additional communities and associate them with a realm. See “Adding
Communities to a Realm” on page 165.
Changing the Order of Communities Listed in a Realm
When users log in to an authentication realm, the appliance looks up the community to which they
belong so that access agents and EPC policy can be deployed to them. If you use only one
community per realm, or if you ensure that each user is assigned to only one community, then the
process of logging in and receiving the appropriate access agent is straightforward.
However, if some users belong to more than one community, the order in which the communities
are listed on the Communities tab of the Configure Realm page determines which community
those users are assigned to. The appliance attempts to match users to communities starting at the
top of the list. Users are assigned to the first community in the list that they match. The best
practice is to place the most specific community at the top of the list.
X
To change the order of the communities for a realm
1. From the main navigation menu, click Realms.
2. Click the name of the authentication realm whose communities you want to re-order. The
General tab of the Configure Realm page appears.
3. Click the Communities tab. The communities that are part of this realm will be matched in
the order that is listed here.
4. Use the Move Up or Move Down links to move the selected community up or down.
5. When the communities are listed in the order you want, click Save.
Notes
z
The community a user is assigned to is displayed on the Aventail WorkPlace home page (click
Details in the Connection Status area).
180
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
Configuring RADIUS Accounting in a Realm
If you use a RADIUS server for collecting accounting information, you can configure a RADIUS
accounting server in AMC and then enable accounting on a per-realm basis. The appliance sends
RADIUS accounting messages to the server identifying user sessions, the time and duration of their
connections, and their source IP addresses.
The appliance can connect to one RADIUS server at a time. If two RADIUS servers are configured
in AMC, the appliance sends messages to just the primary server, and communicates with the
secondary server only if there is a communication failure with the primary one.
X
To configure a RADIUS accounting server
1. From the main navigation menu, click Authentication Servers.
2. In the Other servers area of the page, click the Edit link next to RADIUS Accounting.
3. To enable the appliance to send RADIUS accounting messages to the server, select the Enable
RADIUS accounting check box.
4. In the Primary RADIUS server box, type the IP address for the primary accounting server.
In the Accounting port box, type the port number used to communicate with the server. If
left blank, AMC will use the default server port (1646).
5. If you are using a second RADIUS accounting server as a backup in case communication
between the appliance and the server fails, enter the server’s IP address in the Secondary
RADIUS server box, and the port number in the Accounting port box.
6. In the Shared secret box, enter the shared secret that will allow the appliance to
communicate with the RADIUS accounting server.
7. In the Retry interval box (in the Advanced area), type the number of seconds to wait for a
reply from the RADIUS server before retrying communication with the server.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
181
8. By default, the appliance uses its appliance name (from the Configure Network Interfaces
page) to identify itself to the RADIUS accounting server. However, you can use the NASIdentifier and NAS-IP-Address boxes to have the appliance send different identity
information.
9. In the Locale encoding area, do one of the following:
{
Choose a character set from the Selected list box. See “Selected RADIUS Character Sets”
on page 458 for a list of selected character sets.
{
Click Other and then type the name of a character set in the text box. See “Other
Supported RADIUS Character Sets” on page 459 for a list of character sets that can be
entered.
10. Click Save.
Editing, Copying and Deleting Communities
For information on how to edit, copy, and delete communities, see “Adding, Editing, Copying, and
Deleting Objects in AMC” on page 43.
Managing Users and Groups
User and group management is an ongoing job. Although most user management is done through
external user repositories (users and groups are not stored directly on the appliance, but are
instead referenced), keeping the AMC list current is essential for delivering reliable access.
The users and groups defined in AMC are associated with any directories currently configured on
the appliance.
Viewing Users and Groups
Users and groups configured in AMC are displayed on the Groups, Users, and Local Accounts
pages.
X
To view users and groups
1. On the main navigation menu, click Users & Groups.
2. Select the tab for the user object you want to view:
Tab
Description
Groups
Manage groups of users that are mapped to group information stored
on an external authentication server, or create new groups based on
directory information.
Users
Manage individual users mapped to group information stored on an
external authentication server.
Local Accounts
Manage users that are stored in a local repository on the appliance.
182
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
3. Optionally use the Filters settings to display only the objects you are interested in. For
information about using filters, see the “Filters” section under “A Quick Tour of the AMC
Interface” on page 38.
4. Review the data shown in the list of groups, users, or local accounts:
{
The check-box column is used to select one or more list items to delete.
{
The plus sign (+) column expands the display of user, group, or local account information.
{
The Name column displays the name you assigned when creating a user, group, or local
user account.
{
The Description column shows the text you entered when creating an account.
{
The Realm column displays the realm with which a user, group, or local user account is
associated.
5. Click a column heading to sort the list by that column.
Managing Users and Groups Mapped to External Repositories
Users and groups are not stored directly on the appliance, but are instead referenced from external
user directories. In most cases, you manage individual users in AMC only when you need to assign
them permissions that are different from those that their group membership allows. There are two
ways to form groups of users in AMC using information stored in external directories:
z
Use the same group names as the external directory. In most directories, similar user accounts
are grouped together so they can be granted similar rights and permissions. Assuming that your
directory is organized in this way, your user management on the appliance is usually centered
around groups, not users. Set up the appliance to reference user groups stored in your
directory, and then reference those groups in access control rules.
z
Query the external directory using common attributes. The results can be used to create a new
group (one that is not referenced in the external directory) that can be used in access control
rules. You might create a new group named “Local employees” by querying the directory for all
employees living within a given set of zip codes.
For Microsoft Active Directory and LDAP directories, there are several ways to add groups (this
feature is not available for adding users referenced by a RADIUS realm or in the local user store):
z
Manually type a distinguished name (DN)
z
Search the contents of the directory and select groups from a list
z
Build a dynamic group expression
For testing and evaluation purposes, you can also create local users on the appliance. See
“Managing Local User Accounts” on page 191.
Adding Users Manually
When you create an access control rule, one of the things you do is specify the users and groups to
which a given rule applies. You must add users before you can specify them in access control rules.
X
To add a user manually
1. From the main navigation menu, click Users & Groups.
2. Click the Users tab, and then click New.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
183
3. Select Manual entry. The Add User Mapping page appears.
4. In the Realm name list, select the realm to which the user belongs. If the user exists in
multiple realms and you want the appliance to search for any occurrence, select Any from the
realm list.
5. In the Username box, type the username exactly as it appears in the external repository.
(Usernames are case-sensitive.) The following table explains the syntax used to define users
and groups.
Directory type
What to enter
Active Directory or RADIUS
Type a username. For example, jsmith.
LDAP
Type a distinguished name (DN). For example,
cn=jsmith,cn=Users,dc=example,dc=com.
6. (Optional) In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the user.
7. Click Save, or Save and Add Another.
Notes
z
If you enter the name incorrectly the user will not be authorized to access any resources.
z
For Active Directory or LDAP directories, you can also click Browse to search the directory. See
“Adding Users or Groups by Searching a Directory” on page 184 for more information.
Adding Groups Manually
When you create an access control rule, one of the things you do is specify the users and groups to
which a given rule applies. Groups appear in a list on the Groups tab of the Users & Groups page.
X
To add a group manually
1. From the main navigation menu, click Users & Groups.
2. On the Groups tab, click New, and then select Manual entry. The Add/Edit Group Mapping
page appears.
3. In the Realm name list, select the realm to which the group belongs. If the group exists in
multiple realms and you want the appliance to search for any occurrence, select Any from the
realm list.
4. Type the name of a known group on the external directory in the Group name field. The
name depends on the type of directory to which you are mapping:
Directory type
What to type
LDAP
Type a distinguished name (DN). For example,
cn=Sales,cn=Users,dc=example,dc=com.
184
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
Directory type
What to type
Active Directory
Type a common name (CN) or distinguished name (DN). A CN is
easier to enter than a DN (for example, you can type Sales
instead of cn=Sales,cn=Users,dc=example,dc=com), but the
CN is not guaranteed to be a unique match. When in doubt, it’s
best to use a DN.
RADIUS
Type a group name. For example, Sales.
When you specify an Active Directory or LDAP group, its sub-groups (if any) are also included.
The number of nesting levels that you want to include when evaluating group membership is
configured when you set up an authentication server; see “Configuring LDAP with Username
and Password” on page 94 and “Configuring Active Directory with Username and Password” on
page 84 for more information.
Notes
z
When you add a user group in AMC, you are not actually grouping users. You are merely adding
the name of a user group that is defined in your external user repository.
z
The appliance also supports local users for testing and evaluation purposes. See “Managing
Local User Accounts” on page 191.
Adding Users or Groups by Searching a Directory
The most common way to add groups in AMC is to browse an external directory and add matching
groups.
X
To add a user or group by searching a directory
1. From the main navigation menu, click Users & Groups.
2. On the Groups or Users tab, click New, and then select Directory search. The Search
Directory page appears.
3. Select the realm you want to search (only realms that use an Active Directory, Active
Directory Tree, or LDAP authentication server are available).
If you select a realm that uses an authentication server on which group checking is disabled,
the Search box will not be clickable and the message “Group checking has been disabled for
this realm” is displayed. See “Disabling Authorization Checks” on page 83 for more
information.
4. If the realm you selected uses an Active Directory Tree authentication server, select the
domain you want to search.
5. Define your search criteria:
{
In the Search for box, type all or part of a user or group name. The default is *, which
returns all records in the realm. You can use the wildcard character (*) anywhere in the
search string. For example, to find group names beginning with the letter “j,” you would
type j*. Or, to find users named “Mary” or “Marty” (but not “Max”), you could type m*y.
{
To narrow your search, type an AD or LDAP attribute in the Attribute box. For example,
you might type sn to look for a user’s surname, or cn to find a common name.
{
Type the number of results you want returned on each page in the Show box. The default
is 25.
{
To specify more detailed search criteria, click the Advanced tab; see “Advanced Search
Methods” on page 187 for details.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
6. Click Search.
|
185
186
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
7. Locate the objects you want to add:
{
Use the arrow buttons (< and >) in the lower left pane to page through the results. Use
<< and >> to display the first and last pages.
{
To view detailed information about a user or group, click its name. A detailed list of
attributes appears in the right-hand pane. If a group is nested, click the sub-group to see
its details:
The number of nested levels that it is possible to display is configured when you set up an
authentication server; see “Configuring LDAP with Username and Password” on page 94
and “Configuring Active Directory with Username and Password” on page 84 for more
information.
{
Select the check box to the left of any users or groups you want to add to the appliance.
8. To add selections to the appliance, click the Insert Selected Users or Insert Selected
Groups button. The items are added to the list on the appropriate page (Groups or Users) in
alphabetical order. To select (or deselect) all users or groups on the current page, use the
Select all/none check box.
9. When you’re finished, click the Close button in the upper right to close the Search Directory
window.
Notes
z
By default, the basic search is configured to locate users and groups by querying the
sAMAccountName, cn, uid, and userid attributes.
z
Most chained authentication deployments involve an LDAP or AD server paired with another
authentication server (like RADIUS). In the unlikely event that you are using chained
authentication with a combination of LDAP and AD servers, keep the following in mind:
{
If you are searching for users, only search results from the first LDAP or AD authentication
server in the chain are displayed. The policy server, however, returns results from both
servers in the chain.
{
The same is true when searching for groups (except if an affinity server is configured for
the realm: it will be searched instead of the authentication servers).
For example, if you have a group called Accounting on both LDAP or AD servers in your
chained authentication, any access control rules you create that are restricted to the
Accounting group will apply to group members on both servers, even though the Search
Directory page shows results from just the first server in the chain.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
187
Advanced Search Methods
If you are familiar with LDAP syntax, you can create an advanced search to further narrow the scope
of your query. This is especially useful when querying a large directory. In some cases, you may
also need to perform an advanced search in order to query a directory using a non-standard
schema. To perform an advanced search, click the Advanced tab.
The fields used to specify advanced search criteria are explained in the following table:
Attribute
Description
Search for
Specify an LDAP search filter to reduce the scope of the search. Type all
or part of a user or group name. The default is *, which returns all records
in the realm. You can use the wildcard character (*) anywhere in the
search string. For example, to find group names beginning with the letter
“j,” you would type j*. Or, to find users named “Mary” or “Marty” (but not
“Max”), you could type m*y.
Attribute
Type an LDAP attribute in the Attribute box. For example, you might type
sn to look for a user’s surname, or cn to find a common name.
Filter
Specify an LDAP search filter that will reduce the scope of the search.
188
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
Attribute
Description
Syntax:
filter=(operator(LDAP attribute=value)(..))
Operators:
z
OR = “|”
z
AND = “&”
z
NOT = “!”
Examples:
(cn=Sandy Cane)
(!(cn=Tim Howes))
(&(objectClass=Person)(|(sn=Cane)(cn=Sandy C*)))
Search base
Specify the point in the LDAP directory from which to begin searching.
Usually, this will be the lowest point in the directory tree that contains
users or groups.
For LDAP, you might type ou=Users,o=example.com. To search Microsoft
Active Directory, you might use CN=users,DC=example,DC=corp,DC=com.
Object class
Specify the object class containing users or groups. For users, this is
typically user or inetOrgPerson. For groups, this is usually group,
groupOfNames, or groupOfUniqueNames.
Scope
Specify the containers that you want to search:
one
Retrieves information from one level below the search base. The search
base itself is not included in this scope.
sub
(The default) retrieves information from the search base and all levels
below the search base.
base
Retrieves information only from the search base. No containers below the
search base are searched.
Notes
z
For more information on LDAP search filters, see RFC 2254 at
http://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc2254.txt.
z
The LDAP search syntax is flexible and provides several ways to accomplish the same result.
For example, you might use the object class to search for all groups in a directory:
objectclass=group;groupOfNames
Alternatively, you can get the same result using a search filter:
(|(objectclass=group)(objectclass=groupOfNames))
Creating Dynamic Groups Using a Directory
If you are using an external Microsoft Active Directory or LDAP directory, you can form AMC groups
by building your own directory query or, if you’re familiar with LDAP syntax, writing your own
directory query. Whenever this dynamic group is referenced in an access control rule, the external
directory is queried and the results are cached for 30 minutes.
Dynamic groups are useful if you want to create a policy that applies to a group that is not already
defined in the external directory. For example, you might want to create a group called Operations
(Seattle). Although the external directory might already have a group called Operations, you want
to narrow it down to members who are based in Seattle.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
189
To add a dynamic group using an external directory
1. From the main navigation menu, click Users & Groups.
2. On the Groups page, click New and then select Dynamic group expression. A separate
Add/Edit Dynamic Group Expression window opens.
Users who match the expression that you build or write in this window are dynamically
included in this group. If a user is added later and matches this expression, he or she is
automatically included in this group.
3. Select the realm to which this new group belongs from the Realm list. Only realms that have
been configured with an Active Directory or LDAP server (single or chained authentication) are
available.
4. If the realm you selected uses an Active Directory Tree authentication server, select the
domain you want to search.
5. Choose between Simple and LDAP syntax. Use the one you are most familiar with so that you
can edit the query (if needed) in the Expression text box.
6. Use these fields in the Create expression area to build your query (see “Advanced Search
Methods” on page 187 for help with LDAP query syntax):
Setting
Description
Attribute
An initial query is sent to the external directory server to get a list of
defined attributes. (If this list does not look correct, check the name
of the realm you selected in the Realm list.)
Filter operators
A list of commonly used LDAP search operators (=, !=, >=, and <=)
to filter the values returned by the LDAP or Active Directory server.
Value
A user-entered value that can contain wildcards. Assuming an
Attribute of ZipCode, for example, you could type a Value of 98* to
query for all employees living in Washington state.
Operator
Common logical operators (AND, OR).
190
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
Setting
Description
Add to Expression
Adds the current attribute, value, and operator to the Expression
text area. You can cycle back through (as many times as needed),
defining an additional Attribute, Value, and Operator to further
refine your query. Click Add to Expression after each addition.
Expression
The query you are creating is displayed here so that you can edit it (if
necessary).
You can also type a query directly in the Expression text box.
7. Test the expression you’ve created. The results should tell you whether you need to broaden
or refine your search. If necessary, you can simply modify the query by either building the
expression in the Create expression area, or editing the query directly in the Expression
text box.
Setting
Description
Test Expression
Sends the LDAP search query displayed in the Expression area to
the LDAP or AD server and displays the results (a list of users) in the
right-hand pane. If the results are not what you expect, modify the
query and test again.
A new group should not be saved until the expression has been
tested.
Name
The name of this dynamic group.
Description
(Optional) A description of the group is useful later when you are
creating access rules that apply to only certain groups.
Notes
z
Most chained authentication deployments involve an LDAP or AD server paired with another
authentication server (like RADIUS). In the unlikely event that you are using chained
authentication with a combination of LDAP and AD servers, keep the following in mind:
{
If you are searching for users, only search results from the first LDAP or AD authentication
server in the chain are displayed. The policy server, however, will return results from both
servers in the chain.
{
The same is true when searching for groups (except if an affinity server is configured for
the realm: it will be searched instead of the authentication servers).
For example, if you have a group called Accounting on both LDAP or AD servers in your
chained authentication, any access control rules you create that are restricted to the
Accounting group will apply to group members on both servers, even though the Search
Directory page shows results from just the first server in the chain.
z
When conducting a multi-valued query against an LDAP or AD directory, you must specify the
full DN of the group being queried.
Editing Users or Groups
If a user or group name or distinguished name changes in your external directory, you must modify
the account on the appliance.
X
To edit a user or group
1. From the main navigation menu, click Users & Groups.
2. Choose the object you want to edit:
{
To edit a group, click the Groups tab, and then click the name of the group that you want
to edit. The Add/Edit Group Mapping page appears.
{
To edit a user, click the Users tab, and then click the name of the user that you want to
edit. The Add/Edit User Mapping page appears.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
191
3. Make any edits as needed. If the user or group is in an Active Directory or LDAP realm, you
can click Browse and then search for the user. Click Insert Selected User or Insert
Selected Group to update the user or group mapping on the appliance.
4. Click Save, or Save and Add Another.
Deleting Users or Groups
When you delete a user or group, its mapping is removed from the system. Deleting a user or group
does not remove it from the external user directory.
X
To delete a user or group
1. From the main navigation menu, click Users & Groups.
2. Choose the object you want to delete:
{
To remove a group, click the Groups tab, and then select the check box to the left of any
groups that you want to delete.
{
To remove a user, click the Users tab, and then select the check box to the left of any
users that you want to delete.
3. Click Delete.
Notes
z
You cannot delete a user or group if it is referenced by another object. For example, if you try
to delete a user or group that is referenced in an access control rule, AMC displays an error
message. You must first remove all references to the user or group before you can delete it.
See “Deleting Referenced Objects” on page 54 for more details.
Managing Local User Accounts
The appliance provides two different ways for creating local user accounts on the appliance:
z
You can create local users when you run Setup Wizard to configure the appliance. See “WebBased Configuration Using Setup Wizard” on page 32.
z
You can create local user accounts in AMC and store them in a local authentication repository.
In either case local users are, as the name implies, stored on the appliance, unlike all other users
who are stored in external authentication repositories and referenced by AMC. AMC lets you create,
modify, and delete local accounts for individual users on the appliance, but it does not support local
accounts for groups of users.
Notes
z
Local users are best suited for testing and evaluation purposes. SonicWALL recommends that
you set up your production environment to integrate with an external authentication directory
such as LDAP or Microsoft Active Directory.
Adding Local Users
Before you can add local users, you must first create a local authentication repository on the
appliance, as described in “Configuring Local User Storage” on page 107, and then create a realm
that uses it.
Once you’ve created a local authentication store and realm, you can add local users to the
appliance.
X
To add local users to the appliance
1. On the main navigation menu, click Users & Groups.
192
|
Chapter 6 - User Management
2. Click the Local Accounts tab, and then click New. The Add Local User page appears.
3. In the Realm name list, select the local authentication repository.
4. In the Username box, type the name of the local user you want to add to the local
authentication repository.
5. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the local user.
6. In the Password box, type a password for the local user, and type it again in the Confirm
Password box.
7. Click Save to create the local user account and save it to the local authentication repository on
the appliance.
Editing Local Users
Perform the following steps to change a local user’s settings.
X
To edit a local user
1. From the main navigation menu, click Users & Groups.
2. Click the Local Accounts tab.
3. Click the name of the user you want to edit. The Add/Edit Local User page appears.
4. Make any edits to the user’s settings, and then click Save.
Deleting Local Users
Perform the following steps to delete a local user.
X
To delete a local user
1. From the main navigation menu, click Users & Groups.
2. Click the Local Accounts tab.
3. Select the check box for the user you want to delete, and then click Delete.
Notes
z
You cannot delete a local user if he or she is referenced by another object. For example, if you
try to delete a local user referenced in an access control rule, AMC displays an error message.
Click the link in the error message to see a list of all references to this user. See “Deleting
Referenced Objects” on page 54 for more details.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
193
Chapter 7
System Administration
This section describes how to configure and use system logging and monitoring, and how to
configure Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) encryption options. It also describes how to use a variety of
tools to upgrade, roll back, or reset software versions and to back up or reset configuration files.
Optional Network Configuration
This section describes how to configure a variety of network services and tools. It explains how to
enable SSH access from remote hosts, and how to enable Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP)
so you can ping the appliance. It also describes how to configure the time settings on the appliance.
For information about configuring and using SNMP, see “SNMP Configuration” on page 214.
Enabling SSH Access from Remote Hosts
Enabling SSH provides an easy way to access the appliance console from another system. You can
enable SSH access from your internal or external network. The local SSH server daemon (sshd)
listens on port 22 (the well-known port number for SSH).
X
To enable SSH access
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services.
2. In the Network Services area, click the Configure link for SSH.
194
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
3. To enable SSH, select the Enable SSH check box.
4. To add a host from which you want to enable SSH access, click New, type the IP address and
subnet mask for the host you want to add, and then click OK.
5. Click Save.
X
To delete a host
1. Select the check box to left of any hosts you want to remove.
2. Click Delete, and then click Save.
Notes
z
You can enable SSH access from any host by typing 0.0.0.0 for both the IP address and the
subnet mask. Keep in mind, however, that the trade-off for this convenience is decreased
appliance security.
Enabling ICMP
Enabling ICMP allows you to use the ping command to test network connectivity to the appliance
from another computer on the same subnet. This will not enable broadcast pings.
!
X
CAUTION Enabling ICMP makes it possible to ping the appliance from both network interfaces
(external and internal). Unless you suppress ICMP Echo Request traffic using a firewall or other
network device, it will be possible to discover the appliance from the Internet.
To enable ICMP
1. From the main navigation menu, click Network Settings.
2. In the Basic area, click the Edit link. The Configure Basic Network Settings page appears.
3. In the ICMP area, select the Enable ICMP pings check box.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
195
4. Click Save.
Configuring Time Settings
To set the date and time referenced on the appliance and in system logs, select a time zone and
then set the local time, if necessary. There are two ways to set the current time: manually, or by
synchronizing with one or more Network Time Protocol (NTP) servers.
X
To change the time zone
1. From the main navigation menu, click General Settings.
2. In the Appliance options area, click Edit.
3. In the Date/time area, select your current local time zone from the Time zone list, and then
click Save. By default, the appliance is set to Greenwich Mean Time (GMT).
4. Apply your pending changes.
X
To manually configure the system time
1. From the main navigation menu, click General Settings.
2. In the Appliance options area, click Edit.
3. In the Date/time area, click Change and then enter the current date and time. Click Set to
apply your changes immediately.
Notes
z
If you are using a SonicWALL-provided evaluation license, do not move your system time
backward from the current time; doing so will disable all services on your appliance for licensing
reasons.
X
To configure the system time using NTP
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services.
196
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
2. In the Network services area, click the Configure link next to NTP.
3. To enable NTP, select the Enable NTP check box.
4. To configure NTP, type the IP addresses for one or more NTP servers in the Primary server
and Backup server boxes. The appliance attempts to synchronize with the primary server,
and uses the secondary servers as needed if the primary server is unavailable.
5. Click Save.
Notes
z
The appliance does not use NTP authentication keys, making it possible for someone to spoof
an NTP server and provide the appliance with incorrect time settings. We recommend that you
synchronize only with NTP servers on your internal network.
System Logging and Monitoring
The SonicWALL appliance logs a variety of useful information, including user access, system events,
and changes in AMC. This section explains how to configure and view logs in AMC, and how to send
messages to an external syslog server. It also describes the system status information displayed by
AMC.
If a central syslog server is not available, you can review log files from the command-line interface
on the appliance itself using standard UNIX commands. For information on how to manually view
and interpret raw log data, see “Log File Output Formats” on page 443.
Overview: System Logging and Monitoring
The appliance logs data for the operation of AMC and the services on the appliance; it also collects
data on how administrators have used and changed the system. All system logs are collected and
stored in the syslog format, and log messages are handled using an updated version of the standard
syslog format.
The appliance is initially configured to store log files locally. If you configure it to send log files to a
central syslog server, you can monitor system-level events in near real time, and receive
notifications about significant events. You can also export log message data to a comma-separated
values (.csv) file for viewing and analysis with other applications.
Log Files
The appliance generates several types of log files that can be viewed and exported from the
Logging page in AMC. There are also two log files related to Aventail WorkPlace that can’t be
viewed in AMC; they are described in “WorkPlace Logs” on page 454.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
197
Viewing Logs
There are several log files generated by the SonicWALL appliance, and AMC enables you to sort,
search, and filter them.
X
To view logs
1. From the main navigation menu, click Logging. The View Logs page appears.
2. Select the SonicWALL system or service log file you want to view from the Log file list. The
columns of information displayed are different for each type of log file:
Log file
Description
System message log
Displays server processing and diagnostic information
about the network tunnel service and the Web proxy
service. It also provides detailed messages about all
access control decisions: each time a user request
matches a policy rule, a log file entry is recorded
explaining the action taken.
For details, see “System Message Log” on page 201.
Network proxy/tunnel audit log
Web proxy audit log
There are two access service audit logs: one for the Web
proxy service (called ExtraWeb in the log files), and one
that combines messages from both the network proxy and
network tunnel services (called Anywhere VPN in the log
files). These two logs provide detailed information about
connection activity, including a list of users and the
amount of data transferred.
For details, see “Network Tunnel Audit Log” on page 204
and “Web Proxy Audit Log” on page 205.
3. Use the Show last box to select the number of log messages you want to display. You can
choose 50, 100, 250, 500, or 1000 messages.
198
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
4. Click the Refresh button to update the page to show the most recent log messages, or to view
the results of any filtering selections you’ve made.
By default, the log viewer’s Auto-refresh option is set to 1 min. You can optionally set the
refresh time to 30 sec., 1 min., 5 min., 10 min., 15 min., or turn it Off during your AMC
session.
5. Use the optional Search for and Level, Source, and Status sorting options to find log
messages that meet specific criteria. See “Sorting, Searching, and Filtering Log Messages” on
page 198.
6. A plus sign is displayed in the message column when a log entry is more than a few lines long:
click it to expand the entry.
Notes
z
When Auto-refresh is set to any time interval other than Off and the View Logs page is
displayed, the refresh activity prevents the AMC session from automatically timing out after the
default inactivity period (15 minutes). This means that if you leave AMC unattended while the
View Logs page is displayed and in auto-refresh mode, AMC will not time out. A good security
practice is to always switch to another page in AMC when you are done viewing log messages.
See “Appliance Sessions” on page 440 for more information.
Sorting, Searching, and Filtering Log Messages
The AMC log viewer allows you to customize the display of log message data using sorting,
searching, and filtering options. You can use these options separately or in any combination.
Sorting
Data displayed in each of the columns in the log table can be sorted in ascending or descending
order by clicking the column heading. By default, log messages are sorted by the Time column,
with the most recent messages shown at the top.
Searching
To search for text strings in the log files, such as an IP address or a user ID, type the (casesensitive) search criteria in the Search for box and then click Refresh to view the results. You can
use the wildcard characters * and ? in your search criteria. To clear the search criteria, click the
reset link.
When you’re viewing a system message log, you can click a session ID number in the ID column
to automatically search for all log messages that share the same session ID. For information on
session ID see the table of field descriptions in “System Message Log” on page 201.
In the Web proxy audit log and the network proxy/tunnel audit log, you can click a user ID in the
Username column to automatically search for all log messages about a specific user.
Filtering
With the filtering options, you can include or exclude certain types of logging data for each log file.
For example, if you want to see Management message log entries that are not AMC-related (such
as system control authority messages), select all of the Level check boxes and make sure the AMC
check box under Source is cleared. The available options vary depending on the type of log file you
are viewing.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
199
Exporting Log Files
If you need to perform additional analysis of the log message data, or display the data differently,
you can export selected data to files for use by another application, such as Microsoft Excel (in the
case of logs with comma-separated values) or an XML editor (in the case of the log for unregistered
devices).
You can reduce the size of the exported file by first applying filter or search criteria. The Show last
<n> messages setting determines the maximum number of messages included in the exported
log file.
X
To export a log file
1. From the main navigation menu, click Logging. The View Logs page appears.
2. Use the Log file list to select the SonicWALL system or service log file you want to view.
3. Apply any filter or search criteria to the log data. See “Sorting, Searching, and Filtering Log
Messages” on page 198.
4. Click Export.
5. You are prompted to save or open the file. Click Save.
6. In the Save As dialog box, browse for the location where the file will be saved, optionally
rename the file, and then click Save. By default, AMC assigns the following file names to the
exported files:
File name
Description
sysmessage.csv
System message log
management.csv
Management message log
consoleaudit.csv
Management audit log
netaudit.csv
Network proxy/tunnel audit log
webaudit.csv
Web proxy audit log
UnregisteredDevices.xml Log of devices with an equipment ID that is not
recognized. For the steps necessary for collecting device
identifiers in this log, see “Collecting Equipment IDs from
Unregistered Devices” on page 277.
Configuring Log Settings
If you are debugging the system, you can set the message log level for the SonicWALL services in
AMC. Additionally, you can configure the appliance to send log files to an external syslog server.
Setting Log Levels
You can specify how much detail is written to the message logs for each service. Increasing the
message log detail requires more disk space and has a greater impact on system performance.
X
To set the logging level
1. From the main navigation menu, click Logging. The View Logs page appears.
200
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
2. Click the Configure Logging tab.
3. Select the appropriate level of message detail for the services on the appliance, which are
listed in order of increasing detail. The highest detail log levels (Verbose and Debug) are
valuable for troubleshooting purposes, but they require more disk space and can have a
significant performance impact: they should not be used in normal operation.
4. You can also configure the appliance to send system logs to one or more syslog servers. Type
the IP addresses and port numbers for the syslog servers in the Syslog configuration area.
port 514 is the standard syslog-ng port, but you can use another port as needed to match
your server configuration. Regardless of whether you configure syslog, all system events are
logged locally.
5. Click Cancel to discard any changes you’ve made, or click Save.
Sending Log Files to a Syslog Server
The SonicWALL Aventail appliance can send system logs to a syslog server. Regardless of whether
you configure syslog, all system events are logged locally. To avoid flooding the network with log
information, the appliance forwards log messages for only the three highest severity levels (fatal,
error, and warning).
For information on the syslog protocol, see RFC 3164 (http://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc3164.txt).
X
To send log files to a syslog server
1. From the main navigation menu, click Logging. The View Logs page appears.
2. Click the Configure Logging tab.
3. Under Syslog configuration, type the IP address and port numbers for one or more syslog
servers. The default for the syslog-ng port is 514, but you can use another port as needed to
match your server configuration. Use the Protocol list to specify whether the appliance will
communicate with syslog using the TCP or UDP protocol.
4. Click Cancel to discard any changes you’ve made, or click Save.
Notes
z
Because syslog data is not encrypted, sending log messages to an external server is a potential
security issue.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
201
System Message Log
The system message log displays server processing and diagnostic information about the Web proxy
service, network proxy, and the network tunnel service. It also provides detailed messages about
all access control decisions: each time a user request matches a policy rule, a log file entry is
recorded explaining the action taken. To view this log, select System message log from the Log file
list on the View Logs page in AMC.
The View Logs page displays the following information from the system message log file:
Column
Description
Level
Log message detail level: Fatal, Error, Warning, Info, or Verbose.
Time
Date and time when the message was generated by the service.
Source
Indicates which service generated the message: Network proxy, Network
tunnel, Web proxy, or Policy server.
ID
The unique ID number assigned to each user session. Click a session ID
number to automatically search for all log messages associated with it. For
more information on session ID numbers, see “System Message Log” on
page 444.
Message
Message text.
Notes
z
For information on manually reviewing log files from the command-line interface on the
appliance, see “System Message Log” on page 444.
202
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
Management Message Log
The Management message log contains entries regarding the operation of AMC, including when the
console was started and stopped, and what errors occurred during administration of the appliance.
If the replication of configuration data fails, for example, a detailed message is added to the log to
help diagnose the issue. To view this log, select Management message log from the Log file list on
the View Logs page in AMC.
The View Logs page displays the following information about the Management message log:
Column
Description
Level
Log message detail level: Error, Warning, Info, Verbose, or Debug.
Time
Date and time message was logged.
Source
Shows the source for the change: AMC or Other, which includes WEEKPRUN
and sysctrl.
Message
Describes the log entry in more detail.
Management Audit Log
The Management audit log provides an audit history of configuration changes made in AMC by
administrators, showing when changes were made and by which administrator. Configuration
changes are either active or pending:
z
Active configuration: Configuration items that precede the log message “Applied
configuration changes” are ones that have been applied and are currently active.
z
Pending changes: As changes are made, they are saved to disk but not immediately applied.
In the Management audit log, these pending changes follow the “Applied configuration changes”
message and can be discarded. See “Discarding Pending Configuration Changes” on page 53 to
find out how to do so.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
203
To view this log, select Management audit log from the Log file list on the View Logs page in AMC.
The View Logs page displays the following information about the Management audit log:
Column
Description
Level
Log message detail level: Fatal, Error, Warning, or Info.
Time
Date and time of the AMC configuration change.
Username
Shows the name of the administrator as it is configured on the Manage
Administrator Accounts page.
Message
Shows configuration changes made in AMC.
Notes
z
For information on manually reviewing log files from the command-line interface on the
appliance, see “Management Console Audit Log” on page 454.
204
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
Network Tunnel Audit Log
The network proxy/tunnel audit log provides detailed information about connection activity for
users who are accessing resources using Connect Tunnel or OnDemand Tunnel, including a list of
users and the amount of data transferred. To view this log, select Network tunnel audit log from
the Log file list on the View Logs page in AMC.
The View Logs page displays the following information about the network proxy/tunnel audit log
file:
Column
Description
Status
Displays color-coded connection status for each connection request:
z
Red: Error
z
Orange: Information
z
Green: Success
When you move the pointer over a connection status code for a specific log
message, AMC displays explanatory text below the message.
Time
Date and time of the connection.
Source
Indicates which service generated the message: Network proxy, Network
Tunnel, Web proxy, or Policy server.
Source IP
The IP address and port number of the computer using the network proxy or
tunnel service.
Destination IP
Indicates the IP address and port number of the resource being accessed.
Bytes
Shows three sets of values:
Username
z
The number of bytes sent
z
The number of bytes received
z
The connection duration (in seconds)
The user who requested the resource. You can search for all log messages for
a specific user by clicking a username link.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
205
Notes
z
For information on manually reviewing log files from the command-line interface on the
appliance, see “Network Tunnel Audit Log” on page 450.
Web Proxy Audit Log
The Web proxy audit log provides detailed information about connection activity for users who are
accessing resources using Web Proxy Access or Translated Access, including a list of users and the
amount of data transferred. To view this log, select Web proxy audit log from the Log file list on
the View Logs page in AMC.
The View Logs page displays the following information about the Web proxy audit log file:
Column
Description
Status
Displays color-coded return codes for each HTTP request. Move the pointer
over an HTTP return code number to see explanatory text. The code numbers
are in the following ranges and colors:
z
500: server error (red)
z
400: client error (orange)
z
300: redirection (green)
z
200: success (green)
Time
The date and time at which the request was received by the appliance.
Source IP
The IP address and port number of the computer that used the Web proxy
service.
Bytes
The number of bytes sent in the body of the response, excluding the size of
the HTTP headers.
Username
The name with which the user authenticated to the Web proxy service. You can
search all log messages related to a specific user by clicking a username link.
Request
Shows the first line of the HTTP request, which contains the HTTP command
(such as GET or POST), the requested resource, and the HTTP version number.
206
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
Notes
z
For information on manually reviewing log files from the command-line interface on the
appliance, see “Web Proxy Audit Log” on page 452.
Client Installation Logs (Windows)
When users log in to a realm, the access methods available to them depend on a few different
things:
z
The network access agents or clients that are permitted for a particular community, which is
something that you specify when you set up a realm
z
The user’s environment: the operating system, browser, the availability of ActiveX or Java, and
whether any clients or agents are already present
If something goes wrong during client or agent installation on a computer running Windows, the
error is recorded in a client installation log. These logs are automatically uploaded to the appliance
and listed in AMC if the user has Aventail Access Manager installed. See “Client and Agent
Provisioning (Windows)” on page 319 for details about Aventail Access Manager.
To see the list of client logs for all users, select Client installation logs from the Log file list on the
View Logs tab in AMC.
You can sort the client installation logs by time or username; to download a log file, click on it. The
log appends information about each step in the provisioning process: bootstrapping, provisioning
new components, and interrogating the device (for device profile matching). The last set of
information is probably where the installation problem occurred.
When troubleshooting, first look at a user’s client installation log in AMC, and then (if necessary)
the log file epiBootstrapper.log, stored on the user’s local machine in the \Documents and
Settings\<username>\Application Data\Aventail\LogFiles folder.
Monitoring the Appliance
AMC displays a variety of information that is helpful in monitoring basic system settings, disk and
memory usage, current connections, and network bandwidth use.
This section describes how to monitor system status and active users, and how to terminate VPN
connections for selected users.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
207
Monitoring Overall Activity and System Status
The AMC home page displays a graphical summary of information that is helpful in monitoring
system status. The graphs show average usage for the most recent hour of activity.
If you are set up to share configuration data with other appliances
(policy replication), the appliance name is shown here.
Click Details at the bottom of the AMC home page to display the System Status page, which
contains more detailed status information and enables you to customize the type of data displayed.
X
To monitor system status
1. From the main navigation menu, click System Status. The System Status page appears,
displaying information about the appliance’s current status, such as memory utilization.
208
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
2. In the Show drop-down list, select the type of data you want to view.
Type of data
Description
Active users
Displays the number of active user sessions for the specified
time period. This graph includes a horizontal line that
indicates the maximum number of concurrent users allowed
by your license.
Notes:
z
In a clustered environment, this list shows just the active
users on the node from which you are accessing AMC, not
the users on both nodes.
z
“Active” user sessions are not the same as licensed ones;
for more information, see “Open vs. Licensed Sessions”
on page 211.
CPU utilization
Displays the percentage of the CPU capacity that was used for
the specified time period.
Memory utilization
Displays the percentage of memory that was used for the
specified time period. The percentage is calculated from
information returned by the meminfo utility on the appliance:
((MemTotal - Cached - MemFree) / MemTotal) * 100
Network bandwidth
Displays the network bandwidth in Mbps for the specified time
period. If both the internal and external interfaces are
enabled, graph data for the internal interface is represented
by a green line and data for the external interface is displayed
in blue. The scale of this graph automatically adjusts to reflect
the amount of traffic (for example, the graph might use a 1
Mbps scale or a 100 Mbps scale, depending on traffic).
Swap utilization
Displays the amount of free swap space available for the
specified time period.
3. In the second Show box, indicate the time interval you want to show:
Interval
Description
Hourly
Displays average activity during the last hour based on
samples collected every 20 seconds.
Daily
Displays average activity for the last day based on samples
collected every ten minutes.
Weekly
Displays average activity for the last week based on samples
collected every 60 minutes.
Monthly
Displays average activity for the last 32 days based on
samples collected every four hours (six samples per day).
4. In the Auto-refresh box, select a value that indicates how often AMC will automatically
update the selected data.
5. Optionally, in the Also show box, you can select another type of data graph. This can be
useful if you want to compare two types of data for a given time period.
6. To update the page at any time, click Refresh.
Notes
z
When Auto-refresh is set to any time interval other than Off and the System Status page is
displayed, the refresh activity prevents the AMC session from automatically timing out after the
default inactivity period (15 minutes). This means that if you leave AMC unattended while this
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
209
page is displayed and in auto-refresh mode, AMC will not time out. A good security practice is
to always switch to another page in AMC when you are done reviewing status. See “Appliance
Sessions” on page 440 for more information.
Viewing User Sessions
You can monitor, troubleshoot or terminate user sessions on your appliance, or HA pair of
appliances, in AMC. By sorting through the list and filtering the sessions—by user name, realm
(authentication server), community, access agent, traffic load, and so on—you can narrow your
search to particular sessions and view further details about them. Here are two filtering examples.
X
To view all open user sessions
1. From the main navigation menu, click User Sessions.
You can get a quick read on what state a session is in by looking at its icon. See “Open vs.
Licensed Sessions” on page 211 for a complete description of each state.
Session states
2. In the View list, select All open sessions. This displays sessions that are either licensed or idle. An
idle session is one that can be resumed: its license is released after the connection is inactive
for more than 15 minutes, but up until that moment the session can be resumed. See “Open
vs. Licensed Sessions” on page 211 for more information on what sessions are considered
“open.”
3. You can filter your list of sessions further using a combination of other properties, such as
realm and zone. Click Refresh to update the list of sessions based on your filters.
4. Review the session list. To resort the list, click the heading at the top of a column.
210
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
5. For a quick summary of a particular session, expand the item in the session list:
For complete session details, such as the resource a user attempted to access and what policy
rules were applied in the process, click the username link. See “Viewing User Access and Policy
Details” on page 212 for more information on this troubleshooting tool.
X
To search for sessions with a high traffic load
1. From the main navigation menu, click User Sessions.
2. In the View list, select All sessions.
3. If you plan to end sessions that are taking up too much bandwidth, restrict the list to licensed
sessions: in the Filters area, select Licensed in the Status list, and then click Refresh.
4. To isolate the time range you’re interested in, make a selection in the Time period list box:
{
Select All to see data from sessions that are up to one week old, and select Last 24 hours
to see user activity for the last day.
{
Select Custom to specify a particular range by date and time.
Click Refresh to view updated results.
5. To find out which sessions involve the most traffic, sort the list by clicking Avg data (the
amount of traffic for the last hour) or Total data (the total amount for the session) at the top
of the column.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
211
Open vs. Licensed Sessions
When you look at user sessions in AMC it’s important to understand the distinction between
different types of sessions. For example, if a user has a question about access to a resource, you
will want to see all of the sessions associated with that user (even the failed ones), not just the ones
that are licensed.
Session types
Licensed sessions
A licensed session does not represent a person, but rather a user
authentication. A user who is logged in on two devices, for
example, consumes two licenses as soon as a resource protected
by the appliance is accessed.
Until the user explicitly logs out of a session or the session has
timed out (after 15 minutes of inactivity), a license is consumed
(simply closing the browser window in WorkPlace, for example,
does not free up a license).
All open sessions
An open session is defined as a session that is either licensed or
that can be resumed. This idle, “can be resumed” state is
different for browser and tunnel sessions:
z
A browser session will have its license released after the
connection is inactive for more than 15 minutes.
z
A Connect Tunnel session will have its license released 15
minutes after the tunnel has been disconnected due to a
network event, for example, when a mobile user moves out
of range or a laptop lid is closed. (Even when the user has
stopped using a tunnel session, it remains active because of
network traffic, such as keep-alive packets.)
Unlicensed sessions in this open state can be resumed as long as
the authentication token remains valid and a license is available
when the session is resumed. By default, the authentication
token is valid several hours after a session is started.
All sessions
This category includes all open sessions, plus sessions that were
ended or where the login has failed after successive retries. If the
user abandons his or her login attempts before receiving a final
failure message, no information about those attempts is
displayed in this list. Data about sessions that ended more than
7 days ago is discarded.
Notes
z
See “How Licenses Are Calculated” on page 244 for more information.
Ending User Sessions
You can immediately terminate a user’s session, even if the user has multiple connections on
different services or nodes, or temporarily disable a user’s network access for 10 minutes (the user
can log in to the network again after that period if your access policy allows it). To permanently
prevent a user from logging in to your VPN, you must do one of the following:
z
Modify the applicable access control rules
z
Modify or delete the applicable user and group definitions
z
Delete the user from your user directory
X
To end open user sessions
1. From the main navigation menu, click User Sessions.
212
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
2. In the View lists, select the number of sessions you want to display, and then select All open
(only sessions that are open can be terminated).
3. You can filter the list of sessions using a combination of other properties:
{
User: Enter all or part of a user name. You can use wildcard characters (* or ?) anywhere
in the search string.
{
Realm: Select a realm, or all realms.
{
Community: Select a community, or all communities. If you selected a realm, the
communities you see in this list are restricted to those that are associated with it.
{
Zone: Select a zone, or all zones.
{
Agent: Select one or more access agents, or specify that none have been activated
(translation only).
4. There are two ways to terminate sessions manually in AMC. Only open sessions—those for
which there is either a license or those that can be resumed—can be terminated. Select the
check box next to any session you want to end, or select the check box at the top to select all
the users in the list, and then click one of the session termination buttons:
Terminate session
When you click Terminate session, all connections associated with the selected sessions are
terminated. This is a good way to free up a license from an idle session, for example.
Termination occurs on a session-by-session basis, so if a user has several sessions you can be
selective about which ones you end. The user whose session was terminated can immediately
reauthenticate and log in to the appliance.
Terminate session - restrict logins
This type of termination is the same as above, but there is a ten-minute interval during which
the user is not allowed to generate new sessions. If there are any existing sessions, they can
be used, but until ten minutes elapse, no new sessions can be created. This is the type of
termination you would use, for example, if you wanted to end all of a user’s sessions and
prevent any new ones from being established while you remove his or her credentials from the
authentication store.
Viewing User Access and Policy Details
If a user is experiencing trouble with a session—for example, he is logged in but cannot establish
a connection or is denied access to resources—you can use the Session Details page to diagnose
the problem. It enables you to troubleshoot a session, whether or not it’s still active, by assessing
its status, determining why a user’s device is classified into a particular zone, and discovering what
policy rules are applied, editing them as needed.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
213
To view user session details
1. From the main navigation menu, click User Sessions.
2. Click the username link for the session you want more details about; if needed, narrow the
displayed list by setting filters, and then click Refresh.
{
To troubleshoot access to resources, look at the Access requests list. You can expand a
list item to see the access control rule that determined whether this particular connection
request should be allowed or denied. If the rule still exists, you’ll also a link for editing the
item.
{
An End Point Control zone classifies a connection request based on the presence or
absence of a device profile. On the Zone classification page you can see what EPC zones
(if any) were evaluated during this session and what the outcome of each evaluation was.
214
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
In this example, the mobile device was placed in the Pocket PC zone, but it did not match
the Equipment ID device profile.
{
If the user’s session has any current Connect Tunnel connections, they are listed by IP
address on the Active connections page. Other access agents are not listed here
because they do not keep the VPN connection open.
SNMP Configuration
If you have an SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) tool—such as SonicWALL GMS Net
Monitor, Hewlett-Packard OpenView, or IBM Tivoli—you can use it to monitor the appliance as an
SNMP agent. The appliance supports SNMP versions 1 and 2c, and provides a variety of
management data in Management Information Base (MIB) II format.
Configuring SNMP
This section describes how to configure SNMP settings in AMC.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
215
To configure SNMP
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services.
2. Under Network services, click the Configure link for SNMP.
3. Enable SNMP by selecting the Enable SNMP check box. (If you leave this page to configure
SNMP hosts before clicking Save, the status of this setting will not be saved.)
4. Select the network interface you want SNMP to use by selecting the appropriate option
(Internal, External, or Both) from the Interface selection list.
5. Use the Agent properties area to identify the appliance:
a. Type the string your network management tool uses to query the SonicWALL Aventail
appliance in the Community string box. This field is required, and set to public by
default. It is a good security practice to change your community string to a different
passphrase because public is not secure.
b. Describe the appliance agent in the System location and System contact boxes. For
example, you might specify the physical location of the appliance (for example, Server
lab) and the system administrator contact information (such as Jim Jamerson, 206-5551212).
6. Define the management systems from which the appliance will allow SNMP requests. You can
allow the request to come from any host by typing 0.0.0.0 for both the IP address and the
subnet mask. Keep in mind, however, that the trade-off for this convenience is decreased
appliance security.
a. In the SNMP hosts area, click New.
b. Type the IP address and a Netmask for the host, and then click OK.
7. Click Save.
216
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
Notes
z
You must configure your SNMP manager with the Management Information Base (MIB) used by
the appliance. The appliance supports version 4.2.3 of the University of California, Davis (UCD)
MIB, and MIB II. You must also configure your SNMP manager with the community string
required to query the appliance.
z
Ensure that your internal firewalls are configured to allow port 161/udp traffic.
Downloading the SonicWALL MIB File
AMC enables you to download the SonicWALL Aventail MIB file, which adds VPN-specific data to
already supported MIBs. See “SonicWALL MIB Data” on page 217 for details on the information
provided by the SonicWALL MIB.
X
To download the SonicWALL MIB
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services.
2. Under Network Services, click the Configure link for SNMP.
3. Click the Download Aventail MIB button. A file download message appears.
4. Click Save, browse to the correct directory, and then save the aventailCustomMibs.tar file.
Configuring GMS for SNMP Monitoring of the Appliance
SonicWALL Global Management System (SonicWALL GMS) is a web-based application (purchased
separately) that can help you centrally configure and manage SonicWALL and non-SonicWALL
Internet security appliances. It enables you to monitor the status of and apply configurations to all
managed SonicWALL appliances.
There is a MIB compiler/importer integrated into SonicWALL GMS Net Monitor that you can use to
analyze SonicWALL Aventail MIB files. Once you configure Net Monitor, you can browse the Aventail
OID tree and create your own monitors, use mathematical expressions involving OIDs to create
alerts, and so on. Complete details on configuring Net Monitor are included in the GMS
documentation; a summary of how to do it is described here.
X
To configure GMS Net Monitor to view Aventail MIBs
1. Download the Aventail MIB file archive (aventailCustomMibs.tar), described in “Downloading
the SonicWALL MIB File” on page 216.
2. Expand the archive and add a .mib extension to the files it contains.
3. Copy the Aventail MIB files to the <GMS-Install-Folder>/etc/mibs folder.
4. Add a unit in Net Monitor, making sure to choose SNMP.
5. Click Advanced, and then select Aventail MIBs.
6. Once the unit is acquired, select the SNMP Options/SNMP Manage Realtime Monitors
menu for the device you just added.
Notes
z
Refer to the documentation for SonicWALL GMS Net Monitor on www.mysonicwall.com for
further information.
Retrieving Management Data Using SNMP
SNMP data is arranged in a standardized hierarchy made up of structured text files that describe
valuable management data. These text files (called MIBs) contain descriptions of specific data
variables, such as system information or status.
To retrieve information through SNMP, you query the system for an “object identifier,” or OID. Each
OID includes a text name, but is usually referenced using a number. For example, the OID for
system uptime (sysUpTime) is 1.3.6.1.2.1.1.3.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
217
If you don’t have an SNMP management package, you can retrieve SNMP data by connecting to the
appliance, logging in as root, and then running the snmpwalk or snmpget command. For
example, to retrieve information about disk space availability, you could type the following
snmpwalk command to query OID 1.3.6.1.4.1.2021.9:
snmpwalk -v 1 localhost -c public 1.3.6.1.4.1.2021.9
To view a list containing all of the MIB variables, type:
snmpwalk -v 1 -O n localhost -c public |more
This command returns a list like this:
.1.3.6.1.2.1.1.1.0 = Linux aventailvpn 2.4.20_004 #1 SMP Thu Apr 10 14:35:50 PDT
2003 i686
.1.3.6.1.2.1.1.2.0 = OID: .1.3.6.1.4.1.2021.250.10
.1.3.6.1.2.1.1.3.0 = Timeticks: (1707979) 4:44:39.79
.1.3.6.1.2.1.1.4.0 = Root < [email protected]> (configure
/etc/snmp/snmp.local.conf)
.1.3.6.1.2.1.1.5.0 = aventailvpn
.1.3.6.1.2.1.1.6.0 = Unknown (configure /etc/snmp/snmp.local.conf)
.1.3.6.1.2.1.1.8.0 = Timeticks: (7) 0:00:00.07
.1.3.6.1.2.1.1.9.1.2.1 = OID: .1.3.6.1.2.1.31
..
To view a list containing all of the MIB names (which are helpful for use with the snmpget
command) type:
snmpwalk -O S localhost -c public |more
This command returns a list like the following:
SNMPv2-MIB::sysDescr.0 = Linux aventailvpn 2.4.20_004 #1 SMP Thu Apr 10 14:35:50
PDT 2003 i686
SNMPv2-MIB::sysObjectID.0 = OID : SNMPv2-SMI::enterprises.2021.250.10
SNMPv2-MIB::sysUpTime.0 = Timeticks: (1712451) 4:45:24.51
SNMPv2-MIB::sysContact.0 = Root (configure /etc/snmp/snmp.local.conf)
SNMPv2-MIB::sysName.0 = aventailvpn
SNMPv2-MIB::sysLocation.0 = Unknown (configure /etc/snmp/snmp.local.conf)
SNMPv2-MIB::sysORLastChange.0 = Timeticks: (7) 0:00:00.07
SNMPv2-MIB::sysORID.1 = OID: IF-MIB::ifMIB
..
Notes
z
For more information on the UCD MIB SNMP agent, see http://www.ece.ucdavis.edu/ucdsnmp/.
z
For more information on MIB II (including an explanation of the MIB II variable names), see
http://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc1213.txt.
SonicWALL MIB Data
The SonicWALL MIB modules reference object identifiers (OIDs) or text names that provide the
following information about the SonicWALL VPN:
MIB data
For more detailed information
System information
“MIB Data: System Information Module” on page 218
System health
“MIB Data: System Health Module” on page 219
Service health
“MIB Data: Service Health” on page 220
Security history
“MIB Data: Security History Module” on page 221
Network tunnel service
“MIB Data: Network Tunnel Service Module” on page 221
System traps
“MIB Data: Traps” on page 222
218
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
MIB data
For more detailed information
Other SNMP data
“MIB Data: Other SNMP Data” on page 223
MIB Data: System Information Module
The OIDs in the SonicWALL System Information module provide basic information about the
appliance.
Item
OID
Description
SonicWALL version
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.1.1.0
The version of SonicWALL Aventail firmware
running on this node in major.minor.microhotfix-build format (for example, 10.0-145).
Hardware model
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.1.2.0
The model number of the appliance (for
example, EX7000, EX6000, or EX-2500). New
model numbers may be added in the future.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
219
MIB Data: System Health Module
The OIDs in the SonicWALL System Health module provide information about the operational status
of the appliance.
Item
OID
Description
Currently logged in
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.1.1.0
The number of currently authenticated active
user sessions.
Maximum licensed
users
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.1.3.0
The maximum number of active user sessions
for which the appliance (or cluster of
appliances) is licensed.
Current connections
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.2.1.0
The number of concurrent connections
currently being serviced by the appliance (or
cluster of appliances).
CPU utilization
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.3.0
The percentage of the CPU (or sum of CPUs,
on a dual-processor machine) being used on
a single appliance node over a time span of
five seconds.
RAM utilization
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.4.1.0
The current virtual memory (RAM)
percentage in use.
Swap utilization
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.4.2.0
The current virtual memory (swap)
percentage in use.
Log utilization
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.9.0
The percentage of the log file disk partition
being used.
Item
OID
Description
Peak logged in
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.1.2.0
The maximum number of authenticated,
active user sessions since the last reset; the
reset interval is 24 hours.
Peak connections
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.2.2.0
The maximum number of concurrent
appliance connections since the last reset;
the reset interval is 24 hours.
Internal interface
current throughput
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.5.1.0
Over a time span of five seconds, the current
VPN throughput (inbound and outbound) in
megabits per second as measured on the
internal interface of the node.
Internal interface
peak throughput
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.5.2.0
The peak VPN internal interface throughput
(inbound and outbound) in megabits per
second since the last reset.
External interface
current throughput
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.5.3.0
Over a time span of five seconds, the current
VPN throughput (inbound and outbound) in
megabits per second as measured on the
external interface of the node.
External interface
peak throughput
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.5.4.0
The peak VPN external interface throughput
(inbound and outbound) in megabits per
second since the last reset.
220
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
Item
OID
Description
Cluster interface
current throughput
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.5.5.0
Over a time span of five seconds, the current
mean average VPN cluster interface
throughput (inbound and outbound) in
megabits per second. The reset interval is 24
hours.
Cluster interface
peak throughput
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.2.5.6.0
The peak VPN cluster interface throughput
(inbound and outbound) in megabits per
second since the last reset. The reset interval
is 24 hours.
MIB Data: Service Health
The OIDs in the SonicWALL Service Health module provide information about the status of each
service running on the appliance. For each service, the MIB provides a service ID, service
description, and a service state of up or down.
Item
OID
Description
Service ID
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.3.1.1.1.0
The service ID for the Aventail Management
Console (AMC) is 0.
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.3.1.1.1.2
The service ID for the SonicWALL Web proxy
service is 2.
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.3.1.1.1.3
The service ID for Aventail WorkPlace is 3.
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.3.1.1.1.4
The service ID for syslog-ng (the process that
writes out the SonicWALL appliance log files)
is 4
Service description
Service state
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.3.1.1.2.0
Aventail Management Console (AMC)
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.3.1.1.2.1
(Obsolete) Client /Server Access Service
(AVPN)
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.3.1.1.2.2
Secure Web access service (ExtraWeb). This
is also referred to as “Web proxy service.”
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.3.1.1.2.3
ASAP WorkPlace; this is the same as “Aventail
WorkPlace.”
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.3.1.1.2.4
Syslog-ng (the process that writes out the
SonicWALL appliance log files)
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.3.1.1.3.0
The current state of AMC: 1 (up) or 2 (down).
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.3.1.1.3.2
The current state of the Web proxy service: 1
(up) or 2 (down).
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.3.1.1.3.3
The current state of Aventail WorkPlace:
1 (up) or 2 (down).
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.3.1.1.3.4
The current state of syslog-ng:
1 (up) or 2 (down).
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
221
MIB Data: Security History Module
The OIDs in the SonicWALL Security History module provide information on login and access
denials.
Item
OID
Description
Number of login
denials
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.4.1.0
The number of login denials in the last 24
hours.
Last user denied
login
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.4.2.1.0
The last user who was denied authentication,
shown in the format [email protected]
Last denied login
time
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.4.2.2.0
The time and date when the last user was
denied authentication. The string is in the
form Wed Jun 30 21:49:08 2008, in the same
time zone for which the appliance is
configured.
Number of access
denials
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.4.3.0
The number of access denials in the last 24
hours.
Last user denied
access
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.4.4.1.0
The last user who was denied access, shown
in the format [email protected]
Last resource access
denied
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.4.4.2.0
The URL, host:port or host of the last
resource to which access was denied.
Last access denied
time
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.4.4.3.0
The time and date when the last user was
denied access. The string is in the form Wed
Jun 30 21:49:08 2008, in the same time zone
for which the appliance is configured.
MIB Data: Network Tunnel Service Module
The OIDs in the SonicWALL NG Server module provide information status of the network tunnel
service.
Item
OID
Description
NG server state
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.1.0
The current state of the network tunnel
service: Active, Down, or Crashed.
Number of client
address pools
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.2.0
The number of client address pools assigned
to the network tunnel service.
Client address pool
range table
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.3
A table showing how many IP address pools
are currently active and their IP address
ranges.
Client address pool
entry
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.3.1
The number of currently active IP address
pools.
Client address pool
ID
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.3.1.1.0
An ID number assigned to an IP address pool.
Client address pool
utilization
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.3.1.2.0
Percentage of virtual IP addresses (VIPs) that
are issued from a client address pool.
Client IP address
pool start range
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.3.1.3.0
The starting IP address of a client IP address
pool range
Client address pool
end range
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.3.1.4.0
The ending IP address of a client IP address
pool range.
Number of NG SLL
tunnels
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.4.0
Total number of active network tunnels.
222
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
Item
OID
Description
SSL tunnel table
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.5
A table showing network tunnel statistics.
SSL tunnel ID
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.5.1.1.0
An ID number assigned to a network tunnel
session.
SSL tunnel user
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.5.1.2.0
The user name associated with a network
tunnel session.
SSL tunnel VIP
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.5.1.3.0
The virtual IP address (VIP) associated with a
network tunnel session.
Number of flows per
tunnel
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.5.1.4.0
The number of data flows in a network tunnel
session.
SSL Tunnel Uptime
1.3.6.1.4.1.4331.5.5.1.5.0
Uptime statistics for a network tunnel
session.
MIB Data: Traps
A trap is a message the SNMP agent sends to indicate that a significant event has occurred that
needs an administrator’s attention. To download the Aventail MIBs, click Services in the main
navigation menu, and then click Configure in the SNMP area. Click Download Aventail MIB to
save a copy of the file (aventailCustomMibs.tar).
Item
MIB filename
Description
ngServerStateChange
aventailNGServer
The server core functionality depends on user
space processes (avssld and avpsd) and two
avevent kernel threads. The SNMP agent
monitors these processes and when any of
these go down this trap is triggered. The trap
description specifies the component; for
example, avssld(0).
ngclientAddrPoolUtilizatio aventailNGServer
nWarning
This trap is triggered when the use of the
client address pool exceeds the threshold.
asapServiceUp
aventailServiceHealth
A service on a single node system, identified
by the IP address from which the trap is sent,
is up. The serviceDescription OID is sent
along with the trap.
asapServiceDown
aventailServiceHealth
A service on a single node system, identified
by the IP address from which the trap is sent,
has gone down. The serviceDescription OID is
sent along with the trap.
cpuCapacityWarning
aventailSystemHealth
The heuristically determined percentage of
CPU capacity used on a single node system
has exceeded the capacity for a single node
(cpuCapacityUtilization).
memoryCapacityWarning
aventailSystemHealth
The heuristically determined percentage of
memory capacity used on a single node
system has exceeded 90 percent of capacity
(memoryCapacityUtilization).
logCapacityWarning
aventailSystemHealth
The percentage of log file disk space used on
a single node system has exceeded 90
percent of the total capacity.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
223
Item
MIB filename
Description
userLimitWarning
aventailSystemHealth
Notification is generated if the concurrent
number of authenticated users on a single
node system (currentlyLoggedIn) has
reached 90 percent of the license capacity
limit.
userLimitReached
aventailSystemHealth
The number of currently authenticated, active
user sessions on a single node system
(currentlyLoggedIn) has reached the current
license capacity limit.
userLimitExceeded
aventailSystemHealth
The number of concurrent, authenticated
users on a single node system has reached
the current license capacity limit
(currentlyLoggedIn), plus grace count, for
authorized users.
asapSystemUp
aventailSystemInfo
For a single appliance (not in an HA pair): the
appliance from which the notification is sent
(identified by IP address) is back online.
asapSystemDown
aventailSystemInfo
For a single appliance (not in an HA pair): the
appliance from which the notification is sent
(identified by IP address) is going offline.
MIB Data: Other SNMP Data
Here is some other information about the appliance that you can retrieve from the standard MIB
file using SNMP.
Item
OID
Description
Service status table
1.3.6.1.4.1.2021.2
Checks the status of any of the following
services. The return data references the
following process names. If a process status is
listed as “not running”, an error is flagged.
z
apache2 (Web proxy service)
z
logserver (log server)
z
syslog-ng (syslog)
z
policyserver (policy server)
In appliance version 8.9.0 and later, srvcmond
(cluster manager) is replaced with a service
named AVFM (Aventail Flow Manager). AVFM
does not appear in a process list on the appliance
because it is run as a kernel module.
Disk space
availability table
1.3.6.1.4.1.2021.9
Checks disk space availability for the following
partitions: “/”, “/var/log”, and “/upgrade”. If the
disk space on a partition drops below 10MB, an
error is flagged.
Load average
checks table
1.3.6.1.4.1.2021.10
Checks the load average for intervals of one, five,
or 15 minutes. An error is flagged if the load
average is greater than 12 at the one-minute
interval, or greater than 14 for the five- and 15minute intervals.
Software version
number table
1.3.6.1.4.1.2021.50
Checks the current version of the SonicWALL
system software.
System name
1.3.6.1.2.1.1.1.0
Checks the name of the system.
224
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
Managing Configuration Data
The configuration data for your appliance is stored in a single export archive (.aea) file that includes
the following types of configuration data:
Type of configuration data
Description
Access policy
Rules, resources, users and groups, Aventail
WorkPlace shortcuts, and EPC signatures and
zones.
Certificates
Certificates, private keys, and certificate
passwords.
Aventail WorkPlace customization
General appearance settings, custom content, and
custom templates.
Node-specific and network-specific settings
Host names, IP addresses, default route
information, DNS settings, and cluster settings.
It’s a good practice to back up the configuration data on your appliance, especially if you are
working on system changes and may need to revert to an earlier configuration. For example, if you
plan to add new access control rules, first save your configuration, and then make your changes:
you can then revert to the saved (working) configuration if the new rules don’t work as expected.
There are several options for saving and restoring configuration data:
z
Export configuration data to a local machine, and later import it. Exporting involves the
complete set of configuration data, but it is possible to do just a partial import. See “Exporting
the Current Configuration to a Local Machine” on page 224 and “Importing Configuration Data”
on page 226 for more information.
z
Save and restore configuration data files on the appliance. This involves the complete set of
configuration data: you cannot save or restore a partial configuration. For more information,
see “Saving the Current Configuration on the Appliance” on page 225 and “Restoring or
Exporting Configuration Data Stored on the Appliance” on page 226.
z
Distribute configuration data to a group of appliances. Before the configuration on one appliance
is pushed to another one, the configuration data on the receiving appliance is automatically
saved. For more information, see “Replicating Configuration Data” on page 227.
z
You can export the policy from an older SonicWALL appliance and import it to a newer one,
provided the older appliance predates the newer one by no more than three versions. For
example, if you own a version 9.0.0 appliance and you deploy a new appliance, you can import
the policy configuration from your v9.0.0 appliance to the new one. See “Updating the System”
on page 234 for a description of the version number conventions that SonicWALL uses.
!
CAUTION Only configuration data that was generated by AMC is saved or exported. If you
have made manual edits (by editing the SonicWALL files on your appliance directly), these
changes are not included. Manual changes are rare and usually done with the help of
SonicWALL Technical Support.
Exporting the Current Configuration to a Local Machine
You can export your complete set of appliance configuration data to a local machine (you cannot
export a partial configuration). Only saved changes are included; changes that are pending when
you export a configuration are discarded.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
225
To export the current configuration
1. From the main navigation menu, click Maintenance.
2. In the System configuration area, click Import/Export.
3. Click Export. The Export Configuration page appears, and a File Download dialog box
prompts you to open the AventailSSLVPN-<date>-<nnn>.aea file or save it to your hard
drive.
4. Click Save, browse to the correct directory, and then save the .aea file.
5. Click OK on the Export page.
Saving the Current Configuration on the Appliance
In contrast to exporting, saving configuration data stores it on your appliance (up to 20 saved
configurations can be stored). You cannot save a partial configuration, and only changes that have
been applied are included.
X
To save configuration data on the appliance
1. From the main navigation menu, click Maintenance.
2. In the System configuration area, click Import/Export.
3. Click New in the Saved Configurations list.
4. Describe this configuration in the Description box and (if there are multiple administrators) it
is a good practice to identify who is saving it. For example, an entry might read as follows:
Saved by MIS before adding access control rules for mobile devices.
5. Click Save. The current configuration data is stored on the appliance and added to the Saved
Configurations list.
If your appliance is set up to receive configuration data from another appliance, its configuration
data is automatically saved before replication occurs. For more information, see “Replicating
Configuration Data” on page 227.
226
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
Importing Configuration Data
Exporting always involves the complete set of configuration data, but it is possible to do just a
partial import (for example, if you want to import only policy and WorkPlace settings).
The following table describes the types of data that you can import into an existing AMC
configuration:
Type of configuration data
Partial configuration
Entire configuration
X
Description
z
Access policy: Includes rules, resources, users and
groups, and EPC device profiles and zones.
z
Aventail WorkPlace customization: Includes general
appearance settings, custom content, shortcuts, and
custom templates.
z
CA certificates: Includes the CA certificates that are used
to secure authentication server connections, or back-end
Web resources, with SSL.
z
End Point Control: If you use client certificates in device
profiles, a partial configuration includes the CA that issued
them to your users.
z
Partial configuration data (see above).
z
SSL certificates: Includes certificates for AMC and the
appliance, along with private keys and passwords.
z
Node-specific and network-specific settings: Includes
host names, IP addresses, default route information, DNS
settings, administrator accounts, and cluster settings.
To import a full or partial configuration
1. From the main navigation menu, click Maintenance.
2. In the System configuration area, click Import/Export.
3. In the File name box, type the path of the appropriate file (AventailSSLVPN-<date><nnn>.aea), or click Browse to locate it.
4. Click Partial configuration if you want to import just the items listed in the table above.
5. Click Import. To activate the imported configuration, you must apply changes. See “Applying
Configuration Changes” on page 52 for more information.
Notes
z
If an import fails, you can view details in the Management message log file.
z
If you import a configuration while other configuration changes are pending in AMC, the pending
changes are overwritten.
z
You can import the policy from an older SonicWALL appliance, provided the older appliance
predates the newer one by no more than three versions. For example, you can import the policy
configuration from your v9.0.0 to your v10.0.1 appliance.
z
You cannot import a configuration from a single node onto a high-availability cluster, or from a
cluster configuration onto a single node.
Restoring or Exporting Configuration Data Stored on the Appliance
Follow these steps to restore a configuration file that is stored on the appliance. (To specify
configuration data that is stored on a local machine instead of the appliance, use the import feature.
See “Importing Configuration Data” on page 226 for more information.) Only a full configuration
data file can be restored: you cannot restore a partial configuration.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
227
To restore or export configuration data stored on the appliance
1. From the main navigation menu, click Maintenance.
2. In the System configuration area, click Import/Export.
3. Select a configuration from the Saved Configurations list.
4. Restore the configuration or export it to a local machine:
{
Click Restore. Restoration of the selected configuration begins immediately. After the
restore is complete, click Pending changes to apply the new configuration. The restored
configuration remains in the list.
{
Click Export to save a copy of the configuration to a local machine.
Replicating Configuration Data
Replication is the process of distributing configuration data to a group of appliances in order to keep
their settings matched up. When replication occurs, the sending appliance distributes configuration
data to the members of a “collection.” For example, you might have appliances behind an external
load-balancer supporting thousands of users, or appliances in different locations that must share
configurations. This is not a merging of data: some of the settings on the receiving appliances are
overwritten (security policy and CA certificates, for example), and others are not (network
settings). See “What Settings Are Replicated?” on page 228 for a list of what’s included in replicated
configuration data.
When you define a collection of appliances that will share settings, the nodes in the collection
communicate over the internal interface using SSL. Replication can be initiated from any system
that knows the shared secret for a collection—there is always one sending appliance and one or
more recipients, but any receiving appliance that knows the shared secret can become a sender.
This is in contrast to the synchronization that occurs in a high-availability cluster of SonicWALL
appliances, in which one node is designated the master; for more information, see “Overview: HighAvailability Cluster” on page 395.
Requirements for Replication
In order for the nodes in a collection of SonicWALL appliances to share configuration data, certain
requirements must be met, and some configuration elements have to match. The sending node, for
example, must have the same number of WorkPlace sites as the receiving nodes, and the same
WorkPlace site names must be used on all appliances.
Configuration element
Description
System software version
All nodes in the collection must be running the same version of the
system software: the major and minor release numbers (the first
two numbers) must match. The version number is displayed in the
bottom-left of the AMC screen.
Administrator role
Only a primary administrator can initiate replication and distribute
configuration data to other appliances. See “Managing Administrator
Accounts and Roles” on page 46 for a description of administrator
roles.
WorkPlace sites
The sending node must have the same number of WorkPlace sites as
the receiving nodes, and the appliances must share the same
WorkPlace site names. Most of the WorkPlace settings on the
receiving appliances are overwritten (for example, the realm and
description), but the fully qualified domain name settings, SSL
certificate, and any customized templates you’ve created are
preserved. To view site settings, click Aventail WorkPlace in the
main navigation menu.
228
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
Configuration element
Description
Authentication server
settings
On the sending node, you can choose whether to overwrite or retain
the authentication server settings on the receiving nodes:
z
Choose to overwrite if a single directory server is used for all
appliance users. This forces all of the nodes in the collection to
share the same settings.
z
Choose to preserve the authentication settings on each receiving
node if you want to ensure that its authentication server settings
are not overwritten.
Note: Authentication using a digital certificate is the exception—if
the sending node has a PKI authentication server configured, trusted
CA certificates cannot be retained on the other nodes in the
collection.
IP address pools
The sending node must have the same number of IP address pools
as the receiving nodes, and each pool on the sending node must
have a pool with a matching Name on the receiving nodes. The data
within those pools, however, is preserved during replication: the
sending node does not overwrite IP address pool data on the
receiving nodes. Address pools are configured on the Configure
Network Tunnel Service page in AMC (click Services in the main
navigation menu).
Collection size
There can be no more than ten nodes in a group of SonicWALL
appliances that share configuration data through replication. (A pair
of appliances in a high-availability cluster is treated as one node.)
What Settings Are Replicated?
Most configuration data on the destination (“receiving”) nodes is overwritten by the settings on the
sending node during replication. Here’s a summary of the items that are included and excluded
when configuration data is replicated. For the receiving appliance, replication is very similar to doing
a partial import of another appliance’s configuration; see “Importing Configuration Data” on
page 226 for more information.
Included in Replicated Configuration Data
z
Security policy, including access control rules and EPC configuration
z
Network resources
z
Users and groups
z
Realms
z
Authentication servers (the authentication server names should match those on the sending
node, even if the IP addresses do not).
When you define a collection of appliances, you have the option of either overwriting
authentication server settings (which would be typical in a deployment where there is a
shared, central server), or excluding server settings from being overwritten during replication.
See “Defining a Collection—Advanced Settings” on page 231 for more information.
z
WorkPlace shortcuts
z
CA certificates
z
Certificate revocation lists downloaded from a remote CDP (CRL distribution point)
z
Agent configuration, including graphical terminal agents (Citrix and Windows Terminal Server)
and Web browser profiles
z
Local user accounts
z
Single sign-on profiles
Not Included in Replicated Configuration Data
z
Network settings, including IP addresses, routing information, name resolution settings (DNS
and WINS), and the settings for the network services (NTP, SSH and SNMP)
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
229
z
If you have configured fallback servers for your Connect Tunnel users, each appliance has a
unique list that is not replicated on the other servers
z
License files
z
SSL certificates
z
WorkPlace configuration data (customized templates)
z
Administrator user accounts and role definitions
z
(Optional) You can exclude authentication server settings from being overwritten during
replication, which is typical for a deployment where each appliance has its own authentication
server. See “Defining a Collection—Advanced Settings” on page 231 for more information.
Getting Started
Before configuration data can be sent to other appliances, you must ensure that the receiving
appliances have certain settings in common with the sender. Some of the settings on the receiving
appliances will be overwritten during replication (security policy and CA certificates, for example),
and others will not (such as network settings). One way to ensure that replication will be successful
is to take the configuration data from the sending appliance and do a partial import of it to each of
the receiving appliances. This may be unnecessary in cases where appliances are already sharing
enough configuration data, but it’s an easy way to ensure that the receiver's configuration is
compatible with the sender's.
Once you have ensured that the appliances share certain settings, define the members of the
collection and make sure that replication is enabled on each one.
X
Preparing a group of appliances to share configuration data
1. Identify the sending appliance and up to ten receiving appliances. A pair of appliances in a
high-availability cluster is treated as one node.
2. On the sending appliance, apply any pending changes and then export a copy of the
appliance’s configuration data (.aea) and save it locally (for instructions on doing this, see
“Exporting the Current Configuration to a Local Machine” on page 224).
3. On each appliance that will receive configuration data, export a copy of the appliance’s
configuration data and save it locally as a backup.
4. On each receiving appliance, do a partial import of the sender's configuration data (for
instructions on how to do this, see “Importing Configuration Data” on page 226).
5. Save and apply the changes on the receiving appliances. All of your appliances now share
enough configuration data for replication to succeed.
X
Enable replication on all of the appliances
1. Enable replication on each of the receiving appliances using a shared secret:
a. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Maintenance, and then click the Configure
button under Replicate.
b. Select Enable replication, and then click Receive configuration data.
c. Enter and confirm the Shared secret. The secret must be known by each member of the
collection that will send or receive configuration data.
d. Click Save, and then apply your changes.
2. Enable replication on the sender.
3. On the sending appliance, define the members of the collection and test your connections to
them (connect to the AMC of each of the destination nodes by clicking its name on the
Configure Replication page). See “Defining a Collection of Appliances to Receive
Configuration Data” on page 230 for step-by-step instructions.
4. Click Save, and then apply your changes.
230
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
Defining a Collection of Appliances to Receive Configuration Data
To define a collection of appliances that will have configuration data in common, the primary
administrator logs into the node that will “push” configuration data to other appliances and specifies
a name and the IP address for each receiving node in the collection. If you have a pair of appliances
in a high-availability cluster that will be configured to receive configuration data, it is treated as one
node.
X
To define a collection of nodes to share configuration
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Maintenance, and then click the Configure
button under Replicate.
2. Select Enable replication, and then click Send configuration data.
3. Enter and confirm a Shared secret. In order to send or receive configuration data, each
member of the collection must know the shared secret.
4. To define each member of the collection, click New and enter a Name and Host or IP
address. For a high-availability pair of appliances, use the Host or IP address of the master
node.
5. Use the Test connection link to verify that each member is properly configured. In order for
policy replication to succeed, the following must be true:
{
The destination (receiving) node must be accessible from the source node.
{
The shared secret must be entered correctly.
{
Every node must be running the same version of the SonicWALL software.
To cancel the connection test (for example, if you realize that you entered the wrong IP
address for an appliance you want to update with settings), click Cancel or click the Test
connection link again.
6. Click Save, and then apply your changes.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
231
Defining a Collection—Advanced Settings
By default, most of the configuration data on the destination nodes is overwritten during replication
(see “What Settings Are Replicated?” on page 228 for a list of the settings that are excluded). But
in the case of authentication settings you have a choice: you can overwrite or retain the
authentication server settings on the destination nodes.
X
To configure authentication server settings for replication
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Maintenance, and then click the Configure
button under Replicate.
2. Make sure Enable replication and Send configuration data are selected.
3. In the Advanced area, specify whether authentication server settings on the destination
nodes should be overwritten or retained.
!
{
Click Nodes in the collection share centralized authentication servers to force all of
the nodes in the collection to share the same settings. You would use this setting if, for
example, you maintain a single Active Directory server for all employees, regardless of
branch office location.
{
Click Each node has its own authentication server to preserve the authentication
settings on each destination node. The Chicago and London offices for a company, for
example, might maintain their own directory servers; select this option so that the sending
node does not overwrite authentication server settings on the receiving nodes.
For replication to succeed, deployments that have separate authentication servers must still
have authentication servers of the same name on both appliances. In order to replicate the
usage of authentication servers without replicating their actual authentication information, for
every authentication server on the sender there must be a same-named authentication server
counterpart on the recipient.
4. Click Save.
Notes
z
You can specify (in the Advanced area) whether authentication server settings on the
destination nodes should be overwritten or retained, except in the case of authentication using
a digital certificate. If the sending node has a PKI authentication server configured, trusted CA
certificates cannot be retained on the other nodes in the collection.
Beginning Replication
To distribute configuration data to other appliances, the primary administrator logs into the node
that will “push” configuration data. Configuration changes on the sending appliance must be applied
before replication can begin.
X
To begin replication
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Maintenance, and then click Replicate.
232
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
2. The Replicate Configuration page lists the appliances configured to receive configuration
data from this appliance, along with an indication (in the Status column) of when the last
replication occurred. Select the check box next to each appliance that should receive settings
(the pair of appliances in a high-availability cluster is treated as one node).
3. Click Replicate.
{
To stop replication, click Cancel before the status message indicates that the
configuration is being applied.
{
If replication fails, you can open the management log for the appliance in question by
clicking its View log link.
{
There is no need to apply changes on the destination nodes after replication is done—it is
done automatically, as part of the replication process.
Notes
z
On the appliances receiving configuration data, a backup of the appliance’s configuration data
(prior to replication) is automatically created. On the receiving node, you can go to the
Import/Export page in AMC and see the date and time of the replication, along with the name
of the sending appliance. If you need to restore saved configuration data, follow the steps
described in “Restoring or Exporting Configuration Data Stored on the Appliance” on page 226.
Replication Status Messages
During replication the changing status of each node in the collection is displayed on the Replicate
Configuration page. The rate at which replication progresses will differ among the appliances,
depending on factors such as network latency. The sending appliance might, for example, be
starting replication on one appliance, and already validating it on another.
The following table shows the status messages in roughly the same order they appear during
replication.
Status message
Description
Contacting appliance
The sending appliances contacts each node in the collection to
determine whether it is accessible.
Starting replication
The sending appliance verifies the shared secret and whether its
system software version is compatible with that of the receiving
appliances: the major and minor release numbers—the first two
numbers—must match.
Comparing configurations
The configuration changes being sent are compared with the
settings on each destination node.
Validating configuration
The appliance determines that each destination node is able to
apply the changes. Some configuration elements (for example, the
number of WorkPlace sites and their names) must match in order
for replication to proceed. See “Requirements for Replication” on
page 227 for a complete list.
Applying configuration
The configuration data on each receiving appliance is automatically
backed up and stored on the destination node, and then the new
configuration is applied.
Canceling replication
Replication can be canceled at any time before the new
configuration data is applied.
Replication finished
Indicates the replication was successful.
Replication failed
Indicates the replication failed.
Replication canceled
The replication was successfully canceled.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
233
Notes
z
Replication can fail on one node but continue on all of the others; in other words, the nodes in
the collection are validated and changes are applied independent of what happens on the other
destination nodes.
z
The replication process can be canceled up until the configuration data is applied (before the
message in the Status column reads “Applying configuration...”).
Viewing Configuration Data Recipients
In order to receive configuration data, an appliance must first be added as a member of a collection
by the “sending” appliance, as described in “Defining a Collection of Appliances to Receive
Configuration Data” on page 230. Regardless of whether the appliance is configured to send or
receive configuration data, you can always see a list of the other collection members.
X
To view collection members on an appliance set up to receive configuration data
On any page in AMC, click the Configuration recipient link in the top, right-hand corner. The
appliances in the collection are listed on the Configure Replication page.
X
To view collection members on an appliance set up to send configuration data
From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Maintenance, and then click the Configure
button in the Replicate area.
Notes
z
If there is a high-availability cluster of appliances in the collection, it is treated as one node and
referred to by a single name.
Upgrading, Rolling Back, or Resetting the System
SonicWALL periodically offers software updates that add new functionality or address existing
issues. An update is delivered as a compressed .bin file and can be in the form of a hotfix or an
upgrade:
z
A hotfix addresses issues with a particular version of the appliance software and typically
contains only the files that have changed from the original version.
234
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
z
An upgrade is a new version of the software (the version number on the appliance is
incremented).
Installing either kind of update, or rolling back to a previous version, can be done using AMC.
To view the current version of the system, click System Status or Maintenance from the main
navigation menu. If any hotfixes have been applied, you can view the list by clicking the hotfixes
link.
z
Updating the System
You can find system updates (hotfixes and upgrades) on the MySonicWALL Web site. To access
www.mysonicwall.com, you must first create an account, which is described in “Creating a
MySonicWALL Account” on page 246. Once you have an account, new system updates and
documentation are available in the Download Center on the Web site.
Naming Conventions for Upgrades
SonicWALL uses the following syntax to describe version numbers for upgrade files:
upgrade_<major>_<minor>_<micro>_<build>.bin
The version number for AMC (displayed in the bottom-left corner of every AMC page) and client
software follows a similar pattern:
<major>_<minor>_<micro>-<build>
Name
Description
major
The major release number. If this is the only number that is present, it indicates
that this release contains significant new features plus fixes. It also indicates that it
contains a full image of the entire system.
minor
The minor release number. If the version number contains only the major and minor
numbers, it indicates that this release contains incremental features plus fixes. It
also indicates that it contains a full image of the entire system.
micro
The micro release number. If the version number contains only the major, minor,
and micro numbers, it indicates that this release contains a small number of
features plus fixes. It also indicates that it contains a full image of the entire system.
build
An internal build number used by SonicWALL. All releases contain a build number.
Major
Minor
Micro
Build
upgrade_9_0_0_111.bin
Examples
z
upgrade_8_0_0_23.bin upgrades your appliance to an 8.0.0 major release (build 23).
z
upgrade_8_7_0_13.bin upgrades your appliance to an 8.7.0 minor release (build 13).
z
upgrade_9_0_1_006.bin upgrades your appliance to the 9.0.1 micro release (build 6).
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
235
Notes
z
You don’t need to download the release notes; they are included in the upgrade file and are
expanded to an /upgrade directory when you install the upgrade.
z
To find out if any hotfixes have been applied, click System Status or Maintenance from the
main navigation menu, and then click hotfixes next to the version number.
Naming Conventions for Hotfixes
Between releases SonicWALL may issue a hotfix that replaces a subset of the SonicWALL software
files on your appliance. Hotfix filenames use the following naming convention:
<component>-hotfix-<version>-<hotfix number>.gz
For example, admin-hotfix-9_0_x-001.gz is hotfix 001 for version 9.0.0 and later that fixes a
problem in Aventail Management Console. The <component> is one of the following:
Component
Description
admin
Aventail Management Console
clt
Client software
evpn
Tunnel service (Connect Tunnel, Connect Mobile, Connect Tunnel Services)
ew
Translated, Custom port mapped, Custom FQDN mapped Web access
(“extraweb”)
pform
Platform/operating system
ps
Policy server (access control)
wp
Aventail WorkPlace
Notes
z
To check whether any hotfixes have been applied, click System Status or Maintenance from
the main navigation menu. If any hotfixes have been incorporated, you’ll see a hotfixes link
next to the version number. Click the link for more information about which ones have been
applied.
Installing System Updates
You can use AMC to install version upgrades and hotfixes. For information on updating the software
on a cluster, see “Upgrading a Cluster” on page 403.
236
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
X
To download and install a system upgrade or hotfix
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Maintenance.
2. In the System software updates area, click Update.
3. If you have not already downloaded the upgrade or hotfix file, click the Web site link (login
required) and download the appropriate file from www.mysonicwall.com to your local file
system.
4. Type the path of the file, or click Browse to locate it.
5. Click Install Update. A file upload status indicator appears. If necessary, you can click
Cancel to stop the upload process.
After the file upload process is complete, the update is automatically installed on the
appliance. You cannot cancel the installation process. After the installation process is
complete, the appliance automatically restarts.
6. After the appliance restarts, log in to AMC and verify the new version number in the bottomleft corner of the AMC home page.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
237
Notes
z
If you see an error message indicating that a upgrade file is invalid or corrupt, follow the steps
in “Verify a Downloaded Upgrade File” on page 417 to see if the checksum for the file is correct.
Rolling Back to a Previous Version
From AMC, you can undo the most recent update installed on the system. If you experience
problems after installing an upgrade or hotfix, you may want to use this feature to roll back to a
known state. Each time you roll back, the most recent update is removed.
!
X
CAUTION If you have made any configuration changes since you updated the appliance they
will be lost if you restore a previous version of the system software. When you remove a hotfix,
on the other hand, your configuration changes are preserved.
To roll back to a previous version
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Maintenance.
2. In the System configuration area, click Rollback.
3. To roll back to the version displayed on the Rollback page, click OK. After the rollback
process is complete, the appliance automatically restarts and applies the changes.
4. After the appliance restarts, verify the new version number in the bottom-left corner of the
AMC home page.
Resetting the Appliance
From AMC, you can reset your appliance using one of three reset levels. The mildest level erases
your configuration information, log files, and the current firmware, but leaves you the option to roll
back to a previous version, if one is loaded.
The second level removes all configuration, log files, and firmware from the appliance. With this
option, you cannot roll back to a previous version.
The third level also removes all configuration, log files, and firmware from the appliance, and then
securely erases the hard drive, which can take up to 45 minutes. If you select this option, you
cannot roll back to a previous version.
There are a couple of scenarios in which a reset may be appropriate:
z
You want to completely clean the machine and reuse it elsewhere.
z
The appliance is in an unrecoverable state. In this case, you should contact SonicWALL Technical
Support and confirm that there is no other solution to your problem. A reset should be used
only as a last resort to restore the appliance to a working condition.
To configure the appliance after it has been reset, you will need to use the LCD panel or serial
console.
X
To reset the appliance
1. Back up the configuration data on the appliance. You can do this in AMC (see “Exporting the
Current Configuration to a Local Machine” on page 224), or by using Backup Tool (see “Saving
Configuration Data” on page 409).
2. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Maintenance.
3. Near the top of the page, click Reset.
4. On the Maintenance > Reset page, select one of the following three radio buttons under Reset
Options:
{
Reset the current configuration – This option erases your current configuration. If you
upgraded from a previous version, selecting this option retains the ability to roll back.
{
Reset the entire appliance – This option erases your configuration and deletes all
firmware versions on the appliance. If you select this option, you cannot roll back to a
previous version.
238
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
{
Securely erase the hard drive and reset the entire appliance – This option erases
your configuration, deletes all firmware versions, and securely erases the hard drive. If
you select this option, you cannot roll back to a previous version.
Note: Securely erasing the hard drive can take up to 45 minutes.
5. At the bottom of the page, click Reset to proceed with the reset. To cancel the reset, click
Cancel.
SSL Encryption
Encryption is used to ensure data security for all traffic on the appliance. The appliance encrypts all
data using SSL. You must configure at least one cipher to be used with SSL to secure your network
traffic. Select the “best” cipher from the available set, balancing security and performance tradeoffs (security is weighted much more heavily than performance).
SSL provides some degree of protection from downgrade attacks, but in general you should
configure your servers to permit only those ciphers that you consider strong enough for your needs.
The cipher order, from most to least preferred, is:
z
256-bit AES, with SHA-1
z
128-bit AES, with SHA-1
z
128-bit RC4, with MD5
z
128-bit RC4, with SHA-1
z
Triple DES, with SHA-1
Configuring SSL Encryption
The appliance uses SSL encryption and other cryptographic algorithms—or ciphers—to secure data
transfer. When configuring the encryption settings for the appliance, you must enable at least one
cipher to be used in conjunction with SSL to secure your network traffic. The default settings are
typically sufficient for most deployments.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
239
To configure SSL encryption settings
1. From the main navigation menu, click SSL Settings, and then click the Edit link in the SSL
Encryption area. The Configure SSL Encryption page appears.
2. Select the transport protocols used to encrypt traffic:
{
Select the Use only US government-recommended encryption check box to enable
FIPS 140-2 compliant encryption. This configures the appliance to use only the TLS
protocol and enables only FIPS-compliant ciphers.
{
Select Use TLS protocol only to configure the appliance to use only the TLS transport
protocol.
{
Select Use TLS and SSL v3 to configure the appliance to use both the SSL v3 and TLS
transport protocols.
3. Select the ciphers that the access services (Web proxy, network proxy, and network tunnel)
on the appliance will accept for SSL connections.
4. In the SSL handshake timeout box, type the number of seconds that an SSL handshake can
last before timing out. The default is 300.
5. Click Save.
240
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
FIPS Certification
This section describes configuring your SonicWALL appliance to use FIPS mode.
FIPS (Federal Information Processing Standard) 140-2 Level 2 is a validation standard for
evaluating cryptographic modules, and includes stringent reviews of source code, algorithms,
physical security, and operational testing on cryptographic security products. The United States
Federal Government is required to purchase cryptographic products validated to the FIPS 140-2
standard. In the international marketplace, ISO19790 is being adopted as a standard and is a direct
adaptation of FIPS 140-2.
The SonicWALL E-Class SRA EX7000 and EX6000 appliances have FIPS 140-2 Level 2 certification
from NIST (the National Institute of Standards and Technology, the United States FIPS 140-2
Cryptographic Module Validation Authority) and CSE (the Communications Security Establishment,
the Canadian FIPS 140-2 Cryptographic Module Authority).
FIPS mode is transparent to end users. Internally, FIPS mode enforces secure communication and
system integrity.
Requirements for FIPS
The following items are required to properly configure FIPS for full compliance:
z
A 6000 or 7000 appliance. No other appliances are FIPS-certified. CAUTION: If you have
purchased a SonicWALL E-Class SRA EX7000 or EX6000 appliance with 140-2 Level 2 FIPS
certification, the tamper-evident sticker affixed to it must remain in place.
z
A license to run FIPS
z
A secure connection to your authentication server
z
A strong administrator password, which should be at least 14 characters long and contain
punctuation characters, numbers, and a combination of uppercase and lowercase letters. In
addition, you must specify an authentication server when you set up a realm; "null auth" is not
allowed.
The following states prevent FIPS from being activated, or from reaching full compliance:
z
Unsecured connections with authentication servers
z
Use of RADIUS authentication servers
z
Use of LDAP authentication servers without using SSL connections employing only FIPS
approved ciphers
z
Use of Active Directory single domain authentication servers without using SSL connections
employing only FIPS approved ciphers
z
Use of RSA ClearTrust authentication servers without using SSL connections employing only
FIPS approved ciphers
z
Use of RSA Authentication Manager authentication servers without strong passwords as shared
secrets
z
Use of USB devices for any purpose
z
Use of clustering (High Availability)
Clustering (HA) is not supported in FIPS mode.
z
Use of SonicWALL GMS or Viewpoint servers
z
Loading or unloading of any kernel modules via the shell command line
z
Installation of third party software via the shell command line
z
Firmware upgrades via the shell command line
z
Use of Debug 1, Debug 2, Debug 3 or plaintext logging
z
Use of certificates with private/public key-pairs generated by a non-FIPS-compliant system
z
Use of the zeroization procedure without the primary administrator being physically present
until the procedure completes
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
241
FIPS mode is not automatically enabled after you import your license. You must set it up as
described in “Enabling FIPS” on page 241.
Managing FIPS-Compliant Certificates
Any keys generated on an EX7000 or EX6000 appliance running in FIPS mode will be FIPS
compliant. If you import certificates (and their associated public and private keys) to the appliance,
it is your responsibility to make sure that they are also FIPS compliant. Certificates must be
exported and then reimported when you switch FIPS mode on or off. For the export and import
procedure, see “Exporting and Importing FIPS-Compliant Certificates” on page 242.
The best way to ensure that the certificates you’re using are FIPS compliant is to generate all CSRs
(certificate signing requests) on a FIPS-enabled appliance.
FIPS Violations
Your appliance validates its integrity several ways:
z
A self test is performed at each power-on cycle to verify all FIPS approved cryptographic
algorithms are functioning properly. If any of the self tests fail, the Alarm LED on the front
panel will remain lit, a message detailing the specific failure will be displayed on the serial
console and logged in /var/log/aventail/fips.log, and the appliance will be halted. You should
power-cycle the appliance once to see if it recovers. If it does not, you will need to contact
SonicWALL customer support for further instructions.
z
A continuous self test is performed on the random number generator and on the generation of
new Certificate keys to verify the integrity of cryptographic operations. If any of these self tests
fail, a message detailing the specific failure will be displayed on the serial console and logged
in /var/log/aventail/fips.log, and the appliance will be immediately power-cycled via a reboot in
order to perform the rigorous self-tests for system integrity.
z
All critical security binaries are signed and hashed. Alterations to any of these binaries will be
detected at each reboot and immediately on a running system. If this occurs during the powercycle self tests, the Alarm LED on the front panel will remain lit, a message detailing the
specific tampering will be displayed on the serial console and logged in
/var/log/aventail/fips.log, the system will be halted and you will need to contact SonicWALL
customer support for further instructions. If this tampering is detected on a running system,
the appliance will be immediately power-cycled via a reboot in order to perform the rigorous
self-tests for system integrity.
z
All critical security configuration files are signed and hashed. Manual alterations (as opposed to
alterations made using the AMC) to any of the configuration files will cause the appliance to
immediately transition into an error state. If this tampering is detected on a running system,
the appliance will be immediately power-cycled via a reboot in order to perform the rigorous
self-tests for system integrity. Otherwise, if it is detected during power-cycle self-tests, a
message detailing the specific tampering will be displayed on the serial console and logged in
/var/log/aventail/fips.log, the Test LED on the front panel remain lit and the system will be
placed in single user mode with networking disabled. The primary administrator will need to log
in via the serial console and restore tampered configuration files with valid backup copies or
perform a configuration reset prior to power-cycling the appliance.
z
Firmware upgrade files are signed and hashed. If an upgrade file fails its integrity check, the
upgrade process is aborted without making any state changes to the appliance, a message
detailing the failure is displayed on the AMC Web page, and the appliance remains fully
functional.
Enabling FIPS
Before you enable FIPS mode, you must have a strong password, a secure connection to your
authentication server, and a valid license.
Obtain your FIPS license as described in “Software Licenses” on page 243.
242
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
To be FIPS-compliant, your password must be at least 8 characters long, but it is recommended
that you use at least 14 characters. Although this requirement is not enforced by the software,
having a weak administrator password leaves you vulnerable. A strong password includes a mix of
letters, numbers and symbols. Think of this as a phrase, not just a password. For instance, “I never
saw a purple cow, I never hope 2C1.” has a combination of all three types of characters.
Only administrators with System rights can change the FIPS mode. When in FIPS mode, you will
not be able to select non-compliant SSL algorithms.
To use your existing, FIPS-compliant certificates while in FIPS mode, export the certificates before
enabling FIPS and then import them again after FIPS is enabled. See “Exporting and Importing
FIPS-Compliant Certificates” on page 242.
X
To enable FIPS
1. In the main navigation menu, click General Settings, then click FIPS Security.
2. Click Edit.
3. If you have imported your license, select the Enable FIPS mode check box.
Note: Existing certificates will be deleted from the system in the next step. To preserve your
FIPS-compliant certificates, ensure that you have exported them.
4. Click Save and then apply your Pending changes.
!
Your appliance will be rebooted to apply these changes. Any connections will be terminated.
!
Once in FIPS mode, manual editing of any configuration files via the shell is not allowed and
will cause the appliance to immediately reboot and be placed into single user mode for
remediation by the primary administrator.
If your appliance configuration is not FIPS-compliant, in the upper-right corner you will see an alert
link that says FIPS-compliance warning. Click on the link for more information on how to bring
your appliance configuration into FIPS-compliance.
Caution: The lack of this alert does not mean your environment is FIPS compliant. It is your
responsibility to ensure all of the FIPS prerequisites are met in order to be FIPS compliant.
Exporting and Importing FIPS-Compliant Certificates
If you know your existing Certificate keys were generated on a FIPS-compliant system and you want
to use them after FIPS is enabled, you must export them before enabling FIPS and then import them
after FIPS is enabled.
Similarly, if you plan to disable FIPS mode on your system and you want to use your FIPS-compliant
certificates after disabling FIPS, you must export them before disabling FIPS and then import them
after FIPS is disabled.
X
To export Certificates before the FIPS-mode transition:
1. In AMC, navigate to SSL Setting > SSL Certificates.
2. For each certificate to export, do the following:
a. On the Certificates table, select a certificate and click the Export button.
b. Enter a password for encrypting the exported .p12 file.
c. Click the Save button
X
To import certificates after the FIPS-mode transition:
1. In AMC, navigate to SSL Settings > SSL Certificates.
2. For each certificate to import, do the following:
a. On the Certificates table, select New > Import certificate....
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
243
b. Select the certificate file to import.
c. Enter the password with which the .p12 file was encrypted.
d. Click the Import button
Disabling FIPS
Turning off FIPS disables the FIPS feature and removes all of the constraints imposed by the FIPS
mode prerequisites.
!
Warning: To be fully FIPS compliant, no FIPS critical security parameters can be used outside
of the FIPS approved mode of operation. A few of these parameters are burned into the
firmware itself and thus to be fully compliant, zeroization must be performed. If you wish to
continue using your system rather than returning the hardware to SonicWALL for zeroization,
and you are willing to knowingly skip zeroization, you can disable FIPS mode in the AMC. This
will logically destroy all of the configurable parameters.
To use your existing, FIPS-compliant certificates after disabling FIPS mode, export the certificates
before disabling FIPS and then import them again after FIPS is disabled. See “Exporting and
Importing FIPS-Compliant Certificates” on page 242.
X
To disable FIPS
1. From the main navigation menu, click General Settings, then click FIPS Security.
2. Click Edit.
3. Clear the box next to Enable FIPS mode.
Note: Existing certificates will be deleted from the system in the next step. To preserve your
FIPS-compliant certificates, ensure that you have exported them.
4. Click Save and then apply your Pending changes.
Zeroization
!
Your appliance will be rebooted to apply these changes. Any connections will be terminated.
Zeroization is the practice of permanently destroying all critical security parameters. This is
accomplished by overwriting the entire disk with zeros. Zeroization makes it very hard to retrieve
sensitive data from the appliance. It is used before recycling hardware, or in other cases where data
security is more important than retaining the data. Once this operation is completed, the appliance
can no longer be used at your site and must be returned to SonicWALL for replacement hardware
to restore service.
X
To Zeroize the appliance:
1. Connect to the appliance using a serial connection, and log in as “root”.
2. Type zeroize.
3. Stay physically present with the appliance until the appliance halts.
!
Your appliance can take up to 90 minutes to complete the zeroization process.
Software Licenses
This section describes how to manage software licenses for appliance components. The SonicWALL
appliance uses different types of licenses:
z
Administration test license: When you receive your SonicWALL appliance, you must log in
to MySonicWALL to retrieve your initial user license, which is valid for one user (the
administrator plus one end user) for an unlimited number of days. This allows you to become
familiar with the Aventail Management Console (AMC), which you will use to upload an
appliance license file for additional users or other components.
244
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
z
Appliance licenses: This license is used to monitor and enforce concurrent user counts. If you
exceed your concurrent active user limit, user access is restricted until the active user count
drops below the licensed user limit.
The SonicWALL appliance supports the following:
{
Up to 2,000 concurrent users on an EX7000 or EX-2500 appliance
{
Up to 250 users on the EX6000 or EX-1600
{
Up to 50 users on the EX-750
Depending on your licensing arrangements, however, you may be allowed to exceed the limit
by a certain number of user sessions. In this case, user access is still allowed but the excess
usage is logged. If the active user count exceeds the grace count, however, user access is
restricted until the active user count drops below the grace count.
If user access is restricted, users attempting to log in to your VPN see an error message
indicating that the license count may have been exceeded, and they are denied access to your
network.
z
Component licenses: If the license for an appliance component (such as OnDemand) has
expired, users attempting to use that component see an error message in Aventail WorkPlace.
In the case of a Spike License, the number of days remaining on it and how many users are
covered by it are displayed in AMC.
All license files must be retrieved from www.mysonicwall.com and imported to the appliance, as
described in “Managing Licenses” on page 246.
How Licenses Are Calculated
A user license for the appliance does not represent a person, but rather a user authentication. If a
user logs in to WorkPlace on a desktop computer, for example, and is also logged in on a mobile
device, two licenses are consumed as soon as the user accesses a resource that’s protected by the
appliance.
A license is released when a connection has been inactive for 15 minutes. How this inactivity is
measured depends on the user’s access method:
z
With translated, custom port mapped, or custom FQDN mapped Web access, the license is
released after 15 minutes during which no resources are accessed.
z
When Connect Tunnel is running, the connection to the appliance is kept open, which means
that the license is in use as long as the tunnel is up. Once the tunnel is disconnected, the license
is released after 15 minutes.
There are a few ways to restrict or end sessions:
z
Restrict the number of licenses that a person can have on a per-community basis. When the
limit is reached, no further appliance sessions (and no access to resources) are allowed. The
user can start a new session only by terminating all existing sessions. For a description of the
Maximum active sessions setting, see “Assigning Members to a Community” on page 166.
z
Have tunnel client sessions terminate—on a per-community basis—when the time period set for
Credential lifetime (on the Configure General Appliance Options page) is reached. For a
description of the Limit session length to credential lifetime setting, see “Ending User
Sessions” on page 211.
z
Terminate a user session manually. See “Viewing User Sessions” on page 209 for information
on how to end user sessions in AMC. Also see “Open vs. Licensed Sessions” on page 211 for
more on the distinction between different types of sessions.
Notes
z
Users who reach the limit of their appliance licenses and then attempt to authenticate with just
a client certificate are not prompted to terminate all existing sessions. These users must
terminate an existing session in order to free up a license and start a new one. The best method
for terminating a session is for the user to log out, otherwise he or she must wait 15 minutes
for the session to time out and a license to be released.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
245
Viewing License Details
In AMC, you can view the status of your base appliance license and the licenses for any other
appliance components you may have purchased, such as OnDemand or Spike License. This section
describes how to view details about the status of your licenses.
X
To view license details
1. From the main navigation menu, click General Settings, and then click the Edit link in the
Licensing area. The Manage Licenses page appears.
2. Review the information provided:
License information
Description
Product
The type of SonicWALL appliance to which the license
applies.
License holder
The name of the entity to whom the appliance is licensed.
Maximum concurrent users
The maximum number of concurrent user sessions allowed
by the base appliance license. A concurrent user is a single
login from a single IP address. Users are not counted once
they log off, or when their credentials expire.
If a Spike License is in effect, you’ll see the total number of
allowed users, the number of days remaining for the license,
and at what time the next day begins. For example:
Spike license: 100 users, 60 days Active: Currently on day
2 of 60. Day 3 will begin at 10:15 PM on 9/23/09.
You can pause the Spike License as needed; see “Managing
a Spike License” on page 248 for more information.
Appliance serial number
The serial number derived from the license file imported onto
the appliance. This number is displayed at the bottom of the
main navigation menu in AMC; you will need it if you contact
Technical Support.
246
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
License information
Description
Authentication code
This is the appliance hardware identifier. The license you
obtain from www.mysonicwall.com will be valid only for the
appliance with this authentication code. See “Managing
Licenses” on page 246 for information on obtaining your
license file.
Component and license type
Details about any individual software component licenses. If
the license is a temporary or evaluation license, the
expiration date is displayed. If a license expiration date is
approaching, or if a license has expired, a warning message
is displayed in this area and in the AMC status area.
Managing Licenses
This section describes how to obtain your appliance licenses from www.mysonicwall.com. You must
have a base appliance license file if, for example, you want to replace an evaluation license with a
permanent license after deciding to purchase an appliance. There are also some components—such
as Connect and Spike License—that require a separate purchase and license.
Before you can enable your appliance or a component that requires a separate purchase and
license, you must follow these steps:
1. Create a MySonicWALL account, if you don't already have one. You need an account in order to
register your appliance. (MySonicWALL registration information is not sold or shared with any
other company.) See “Creating a MySonicWALL Account” on page 246 for more information.
2. Register your device on MySonicWALL. Registration provides access to essential resources,
such as your license file, firmware updates, and technical support information. See
“Registering Your SonicWALL E-Class SRA Appliance” on page 247 for more information.
3. Use your mySonicWALL account to apply the license for your appliance. If you have a highavailability cluster, you must apply a separate license to each appliance. See “Retrieving Your
SonicWALL E-Class SRA License” on page 247 for more information.
4. Apply your license file in AMC; see “Applying Your SonicWALL E-Class SRA License” on
page 247 for more information.
!
CAUTION You should ensure that the appliance’s date and time settings are configured
correctly for your time zone before importing a license file. For information about configuring
the system clock settings, see “Configuring Time Settings” on page 195.
For users who already have licenses (version 8.9.0 or earlier): In order to upgrade your
appliance to version 9.0.0 or later, you must go through the same steps as a new customer; this is
because the license is in a different format beginning with version 9.0.0.
Creating a MySonicWALL Account
To create a MySonicWALL account, complete the short online registration form. Registration
information is not sold or shared with any other company.
X
To create a mySonicWALL account
1. In your Web browser, go to the following Web site:
https://www.mysonicwall.com/
2. In the User Login section, follow the link for unregistered users.
3. Enter your account information, personal information, and preferences, and then click Submit.
Be sure to use a valid email address.
4. Follow the prompts to finish creating your account. SonicWALL will send a subscription code to
the email address you entered in step 3.
5. When you return to the login screen, log in with your new username and password.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
247
6. Confirm your account by entering the subscription code you received in email.
Registering Your SonicWALL E-Class SRA Appliance
Registration provides access to essential resources, such as your license file, firmware updates,
documentation, and technical support information.
X
To log in to your MySonicWALL account and register your appliance
1. In your Web browser, go to the following Web site and log in with your username and
password:
https://www.mysonicwall.com/
2. Locate your software Serial Number, which is printed on the back of your SonicWALL E-Class
SRA appliance.
3. Enter your serial number, and then click Next. Follow the on-screen instructions.
4. Confirm your Serial Number.
5. Enter a name for this appliance.
6. Enter the authentication code for this appliance, which is the hardware identifier for the
appliance you purchased. The authentication code is displayed in AMC: click General
Settings from the main navigation menu, and then look in the Licensing area.
7. Click Register to continue.
Follow the online prompts to fill out the survey and complete the registration process.
Retrieving Your SonicWALL E-Class SRA License
To retrieve the license file for your appliance, log in to your MySonicWALL account. If you have a
high-availability cluster, you must download a separate license for each appliance.
X
To retrieve the license file for your appliance
1. In your Web browser, go to the following Web site and log in with your username and
password:
https://www.mysonicwall.com/
2. Click the link for the appliance that requires a license.
3. On the Service Management page, select the appliance software version from the dropdown list for the license you are retrieving.
4. Click the link for the license file (.xml) and save it to your computer. After you get your
appliance up and running you must import this license file using AMC.
Applying Your SonicWALL E-Class SRA License
The SonicWALL appliance ships with a single administration test license that supports 1 user
indefintely; to test or deploy the appliance with additional users, or to enable separate components,
such as a Spike License, you must apply a valid license file. Log in to your MySonicWALL account,
retrieve the license file, and import it in AMC.
Notes
z
For users who already have licenses (version 8.9.0 or earlier): In order to upgrade your
appliance to version 9.0.0, a new license is necessary because it is in a different format
beginning with version 9.0.0. Follow the steps in the Upgrade Guide to retrieve your license.
X
To retrieve the license file from MySonicWALL and import it
1. In your Web browser, go to the following Web site and log in with your username and
password:
https://www.mysonicwall.com/
2. Click the link for the appliance that requires a license.
248
|
Chapter 7 - System Administration
3. On the Service Management page, select the appliance software version from the dropdown list for the license you are retrieving.
4. Click the link for the license file (.xml) and save it to your computer.
5. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click General Settings, and then click the Edit link
in the Licensing area. The Manage Licenses page appears.
6. Click Import License.
7. In the License file box, type the path for the license file, or click Browse to locate it.
8. Click Upload, and then apply the change by clicking the Pending changes link in the upperright corner.
Managing a Spike License
A Spike License enables you to temporarily increase the number of remote users you can support
in the event of a disaster or other business disruption. Licensed separately, this feature helps you
accommodate spikes in remote access traffic during planned or unplanned events.
When you buy a Spike License it is valid for a given number of users and days (this is the total
number of users who are supported when the Spike License is activated, not in addition to your
base license number). You can suspend and resume the use of the license as needed.
X
Activating, pausing, and resuming a Spike License
1. Retrieve your Spike License from mySonicWALL and import it to the appliance, as described in
“Applying Your SonicWALL E-Class SRA License” on page 247.
2. The Spike License is listed as Available on the Manage Licenses page in AMC. When you
need to accommodate more users, click Activate. The maximum number of possible users is
updated, and the timeline for your Spike License is displayed.
3. Click Pause to suspend use of the Spike License, and click Resume to continue using it.
Notes
z
You can upload more than one Spike License to your appliance, but you cannot have more than
one active at a time.
z
Whenever you activate or pause a Spike License, the number of days for which it is valid
decreases by one, even if fewer than 24 hours have elapsed.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
249
Chapter 8
End Point Control
The SonicWALL appliance includes support for End Point Control, which you can use to protect
sensitive data and ensure that your network is not compromised when accessed from devices in
untrusted environments. End Point Control works by:
z
Verifying that the user’s environment is secure
z
Removing user data from a personal computer after a session
z
Controlling access to sensitive resources
Overview: End Point Control
Traditional VPN solutions typically provide access only from the relative safety of a corporate laptop.
In that environment, one of the biggest security concerns is unauthorized network access. An SSL
VPN, on the other hand, enables access from any Web-enabled system, including devices in
untrusted environments. A kiosk at an airport or hotel, or an employee-owned computer, increases
the risk to your network resources.
End Point Control reduces your exposure from untrusted environments in three ways:
Verifying that the user’s environment is secure
Corporate IT departments configure computers under their control with antivirus software,
firewalls, and other safeguards designed to protect them from malicious software (malware). In
contrast, unmanaged computers can easily contain keystroke recorders, viruses, Trojan horses, and
other hazards that can compromise your network.
SonicWALL lets you define “zones of trust” that provide different levels of access depending on the
level of trust at the user’s end point. Connection requests are compared against device profiles you
set up in AMC and then assigned to the appropriate zone.
Removing user data from a PC after a session
It’s easy to inadvertently leave sensitive data on an untrusted PC. For example, a user logged in to
a public kiosk leaves a variety of data in the PC’s cache after logging out, including passwords,
browser cookies, and bookmarked URLs. Users may also accidentally leave files or email
attachments on the hard disk. SonicWALL’s data protection agents automatically remove session
data from the PC.
Controlling access to sensitive resources
You can reference End Point Control zones in access control rules. For example, a connection
originating from a less trusted EPC zone can be denied access to sensitive resources.
250
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
How the Appliance Uses Zones and Device Profiles for End Point Control
End Point Control is managed and deployed at the community level on the appliance. An
authentication realm—the entry point to the appliance for users—references one or more
communities, which are collections of users or groups with similar access needs. A community in
turn references one or more EPC zones. EPC zones can reference one or more device profiles, which
define the attributes that must be present on a client computer. The EPC process works this way:
1. A user connects to the appliance:
a. The user logs in to an authentication realm.
b. The appliance assigns the user to a community that belongs to that realm.
2. The appliance interrogates the user’s computer to determine if it has attributes (contained in a
device profile) that match those defined in one of the community’s EPC zones.
3. If the device matches a profile, the appliance classifies the computer into a particular EPC zone
and deploys the EPC tools configured for that zone.
The following diagram illustrates this process. In this case, the user’s device profile matches an End
Point Control zone named IT-managed. For a more detailed description of this process, see the first
scenario in “End Point Control Scenarios” on page 251.
Client connects
to appliance
Registry key
Antivirus software
Application
Zone =
IT-managed
Check for device
profile attributes
Place client into an
End Point Control
zone
Interrogate
client
Classify into
a zone
Notes
z
End Point Control has some specific Web browser requirements (for example, Safari is
recommended over Mozilla Firefox on Apple Macintosh systems); see “Client Components” on
page 9 for detailed requirements.
z
During client interrogation, the device profile attributes that the appliance is checking for and
whether they were found is recorded in the system message log, provided the log level is set
to verbose. See “End Point Control Interrogation” on page 448 for more information.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
251
Defining Zones
There are three categories of zones that you can customize, plus a built-in zone (Default). A
community can include Deny, Standard, and Quarantine zones; the Default zone, on the other hand,
is global. See “Adding Communities to a Realm” on page 165 for more information about
communities.
Zone type
Description
Deny
Deny zones are evaluated first. The appliance tries to find a match in the list
of Deny zones, starting with the one at the top. If there is a device profile
match (for example, a certain file is found on the device), the user is denied
access to the network. See “Creating a Deny Zone” on page 261 for more
information.
Standard
If the device does not match the criteria for a Deny zone, the appliance tries
to find a match in the list of Standard zones, starting with the one at the top.
If no match is found, the device is placed in the Default zone, or in a
Quarantine zone (if one is defined). See “Creating a Standard Zone” on
page 259 for more information.
Quarantine
A device for which there is no profile match is placed in either the Default zone
or in a Quarantine zone. You can customize the message users see; for
example, you may want to explain what is required to bring the user’s system
into compliance with your security policies. There can be only one Quarantine
zone in a community. See “Creating a Quarantine Zone” on page 262 for more
information.
Default
This zone is global and implicitly present in every community configured in
AMC. If a device does not match any other profile, you choose whether it
should “fall through” to the Default zone, or to a Quarantine zone. You can
customize the Default zone to some extent, but you cannot delete it. See
“Configuring the Default Zone” on page 264 for more information.
The following diagram illustrates the order in which zones are evaluated. Only the Default zone is
required:
Connection
request
Yes
No
Any Deny zones
matched?
Yes
No
Place user in
Deny zone
Place user in
Standard zone
Any Standard
zones matched?
Place user in either
Quarantine or Default
zone
End Point Control Scenarios
This section describes some typical End Point Control scenarios that use zones and device profiles
to classify connection requests and deploy End Point Control tools to clients.
252
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
Scenario 1: Employees Connecting from IT-Managed Laptops
This scenario begins with an employee connecting to the appliance using an IT-managed laptop.
User authenticates
Employee on
IT-managed laptop
Realm
Employees
Client is interrogated
(does it fit a device profile?)
Found:
Registry key
Antivirus software
Application
Community
Full-time
employees
Authentication
server
Zones
Device profiles
Block-access
Client matches the
device profile named
Trusted laptop
IT-managed
Client is classified into a
Standard zone named
IT-managed
Semi-trusted
Untrusted
No data protection is
required on the client
Here’s the sequence of events when a user logs in:
1. The user connects to the appliance, logs in to the realm Employees, and is assigned to the
Full-time employees community.
2. After the user authenticates, the client device is interrogated to determine if it matches any
device profiles belonging to the zones referenced by the Full-time employees community.
Device profiles are evaluated by zone, starting with any Deny zones and then proceeding
through the zones listed for the community.
3. The appliance finds that the client doesn’t match the device profile for the Deny zone (Blockaccess), so it proceeds to check the profile for the IT-managed zone. The IT-managed zone
references a device profile named Trusted laptop. The appliance determines that the user’s
device attributes match that particular device profile (a registry key entry, antivirus software,
and an application).
4. Based on that match, the appliance classifies the device into the IT-managed zone and doesn’t
evaluate the subsequent zones in the list for that community.
5. The IT-managed zone is not configured to require a data protection tool on the client. The
appliance then provisions the access agent configured for the Full-time employees community,
and the user is able to access the appropriate network resources.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
253
Scenario 2: Employees Connecting from a Home PC
This scenario begins with an employee connecting to the appliance from a home PC.
User authenticates
Employee on
home PC
Realm
Employees
Client is interrogated
(does it fit a device profile?)
Found:
Registry key
Antivirus software
Application
Personal firewall
Device profiles
Client matches a
device profile named
Home device
Community
Full-time
employees
Authentication
server
Zones
Block-access
IT-managed
Semi-trusted
Client is classified into
a Standard zone
named Semi-trusted
Untrusted
Cache Cleaner is
deployed to client
Here’s the sequence of events when a user logs in:
1. The user connects to the appliance, logs in to the realm Employees, and is assigned to the
Full-time employees community.
2. Once the user is authenticated, the client device is interrogated to determine if it matches any
device profiles belonging to the zones referenced by the Full-time employees community.
Device profiles are evaluated by zone, starting with any Deny zones and then proceeding
through the others listed for the community.
3. In this scenario, the appliance finds that the client doesn’t match the device profile for the
Deny zone (Block-access) or the Standard zone named IT-managed, so it continues to the
next one in the list: Semi-Trusted.
4. The Semi-trusted zone references a device profile named Home device. The appliance
determines that the user’s device attributes (a registry key entry, antivirus software, an
application, and a personal firewall) match that device profile.
5. Based on that match, the appliance classifies the device into the Semi-trusted zone and
doesn’t evaluate the subsequent zones in the community.
6. Because the Semi-trusted zone is configured to require a data protection tool on the client, the
appliance deploys Cache Cleaner to the client. The appliance then provisions the access agent
configured for the Full-time employees community, and the user is able to access the
appropriate network resources.
254
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
Scenario 3: Employees Connecting from a Public Kiosk
This scenario begins with an employee connecting to the appliance from a public kiosk.
User authenticates
Employee on
public kiosk
Realm
Employees
Client is interrogated
(does it fit a device profile?)
Found:
Nothing
Community
Full-time
employees
Authentication
server
Zones
Device profiles
Block-access
IT-managed
Client does not match
any device profile
Semi-trusted
Untrusted
Client is classified into a
Quarantine zone named
Untrusted
(Another option is to use
the Default zone as the
“fall-through” case)
Here’s the sequence of events when a user logs in:
1. The user connects to the appliance, logs in to the realm Employees, and is assigned to the
Full-time employees community.
2. After the user authenticates, the client device is interrogated to determine if it matches any
device profiles belonging to the zones referenced by the Full-time employees community,
starting with any Deny zones and then proceeding through the others listed for the
community.
3. In this scenario, the appliance finds that the client doesn’t match any of the configured device
profiles. There are a couple of ways to handle this sort situation: classify the client into a
Quarantine zone, or into the Default zone. In this example, the Quarantine zone Untrusted is
used. The only resources a user has access to are those that you have set up: you might, for
example, display a customized page with links to Web resources for bringing a system into
compliance with your security policies.
If you classify the device into the Default zone, you can configure AMC to give the user VPN
access, provided that OPSWAT Secure Desktop Emulator (SDE) can be deployed to the client.
SDE provides enhanced data protection for Windows users and is licensed separately.
a. If the untrusted device (for example, a PC in a public kiosk) is running Windows 7,
Windows Vista, Windows XP, or Windows 2008 Server, and a supported browser, the user
is required to download and install the client component manager, Aventail Access
Manager, as part of portal access. The client component manager automatically deploys
SDE for the user. The appliance then provisions the access agent configured for the Fulltime employees community, and the user is able to access the appropriate network
resources.
b. If the device’s operating system and browser are not compatible with SDE, a message is
displayed.
c. If SDE cannot be deployed on the client, the user’s connection request is denied.
See “Configuring the Default Zone” on page 264 for information on the setup options for this
zone.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
255
Scenario 4: Employee Connects from a PC with Google Desktop
An employee connects to the appliance from a PC outside of the corporate office.
User authenticates
Employee on
untrusted PC
Realm
Employees
Client is interrogated
(does it fit a device profile?)
Found:
Google Desktop
Device profiles
Community
Zones
Block-access
Client matches the
device profile named
Google Desktop
present
Authentication
server
Full-time
employees
Client is classified into
a Deny zone named
Block-access
IT-managed
Semi-trusted
Untrusted
User is logged out
Here’s the sequence of events when a user logs in:
1. The user connects to the appliance, logs in to the realm Employees, and is assigned to the
Full-time employees community.
2. After the user authenticates, the client device is interrogated to determine if it matches any
device profiles belonging to the zones referenced by the Full-time employees community,
starting with any Deny zones.
3. In this case the appliance determines that the PC is running Google Desktop, which makes it a
match for the Google Desktop present device profile. The device is classified into the Deny
zone named Block-access.
4. No other zones are evaluated and the user’s access request is denied.
5. The user is logged out.
Scenario 5: Employee Connects from a Mobile Device
In this scenario an employee connects to the appliance from a mobile device outside of the
corporate office. To establish an association between a particular user and his or her device (in case
the device is misplaced or lost), the administrator has collected the user name and IMEI
(International Mobile Equipment Identity) number for each device, and has added the IMEI number
for user accounts on the Active Directory server. The administrator has also created a device profile
named Mobile resources that verifies that user/IMEI association.
Here’s the sequence of events when a user logs in:
1. The user connects to the appliance, logs in to the realm Employees by entering a user name
and password, and is then assigned to the Mobile employees community.
2. After the user authenticates, the client device is interrogated (using a device profile for the
zone referenced by the Mobile employees community) and its IMEI number is determined.
256
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
3. The IMEI number is compared against the one that is associated with the user in the AD
directory. If there’s a match, the user is allowed access to mobile device-specific links;
otherwise he or she is denied access.
Notes
z
Checking for an IMEI number works only on wide area networks (WAN), not WiFi, and the WAN
service must be on in order for the post-authentication process to determine the IMEI number
on the mobile device.
z
In order to track service by mobile device and user you can process audit log files for network
proxy, Web proxy, or tunnel clients.
Managing EPC with Zones and Device Profiles
Device profiles can include any combination of the following attributes to identify a client and assign
it to a “zone of trust,” quarantine it, or deny it access altogether:
z
Application
z
Client certificate
z
Directory name
z
Equipment ID (the identifier for a device; for example, the IMEI number of a mobile device)
z
File name, size, or timestamp
z
Windows domain
z
Windows registry entry
z
Windows version
If you have Advanced EPC, you have additional attributes for identifying security programs on client
devices:
z
Antivirus program
z
Antispyware program
z
Personal firewall program
An EPC zone can reference one or more device profiles. Multiple device profiles are useful if there
are users with similar VPN access needs who use different computer platforms. For example, you
could configure an EPC zone that references a device profile for Windows computers, and another
zone for Macintosh computers. AMC supports device profiles for Windows, Macintosh, Linux,
Windows Mobile-powered devices, and other mobile devices (such as PDAs and smartphones). You
can create as many additional zones and device profiles as needed to accommodate different access
scenarios and levels of trust, such as separate zones for employees and business partners or
contractors.
AMC includes a predefined zone and some device profiles:
z
You can configure the Default zone to some extent, but you cannot delete it. A device that
cannot be classified into any of the zones you have configured is placed in either the Default
zone, or a Quarantine zone. (When you configure a community, you choose which of these will
be the “fallback” zone; see “Using End Point Control Restrictions in a Community” on page 168
for how to do this.) See “Configuring the Default Zone” on page 264 for more information.
z
To help you get started with Advanced EPC, the appliance includes some preconfigured device
profiles designed for common access scenarios. You can use these as is, or customize them to
meet your needs; see “Advanced EPC: Using Preconfigured Device Profiles” on page 273 for
more information.
Communities are used to specify which zones are available to users after they authenticate. For
information on linking zones to communities, see “Using End Point Control Restrictions in a
Community” on page 168. In addition, you can tie zones to your access policy in much the same
way as users, groups, and resources.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
257
Enabling and Disabling End Point Control
You can globally enable or disable End Point Control in AMC. Here are two examples of situations
where you might want to temporarily disable EPC:
z
You have upgraded your version of antivirus software company-wide from version 2.x to 3.x.
You could temporarily disable EPC in order to change the device profile that specifies the
antivirus software.
z
You can create new device profiles and zones on a production appliance without disrupting
users.
When End Point Control is disabled (which is the default setting), the appliance does not perform
the following EPC actions:
z
Evaluate the attributes of client devices
z
Classify connection requests into zones
z
Enforce zone restrictions in access control rules
X
To enable End Point Control
1. From the main navigation menu, click End Point Control.
2. Click the Disabled link next to End Point Control. The Configure General Appliance
Options page appears.
3. Select the Enable End Point Control check box.
Notes
z
When EPC is enabled, you can specify (on a per-zone basis) how often EPC checks are done:
only once (at login), or at login and then every <n> minutes for the duration of the session.
See “Creating a Standard Zone” on page 259 or “Configuring the Default Zone” on page 264 for
more information.
Zones and Device Profiles
This section describes how to configure and use zones and devices profiles.
Viewing Zones and Device Profiles
You can see the list of End Point Control zones in AMC and quickly determine what types they are
and whether there are any communities associated with them.
258
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
X
To view configured zones
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click End Point Control.
2. The End Point Control Zones page provides a summary of the zones that are configured in
AMC, and a summary of the EPC agent status. The SonicWALL appliance comes with a
preconfigured zone named Default. Click the name of a zone to view or edit its settings.
3. You can see information about each zone in the list:
{
The plus sign (+) column expands a selected zone to display the device profiles and
communities the zone is associated with.
{
The Name column displays the name you assigned when creating a zone; edit a zone by
clicking its name.
{
The Description column lists any descriptive text for the zone.
{
The Type column identifies whether a given zone is a Default, Standard, Deny, or
Quarantine one (these zone types are described in detail in “Defining Zones” on
page 251).
{
The Community column indicates whether the zone is referenced by any communities. A
blue dot indicates it is being used by one or more communities. If a zone is not referenced,
this field is blank.
Device profiles specify the attributes used to identify a client, such as the presence of a registry key
or software program. They are referenced by End Point Control zones.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
259
To view configured device profiles
1. On the Device Profiles tab, review the list of configured profiles. If you have Advanced EPC,
this list includes several preconfigured device profiles.
2. You can see information about each profile:
{
The Name column displays the name you assigned when creating the device profile; edit a
device profile by clicking its name.
{
The Description column lists any descriptive text for the device profile.
{
The Type column displays an icon representing the platform the device profile supports:
Microsoft Windows, Mac OS X, Linux, Windows Mobile, and Other mobile device.
Creating a Standard Zone
Standard zones are evaluated after Deny zones. You could create a device profile, for example,
named Windows firewall that would require that a personal firewall be running. When this End Point
Control policy is in place, any device that is a match is placed in a “zone of trust.”
X
To define a Standard zone
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click End Point Control. The End Point Control
Zones page appears.
2. Click New and then select Standard zone from the menu. The Zone Definition - Standard
Zone page appears.
3. In the Name box, type a meaningful name for the zone (for example, Windows firewall
required). If a zone will be referenced by mobile device users, keep the name short so that all
of it is visible on the mobile device.
4. (Optional) In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the zone.
260
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
5. In the All Profiles list, select the check box for any device profiles that you want to require in
the zone, and then click the right arrow (>>) button. Only one of the profiles in the In Use list
needs to match in order for the device to be placed in the zone you are creating.
6. If there are no device profiles for this zone, click New to add one. See “Defining Device
Profiles for a Zone” on page 265 for more information on creating profiles.
7. In the Access method restrictions area, specify which access methods, if any, will not be
allowed for clients that are classified into this zone.
8. Specify whether a Data protection agent is required. OPSWAT Secure Desktop Emulator
(SDE) provides enhanced protection for Windows users. It is part of Advanced EPC, which is
licensed separately. On unsupported platforms except Linux platforms, Cache Cleaner can be
used instead. Cache Cleaner is not supported on Linux platforms. Automatic fallback to Cache
Cleaner is supported in the following cases:
{
When the user declines SDE installation on Windows platforms
{
When the user attempts to use SDE from a Mac OS X platform
9. In the Recurring EPC area, you can specify how often EPC checks are done: only once (at
login), or at login and then every <n> minutes for the duration of the session. On small form
factor devices, recurring EPC is supported only with Connect Mobile. See “Performing
Recurring EPC Checks: Example” on page 275 for a description of a scenario where the
appliance repeatedly checks for the presence of a USB device: when the check fails, the
session ends.
10. The connection between devices and the appliance can handle interruptions—such as
suspending a session and later resuming it, or temporarily losing connectivity—without
requiring that users reauthenticate, as long as the device is using the same IP address.
To allow users to resume sessions from a different IP address—for example, when roaming
from one IP subnet to another by plugging into another part of your network—select the
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
261
Allow user to resume session from multiple IP addresses check box in the Advanced
area.
11. When you are finished configuring the zone, click Save.
Notes
z
OPSWAT Cache Cleaner and OPSWAT Secure Desktop Emulator are not supported when using
the Connect Tunnel client.
z
Recurring EPC requires an ActiveX control, so it will not occur on (for example) a small form
factor device that can't run ActiveX.
z
For information on how to copy or delete an EPC zone, see “Adding, Editing, Copying, and
Deleting Objects in AMC” on page 43.
Creating a Deny Zone
Deny zones are evaluated first. If there is a device profile match (for example, if a certain file or
registry key is found on the device), the user is denied access and logged out.
X
To define a Deny zone
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click End Point Control. The End Point Control
Zones page appears.
2. Click New and then select Deny zone from the menu. The Zone Definition - Deny Zone
page appears.
3. In the Name box, type a meaningful name for the zone (for example, Google Desktop
present).
4. (Optional) In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the zone.
5. In the All Profiles list, select the check box for any device profiles that you want to require in
the zone, and then click the right arrow (>>) button. (Only one of the profiles in the In Use
list needs to match in order for the device to be placed in the Deny zone you are creating.)
For example, the device profile definition might require that the application
GoogleDesktop.exe be running. If GoogleDesktop.exe is found on the device, the device is a
match for the Deny zone you named Google Desktop present, and the user is denied access
and logged off.
6. If there are no device profiles appropriate for this zone, click New to add one. See “Defining
Device Profiles for a Zone” on page 265 for more information on creating profiles.
262
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
7. At the bottom of the Zone Definition page, you can customize the message that denied users
see when they are logged out (for example, “Your system is running Google Desktop, which
poses a security risk”).
8. When you are finished configuring the zone, click Save.
Notes
z
For information on how to copy or delete an EPC zone, see “Adding, Editing, Copying, and
Deleting Objects in AMC” on page 43.
Creating a Quarantine Zone
For devices that cannot be classified—that is, they do not match any of the Deny or Standard zone
profiles—you can create a Quarantine zone. You can offer a user whose device is classified into this
zone Web links and an explanation, for example, of how to bring his or her device into compliance
with your security policies, or how to configure a system for EPC interrogation.
X
To define a Quarantine zone
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click End Point Control. The End Point Control
Zones page appears.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
263
2. Click New and then select Quarantine zone from the menu. The Zone Definition Quarantine Zone page appears.
3. In the Name box, type a meaningful name for the zone.
4. (Optional) In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the zone.
5. In the Customization area, type the message you want quarantined users to see. You might
offer an explanation for why a device was placed in quarantine and what is required to make it
comply with your security policies.
Remediation steps for devices that are placed in a Quarantine zone should probably include
information on how to configure a system for EPC interrogation. For most users, this means
enabling Java in the browser, enabling ActiveX, or downloading the Java Runtime Environment
(JRE). Your message for users could include some or all of the following:
{
Verify that Java or JavaScript is enabled in the Web browser on the computer (in most
browsers, Java is enabled by default). End point interrogation can’t take place if ActiveX
and Java are both disabled in the user’s browser.
{
If you are using Microsoft Windows and Internet Explorer, verify that ActiveX is enabled:
start Internet Explorer, and then click Internet Options on the Tools menu. On the
Security tab, click the Internet logo at the top of the tab, and then click Custom Level to
configure ActiveX controls and plug-ins.
{
JRE allows Java applications or Java applets to run on personal computers. To see if it is
running on your machine, type java -server at the command prompt.
6. Add any Web links that can help users bring their devices into compliance. This can be a
mixture of public and private URLs:
{
A public address might reference an Internet URL from which the user can download a
software component, such as a Java Virtual Machine. Public resources are normally
redirected through the appliance; you can prevent this redirection by adding the resource
in the exclusion list. See “Using the Resource Exclusion List” on page 129 for instructions
on how to do this.
264
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
{
A private address might reference an intranet URL containing the latest virus definitions.
In this case, rules are automatically created to give users access to the URL you specify
and to prevent them from accessing any other resources.
7. Click Save, or Save and Add Another.
Notes
z
When you configure a community, you choose the “fallback” zone for devices that cannot be
classified: they can either be placed in the Default zone or a Quarantine zone. For more
information, see “Using End Point Control Restrictions in a Community” on page 168.
z
Only one Quarantine zone per community can be defined (you can create multiple Deny and
Standard zones).
Configuring the Default Zone
AMC provides a global Default zone that serves as a fail-safe to either allow or block VPN access for
any connection requests that don’t match the other zones you set up. When the appliance receives
a connection request that it can’t classify into a zone—meaning it can’t identify the client device’s
operating system, browser, or other attributes—that device is automatically placed in the Default
zone. You can choose whether to grant or deny VPN access to users whose devices are assigned to
the Default zone.
Unlike other zones, the Default zone does not include device profiles, but it can be configured to
require the presence of a data protection agent. The Default zone is implicitly present in every
community configured in AMC.
X
To configure the Default zone
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click End Point Control.
2. Click the Default zone link. The Zone Definition page appears with Default zone
automatically entered in the Name box. (The name for this zone cannot be changed.)
3. In the Access restrictions area, select whether the appliance will Allow VPN access or
Block VPN access for devices that are placed in the Default zone. If you select Block VPN
access, users who are assigned to the Default zone are logged off of the appliance.
4. In the Access method restrictions area, specify which access methods, if any, will not be
allowed for clients that are classified into this zone.
5. In the Data protection area, specify whether client devices placed in the Default zone are
required to have Secure Desktop Emulator or Cache Cleaner in order to connect. OPSWAT
Secure Desktop Emulator provides enhanced data protection for Windows users. It is part of
Advanced EPC, which is licensed separately. On unsupported platforms except Linux
platforms, Cache Cleaner can be used instead. Cache Cleaner is not supported on Linux
platforms.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
265
Automatic fallback to Cache Cleaner is supported in the following cases:
{
When the user declines SDE installation on Windows platforms
{
When the user attempts to use SDE from a Mac OS X platform
6. In the Recurring EPC area, you can specify how often EPC checks are done: only once (at
login), or at login and then every <n> minutes for the duration of the session.
7. The connection between devices and the appliance can handle interruptions—such as
suspending a session and later resuming it, or temporarily losing connectivity—without
requiring that users reauthenticate, as long as the device is using the same IP address.
To allow users to resume sessions from a different IP address—for example, when roaming
from one IP subnet to another by plugging into another part of your network—select the
Allow user to resume session from multiple IP addresses check box in the Advanced
area.
8. Click Save.
Examples
If you want to provide a limited degree of access to users whose connection requests don’t meet
your criteria for a trusted relationship, you can include the Default zone in a restrictive access
control rule. For example, you could let users access their email by including the Default zone in a
“permit” access control rule limited to Web browsers connecting to Outlook Web Access.
If you have a restrictive access policy that requires a high degree of trustworthiness and does not
allow connection requests unless they are explicitly defined, setting the Default zone to Block VPN
access is the best strategy. Keep in mind that if your other zones and access control rules
inadvertently omit legitimate users, the Default zone will block them without exception.
Defining Device Profiles for a Zone
A device profile establishes a trust relationship with a client device by looking for one or more
attributes, such as an antivirus program, application, or Windows registry entry. Device profiles can
be referenced by one or more zones.
A device profile can be defined to detect only one attribute on a client computer, or it can require
multiple attributes. When a device profile references multiple attributes, each of those attributes
must be present on a client computer in order for there to be a match.
In addition to supporting Microsoft Windows, Apple Macintosh, Linux operating systems, and
Windows Mobile-powered devices, profiles can also be used for other mobile devices such as PDAs
and smartphones.
X
To define a device profile for a zone
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click End Point Control.
266
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
2. Click the Device Profiles tab, click New, and then select one of the following platforms:
{
Microsoft Windows
{
Mac OS X
{
Linux
{
Windows Mobile
{
Exchange ActiveSync
{
Other mobile device
3. On the Device Profile Definition page, type a meaningful name for the device profile in the
Name text box.
4. (Optional) In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the device profile.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
267
5. Select attributes for the device profile. After selecting each attribute, click Add to Current
Attributes. The attribute is added to the Current attributes list at the bottom of the AMC
page.
{
The available attributes depend on the device profile you selected; Client certificate, for
example, is not available as an attribute in a Linux profile, and Antispyware program is
available only for users who have Advanced EPC.
{
Where multiple entries are allowed for an attribute, note whether a device profile must
match all (and) or match any (or) items on the device.
Detailed descriptions of the attributes and the platforms on which they are available are in
“Device Profile Attributes” on page 267.
6. Click Save.
Notes
z
For information on how to copy or delete a device profile, see “Adding, Editing, Copying, and
Deleting Objects in AMC” on page 43.
Device Profile Attributes
A device profile can have several attributes, all of which are detailed in this section. There are a few
things to note about this list:
z
The attributes from which you can choose differ, depending on the platform you selected for
your device profile.
z
Users who have Advanced EPC can pick from a wide range of security programs. Advanced EPC
is included with the EX7000 and EX-2500; it can be purchased separately for the other
appliance models.
z
Where multiple entries are allowed for an attribute, a device profile must either match all (and)
or any (or) items on the device. In the following example, only one of the two antivirus
programs is required in order for there to be a match, but both of the Windows registry keys
are required:
z
To delete an item in the list, select the check box in the left column and click Delete. To delete
a single (or) item, for example, Norton AntiVirus but not eTrust EZ Antivirus, move your pointer
to the left of the item you want to delete and click the red “X” that appears (in the Value
column) for the item you want to delete.
268
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
The following section describes each attribute, the platforms on which it can be used, and whether
multiple attributes of the same type (where allowed) are ORed or ANDed.
Antivirus program
Platform
(This attribute is available only if you have Advanced EPC.) Select the
antivirus programs that EPC should check for in this profile. See
“Advanced EPC: Extended Lists of Security Programs” on page 272 for
more information.
Windows
If you don’t have Advanced EPC, or if you don’t see the security
programs that your users require, you can still specify programs by
adding them to a device profile using another attribute, such as
Application or Windows registry entry.
Mac OS X
Match
(Match any)
Linux
Antispyware program
Platform
Match
(This attribute is available only if you have Advanced EPC.)
Select an antispyware vendor on the left, and the name and
parameters for the program on the right.
Windows
If you don’t have Advanced EPC, or if you don’t see the
security programs that your users require, you can still
specify programs by adding them to a device profile using
another attribute, such as Application or Windows registry
entry.
Mac OS X
If you add more
than one
antispyware
program, specify
whether it should
match any item in
your list (or), or all
of them (and).
Application
Platform
The device profile can check for the name of an application process
that is running on the client device. Type the name of the application;
names can contain wildcard characters (* and ?) and are not casesensitive.
Windows
Mac OS X
Linux
Windows
Mobile
Match
(Match all)
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
Client certificate
Platform
Select a Certificate Authority from the drop-down list in the CA
certificate area. (See “Importing CA Certificates” on page 74 if the
CA you want to use is not listed). A client device will match this profile
as long as the appliance is configured with the root certificate for the
CA that issued the client certificate to your users (an intermediate
certificate will not work).
Windows
Select the certificate store(s) you want searched:
z
System store only specifies that only the system store
(HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\SystemCertificates) is searched
z
System store and user store specifies that the system store is
searched first, followed by the user store
(HKCU\Software\Microsoft\SystemCertificates)
Mac OS X
|
269
Match
(Match any)
Windows
Mobile
Notes:
z
A device profile can contain only one client certificate attribute.
z
A Windows Mobile-powered device has only one user, which
means that any client certificates in the local user store are always
the same. (On a desktop or laptop device, there can be multiple
users.)
z
The system store cannot be searched unless the user has
administration privileges on the client device.
Directory name
Platform
Type the name of a directory that must be present on the hard disk
of the device. Directory names are not case-sensitive.
Windows
Mac OS X
Linux
Windows
Mobile
Match
(Match all)
270
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
Equipment ID
Platform
The device identifier is usually an attribute in the authentication
directory represented by a variable; for example, {unique_id}.
Windows
z
For a Microsoft Windows device, the identifier is a unique hard
drive serial number, such as WD-WMAM9SK79685, that identifies
a particular device.
z
For a Mac OS X device, the Universal Unique Identifier (UUID) is
used, which is a 128-bit number that combines references to the
network address of the host that generated the UUID, the
timestamp, and a random number. An example of a UUID is:
951A240E-F502-5632-BDAB-D1ECA43FA371.
z
Linux
Windows
Mobile
For a Linux device, the UUID is the device identifier.
z
For a Virtual Machine, the UUID is the device identifier.
z
In the case of the Apple iPhone, it is the serial number of the
device with “Appl” prepended; for example, Appl828315FLY7H.
z
For a Google Android device, the device serial number is the
identifier. For an Android smartphone, “droid” is prepended to the
ID.
z
For a Windows Mobile 6 device, the identifier is the unique 15-digit
IMEI (International Mobile Equipment Identity) code for the
device; for example, 350077-52-323751-3.
z
For other mobile devices including a Nokia Symbian device, the
identifier is the unique 15-digit IMEI.
For a mobile device that uses Exchange ActiveSync to synchronize
email, calendars, and contacts with an Exchange Server, the identifier
is the string that ActiveSync reports. A good way to get the correct
device ID is to look at the POST message in the AMC Web proxy audit
log file, available on the Logging page after the device attempts to
connect to the appliance.
You can also use the procedure in Knowledge Base article #8901 to
determine the unique ID of your Windows, Mac, or Linux device.
The variable can either be a variable that is already part of your
directory server, or (if you are collecting the IDs of unregistered
devices) a variable that is not yet defined:
z
See “Using Query-Based Variables” on page 132 for information
on defining a variable.
z
See “Collecting Equipment IDs from Unregistered Devices” on
page 277 for steps on how to collect equipment identifiers from
unregistered devices, including smartphones.
Note for mobile devices
z
Mac OS X
Checking for an IMEI number works only on wide area networks
(WAN), not WiFi. The WAN service must be on in order for the
post-authentication process to determine the IMEI number of the
device.
Apple
iPhone
Google
Android
phones
Match
(Match any)
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
File name
Platform
Type the name of a file (including its extension and full path) that
must be present on the hard disk of the device. File names are not
case-sensitive. You can use environment variables (such as %windir%
or %userprofile%), or wildcard characters (* and ?).
Windows
You can optionally specify a File size or the date and time (GMT) the
file was Last modified. Both of these options use a comparison
Operator; for more information and examples, see “Using
Comparison Operators with Device Profile Attributes” on page 274.
The file’s modification date and time can be specified as an Absolute
or Relative value.
Mac OS X
|
271
Match
(Match all)
Linux
Windows
Mobile
The device profile can be configured to validate file integrity using an
MD5 or SHA-1 hash (valid on all platforms), or use a Windows catalog
file to validate Windows system files.
Mac OS X version
Platform
Type the major and minor versions, and the build number for the operating system.
Examples of versions for the Mac OS are:
Mac OS X
z
v10.2 (Jaguar)
z
v10.3 (Panther)
z
v10.4.4 (Tiger)
z
v10.5.6 (Leopard)
The comparison Operator applies to all three values. To specify all versions of
Leopard, for example, enter “greater than or equal to” (>=) as the Operator, and
then type 10 in the Major and 5 in the Minor text boxes. For more information,
see “Using Comparison Operators with Device Profile Attributes” on page 274.
Personal firewall program
Platform
(This attribute is available only if you have Advanced EPC.) Select the
firewall programs that EPC should check for in this profile. See
"Advanced EPC: Extended Lists of Security Programs" on page 170 for
more information.
Windows
Mac OS X
If you don’t have Advanced EPC, or if you don’t see the security
programs that your users require, you can still specify programs by
adding them to a device profile using another attribute, such as
Application or File name.
Linux
Windows domain
Platform
Type the domain name the computer belongs to in NetBIOS syntax
(for example, mycompany), without a DNS suffix. Separate multiple
entries with a semicolon. The domain can contain wildcard characters
(* and ?).
Windows
Match
(Match any)
Match
(Match any)
272
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
Windows registry entry
Platform
Type the Key name, and optionally enter a Value name and Data,
and then select a comparison Operator for the Data field. See “Using
Comparison Operators with Device Profile Attributes” on page 274 for
more information.
Windows
Wildcards can be used for the value and data, but not for the key. To
enter a special character (such as a wildcard or backslash), you must
precede it with a backslash.
Windows
Mobile
Match
(Match all)
Windows version
Platform
Type the major version, minor version, and build number for the operating system.
The major/minor versions for Windows are:
Windows
z
Windows Vista: 6/0
z
Windows XP: 5/1
z
Windows 2000: 5/0
Windows
Mobile
The comparison Operator applies to all three values. For more information, see
“Using Comparison Operators with Device Profile Attributes” on page 274.
Advanced EPC: Extended Lists of Security Programs
Advanced EPC is an optional component—licensed separately—that provides an extended and
detailed list of security programs. You can configure EPC device profiles to check for personal
firewall, antivirus, and spyware programs on clients running Microsoft Windows or Mac OS X, and
to check for personal firewall and antivirus programs on clients running Linux. Advanced EPC is
included with the EX-2500 and can be purchased separately for the other appliance models.
Advanced EPC includes a built-in list of device profiles you can use as is or modify; see “Advanced
EPC: Using Preconfigured Device Profiles” on page 273 for more information.
X
To add attributes using Advanced EPC
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click End Point Control.
2. On the Device Profiles tab, click New, then select an operating system from the list.
3. After giving the profile a Name (a Description is optional), select the Type of program that
EPC should check for (for example, Antivirus program). (On the Linux platform, Antispyware
program is not available.)
4. Select a Vendor and Product name. In Windows device profiles, select the Any product
from this vendor check box, available for antivirus, antispyware, and personal firewall
program vendors, to select all product names and create a profile that does not require
updating everytime the vendor releases a new version. When this option is selected, you can
still specify additional criteria, such as signatures updated, file system scanned, and real-time
protection enabled, as long as all the versions of all the products in the list support that
functionality.
5. Specify an absolute or relative Product version.
Some products are known by several different names. For example, McAfee Inc. offers a core
product named McAfee VirusScan that is also known as McAfee VirusScan 2004 and McAfee
VirusScan 2005. (When you select a product name that has an asterisk, you’ll see a footnote
indicating its “core” product name.) Using the name indicated in the footnote is recommended
so that you don’t have to update your device profile every time a core product is marketed
under a new name.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
273
6. There are optional parameters you can use to more narrowly define the security program
settings that the device profile requires (not all parameters are available for each program
choice—any that are not available are dimmed):
{
Signatures updated: Defines how recently the list of antispyware or antivirus signatures
was updated on the client device.
{
File system scanned: Defines how recently the client device’s disk was scanned using
this antispyware or antivirus program.
{
Realtime protection required: If the device profile requires that realtime scanning for
viruses and spyware is enabled, select this check box.
7. Click the Add to Current Attributes button to add an entry to the list at the bottom of the
page. When you add additional programs (for example, if you want the device profile to check
for any of several programs), the device profile must match all (and) or any (or) items on the
device:
{
Additional antivirus programs are grouped together, but the device profile requires just
one of the programs for a match.
{
When you specify more than one antispyware program, you can specify whether all of
them are required (and), or just a single one (or).
For example, this device profile is matched if one of two antivirus programs is present, along
with one of two antispyware programs:
8. Click Save.
Notes
z
The product names you can choose from include some that use Far Eastern language
characters. If you do not have international support enabled on your operating system, these
characters may be displayed as boxes or question marks. The name of one of the Symantec
products you can choose, for example, may look like this if the appropriate font support is
missing:
With international support enabled, it looks like this:
Advanced EPC: Using Preconfigured Device Profiles
To help you get started with End Point Control, there are several preconfigured device profiles,
grouped by operating system, that you can use as is or copy and modify to suit your access policy
and resource requirements. Click End Point Control in the main navigation menu in AMC, and then
click the Device Profiles tab to see the list:
z
Home Users
z
McAfee Corporate
z
Norton Corporate
z
Sophos Corporate
z
Trend Micro Corporate
274
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
The device profile named Windows - McAfee Corporate, for example, is a Windows device profile
preconfigured to require McAfee VirusScan Enterprise (version 7.50.0 or later), and either one of
the specified personal firewall products:
Attribute type
Product name
Antivirus program
McAfee VirusScan Enterprise, version >= 7.5.0.x
AND
Personal firewall
McAfee Personal Firewall Express, version >= 5.x
OR
McAfee Personal Firewall Plus, version >= 5.x
You can use these predefined profiles as a starting point for your own. Copy one that matches your
environment the closest, and then modify it, changing (for example), the acceptable product
versions and the requirement for how recently the list of antispyware or antivirus signatures was
updated on the client device. To delete an entire row in the list of current attributes, select the check
box for that row and click Delete. To delete an item in an ORed list (one of the personal firewall
products in the McAfee Corporate profile, for example), move your mouse cursor over the “or” and
then click the red “X” that appears.
Using Comparison Operators with Device Profile Attributes
Some device profile attributes can be modified using comparison operators, which is useful in
situations such as these:
z
Keeping a device profile current with software that is automatically updated on client devices—
you don’t need to manually change the profile each time the software is updated
z
Specifying that a specific file detected on client machines has a timestamp greater than a
certain date and time
z
Specifying that the Windows operating system detected on the client device be greater than or
equal to a certain version
The available comparison operators are:
Operator
Description
<
Less than
<=
Less than or equal to
=
Equal to
>=
Greater than or equal to
>
Greater than
!=
Not
Comparison operators can be used in conjunction with the following device profile attributes:
z
File date or time stamp for a specific file
z
File size for a specific file
z
Registry entry (when value data is selected for a registry key)
z
Windows version
Example
Use these steps to find a file on a PC running Microsoft Windows that has recently been updated.
X
To specify a relative or absolute file date
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click End Point Control.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
275
2. Click the Device Profiles tab, and then click New.
3. Select Microsoft Windows on the shortcut menu.
4. Type a meaningful name for the device profile in the Name text box.
5. (Optional) In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the device profile.
6. In the Add attribute(s) area, select File name in the Type list.
7. In the File name field, type weekly_timesheet.xls. The following are two examples of how
to specify a time stamp for the file:
{
To specify that weekly_timesheet.xls has been updated within the last five days, select <=
in the Last modified list, click Relative, and then type 5 in the text box.
{
To specify that the file was updated after June 1, 2006, select >= in the Last modified
list, click Absolute, and then type 06/01/2006 in the text boxes.
8. Click Add to Current Attributes, and then click Save.
Using End Point Control with the Connect Tunnel Client
You can use End Point Control on devices that connect to the appliance using the Connect Tunnel
client. As with other access methods, EPC for the Connect Tunnel client supports the use of device
profiles and EPC zones. However, the Connect Tunnel client does not support OPSWAT Secure
Desktop Emulator or Cache Cleaner; these data protection options are ignored by the Connect
Tunnel client.
Performing Recurring EPC Checks: Example
A connection request is classified into an EPC zone based on attributes defined in a device profile.
This check is always performed when the user logs in; in addition, you have the option of checking
at regular intervals whether a device continues to match the profile for a particular zone.
An example illustrates how this setting might be used. In this scenario the system administrator
has given each systems engineer in the organization a USB device that provides access to resources
protected by the SonicWALL Aventail appliance. This provides two-factor authentication: During a
user’s session, the appliance repeatedly checks for the presence of a client certificate associated
with a USB device: if the check fails, the session ends. Since an essential part of the user’s
authentication (the client certificate) is on the USB device, authentication data does not remain on
the system when the systems engineer removes the key.
Here’s how it looks from the systems engineer’s perspective:
1. Insert your personal USB device into any desktop or laptop device (trusted or untrusted). If
the device is running Windows Vista and Internet Explorer 7, Protected Mode must be off.
2. Enter your PIN number.
3. Log in for access to the VPN and authenticate. The SonicWALL Aventail appliance checks for
your client certificate when you log in and at regular intervals thereafter (the interval is set by
the SonicWALL Aventail appliance administrator). When the USB device is removed, the check
fails and the connection is ended.
Here’s an overview of the configuration steps the administrator must take:
1. To establish a trust relationship between the USB device and the appliance, you must
reference a root CA certificate in the EPC device profile. If it’s not already present, import the
certificate to the appliance (click SSL Settings in the main navigation menu, and then click
Edit in the CA Certificates area).
2. Using Aventail Management Console, create a device profile for Windows, Mac, or Linux
devices that checks for the presence of a client certificate on the USB devices you plan to
distribute. The certificate must descend from the root certificate from step 1. When creating a
device profile for Windows, make sure that both the system and user certificate stores are
searched.
3. Create an EPC Standard zone that requires the device profile from the preceding step.
276
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
4. When you are defining the zone, specify in the Recurring EPC area at what intervals EPC will
check the client systems that are classified into this zone. In this case, you might want to
perform frequent checks (for example, every minute).
5. A device for which there is no profile match—the client certificate does not descend from the
root CA certificate identified in the first step, or the USB device has no certificate—will “fall
through” to either the Default zone or a Quarantine zone:
{
To deny access to any connection requests that don’t meet your criteria, configure the
Default zone to simply deny access. In the Access restrictions area on the Zone
Definition page, select Block VPN access.
{
If you prefer, you can create a Quarantine zone and customize the message users see; for
example, you may want to explain what is required to bring the user’s system into
compliance with your security policies.
Notes
z
It’s important for users to understand that their connectivity depends on the presence of the
USB device. For this reason they should also not leave the USB device plugged in and
unattended.
Creating Zones for Special Situations
While the majority of connection requests—those involving Microsoft Windows and Internet
Explorer or Mozilla Firefox—can be accommodated by Standard zone configurations, you may need
to address special situations involving other operating systems and browsers, or connection
requests that don’t match any of the zones you’ve defined. You can use zones and device profiles
to address the following types of situations:
z
Clients that don’t match the criteria for any defined zones and device profiles.
z
Clients that don’t support the EPC interrogation necessary for classifying a client into an EPC
zone.
z
Clients running certain Web browsers (anything other than Internet Explorer and Firefox) on
Windows, or users running earlier (pre-Windows XP) versions of Windows.
z
Special classes of users who require access regardless of the client device they’re running.
Be sure to configure the global Default zone, which is implicitly present in every community
configured in AMC.
Defining Zones for Certain Browsers or Earlier Versions of Windows
When a user connects to the SonicWALL appliance, the appliance interrogates the user’s computer
and determines (among other things) what operating system it’s running and what Web browser is
in use. EPC requires Windows XP or later, and either Internet Explorer or Firefox, but you can define
a special zone for users who don’t meet those requirements. This prevents them from being placed
in the Default zone, which might block their access. The only attribute used to distinguish this type
of zone is the presence of the Windows system.
This configuration can also be used to define a zone for users who are running a version of Microsoft
Windows that was released before Windows XP.
X
To define a zone for clients with non-standard browsers
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click End Point Control. The End Point Control
Zones page appears.
2. Click New and then select Standard zone from the menu. The Zone Definition page appears.
3. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the special browser zone.
4. In the Device Profiles area, click New and then select Microsoft Windows from the menu.
The Device Profile Definition page appears.
5. In the Name box, type a meaningful name for the device profile.
6. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the device profile.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
277
7. In the Add attribute area, select Windows version from the Type list and then click Add to
current attributes. Do not specify any other attribute settings.
8. Click Save.
9. Select the check box for the browser Device profile that you want to include in the zone.
10. Use the >> button to move the items to the In use list.
11. If you want the device profile to require the presence of a data protection component, select
Secure Desktop Emulator or Cache Cleaner from the Required data protection tool list.
Cache Cleaner is not supported on Linux platforms. SDE is only supported on Windows.
12. When you are finished configuring the zone, click Save.
Collecting Equipment IDs from Unregistered Devices
Every computer and mobile device has a unique identifier, and you can use this identity in a device
profile to ensure that only certain devices have access to protected resources. But before you can
add equipment ID data to your directory server as a user attribute, you must first collect the data.
You can do this in several ways:
z
By creating device profiles for unregistered devices and having users log in: the device ID is
collected in the Unregistered device log. See “Creating Device Profiles that Allow Unregistered
Devices” on page 278.
z
By creating a device profile that uses a device identity, but does not have the Match Profile if
user has no registered devices option enabled. See “Disabling Match Profile if user has no
registered devices in the Device Profile” on page 280.
z
By creating a quarantine zone associated with a device profile that matches users who log in
using an unregistered device. See “Quarantining Unregistered Devices” on page 280.
z
By creating a deny zone associated with a device profile that matches users who log in using
an unregistered device. See “Locking Out Unregistered Devices” on page 281.
z
By exporting the log messages for login attempts by unregistered devices to an external
machine, where an IT administrator can view the list and register the devices or they can be
automatically registered. See “Exporting the Unregistered Device Log for External Processing”
on page 281.
Note about “Match profile if user has no registered devices”:
When selected, the Match profile if user has no registered devices check box is applicable
when the user has no devices registered in the back end AD or LDAP server and there are no
hard coded devices in the device profile.
For example, consider the case where two attributes have been created for user 'test' in the
AD/LDAP server, and these attributes are mapped to two policy variables. A device profile is
created containing these two variables and the equipment ID "4JV5DQH1". The check box is
selected. This device profile is a part of a zone called 'std_desc'. Unlike user 'test', user 'test1'
has no representation in the backend LDAP/AD server.
User 'test' logs in with a device that is registered in the backend server. The zone classification
is std_desc. However, user 'test1' logs in with the same device and is classified into the default
zone. Note that the check box does not apply to user 'test1' in this case.
However, if you remove the device ID '4JV5DQH1' from the device profile, leaving just the two
policy variables, you will see a different zone classification for user 'test1'. In this case, user
'test' logs in with a registered device and is classified into the std_desc zone. User 'test1' logs
in and is also classified into the std_desc zone. Note that the check box applies in this case
because user 'test1' has no devices registered, the two policy variables in the device profile of
the zone return with NULL values, and there isn't the third hard coded device in the device
profile.
If you are using mobile devices, you may already have the device identities entered into your
database. In this case, you could simply refer to them in a profile. Users logging in from one of
these devices will match this profile and qualify for the associated zone. A device that supports
Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync reports its device ID.
278
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
The device identifier is usually an attribute in the authentication directory represented by a variable;
for example, {device_identity}. The format of the identifier differs, depending on the kind of
device used:
z
For a Microsoft Windows device, the identifier is a unique hard drive serial number; for example,
WD-WMAM9SK79685.
z
For a Mac OS X device, the Universal Unique Identifier (UUID) is used. A UUID is a 128-bit
number that combines references to the network address of the host that generated the UUID,
the timestamp, and a random number. An example of a UUID is: 951A240E-F502-5632-BDABD1ECA43FA371.
z
For a Linux device, the UUID is the device identifier.
z
For a Virtual Machine, the UUID is the device identifier.
z
For a Windows Mobile 6 device, the identifier is the unique 15-digit IMEI (International Mobile
Equipment Identity) code for the device; for example, 350077-52-323751-3.
z
For a Nokia Symbian device, the identifier is the unique 15-digit IMEI.
z
For a Google Android device, the device serial number is the identifier.
z
For an Apple iPhone/iPad, the device serial number is the identifier.
In the case of the Apple iPhone, the device prepends “Appl” to its device ID/serial number
when it communicates with Exchange servers. For example: Appl828315FLY7H.
You can use the procedure in Knowledge Base article #8901 to determine the unique ID of your
Windows, Mac, or Linux device. The Knowledge Base is available at:
http://www.sonicwall.com/us/support/2213.html
Another method to get the correct device ID for a smartphone is to view the POST message in the
AMC log after the phone attempts to connect to the appliance. Navigate to the Logging page, and
select Web proxy audit log in the Log file drop-down list on the View Logs tab. The POST message
looks like this:
http://10.10.11.12/Microsoft-ServerActiveSync?User=jt&DeviceId=Appl828315FLY7H&DeviceType=iPhone&Cmd=Sync
Use the DeviceId value in your database for profiles to refer to.
Your directory server may be set up with a different attribute for each of these types of identifiers,
or you can store the data in a single attribute. In the following example, a single attribute and
variable is used.
Creating Device Profiles that Allow Unregistered Devices
X
To collect equipment IDs from unregistered devices by using a device identity
variable with device profiles
1. Identify or set up the AD or LDAP authentication server and realm you want users with
unregistered devices to log in to. If you’re starting from scratch, see “Creating Realms” on
page 163 for more information. In this example, the realm is named Employees.
2. Create a variable named device_identity that points to an attribute in the directory server
specified in step 1 (you can create the variable and capture data even if the attribute it points
to doesn’t exist yet):
a. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
b. On the Variables tab, click New, and then type the name for the variable; for example,
device_identity.
c. Select User attribute from the Type list, and then make sure Employees is selected in the
Realm list.
d. If the user attribute that holds device ID data already exists, enter a valid user name in
the User text box, and then select the attribute from the Attribute list. If it doesn’t exist
yet, just enter its name in the Attribute text box.
e. If it’s possible that some users will be associated with more than one device (for example,
a desktop computer and a laptop), select Multiple results in the Output list.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
279
3. Now create device profiles and a zone for unregistered devices. If you are collecting data from
all three types of devices, you’ll need one device profile for each one:
a. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click End Point Control; make sure that EPC is
enabled.
b. On the Device Profiles page, click New, and then select Microsoft Windows, Windows
Mobile, or ActiveSync.
c. Give the device profile a name (for example, Unregistered - Windows), and then select
Equipment ID in the attribute Type list.
d. Select Matches as the Value. You’ll create a Standard zone later in this procedure.
e. Click the {variable} button next to the Device identifier text box, select the variable
you created in step 2, and then click Insert. Click {variable} again to close the list.
f. In the Unregistered devices area, select the Match profile if user has no registered
devices check box. Devices that are not already registered on the external AD/LDAP
server will be a match for this profile and their identifiers will be recorded in the
Unregistered device log. If you haven't already defined the variable, you'll see a warning
(Undefined: {device_identity}), which can be ignored for now.
g. Click the Add to Current Attributes button, and then click Save.
h. Add a device profile for each of the other types of devices you want to accommodate. For
example, Unregistered - WinMobile, or Unregistered - ActiveSync.
4. Create a Standard zone named Data collection that uses the device profiles that you created.
See “Creating a Standard Zone” on page 259 for more information.
5. Now create a community named New devices in the Employees realm. On the End Point
Control Restrictions page for that community, move the Data collection zone to the In use
list. See “Creating and Configuring Communities” on page 166 if you need help setting up a
community.
6. When you apply and save your changes, click End Point Control in the main navigation
menu; the Data collection zone should look like this:
7. When an unregistered device is detected during login, the user is placed in the Data collection
zone because the device matches the Unregistered profile. To see device identity details,
select Unregistered device log on the Logging page in AMC.
280
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
8. Select No devices in the Device count list, and then click Refresh, so that you're sure to
capture all new users. An expanded entry might look like this:
9. If you need to do any additional analysis of the logged data, export it to an XML file. You can
reduce the size of the exported file by first applying filter or search criteria. The Show last
<n> messages setting determines the maximum number of messages included in the
exported log file.
Disabling Match Profile if user has no registered devices in the Device Profile
If you create a device profile that uses a device identifier and disable the Match Profile if user
has no registered devices option, a user with a new device (even if some devices are registered
to that user) will not match this profile and will not be qualified into this zone. The unregistered
device ID will be collected and placed into the unregistered devices list, provided that the user met
all other (non-device) criteria to match the profile. The administrator can collect the device
information from the unregistered device list and then register the device semi-automatically. Thus,
with no user interaction, the next time the user attempts to log in using the device they may be
able to classify into the zone.
Quarantining Unregistered Devices
You can create a device profile that specifies that the user does not match any of the device IDs
currently registered for this user. This profile can be associated with a quarantine zone. A user with
a new device will match this profile and be placed into the quarantine zone. You can configure a
message to the user that the current device is unregistered, but that the device information was
collected from their login attempt and their device will be registered for them, allowing their next
login to qualify for the usual (non-quarantine) zone.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
281
Locking Out Unregistered Devices
You can use a deny zone to lock out a particular device. To do this, create a device profile that
contains an Equipment ID attribute and select the Does not match checkbox when adding the
Device Identifier. This feature allows you to lock out, for example, a device that you suspect has
been compromised, while not completely locking out the user who owns that device. The device
information is collected from the login attempt.
Exporting the Unregistered Device Log for External Processing
There are unregistered device log messages for every new unregistered device that is used in a
login attempt. These messages can be exported in XML format to an external machine either from
the Logging page in the AMC or by using a curl or wget command from an external machine. See
“Unregistered Device Log Messages” on page 448 for more information. This export feature allows
you to collect these messages and then either automatically register each device, or inform a help
desk of each new unregistered device that was used by each user.
Advanced: If you need be notified immediately when a user attempts to log in using an
unregistered device, you can configure a Syslog server on the Configure Logging page in AMC. The
appliance will generate a log message with the following format when a login or login attempt
occurs:
New Equipment: user '#1', platform '#2', device '#3', existing Devices '#4'
Where:
#1 is the name of the user
#2 is the name of the platform
#3 is the ID of this device or piece of user equipment
#4 is the number of devices already registered for this user
Defining Zones for Special Classes of Users
Another method for preventing special classes of trusted users from being assigned to the Default
zone (and potentially being denied access) involves creating a zone that contains no device profiles,
and then assigning that zone to a community to which only those trusted users belong.
282
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
For example, if you want system administrators to be able to access network resources regardless
of the client device they’re using, you could assign them to a community that contains a no-profile
zone. Then when system administrators select a realm that references that community and log in,
they are placed in the no-profile zone, instead of the global Default zone, which may be set up to
block unrecognized clients.
X
To create a no-profile zone
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click End Point Control. The End Point Control
Zones page appears.
2. Click New. The Zone Definition page appears.
3. In the Name box, type a meaningful name for the zone.
4. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the zone.
5. You can optionally select a Required data protection tool for the zone. However, if you
want this special class of trusted users to have flexibility regarding the types of devices they’re
connecting with, leave this field set to None.
6. Click Save.
After you’ve defined the no-profile zone, you must create a realm specifically for this special class
of trusted users. Configure the realm with a dedicated community so that only this special class can
log in to it. For more information, see “Assigning Members to a Community” on page 166.
Using the Virtual Keyboard to Enter Credentials
If there is a concern that credentials may be stolen, you can offer (or require) that users logging in
to WorkPlace provide their credentials by pointing to characters on a keyboard display instead of
typing them.
Because the virtual keyboard is used before a user is authenticated (and before a realm is chosen),
the way in which it’s configured applies to all realms: you can’t offer the virtual keyboard to just
certain groups of users, or require it only in certain cases. End Point Control does not have to be
enabled in order for the virtual keyboard to be used.
The virtual keyboard settings do not apply to small form factor devices, such as smartphones; for
information about optimizing WorkPlace for these devices, see “Optimizing WorkPlace for Display
on Small Form Factor Devices” on page 306.
X
To configure the virtual keyboard in Aventail WorkPlace
1. From the main navigation menu, click Agent Configuration and then, in the Client integrity
area, click Edit. The Configure Client Integrity page appears.
2. To give users the option of entering their credentials on the WorkPlace login page using a
virtual keyboard, click Enable virtual keyboard. When this setting is enabled, all WorkPlace
users, regardless of login realm, have this option. To require users to enter their credentials
with the virtual keyboard, click Require use of keyboard.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
283
Configuring Data Protection
OPSWAT Secure Desktop Emulator (SDE) is part of Advanced EPC, which is included with the EX2500 and EX7000, and is an optional component—purchased and licensed separately—on the other
appliance models.
Cache Cleaner is included with your appliance license.
About Secure Desktop Emulator
When SDE is enabled, the SDE desktop appears after the user logs into WorkPlace. The SDE icon is
displayed in the taskbar notification area, and the WorkPlace login page opens in a new browser
window in the SDE desktop. The SDE desktop features a distinctive background color and image,
making the virtual session created by SDE easily distinguished from other sessions.
The user accesses network resources as needed. The user can launch new browser windows and
browser plug-ins, and locally installed applications via file association. The user can save data to
files within the SDE session for purposes of uploading.
The user can download and install new programs within the context of the desktop emulator. Any
program installed that way shall only be accessible within the desktop emulator window. All data
transferred to the client file system via the WorkPlace portal session is protected from access by
any application running outside the SDE session. This prevents opening the file outside the context
of the desktop emulator.
If enabled by the administrator, the user can switch between the desktop emulator and the normal
desktop.
When the user is ready to end the WorkPlace session, he or she terminates the WorkPlace session,
either by clicking the Log out link on the portal page, by closing the browser window that contains
the portal page, or by ending the desktop emulator program.
The session can also end if the mouse & keyboard inactivity timeout expires.
When the session ends, SDE permanently removes all data downloaded from the VPN, including
session-related data files downloaded and stored on the local hard disk, plus any temporary data
associated with the Web browser. The data is obfuscated by writing random or “zeroed” data over
it. All applications open within the desktop emulator are terminated. Any programs installed via SDE
are removed from the end point system.
Because SDE permanently removes all session-related data files from the local hard disk, you
should instruct users not to save any data to their local disk when working with SDE. Examples
include:
z
Don't save files to the local disk. For example, if a user downloads a file from your network
and saves it to a local hard disk, it will be deleted when the session ends.
z
Don't save application data to the local disk. Some client/server applications (such as
Microsoft Outlook) allow users to store data locally. Users should be aware of the interaction
between these applications and SDE. For example, if an Outlook user is storing data locally (in
a .pst file) and moves an email message from the system Inbox to a local mail folder while SDE
is running, the message will be deleted from the local disk when the session ends.
About Cache Cleaner
When Cache Cleaner is enabled and the user logs into WorkPlace, the Cache Cleaner icon appears
in the taskbar notification area. Users can access network resources as needed.
When the user ends the Cache Cleaner session, Cache Cleaner deletes all data associated with the
session. All browser windows are closed by Cache Cleaner upon logout. A dialog box warns users
that all browser windows will be closed on logout.
284
|
Chapter 8 - End Point Control
Notes
z
Because Cache Cleaner closes all browser windows on logout, make sure your users are aware:
if someone is filling out a form, for example, anything that isn’t submitted when the browser
window closes will be lost.
Configuring Data Protection Settings
X
To configure data protection in Aventail WorkPlace
1. From the main navigation menu, click Agent Configuration and then, in the Data
Protection area, click Edit. The Configure Data Protection page appears.
2. In the End inactive user connections list, select a timeout to automatically end inactive
user connections and remove data from the client. This minimizes your exposure in case a
user forgets to log out from a kiosk or other shared computer.
3. Select the Enable Cache Cleaner check box to clean the user’s browser cache after each
session. Cache Cleaner is not supported on Linux platforms.
4. To allow the user to close Cache Cleaner and bypass the cache-cleaning function, select the
Allow user to disable Cache Cleaner check box.
5. Specify whether all browser items should be cleared, or just those related to the current
session: Clean session items only or Clean all items.
6. To enable OPSWAT Secure Desktop Emulator (SDE), select the Enable Secure Desktop
Emulator check box. SDE cleans the browser cache and removes all files from the local file
system after each user session. It is available only on selected Windows environments.
7. To allow the user to switch between the normal Windows session and the virtual session
created by SSD, select the Allow user to switch between desktops check box. Enabling
this option slightly weakens the data protection provided by SDE (for example, it means that
the user could use the clipboard to copy data between sessions, or copy data to removable
media).
8. Click Save.
9. Apply the pending changes.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
285
Chapter 9
The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
The Aventail WorkPlace portal provides your users with dynamically personalized access to Webbased (HTTP) resources. It also gives users access from their Web browsers to files and folders on
Windows file servers, and to TCP/IP resources through SonicWALL agents that can be provisioned
from WorkPlace.
The SonicWALL appliance includes a default WorkPlace portal that you can modify. Additional sites
can be set up for different user populations, each with its own appearance; see “WorkPlace Sites”
on page 298 for more information. For details on client system requirements for WorkPlace, see
“System Requirements” on page 7.
A Quick Tour of Aventail WorkPlace
When a user accesses Aventail WorkPlace, the login page appears. In this example, the
administrator has configured the WorkPlace site to have a different login page appearance and to
give users a list of realms from which to choose.
286
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
The user is then prompted to specify authentication credentials. Users authenticating with client
certificates do not see this page.
You can require users to enter
credentials with the virtual keyboard
(for security), or make it optional.
When authenticating against an
Active Directory or LDAP server,
you can offer users the opportunity
to change passwords.
If you’ve configured the system to use End Point Control, see “End Point Control and the User
Experience” on page 314 for information on how it affects the way users access the system.
Home Page
After a user has authenticated, the Aventail WorkPlace home page appears. In this example, the
administrator has customized the logo and greeting text (the WorkPlace style) and organized the
shortcuts into columns and groups (the WorkPlace layout).
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
287
Configurable WorkPlace Elements
Most of the features on the home page are configurable:
WorkPlace element Description
Layout
WorkPlace page content and layout can be customized on a percommunity basis. These layout elements include:
z
Content (what shortcuts and shortcut groups are displayed)
z
Pages (single vs. multiple)
z
Columns (single vs. multiple)
z
Navigation (on the left or along the top)
See “Modifying the Appearance of WorkPlace” on page 302 for details.
Shortcuts
Shortcut groups
These are administrator-defined shortcuts to the Web, file system, and
terminal server resources that the user is allowed to access. Shortcuts are
dynamically displayed based on your access policy: each user sees only
those resources he or she has privileges to use.
Each type of shortcut behaves differently:
z
Web resource: Opens in a new browser window.
z
Terminal server resource: Opens in a new browser window and the
appropriate graphical terminal agent is automatically started or, if
necessary, provisioned.
z
Shared folder or file: Opens the WorkPlace Network Explorer page,
which appears in a new browser window. Network shortcuts, which
point to file system resources, do not appear if you have disabled all
access to file system resources (disabling access to file system
resources is described in “Configuring WorkPlace General Settings” on
page 291).
For information about creating shortcuts, see “Working with WorkPlace
Shortcuts” on page 292.
Help button
The Help system included with WorkPlace contains all the basic
information that a user will need. If you would like to make a custom
HTML help file available to users instead, you can specify it when you
confiigure your WorkPlace style. This is a convenient way to add
information that is unique to your environment (for example, information
about the resources available on your VPN, and technical support details).
This file must be a well-formed, single HTML file.
Built-In WorkPlace Elements
When you set up a WorkPlace portal for users, you can choose from among several built-in
resources and WorkPlace elements. Whether you offer these resources can be configured on a percommunity basis.
WorkPlace element Description
Intranet Address
You can specify whether you want this box to appear and configure
whether it can be used to access Web resources (by typing a URL), file
system resources (by typing a UNC path name), or both.
See “Intranet Address Box” on page 289 for details.
Personal
Bookmarks
You can allow users to create and manage personal links (similar to
bookmarks) that point to URLs and other resources, such as SMB hosts,
protected by the SonicWALL appliance. Personal links are stored on the
appliance; users have access to them whenever they are logged in to
WorkPlace, regardless of the computer they are using.
See “Bookmarks” on page 289 for more information.
288
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
WorkPlace element Description
Connect Tunnel
You can make the built-in Install Connect Tunnel shortcut available to
enable users to download and install the Connect Tunnel client from the
WorkPlace portal.
Network Explorer
You can offer users the ability to browse a Windows network containing
shared folders and files.
See “Network Explorer Page” on page 290 for more information.
WorkPlace Status Bar
The WorkPlace pages have a status bar indicating the following:
WorkPlace element Description
Access
Indicates which user access methods are currently running.
For more information about user access agents, see “User Access
Components and Services” on page 317.
User
The username used during login.
Session start
The time at which the current session began, in 24-hour format.
Log out button
Users can log out of WorkPlace using this button, but this does not
necessarily log them out of any applications that are running (depending
on which user access agent is being used). To increase security, users
should log out of or quit applications when they finish working with them,
particularly when working on computers that are shared with other users.
Details
Users can click this button for system status information (not items appear
for all users):
z
Zone: Security zones are used to allow or deny access to members of
each community.
z
Realm: A realm allows users to authenticate using credentials stored
on an external authentication server.
z
Community: Communities allow you to group realm members based
on different security needs.
z
Data protection: Cache Cleaner or Secure Desktop Emulator, which
is part of Advanced EPC.
Notes
z
For users accessing WorkPlace on small form factor devices, the WorkPlace appearance varies
depending on the capabilities of the device. For more information, see “End Point Control and
the User Experience” on page 314.
z
On Windows systems, using browser toolbars with popup blocking enabled may prevent
WorkPlace from closing any open Network Explorer and graphical terminal session windows
when the main WorkPlace window is closed.
z
Logging out of Outlook Web Access (OWA) during a WorkPlace session also logs the user out of
WorkPlace. This is because the OWA logoff script clears all browser cookies, including the one
used by WorkPlace. Users can simply close the browser window instead of logging out of OWA
to work around this issue.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
289
Intranet Address Box
If enabled, the Intranet Address box appears along the bottom of the WorkPlace page, except on
small form factor devices, and gives users an alternate method to access Web resources, Windows
network resources, and terminal servers.
When you set up communities within a realm (for example, a community of employees and one of
partners), you can give each one a unique appearance, using WorkPlace styles and layouts. The
WorkPlace layout determines whether the Intranet Address box is displayed for a particular
community. See “Creating or Editing a WorkPlace Layout” on page 304 for more information.
Configuring the functionality of the Intranet Address box is a global configuration setting.
Depending on the configuration, users can type URLs to reach Web resources if WorkPlace is running
in translated mode, or they can type UNC paths to reach file system resources. (If WorkPlace is
running in non-translated mode, users can type URLs directly in the Internet Explorer Address
box.) This is especially useful if you have defined an entire DNS or Windows domain as a resource
and want to give a group of users direct access to all the resources in that domain.
To access a Web resource or terminal server when WorkPlace is running in translated mode, the
user types the URL in the Intranet Address box and then clicks Go. If the user has appropriate
access privileges, the resource then opens in a new browser window.
The Intranet Address box accepts a variety of user input for accessing Web resources and
terminal servers. Here are some guidelines:
Element
Description
Resource address
A user can access a resource by typing a complete URL (domain and host
name) or just a host name. For example, a user could access a resource
named “CRM” on a host named “fred” using a full URL (such as
http://fred.example.com/CRM/) or a host name (such as http://fred/CRM/
or fred/CRM/).
UNC path
To access a file system resource, the user types the UNC path (for example,
\\jax\software\download) in the Intranet Address box and then clicks Go.
If the user has appropriate access privileges, the Network Explorer page
appears, displaying the contents of the requested file system resource.
Protocol
The user does not need to include the http:// protocol identifier to access a
standard Web resource. To access a secure Web site, however, the user must
include the https:// protocol identifier.
When specifying a terminal server resource name, users must include the
appropriate protocol identifier in the URL. Supported terminal server types
are Windows Terminal Services, which uses the rdp:// identifier, and Citrix,
which uses citrix://.
Port number
To access a Web resource on a non-standard port (that is, other than 80),
the user must type the port number after the host name. For example,
fred:8080/SAP and https://fred:443/SAP are both valid entries.
For information about configuring the Intranet Address box to allow access to UNC pathnames,
URLs, or both, see “Configuring WorkPlace General Settings” on page 291.
Bookmarks
You can allow users to create personal links in WorkPlace for quick access to any resources that they
have privileges to use, such as URLs or SMB hosts.
290
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
WorkPlace personal links are similar to Web browser bookmarks or favorites lists except that they
are stored on the SonicWALL Aventail -appliance, while standard browser bookmarks are stored on
a specific computer. Users can access and manage their WorkPlace personal links whenever they
are logged in to WorkPlace, regardless of the computer they are using.
When you set up communities within a realm (for example, a community of employees and one of
partners), you can give each one a unique appearance, using WorkPlace styles and layouts. The
WorkPlace layout determines whether the Personal Bookmarks group is displayed for a particular
community. See “Creating or Editing a WorkPlace Layout” on page 304 for more information.
Notes
z
To access non-HTTP resources (for example, an SMB host) through WorkPlace bookmarks, users
must be running an access agent, such as one of the tunnel clients. For more information, see
“User Access Agents” on page 317.
Network Explorer Page
When a user accesses a file system resource (by clicking a network shortcut, typing a UNC path in
the Intranet Address box, or clicking the Network Explorer link on the WorkPlace home page),
the Network Explorer page appears. The Network Explorer page is not available on small form factor
devices.
This page displays the contents of the requested file system resource and, depending on the user’s
access privileges, allows the user to perform the following actions on a file:
z
View contents and properties, rename, copy, move, download, and delete.
z
Create new folders.
z
If the administrator has enabled upload functionality, and the user has write privileges, the user
can upload files. See “Configuring WorkPlace General Settings” on page 291 for more
information.
When you set up communities within a realm (for example, a community of employees and one of
partners), you can give each one a unique appearance, using WorkPlace styles and layouts. The
WorkPlace layout determines whether the Personal Bookmarks group is displayed for a particular
community. See “Creating or Editing a WorkPlace Layout” on page 304 for more information.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
291
Web Shortcut Access
The SonicWALL appliance offers two options for providing access to basic Web (HTTP) resources
through WorkPlace shortcuts for users who are running the OnDemand Tunnel agent:
z
Redirect through network agent: When this method is enabled, Web content is proxied
through the appliance for users running the OnDemand Tunnel agent, provided that the agent
is loaded. In this method, Web traffic from Workplace links does not use translation, does not
support single sign-on, and does not use URL-based rules to control access. However, this
method generally provides better application compatibility than the Web content translation
option does.
If you enable this setting, you can optionally configure selected WorkPlace resources to be
translated by defining aliases for those specified resources. You can also enforce policy at the
URL level and support single sign-on using this approach. For more information, see “Adding
Web Application Profiles” on page 140.
z
Web content translation: Web content is translated using the SonicWALL Web translation
engine, a reverse proxy that provides single sign-on and fine-grained access control. When this
method is enabled, you can provide single sign-on and use URL-based rules to control access;
however, this method provides more limited application compatibility than the Redirect
through network agent option does. To provide single sign-on, you must specify an alias to
the resource; for more information, see “Adding Resources” on page 119.
The Web shortcut access method you choose will depend on several factors, including the network
protocols used by your applications, your security requirements, convenience for end users, and
the target platforms. This option is configured on the Aventail WorkPlace Settings page.
Configuring WorkPlace General Settings
This section describes how to configure the Aventail WorkPlace general settings that apply to any
WorkPlace site that you create. You decide here whether to enable access to UNC pathnames, URLs,
or both in the Intranet Address box, but your WorkPlace layout determines whether the Intranet
Address box is displayed for a particular community.
You can customize WorkPlace to varying degrees:
z
You can modify the appearance of WorkPlace by setting up a style that uses a particular logo,
color scheme, and greeting text. For a consistent look, this same style can be specified for the
site’s login, error, and notification pages. See “WorkPlace Sites” on page 298 for more
information.
z
For sites that require even more control over the look and feel of WorkPlace, see “Fully
Customizing WorkPlace Pages” on page 310.
X
To configure Aventail WorkPlace general settings
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services and then, in the Access services section,
under Aventail WorkPlace, click Configure. The Settings tab for Aventail WorkPlace
appears.
2. Select one of the Web shortcut access options. This setting determines how URL resources
are accessed if WorkPlace activates the tunnel agent. For information about these options, see
“Web Shortcut Access” on page 291.
{
Redirect through network agent: Web content is proxied through the appliance for
users running the OnDemand Tunnel agent.
{
Use Web content translation: Web content is translated using the SonicWALL Aventail
Web translation engine.
3. If the layout specified for your WorkPlace site includes the Network Explorer resource, users
will have access to file system resources from the Network Explorer page in WorkPlace. Select
Enable file uploads to < > megabytes to enable users to upload files to a Windows file
system resource. This setting takes precedence over any permissions you set in a file system
access control rule. If an access rule grants a user write access to a file system but file uploads
are disabled for the WorkPlace service, the user can only move and delete files, not write to
them.
292
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
A single file upload cannot exceed the number of megabytes you specify. Enabling users to
upload large files may have a negative effect on the performance of the appliance.
4. In the Intranet Address box area, specify settings that control the functionality of the
Intranet Address box in WorkPlace. (Whether the Intranet Address box is available is
specified in your WorkPlace layout and also depends on your device: it cannot be displayed on
mobile devices.)
Select Enable access to UNC pathnames and Enable access to URLs if you want to enable
users to reach a Web resource by typing its UNC pathname or URL in the Intranet Address
box on WorkPlace. This can be useful if, for example, you have defined an entire DNS domain
as a resource and want to provide access to all Web servers within the domain without
needing to define each individual Web resource in the domain. This setting applies only when
WorkPlace is running in translated mode.
For information about defining Web resources, see “Adding Resources” on page 119.
Notes
z
The settings that you specify in the Intranet Address box have no effect on your access
control policy. For a detailed discussion of this feature, see “Intranet Address Box” on page 289.
z
If you are concerned that user credentials may be stolen, you can offer (or require) that users
logging in to WorkPlace provide their credentials by pointing to characters on a keyboard display
instead of typing them. See “Using the Virtual Keyboard to Enter Credentials” on page 282 for
more information.
Working with WorkPlace Shortcuts
Aventail WorkPlace enables users with appropriate access privileges to use a Web browser to access
Web resources, terminal servers, and files and folders on a Windows file server. Even though you
may have defined your resources in AMC, none of them appear in WorkPlace until you create
corresponding shortcuts. This section explains how to create and manage the shortcuts and
shortcut groups in Aventail WorkPlace.
For information about enabling access to file system resources, file uploads, and the Intranet
Address box, see “Configuring WorkPlace General Settings” on page 291.
Viewing Shortcuts
As the administrator, you see the entire list of shortcuts you have configured in AMC; however, when
a user logs into Aventail WorkPlace, the list is filtered to display only the resources that he or she
has permission to use, based on your policy and the type of device for which the shortcut is enabled.
All types of shortcuts (Web, network, and graphical terminal) and groups of shortcuts are displayed
in AMC and WorkPlace. How they are laid out is determined by the WorkPlace layout in use for a
given community.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
293
To view shortcuts in AMC
1. From the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace.
2. Optionally use the Filters settings to display only the objects you are interested in. For
information about using filters, see the “Filters” section under “A Quick Tour of the AMC
Interface” on page 38.
3. Review the data in the Shortcuts list:
X
{
Use the check boxes to select the shortcuts you want to move or delete.
{
To display configuration details about a shortcut, click the plus sign (+) next to it. You’ll
see what shortcut group it belongs to, if any, whether it is restricted by device type, and
the names of any WorkPlace layouts to which it belongs.
{
The number indicates the order in which the shortcut is listed in Aventail WorkPlace; you
can change this order here, or edit the list of shortcuts associated with a layout on the
Configure WorkPlace Layout page. For more information about changing a layout, see
“Creating or Editing a WorkPlace Layout” on page 304.
{
The Link text column displays the hyperlink text that users see.
{
The Resource column displays the name of the resource as defined on the Resources
page in AMC. For more information about configuring resources, see “Creating and
Managing Resources” on page 115.
{
The Type column indicates the type of shortcut. The supported shortcut types are Web,
network, and graphical terminal.
{
The Used column indicates whether the shortcut is included in a group or WorkPlace
layout.
To view shortcut groups in AMC
1. From the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace.
294
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
2. Click the Shortcut Groups tab.
3. Optionally use the Filters settings to display only the objects you are interested in. For
information about using filters, see the “Filters” section under “A Quick Tour of the AMC
Interface” on page 38.
4. Review the data in the list of groups:
{
Use the check boxes to select the groups you want to move or delete.
{
To display configuration details about a shortcut group, click the plus sign (+) next to it.
You’ll see what shortcuts it includes, and the names of any WorkPlace layouts to which it
belongs.
{
The number indicates the order in which the shortcut group is listed in Aventail WorkPlace;
you can change this order here, or edit the list of groups associated with a layout on the
Configure WorkPlace Layout page.
{
The Name column displays the group heading that users see.
{
The Description column contains the description, if any, that you gave this group.
{
The Used column indicates whether the shortcut group is used by a WorkPlace layout.
Adding Web Shortcuts
Web shortcuts give your users quick access to Web resources. Before you can create a shortcut to
a Web resource, you must first define the resource; for more information, see “Adding Resources”
on page 119.
X
To add a Web shortcut
1. From the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
295
2. On the Shortcuts page, click New, and then select Web shortcut from the list. The Add Web
Shortcut page appears.
3. In the Position box, type a number that specifies the shortcut’s position in the list.
4. In the Resource list, select the resource to which this shortcut will be linked. This list contains
the available URL resources that are defined on the Resources page in AMC. (For more
information about defining resources, see “Creating and Managing Resources” on page 115.)
5. Specify the link and descriptive text that users will see in WorkPlace. The entries can include
variables to make them even more user- or session-specific; see “Using Variables in Resource
and WorkPlace Shortcut Definitions” on page 130 for more information.
{
In the Link text box, type the hyperlink text that users will click to access the Web
resource. The Link text should be no longer than 25 characters.
{
In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the shortcut. Although
optional, a description helps users identify the Web resource. The comment appears next
to the link.
6. To specify additional options, click Next. The Advanced tab of the Add Web Shortcut page
appears.
7. Under Make link available to these devices, associate the WorkPlace shortcut with the
device types that can be used to access it:
296
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
{
If you select All devices, the shortcut will appear on all devices types, regardless of
whether the Web resource itself is supported on all device types.
{
To restrict display of the shortcut to only certain types of devices, clear the All devices
check box, and then select just the device types that are supported.
For example, WorkPlace supports a variety of small form factor devices, but not all Web
resources are compatible with all devices. Outlook Web Access is available only on
standard browsers, while Outlook Mobile is available only on small form factor devices. So
if you have Outlook Mobile set up as a resource, you should select both the basic and
advanced mobile devices.
8. Use the Start page box, if necessary, to append more specific information to the selected
URL. For example, if you want the link to point to a directory or file other than the root, type a
relative path in the Start page box.
This is useful for Web applications that store their content in a location other than the root. For
example, if the selected URL is for Outlook Web Access and it points to mail.example.com, you
could set the start page to /exchange/root.asp. The resulting URL would be
https://mail.example.com/exchange/root.asp.
9. Use the Shortcut group area to either add this shortcut to an existing group, or put it in a
new one. Groups are one of the organizational elements in a WorkPlace layout. You could, for
example, put all of the client downloads for users in a group, and then (on the Configure
WorkPlace Layout page) put the group in a column or on its own WorkPlace page.
Creating a Group of Shortcuts
You can group Web and network shortcuts together for better WorkPlace organization and a more
streamlined look. The WorkPlace user has the option of collapsing a group of file shares. Here is a
collapsed group for example:
The expanded group might look like this:
Users see only the groups to which they are permitted access. To create a group, you select from
among existing WorkPlace shortcuts (not resources). Shortcuts can be members of more than one
group.
X
To create a group of shortcuts
1. From the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace.
2. On the Shortcut Groups tab, click New.
3. Enter a name and (optionally) a description for the group. The description appears below the
group’s name in WorkPlace. In the example above, Domain and stand-alone shares is the
description.
4. In the Position box, type a number that specifies the shortcut group’s position in the list. The
order of shortcuts and groups can be changed later in the layout you choose for this WorkPlace
site, on the Configure WorkPlace Layout page.
5. Existing shortcuts are listed: select the ones that you want to add to this group, and then click
Save. An individual shortcut can be a member of more than one group. You can also opt to
save an empty group (without any shortcuts selected), and then edit it later.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
297
Adding Network Shortcuts
Network shortcuts provide your users with quick access to file system resources. Before you can
create a shortcut to a file system resource, you must first define the resource (see “Adding
Resources” on page 119 for more information).
X
To add a network shortcut
1. From the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace.
2. On the Shortcuts page, click New, and then select Network shortcut from the list.
3. In the Position box, type a number that specifies the shortcut’s position in the list.
4. In the Resource list, select the file system resource to which this shortcut should be linked.
This list contains the file system resources that are defined on the Resources page in AMC;
Network Explorer, for example, is a built-in resource for which you can configure a shortcut
here. For more information about defining resources, see “Creating and Managing Resources”
on page 115.
5. Specify the link and descriptive text that users will see in WorkPlace. The entries can include
variables to make them even more user- or session-specific.
{
In the Link text box, type the hyperlink text that users will click to access the file system
resource. The Link text should be no longer than 25 characters.
{
In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the shortcut. Although
optional, a description helps users identify the file system resource. This comment appears
beside the link in Aventail WorkPlace.
6. Groups are one of the organizational elements in a WorkPlace layout. Use the Shortcut group
area to either add this shortcut to an existing group, or put it in a new one. You could, for
example, put all of the file system-related shortcuts in a group, and then (on the Configure
WorkPlace Layout page) put the group in a column or on its own WorkPlace page.
Editing Shortcuts
You can create new WorkPlace shortcuts when defining resources, but to edit or delete them you
must use the Shortcuts page.
X
To edit a shortcut
1. From the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace.
2. Click the number or the link text of the shortcut that you want to edit.
3. Make edits as needed, and then click Save.
298
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
If you delete a shortcut, users will no longer see it in Aventail WorkPlace. To delete a shortcut, you
must use the Shortcuts page.
X
To delete a shortcut
1. From the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace.
2. Select the check box to the left of any shortcuts that you want to delete, and then click
Delete. Deleting a shortcut does not delete the resource to which it refers.
Aventail WorkPlace displays the list of shortcuts in the same order as they appear on the Shortcuts
page. You can move one or more shortcuts at the same time. The order of shortcuts (and groups
of shortcuts) can be changed later in the layout you choose for your WorkPlace site, on the
Configure WorkPlace Layout page.
X
To move one or more shortcuts
1. From the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace.
2. Select the check box to the left of any shortcuts that you want to move.
3. Click Move Up or Move Down as appropriate. Each click of the button moves the selected
shortcuts up or down one row.
To reorder an individual WorkPlace shortcut, an alternative method is to click its number or link text
and then type its new list position in the Position box.
WorkPlace Sites
You can create multiple WorkPlace sites for different user segments, such as employees, business
partners, and suppliers. Each site can have a unique external URL and a unique appearance, or
bypass the WorkPlace portal and redirect the user to a different start page.
For example, you could create a WorkPlace site for your employees with a customized title and logo,
and a URL of http://employees.headquarters.com, and create a different site for your partners at
http://partners.subsidiary.com. If you create multiple WorkPlace sites with unique external URLs,
you can import a wildcard certificate to the appliance and designate it as the server certificate for
multiple WorkPlace sites, or procure a separate SSL certificate for each site whose FQDN is different
from the appliance’s domain name. For more information, see “Certificates” on page 66.
Optionally, if you have configured multiple realms, you can associate a WorkPlace site with a realm;
this enables users to bypass the portion of the authentication process in which they would normally
specify a realm to log in to. If you associate a WorkPlace site with a realm, users cannot select a
different realm to log in to; a user who does not belong to the specified realm cannot log in to the
specified WorkPlace site.
You can customize the following components of Aventail WorkPlace:
z
Company logo
z
WorkPlace title
z
Greeting at top of page
z
Color scheme
z
Help file
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
z
|
299
Font family
WorkPlace title
Custom URL
Link to custom help file
Company
logo
Greeting
Navigation: tabs
or side menu
Personal
Bookmarks
Shortcut group
(collapsible)
One- or twocolumn layout
Intranet box: an additional way to access resources
You can have users bypass the WorkPlace portal and go directly to a different start page, provided
that the realm they log in to allows translated, custom port mapped, or custom FQDN mapped Web
access exclusively. See “Adding WorkPlace Sites” on page 299 for more information.
The URL a user types to log in to Aventail WorkPlace is preceded by the http:// protocol identifier.
The Web session is then redirected to a site that uses secure HTTP (HTTPS) and uses the https://
protocol identifier.
Notes
z
If you do not specify a custom WorkPlace site, or if users access the appliance using its default
name, the default WorkPlace site is automatically used.
z
Rather than creating a new WorkPlace site from scratch, you can save time by making a copy
of an existing site and changing some parameters to fit the new site. For information about
copying a WorkPlace site, see “Adding, Editing, Copying, and Deleting Objects in AMC” on
page 43.
z
You can delete a WorkPlace site if you no longer need it, but you cannot delete the default
WorkPlace site. For information about deleting WorkPlace sites, see “Adding, Editing, Copying,
and Deleting Objects in AMC” on page 43.
Adding WorkPlace Sites
AMC includes a preconfigured default WorkPlace site. You can create additional WorkPlace sites as
needed; this section describes how to do so.
You can make WorkPlace look different, on a per-community basis, if you set up different styles and
layouts. For more information, see “Modifying the Appearance of WorkPlace” on page 302. For
information about configuring WorkPlace sites for small form factor devices, see “WorkPlace and
Small Form Factor Devices” on page 305.
The fully qualified domain name (FQDN) for the WorkPlace site can include one of the following:
z
A host within the same domain name as the SonicWALL appliance. Optionally, you can configure
a separate SSL certificate for this type of site.
300
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
z
A custom FQDN. This option can use a wildcard SSL certificate when its IP address is the same
as another WorkPlace site that uses the wildcard certificate, or you can use a separate SSL
certificate for the site. Before creating the site, you must obtain the certificate. For more
information, see “Certificates” on page 66.
In either case, you must communicate the external FQDN to users so they know how to access
WorkPlace. You must also add this FQDN to your public DNS.
X
To add a WorkPlace site
1. On the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace, and then click the WorkPlace
Sites tab.
2. Click New. The Configure WorkPlace Site page opens with the General settings displayed.
3. In the Name box, type a unique name for the WorkPlace site.
4. (Optional) In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the WorkPlace site.
5. Specify the Fully qualified domain name settings:
{
If the WorkPlace site will have the same domain as the appliance, click Custom host
name only and then type the host portion of the FQDN. Users will type this name,
prefixed with http://, to access WorkPlace.
{
If the WorkPlace site will have a custom URL (so that it can have its own “branding,” for
example), click Custom FQDN and then type an FQDN (for example,
vars.partnersite.com).
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
301
6. If you select the Custom FQDN option, additional settings are required. When using wildcard
certificates, multiple Workplace sites can share the same IP address and certificate.
a. In the IP address drop-down list, either select an existing IP address or select (New)
and type the IP address in dotted decimal form (w.x.y.z) for the WorkPlace site into the
New IP address field. A new address must be on the same subnet as the external
interface; in addition, the address must not be in use elsewhere. You can also select the
existing IP address of either the appliance, another WorkPlace site, or a custom FQDN
mapped resource, if the appliance, site, or resource uses a wildcard certificate (for
example, *.sonicwall.com).
b. Specify the certificate you want to use for this site: you can select an unused certificate in
the SSL Certificate list, which contains all of the certificates configured for the appliance,
or select (New) to add it. You can also select an existing wildcard certificate already
associated with either the appliance, another custom WorkPlace site, or a custom FQDN
mapped resource. When an existing IP address is selected from the IP Address dropdown list, the SSL certificate that goes with that IP address will be automatically selected
in the SSL Certificate drop-down list. For more information on adding and importing
certificates, see “CA Certificates” on page 73.
c. Type the name of your company or organization into the Organization field.
d. Type the 2-letter abbreviation for your country into the Country field.
If the host name or IP address on the certificate does not match the Custom FQDN or IP
address that you specified for this site, a security warning is displayed when users access the
site.
7. Select a style—which includes the logo, color scheme, and text—for the WorkPlace login page.
The style and layout for other WorkPlace portal pages is specified during community
configuration; see “Modifying the Appearance of WorkPlace” on page 302 for information on
modifying or creating a style.
8. Click Next to open the Advanced page.
9. In the Realm area, select one of these options:
{
Log in using this realm: Users are not prompted to select a realm, and only members of
the specified realm can access the WorkPlace site.
{
Prompt user for realm: Offer users a list of realms from which to choose. You can offer
them all of the configured realms, or clear the All realms selection and choose the ones
302
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
that should be in the list. Any authorized user can access the WorkPlace site after selecting
a realm during login.
10. In the Start page area, select Display this page after authentication if you want users to
bypass the default WorkPlace home page after authentication. For example, if you have
someone who will submit content using a Web-based content management system, this
setting allows you to present the writer with the CMS interface immediately after he or she
logs in.
This setting is available only if the realm specified in the Realm area offers translated, custom
port mapped, or custom FQDN mapped Web access exclusively. The URL you enter in this text
box will be automatically prefixed with http://. If this is a URL for a secure site, you must
include the https:// protocol identifier.
If you specify an alternate page for users and they bypass the default WorkPlace portal, the
user's session is valid as long as the browser window is open, or until the session times out.
Unlike the WorkPlace portal, the alternate page will not include a Log out option.
11. Click Finish to save your WorkPlace site settings.
Note
z
You can enter a URL alias in the Start page area (if you don’t want users to see the complete
URL in WorkPlace), provided that you create a URL resource for it. For example, if you define a
URL resource as http://intranet.mycompany.com with an alias of intranet, you can specify
the start page for WorkPlace here simply with intranet (or a more specific path, such as
intranet/some/path). When users authenticate, they are redirected to
https://<appliance>/intranet or https://<appliance>/intranet/some/path.
Modifying the Appearance of WorkPlace
When you create a new WorkPlace site, you have control over the look-and-feel of the pages and
the organization of resource shortcuts and other elements, such as intranet browsing and Network
Explorer. The appearance of WorkPlace is controlled by the following design elements, which can be
created and reused:
z
A WorkPlace style determines the color scheme, fonts, and images used in WorkPlace. A style
can be applied to two groups of pages: those that contain user resources, and the login, error,
and notification pages.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
303
An important thing to remember is that WorkPlace login, error, and notification pages are
assigned a style when you configure a WorkPlace site (see “Adding WorkPlace Sites” on
page 299 for more information), and the portal pages are assigned a style when you configure
a community (see “Creating and Configuring Communities” on page 166 for more
information).
z
A WorkPlace layout determines elements like WorkPlace navigation, the number of columns on
a page, whether users see the Intranet Address box, and which shortcuts appear and how
they are arranged. A layout applies only to WorkPlace resource pages.
If your site requires a complete overhaul of the way WorkPlace looks and you are familiar with
creating Web content and style sheets (.css), you can upload a complete style to the appliance and
then select it when you create your site and assign it a style. See “Fully Customizing WorkPlace
Pages” on page 310 for more information. To do further customization—for example, to insert a use
agreement into the login process—see “Overview: Custom WorkPlace Templates” on page 311.
Notes
z
The Default Style and Default Layout for WorkPlace cannot be deleted.
Creating or Editing a WorkPlace Style
X
To create a new WorkPlace style
1. On the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace, and then click the Appearance
tab.
2. In the Styles area, choose an existing style to base your new one on (select its check box,
and then click Copy), or click New.
3. In the Name box, type a unique name for the WorkPlace style.
4. (Optional) In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the style.
5. In the Font family list, select the type of font you want to use (Serif or Sans-serif).
6. In the Color scheme list, click the name of the color scheme you want to use. If you select
Custom, you can set custom colors for the WorkPlace Page background, Subheadings, and
Main heading. Specify color settings by typing the applicable hexadecimal RGB value, or by
clicking a color swatch and then selecting a color from the Please choose a color dialog box.
7. To replace the SonicWALL Aventail logo that is displayed in WorkPlace with a different image,
use the Replace with box to enter or browse for the .gif or .jpg file you want to use. For best
results, the image should not exceed 200 pixels wide by 50 pixels high.
304
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
8. When Display gradient background behind logo is selected, the accent color of your Color
scheme is displayed at the top of each WorkPlace page, gradually going from dark (at the top
of the page) to light. Any heading that you have appears in white.
9. On small form factor devices, the logo specified in the Images area is resized by default, but
for best results you may want to specify an alternate image that does not exceed 40 pixels by
100 pixels. Type the path of the image file, or click the Browse button to select the image file
you want to use. The logo is automatically omitted from WAP and i-mode devices, so this
setting does not affect the display on those devices.
10. In the Title box, type the text that will appear as the title on the page and in the browser’s
title bar. The title must be no longer than 25 characters.
11. In the Greeting box, type the introductory text that should appear below the title. The
greeting must not exceed 250 characters, but you may want to use a shorter one, especially if
you want it to appear on small form factor devices.
12. To further assist the user, you could specify a custom Help file that provides more detailed
information about the resources available on your VPN, or describe how to get technical
support. Click Browse to specify a well-formed HTML file that contains custom Help
information. Your custom Help content is integrated with the default WorkPlace Help system.
To make changes to your custom help content, edit the file locally and upload it to the
appliance again.
13. Click Save to save your WorkPlace site settings, or click Reset Defaults to restore the
factory-default settings.
Creating or Editing a WorkPlace Layout
X
To create a new WorkPlace layout
1. On the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace, and then click the Appearance
tab.
2. In the Layouts area, click New.
3. In the Name box, type a unique name for the WorkPlace layout.
4. (Optional) In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the layout.
5. In the Initial content area, select a layout for your current WorkPlace content (any shortcuts
and shortcut groups that you’ve defined), or choose to set up an initial structure for your
content and add WorkPlace resources later. No matter how you decide to lay out your initial
content, you can change it later by adding, removing, or rearranging pages and page content.
6. In the Page navigation area, specify the kind of navigation controls that will be displayed if
your content requires more than one page.
7. Specify whether the Intranet Address box will be displayed when this layout is used. It gives
users access to resources by typing a resource name (a UNC path, URL, or both). Click Next.
8. Click the Edit page properties link to change the basic properties of this WorkPlace page: its
name (for example, Home) and a short description.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
305
9. Use the page, column, and shortcut controls to add pages, content, and rearrange the
elements on each page. Rearranging items in a layout or deleting them from a layout does not
affect the resource itself, just its appearance in WorkPlace.
10. Click Next to move to the Device Preview page. This page allows you to see how your layout
will appear on different types of devices with different display capabilities. On a mobile device,
for example, the Intranet Address box cannot be displayed, even if it is configured to be part
of a layout.
WorkPlace and Small Form Factor Devices
WorkPlace provides support for a variety of small form factor devices, including PDAs, Pocket PCs,
smartphones, WAP 2.0-compatible phones, and i-mode phones. This section explains how to
configure the appliance to support these devices.
Overview: WorkPlace and Small Form Factor Devices
When a user logs in to WorkPlace from a small form factor device, WorkPlace detects the device
type and automatically transforms to best match the capabilities of the client device. This
transformation affects several aspects of the user experience:
z
z
WorkPlace functionality: Some WorkPlace features that are available from a standard
desktop browser are omitted on small form factor devices:
{
The Network Explorer page is not available for accessing network shares.
{
The Intranet Address box is not available for typing a URL or UNC path name.
{
WorkPlace bookmarks are not supported.
{
Most of the Web-based agents are not supported, including the OnDemand access agent,
the EPC data protection agents, and terminal server agents. (Connect Mobile is available
for Windows Mobile-powered devices.)
{
The custom online Help file is not available.
WorkPlace look and feel: The standard WorkPlace appearance (including any customizations
you’ve made) is automatically modified for optimal display on small form factor devices.
For example, WorkPlace might look like this on a Pocket PC:
306
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
Neither i-mode phones nor devices with WAP v2.0 support will display WorkPlace images and
colors. On such a device, the same instance of WorkPlace might look like this:
For information about configuring the appearance of WorkPlace on a small form device, see
“Optimizing WorkPlace for Display on Small Form Factor Devices” on page 306.
z
Resource availability: You can control which WorkPlace shortcuts will appear on a small form
factor device. This allows you to omit Web resources that are incompatible with a particular type
of device.
For example, you might want to hide the link for Outlook Web Access and instead provide a
link to Outlook Mobile Access. This setting is controlled when creating a WorkPlace shortcut;
for more information, see “Adding Web Shortcuts” on page 294.
z
End Point Control classification: To restrict access based on device type, you can create an
EPC zone for a specific type of device and then reference that zone in an access control rule.
For more information, see “Defining Zones” on page 251.
The appliance is preconfigured to classify most common small form factor devices into one of
several categories. The default settings should be sufficient for most deployments, but you can
modify the configuration to change the classification or recognize other devices, as needed. For
more information on how devices are classified, see “Overview: Browser Profiles” on page 307.
Notes
z
Some small form factor devices do not display error pages, but instead return an error code
(such as a “500” error) from the Web server, without any descriptive error text.
z
WAP v1.x devices are not supported. A user attempting to log in to WorkPlace from such a
device will receive an error message.
z
For users who connect to the appliance from small form factor devices, you should configure
the appliance with a certificate from a leading CA (such as VeriSign), or else import the CA
certificate to your users’ small form factor devices—many devices will fail to connect when
presented with a certificate from an unknown CA and will not provide any error message. For
more information, see “CA Certificates” on page 73.
Optimizing WorkPlace for Display on Small Form Factor Devices
The general WorkPlace appearance, including any customizations you’ve made, is automatically
modified for optimal display on small form factor devices. The results are sufficient for most
deployments, but you may want to manually configure a few settings to improve the display. Most
of the settings are configured as part of a WorkPlace style; when you configure a WorkPlace layout
you’ll be able to see how page navigation and other elements will work on different mobile devices.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
307
To optimize a WorkPlace site for display on small form factor devices
1. On the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace, and then click the Appearance
tab.
2. In the Styles list, select a style you want to modify, or click New to start from scratch.
3. In the Images area, specify a logo for WorkPlace. For optimum results on smaller devices, the
image should not exceed 100 pixels by 40 pixels. By default, the logo specified in the
Standard logo image file box is used. To specify an alternate image, type the path of the
.gif, .jpg, or .png file in the Replace with box, or click Browse to locate it. Graphics are
automatically omitted from WAP and i-mode devices: this setting does not affect the display
on those devices.
4. To reduce the amount of vertical scrolling required, clear the Display greeting on small
form factor devices check box in the Text and Files area.
5. Click Save or Finish to save your WorkPlace site settings, or click Reset Defaults to restore
the factory-default WorkPlace site settings.
Notes
z
If you are using a mobile device that doesn't support UTF-8, such as the Sanyo W32SA handset,
localized content is displayed using illegible characters. To log in, the user must enter his or her
credentials in ASCII format.
X
To preview a WorkPlace layout on a small form factor device
1. On the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace, and then click the Appearance
tab.
2. In the Layouts list, select the layout you plan to use, or click New to configure one.
3. General settings: If your layout contains more than one page, you can specify the kind of
navigation controls that will be displayed. Only an advanced mobile device, which is defined as
one that has a browser that supports JavaScript, supports multiple pages. An example is a
Pocket PC running Windows Mobile Professional.
4. Device preview: There are two approaches to layout for a community on smaller devices.
{
You can have the appliance accommodate smaller devices automatically. For example, the
Intranet Address box (if it is part of the layout) is automatically not displayed on mobile
devices, and whatever logo you have specified is scaled down.
{
If the automatic results are not acceptable, you can create a different layout, intended
only for mobile devices, and then specify it when you configure the community. See
“Configuring the Appearance of WorkPlace” on page 170 for more information.
Overview: Browser Profiles
The appliance is preconfigured to recognize most popular desktop browsers and many common
small form factor devices. When a user connects to WorkPlace, it uses this profile information to
classify the device into one of several categories. This in turn determines how WorkPlace appears,
which shortcuts are visible on the device, and how the device is classified for use with EPC.
The browser profile is determined by examining a variety of information sent from the client,
including the Web browser’s user-agent string and HTTP headers. The classification details are as
follows:
Client device examples
WorkPlace classifications
z
Windows, Mac, or Linux
Desktop (JavaScript enabled)
z
Apple iPhone
Desktop (JavaScript disabled)
Because JavaScript is disabled, the appliance
cannot interrogate the iPhone to determine
which EPC zone it belongs in.
308
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
Client device examples
WorkPlace classifications
z
Windows Pocket PCs
z
Windows Smartphone Professional
z
Many Windows CE devices
z
Many Palm OS devices
z
Windows Smartphone Standard
Standard mobile (JavaScript enabled)
z
Any Smartphone without JavaScript
Standard mobile (No JavaScript)
z
Some Palm OS devices
z
Any WAP 2.0-compliant phone
(includes many Symbian-based phones)
WAP Phone v2.0
z
Mobile browser using cHTML
(no cookie support)
i-mode phone (cHTML)
Advanced mobile
(Touch screen and JavaScript enabled)
The market for mobile phones and handheld devices is evolving rapidly, and you may need to
modify the default appliance settings. For example, you might need to configure the appliance to
support a new type of smartphone purchased by your sales organization. Or you might want to
override the appliance’s default profile to accommodate a PDA vendor whose user-agent string has
changed. Any browser profiles you define will take precedence over the built-in profiles configured
on the appliance.
AMC’s browser profiles enable you to configure the appliance to support the latest small form factor
devices. A browser profile maps a particular user-agent string to a device type. As mentioned in
“Overview: WorkPlace and Small Form Factor Devices” on page 305, the profile is used to determine
three things:
Feature specified in browser profile
For more information
How WorkPlace is rendered on the device
See “Overview: WorkPlace and Small Form
Factor Devices” on page 305.
Which links appear on WorkPlace
See “Adding Web Shortcuts” on page 294.
How the device is classified into an End Point
Control zone
See “How the Appliance Uses Zones and Device
Profiles for End Point Control” on page 250.
The appliance evaluates browser profiles in the order listed until it finds a match. If there is no
match for a defined user-agent string, the appliance checks its built-in list of profiles. If no match
is found in either list, the device is classified as Desktop (JavaScript enabled) and includes full
browser capability.
Adding Browser Profiles
The appliance is preconfigured to recognize many popular small form factor devices. To override or
supplement this information, you can create a browser profile that determines how WorkPlace is
transformed. A profile is a mapping between the user-agent string sent by the browser and one of
several device types defined in AMC. Any profiles you define take precedence over the built-in
profiles configured on the appliance.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
309
To add a browser profile
1. On the main navigation menu, click Agent Configuration.
2. In the Other Agents area, under Web browser profiles, click Edit. The Browser Profiles
page appears.
3. Click New and then, in the User-agent string box, type a distinguishing portion of the useragent string used by the device. You can use the standard “*” and “?” wildcard characters
when defining a user-agent string. For example, a user-agent string of do* would match
DoCoMo, and a string of MSI? would match any of the MSIE possibilities. For a list of common
user-agent strings, see http://www.pgts.com.au/download/data/browser_list.txt.
4. In the Device type list, select the entry that most closely matches the client information of
the device identified by the user-agent string. For more information on classifying devices, see
“Overview: Browser Profiles” on page 307.
5. (Optional) In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the browser profile.
6. Click OK. The new profile is added to the bottom of the list.
7. Click Save.
Notes
z
The appliance evaluates browser profiles in the order listed, until it finds a match. See “Moving
Browser Profiles” on page 309 for more information.
Moving Browser Profiles
Browser profiles are matched in the order listed. Once the appliance matches a profile, it stops
evaluating the list. You can reorder the placement of one or more profiles as needed to ensure that
a particular small form factor device is properly recognized.
X
To move a browser profile
1. On the main navigation menu, click Agent Configuration.
2. In the Other Agents area, under Web browser profiles, click Edit. The Browser Profiles
page appears.
3. Select the check box for any profiles you want to move.
4. Click Move Up or Move Down as needed; each click of the button moves the selected profiles
up or down one position in the list.
5. Click Save.
310
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
Fully Customizing WorkPlace Pages
The WorkPlace customizations that can be done in AMC (described in “Configuring WorkPlace
General Settings” on page 291) are a convenient way to change the general look and feel of
WorkPlace, but they may not provide enough control for some deployments.
This section describes two levels of customization:
z
WorkPlace style and layout can be configured in AMC, as described in “Modifying the
Appearance of WorkPlace” on page 302. To take this customization a step further and, for
example, use a background image for your WorkPlace pages, or change the size of the header
area, download an existing style, edit it locally, and upload it back up to your appliance. See
“WorkPlace Style Customization: Manual Edits” on page 310 for more information.
z
If you need to do more advanced customization, such as adding a use agreement or end-user
license agreement to the login process, you can customize specific pages in WorkPlace,
including authentication, error, and notification pages. See “Overview: Custom WorkPlace
Templates” on page 311 for more information.
WorkPlace Style Customization: Manual Edits
WorkPlace style and layout can be configured in AMC, as described in “Modifying the Appearance of
WorkPlace” on page 302. If you are familiar with creating Web content and style sheets (.css), you
can take this customization a step further and, for example, make your login and logoff pages
visually consistent with your corporate standards, or modify the error pages (which appear if a
resource is unavailable or a user provides invalid credentials) to include detailed support or
troubleshooting information.
The most efficient way to create a new style is to download an existing style, edit it locally, and
upload it back up to your appliance.
X
To fully customize a WorkPlace style
1. On the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace.
2. In the Styles list on the Appearance page, select a style that you want to use as your
starting point, and then click Download. (Styles can be downloaded only one at a time.)
3. The style is downloaded as a compressed (.zip) file, and its filename is a combination of
WorkPlace_Style followed by the current style name.
{
If you plan to create a new style, rename the .zip file when you save it.
{
If you plan to overwrite an existing style with your changes, keep the current filename.
4. Make edits to the cascading style sheets (one for desktop devices and one for mobile devices)
and graphics. You can use the sample WorkPlace and login HTML pages to see how page
elements are classified.
5. Gather your edits into a .zip file name WorkPlace_Style_<your style name>.zip, and then click
Upload on the WorkPlace Appearance page.
6. On the Upload Style page, select whether you are uploading changes to an existing style, or
adding a new WorkPlace style. Uploading a style in the form of a .zip file overwrites all of the
style files.
7. If you are uploading a new WorkPlace style, give it a name; for example, Corporate Branding.
8. In the Style zip file box, enter the name of the .zip file you edited or created. If your new
style is named Corporate Branding, for example, the name of the corresponding file must be
WorkPlace_Style_Corporate_Branding.zip.
9. Click Upload to transfer the style-related files to your appliance.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
311
Overview: Custom WorkPlace Templates
There are situations in which you need to completely customize the way that WorkPlace looks and
what steps are involved in the login process. For example:
z
You may want to use your existing corporate portal (where that portal application has been
defined as a resource) instead of WorkPlace. Here you would customize the login, logoff,
notification, and error pages to match the look and feel of your existing portal.
z
You might want to provide access to a specific application (which has been defined as a
resource) to a business partner. Here you would customize the login, logoff, notification, and
error pages to match the look and feel of the application.
The templates you can customize fall into three categories. If you modify the ones in one category,
you should probably also modify the others to ensure consistency.
Template type
Description
Authentication
The pages used to gather a user’s credentials, including selecting a realm
and entering a username, password, or passcode.
You might use these templates to provide the user with on-screen
information about how to log in to your network.
Error
The pages displayed when an error occurs, such as invalid user input (an
authorization-denied message or a failed login), or an error in the appliance.
You might use these templates to provide the user with support information,
such as administrator contact information and where to find user guides.
Notification
The pages that provide the user with basic information required to interact
with the system, including the logout page (confirming successful logout)
and pages containing messages from the authentication module (such as a
password-expiration warning).
Although you can redesign the layout or add graphics and text on these pages, you cannot modify
or remove the existing elements. For example, on the authentication page you cannot rename the
Login button. These elements are dynamically generated by WorkPlace.
Notes
z
The WorkPlace pages that are presented to the user after login cannot be customized manually;
they are controlled from AMC.
z
Customized templates are not included in the configuration data that is distributed to other
appliances during replication. See “What Settings Are Replicated?” on page 228 for more
information about replicating configuration data.
How Template Files are Matched
You can customize templates globally, or on a per-WorkPlace site basis. For example, you might
customize the global templates to use one design, and then override that design on a site-by-site
basis by modifying its templates.
When a user connects to a WorkPlace site, the appliance first looks for the most specific template.
If one is not found, it checks for the generic template for the category (authentication, error, or
notification). If neither is found, the default WorkPlace template (the one under AMC’s control) is
used.
The following tables list the templates available for full-screen devices (desktops and laptops),
along with the corresponding file names. For small form factor devices, prefix the file names as
follows:
z
For smartphone and PDA devices, prefix the file name with compact-.
z
For WAP devices, prefix the file name with micro-.
312
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
For example, to customize the page users see when selecting a realm, edit realm-select.tmpl. The
equivalent pages for smaller devices are compact-realm-select.tmpl (for smartphones and PDAs),
and micro-realm-select.tmpl (for WAP devices).
Authentication
Description
File name
User selects a realm
realm-select.tmpl
User provides login credentials
authentication-request.tmpl
Error
Description
File name
Realm selection failed
realm-error.tmpl
Invalid credentials supplied
authentication-error.tmpl
Access to resource is denied
authorization-error.tmpl
Appliance license capacity exceeded
licensing-error.tmpl
EPC error
epc-error.tmpl
Status
Description
File name
Authentication notification (such as password expiration)
authentication-status.tmpl
Logoff successful page
logoff-status.tmpl
EPC successful logoff page
epc-logoff.tmpl
Generic
Description
File name
EPC download page
epc-launch.tmpl
User provides login credentials
authentication.tmpl
General errors
error.tmpl
General status
status.tmpl
General page (applied if no other specific template is found)
custom.tmpl
Notes
z
The default WorkPlace template files (named extraweb.tmpl, compact-extraweb.tmpl, and
micro-extraweb.tmpl) should never be edited: your changes will be overwritten the next time
you customize WorkPlace in AMC.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
313
Customizing WorkPlace Templates
The appearance of Aventail WorkPlace is controlled using several templates. To customize the
templates, you create an HTML file (or, in the case of a small form factor device, an xHTML or cHTML
file) using any standard Web design tool or text editor.
If your customization includes graphics, upload them to this folder:
/usr/local/extranet/htdocs/__extraweb__/images. If an images directory is not already present,
you can create it by typing the following command:
mkdir -p /usr/local/extranet/htdocs/__extraweb__/images
The file names you must use are described in “How Template Files are Matched” on page 311. For
small form factor devices, a prefix is added:
z
For smartphone and PDA devices, prefix the file name with compact-.
z
For WAP devices, prefix the file name with micro-.
X To customize the WorkPlace templates for desktop devices
1. Create an HTML file containing the desired layout, and add the WorkPlace-specific tags:
{
Within the BODY tag, add an HTML COMMENT tag containing the word “EXTRAWEB”:
<!-- EXTRAWEB -->
This tag is required: it determines where to place content dynamically generated by the
appliance. Without it, the user trying to log in to WorkPlace will be repeatedly sent back to
the beginning of the authentication process.
{
Add a reference to the external JavaScript file:
<script language="javascript" src="/__extraweb__/template.js"></script>
{
To have your templates display any WorkPlace content (including the .css file or the
custom logo you configured in AMC), modify your HTML code to reference the
/__extraweb__/images/ path. For example:
<img src="/__extraweb__/images/mylogo.gif">
2. Save the file with the appropriate file name using a .tmpl file extension.
X To customize the WorkPlace templates for small form factor devices
1. Create a file in xHTML (for smartphones or PDAs) or cHTML (for WAP devices) format
containing the desired layout, and add the WorkPlace-specific tags:
{
Within the BODY tag, add a COMMENT tag containing the word “EXTRAWEB”:
<!-- EXTRAWEB -->
This tag is required: it determines where to place content dynamically generated by the
appliance. Without it, the user trying to log in to WorkPlace will be repeatedly sent back to
the beginning of the authentication process.
{
To have your templates display any WorkPlace content (including the .css file or the
custom logo you configured in AMC), modify your code to reference the
/__extraweb__/images/ path. For example:
<img src="/__extraweb__/images/mylogo.gif">
2. Save the file with the appropriate file name using a .tmpl file extension.
Giving Users Access to Aventail WorkPlace
Because Aventail WorkPlace is a Web application, users can access it through a standard Web
browser. You can also incorporate WorkPlace links into a Web page or a portal hosted on your own
network.
314
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
You must tell users which URL to use in order to access WorkPlace. You can give users the default
WorkPlace URL, or you can give them a URL for a customized WorkPlace site.
WorkPlace site type
URL
Description
Default WorkPlace site
https://<server_name>
The <server_name> is the fully qualified
domain name (FQDN) contained in the
appliance’s SSL certificate. For more
information, see “Certificates” on page 66.
Custom WorkPlace site
http://<custom_fqdn>
The <custom_fqdn> is the external FQDN
associated with the WorkPlace site. For
more information, see “WorkPlace Sites” on
page 298.
If users will be accessing WorkPlace from a Web page or portal hosted on your network, you may
want to provide a Log out button to preserve the security of user accounts. To do this, give users
the following WorkPlace site URL:
https://<server_name>/__extraweb__logoff
The <server_name> is the actual FQDN from your appliance’s SSL certificate.
End Point Control and the User Experience
When SonicWALL End Point Control components are enabled, the WorkPlace login process includes
additional steps, which vary depending on whether OPSWAT Secure Desktop Emulator or Cache
Cleaner is used.
z
OPSWAT Secure Desktop Emulator is part of Advanced EPC, which is included with the EX-2500
and EX7000, and is an optional component—purchased and licensed separately—on the other
appliance models.
z
Cache Cleaner is included with your appliance license.
For more information, see “Overview: End Point Control” on page 249.
How OPSWAT Secure Desktop Emulator Works
With OPSWAT Secure Desktop Emulator (SDE), the typical WorkPlace session includes the following
steps:
1. In a Web browser, the user types the appropriate WorkPlace URL.
2. The user logs in to WorkPlace.
3. The user must accept any SonicWALL security warnings that appear. The SDE desktop
appears, the SDE icon is displayed in the taskbar notification area, and the WorkPlace login
page opens in a new browser window in the SDE desktop. The SDE desktop features a
distinctive background color and image, making the virtual session created by SDE easily
distinguished from other sessions.
4. The user accesses network resources as needed. The user can launch new browser windows
and browser plug-ins, and locally installed applications via file association. The user can save
data to files within the SDE session for purposes of uploading.
The user can download and install new programs within the context of the desktop emulator.
Any program installed that way shall only be accessible within the desktop emulator window.
All data transferred to the client file system via the WorkPlace portal session is protected from
access by any application running outside the SDE session. This prevents opening the file
outside the context of the desktop emulator.
If enabled by the administrator, the user can switch between the desktop emulator and the
normal desktop.
5. When the user is ready to end the WorkPlace session, he or she terminates the WorkPlace
session, either by clicking the Log out link on the portal page, by closing the browser window
that contains the portal page, or by ending the desktop emulator program.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
315
The session can also end if the mouse & keyboard inactivity timeout expires.
When the session ends, SDE permanently removes all data downloaded from the VPN,
including session-related data files downloaded and stored on the local hard disk, plus any
temporary data associated with the Web browser. The data is obfuscated by writing random or
“zeroed” data over it. All applications open within the desktop emulator are terminated. Any
programs installed via SDE are removed from the end point system.
Because SDE permanently removes all session-related data files from the local hard disk, you
should instruct users not to save any data to their local disk when working with SDE. Examples
include:
z
Don't save files to the local disk. For example, if a user downloads a file from your network
and saves it to a local hard disk, it will be deleted when the session ends.
z
Don't save application data to the local disk. Some client/server applications (such as
Microsoft Outlook) allow users to store data locally. Users should be aware of the interaction
between these applications and SDE. For example, if an Outlook user is storing data locally (in
a .pst file) and moves an email message from the system Inbox to a local mail folder while SDE
is running, the message will be deleted from the local disk when the session ends.
How Cache Cleaner Works
With Cache Cleaner, the typical WorkPlace session looks like this:
1. In a Web browser, the user types the appropriate WorkPlace URL.
2. The user logs in to WorkPlace.
3. The user must accept any SonicWALL security warnings that appear. The Cache Cleaner icon
appears in the taskbar notification area.
4. The user accesses network resources as needed.
5. When the user ends the Cache Cleaner session, Cache Cleaner deletes all data associated with
the session. All browser windows are closed by Cache Cleaner upon logout. A dialog box warns
users that all browser windows will be closed on logout.
Notes
z
Because Cache Cleaner closes all browser windows on logout, and if you configure Cache
Cleaner to close other browser windows at startup, make sure your users are aware: if someone
is filling out a form, for example, anything that isn’t submitted when the browser window closes
will be lost.
316
|
Chapter 9 - The Aventail WorkPlace Portal
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
317
Chapter 10
User Access Components and Services
The SonicWALL appliance includes several components that enable users to access resources on
your network. This section describes each of the user access components and the services that
control them.
Many of these components are provisioned or activated from the Aventail WorkPlace portal. For
more information about Aventail WorkPlace, see “The Aventail WorkPlace Portal” on page 285.
User Access Agents
User access agents are deployed to client devices based on the community to which the user
belongs. Most agents are deployed automatically when the user logs in to the Aventail WorkPlace
portal using a browser. The main exceptions—the Connect Tunnel agent and the Connect Mobile
agent—can be made available for manual user download and installation from links on the
WorkPlace portal. The installation package for these two access agents can also be made available
for download from a file share on your network or deployed through applications such as Microsoft’s
Systems Management Server (SMS) or IBM’s Tivoli. For more information, see “Selecting Access
Methods for a Community” on page 166.
When deployed automatically—when a user logs in using a browser—the access agents are both
deployed and activated on the first visit. This generally requires the user to accept a download for
the Aventail Access Manager (AAM), which will in turn manage the access agent installation and
future access agent updates. On subsequent visits to the WorkPlace portal from the same client
device using the same browser, the access agents are automatically activated without user
intervention. See “Client and Agent Provisioning (Windows)” on page 319 for more information.
The following table compares the capabilities of access agents and lists their requirements. For
other system-requirement information, see “Client Components” on page 9.
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
x
x
x
x
x
TCP- or UDP-based
client/server
applications
x
x
URLs and Web
applications
x
x
Translated,
Custom Port
mapped,
Custom FQDN
mapped Web
access
OnDemand
Mapped Mode
x
TCP-based client/server
applications
Web access
(HTTP protocol)
Web proxy
agent
Connect Mobile
client
Network tunnel
Proxy access
access (IP protocol) (TCP protocol)
Connect
Tunnel client
|
OnDemand
Tunnel agent
318
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Application support
Windows networking
Web-based file access
x
Native Windows file
access (Network
Neighborhood)
x
x
Mapped network drives
x
x
Windows domain logon
x
Connection types
Forward connections
x
x
Reverse connections
(such as FTP or SMS)
x
x
x
Cross-connections
(such as VoIP)
x
x
Windows
x
x
x
Linux or Macintosh
x
x
x
Operating systems
Windows Mobile
Administrator privileges
required to install
client/agent
x
x
x
x
x
Deployment
Auto-activated from
WorkPlace
x
Provisioned from
WorkPlace
x
Provisioned outside of
WorkPlace
x
(2)
x
x
x
x
(1)
x
x
(1) Port-mapped mode requires ActiveX or Java. For a user without administrator rights who can’t
run ActiveX, the Java Runtime Environment (JRE) is used.
(2) See knowledgebase article 2803 for instructions on how to configure WorkPlace so that Pocket
PC users can download and install the Connect Mobile CAB file directly, without using ActiveSync.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
319
The Connect Tunnel Service is not listed in this table. You can install and configure this add-on
component so that the VPN connection starts automatically without user intervention. For more
information, see “Running Connect as a Service” on page 335.
Aventail Connect for Android is also not provisioned from WorkPlace. You can download and install
the Android client from the Android Market. For more information, see “Aventail Connect for
Android” on page 367.
Client and Agent Provisioning (Windows)
Aventail Access Manager is a component that enables you to provision Windows users with EPC and
access agents reliably when they log in to WorkPlace. It provides better application compatibility
for applications that need an agent, and more reliable EPC interrogation; in addition, most client
updates do not require administrator privileges. If something goes wrong during provisioning, the
error is automatically recorded in a client installation log (identified by username) that you can view
in AMC.
Installing Aventail Access Manager is a one-time step and does not require that the user have
administrator privileges. The only other time users will be (briefly) aware of it once it’s installed is
when an access agent or the Access Manager itself needs to be updated. Installing Aventail Access
Manager is also not required, but users without it will have just Web-only access to resources in
WorkPlace, or be forced to log out, depending on how you configure the community.
Installing Aventail Access Manager
Users are normally required to install a SonicWALL Aventail agent or client before they are granted
access to network resources when they log in to WorkPlace. This is the recommended setting: it
provides better compatibility for applications that need an agent, which means broader access for
users and fewer Help Desk calls for you. (To omit this requirement, clear the Require agent in
order to access network check box when you are configuring the access methods for a particular
community.)
Users logging in to WorkPlace are offered these choices when this setting is enabled:
z
Install: Aventail Access Manager is installed on the user’s computer. Users will need to do this
only once.
z
Logout: The user’s session is ended.
320
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
If you configure the community such that an agent or client is not required, users are offered these
choices when they log in:
z
Install: Aventail Access Manager is installed on the user’s computer. Users will need to do this
only once.
z
Remind me later: The user is prompted to install Aventail Access Manager during the next
login.
z
Don't show this again: The user sees no Aventail Access Manager prompts during subsequent
logins on this computer. This is a good choice for a user who wants to bypass agent provisioning
(in an airport, for example) and is satisfied with just Web-only access.
Caution: In this scenario (assuming EPC is enabled), the user is placed in either the Default
zone or a Quarantine zone, depending on how the community is configured. A Quarantine
zone may be too restrictive, and the Default zone probably needs to accommodate many other
types of users. You might want to create a unique, Web-only zone for users who don’t require
an agent. See “Scenario 3: Employees Connecting from a Public Kiosk” on page 254 for ideas
on how to set up this kind of zone.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
321
Installing Aventail Access Manager on a Computer Running Vista
When users install Aventail Access Manager for the first time on a computer running the Microsoft
Vista operating system, they see an additional consent dialog that Windows XP users will not see.
Users should follow the on-screen instructions and select Do not show me the warning for this
program again, and then click Allow.
Provisioning and Personal Firewalls
Some third-party firewall products regulate outbound connections by process (in addition to port
and protocol). These firewalls may raise a security alert dialog regarding Aventail Access Manager
during the provisioning of agents or EPC components. In most cases, the user should be instructed
to “unblock” or “permit” the outbound connection.
There are a few firewalls, such as one supplied by Trend Micro, that do not permit a user with
restricted rights to override firewall settings. For corporate systems on which users have limited
access rights, you may want to update the firewall settings before deploying the SonicWALL VPN so
that users won’t have to respond to these security dialog prompts. See “Using Personal Firewalls
with Aventail Agents” on page 420 for more information.
Client Installation Logs
If something goes wrong during client or agent installation on a computer running Windows, the
error is recorded in a client installation log on the user’s local computer. These logs are
automatically uploaded to the appliance and listed in AMC if the user has Aventail Access Manager
installed. For more information, see “Client Installation Logs (Windows)” on page 206.
Aventail WorkPlace
Aventail WorkPlace is a Web-based portal that provides dynamically personalized access to Web
resources protected by the Web proxy service. After a user logs in to WorkPlace, a home page
appears that contains an administrator-defined list of shortcuts. These shortcuts point to Webbased file shares, Web-based applications, and terminal server resources to which the user has
access privileges.
All of the SonicWALL user access components are provisioned or activated through the Aventail
WorkPlace portal, with the exception of the Connect Mobile client, which is deployed separately.
322
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
Aventail WorkPlace is accessible from any standard Web browser. For more information, see “The
Aventail WorkPlace Portal” on page 285.
Network Explorer
Network Explorer, available through Aventail WorkPlace, is a Web-based user interface that provides
access to any shared Windows file system resources a user has permission to access (even from a
computer that isn’t running Windows). These resources can include domains, servers, computers,
workgroups, folders, and files.
Network Explorer is an optional component that can be controlled through policy or completely
disabled. It is supported on any browser supported by WorkPlace. For more information, see “The
Aventail WorkPlace Portal” on page 285.
The Tunnel Clients
The SonicWALL tunnel clients provide secure access for TCP and UDP traffic; bi-directional traffic,
such as remote Help Desk applications; cross-connections, such as VoIP applications; and reverse
connections, such as SMS. The clients all provide network-level access to all resources, effectively
making the user’s computer a node on your network:
z
OnDemand Tunnel agent is a browser-based, Web-activated agent.
z
Connect Tunnel client is a Web-installed client. The tunnel clients are managed from AMC using
the network tunnel service. Configuring this service to manage TCP/IP connections from the
network tunnel clients requires setting up IP address pools that are used to allocate IP
addresses to the clients.
OnDemand Tunnel Agent
The OnDemand Tunnel agent enables you to provide complete network and application access
through a Web browser to resources protected by the network tunnel service. The OnDemand
Tunnel agent is a lightweight agent that provides the same broad application and protocol access
as the Connect Tunnel client, but it is integrated into the Aventail WorkPlace portal and
automatically starts each time users log in to WorkPlace.
The OnDemand Tunnel agent is supported on Windows, Linux, and Macintosh, and requires Internet
Explorer with ActiveX or Java enabled, or Mozilla Firefox or Safari with the Java Runtime
Environment (JRE).
Connect Tunnel Client
The Connect Tunnel client provides full access to resources protected by the network tunnel service,
and to any type of application, including those that use TCP, and non-TCP protocols such as VoIP
and ICMP. Connect Tunnel also includes split-tunneling control, granular access controls, proxy
detection, and authentication.
The Connect Tunnel client can be deployed in a number of ways (for more information, see “Client
Installation Packages” on page 326):
z
Offer users a shortcut in WorkPlace for downloading and installing the client; the link points to
the Connect Tunnel resource, described in “Built-In Resources” on page 115.
z
If you don’t want to require users to log in to Aventail WorkPlace, have them download and
install the Connect Tunnel client components from a network location (such as a Web server,
FTP server, or file server).
z
Distribute installation packages using an application such as SMS or Tivoli.
z
Create a master image of a Connect Tunnel install and copy it to user systems using a thirdparty disk-image copying utility such as Norton Ghost.
The Connect Tunnel client is supported on Windows, Linux, and Macintosh operating systems, and
installation of the Connect Tunnel client requires users to have administrator privileges. All Connect
Tunnel configuration and management is performed in AMC.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
323
The Connect Tunnel client supports command-line utilities such as “ngdial” that can modify the
normal run-time behavior of the client and enable you to perform troubleshooting and diagnostic
tasks without using the standard graphical user interface. For more information, see “Command
Line Access to Connect Tunnel with NGDIAL” on page 330.
You can configure the Windows version of the Connect Tunnel client software to be automatically
updated on users’ computers whenever a new version becomes available. For more information,
see “Windows Tunnel Client Automatic Client Updating” on page 173.
Notes
z
A user logged in as a “guest” on a computer running the Windows Vista operating system will
not be able to run Connect Tunnel. A guest account is for users who don't have a permanent
account on your computer or domain—it allows them to use your computer without giving them
access to your personal files.
The Proxy Clients
This section provides an overview of the Connect Mobile client.
Connect Mobile Client
The Connect Mobile client is a lightweight application for Windows Mobile-powered devices. It
provides access to a broad range of resources—including traditional client/server applications, thinclient applications, and Web resources—protected by the Web proxy service.
The Connect Mobile client is installed using a Windows setup program that extracts the application
files and then copies them to the user’s device using Microsoft ActiveSync. For information about
deploying the setup files to users, see “Client Installation Packages” on page 326.
Some legacy devices may display the Windows Mobile branding, but are in fact powered by an older
version of the operating system. For example, the Connect Mobile client does not support the
following Smartphone 2003 devices:
z
Audiovox SMT5600
z
Motorola MPx220
z
Sierra Wireless Voq
z
Samsung i600
z
iMate SP2
But these small form factor devices, along with other Web-enabled devices, can use the Aventail
WorkPlace portal for Web-based access to the SonicWALL SSL VPN appliance. See “WorkPlace and
Small Form Factor Devices” on page 305 for more information.
Web Access
This section provides an overview of the Web proxy agent and zero-client Web access methods such
as translated Web access, custom port mapped Web access, and custom FQDN mapped Web access.
A section describing Exchange ActiveSync Web access is also included.
Web Proxy Agent
The Web proxy agent provides access through the Aventail WorkPlace portal to any Web resource—
including Web-based applications, Web portals, and Web servers—as well as Windows network
shares. The Web proxy agent provides improved application compatibility over Translated Web
access, but provisioning the Web proxy agent can take a little extra time when a user first logs in
to Aventail WorkPlace. The Web proxy agent requires Internet Explorer with ActiveX enabled.
Translated Web Access
By default, the appliance is configured to deploy a Microsoft ActiveX control (the “Web proxy agent”)
on Microsoft Windows systems running Internet Explorer. If the Web proxy agent cannot run,
Translated Web access can be used as a fallback. Translated Web provides basic access to Web
324
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
resources, and enables you to create aliases that obscure internal host names. It proxies Web
content directly through the appliance and provides access to any Web resource that is specifically
configured to run with WorkPlace, as well as access to Windows network shares. Translated Web
access works on any Web browser that supports SSL and has JavaScript enabled. It uses URL
rewriting, which may have limitations with some Web applications, such as AJAX. Custom port
mapping or custom FQDN mapping may be used as an alternative to URL translation.
Custom Port Mapped Web Access
Custom port mapping involves mapping the backend resource or server to a port number at the EXSeries appliance. Apache listens on this port and all HTTPS traffic received on it is terminated at the
appliance. A new HTTP request is made to retrieve the mapped backend resource. The HTTP reply
is transmitted using plain text to facilitate translation of absolute URLs. URL rewriting is not used.
When using custom port mapping, any firewalls in the network must be configured to keep the
specific ports open. Custom port mapping does not require installation of a client agent, and works
with any Web browser.
Custom FQDN Mapped Web Access
Custom FQDN mapping means that the backend resource or server is mapped to an external fully
qualified domain name (host and domain). The resource should be accessed with the FQDN name
rather than with the IP address. The FQDN name should be resolvable to an IP address in the public
domain. Apache listens on port 443 at this IP address. All HTTPS traffic is terminated at this socket.
A new HTTP request is made to retrieve the mapped backend resource. The HTTP reply is
transmitted using plain text to facilitate translation of absolute URLs. URL rewriting is not used.
Notes for Custom Port Mapped or Custom FQDN Mapped Web Access
z
If you are using a resource that is either custom port mapped or custom FQDN mapped, logging
out of applications like OWA, DWA and Sharepoint from an Internet Explorer browser may log
you out of Workplace.
z
Each resource should be configured using only one of the access methods. Do not mix
translated, custom port mapped and custom FQDN mapped modes.
z
The custom FQDN mapped or custom port mapped resource URL should not include a path.
Paths for a resource can be specified on the Start page.
z
Custom FQDN mapped resources should be configured and accessed using host and domain
name only, not via IP address.
z
When using custom port mapped or custom FQDN mapped access for Domino Web Access
(DWA), the page is not automatically refreshed if you edit the layout of the page. Click the
Refresh button for the new layout to take effect.
z
Single sign-on on the appliance might not work with Internet Explorer when a custom FQDN
mapped resource with an invalid certificate is accessed from WorkPlace. For example, this could
happen when a user logs in to WorkPlace and clicks a custom FQDN mapped resource that has
a self-signed certificate or otherwise does not have a valid certificate on the appliance. A
JavaScript certificate warning is popped up to the Internet Explorer user. After the user accepts
the certificate, Internet Explorer does not transmit the “referrer” HTTP header to the initial
page. This referrer value is required for single sign-on functionality.
This Internet Explorer issue is described at:
http://connect.microsoft.com/IE/feedback/ViewFeedback.aspx?FeedbackID=379975
This issue does not occur when using browsers other than Internet Explorer, or when there is
no certificate warning, or when wildcard certificates are used.
Exchange ActiveSync Web Access
SonicWALL Aventail 10.5 supports Exchange ActiveSync for Apple iPhones and smartphones that
run the Symbian 9.x operating system.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
325
Symbian is an open OS that acts as host to many devices. A few popular devices that run the latest
Symbian OS versions and support Exchange ActiveSync (branded as “Mail for Exchange” on Nokia
devices) are:
z
Symbian OS 9.1 – Nokia E65, N71
z
Symbian OS 9.3 – Nokia E72
z
Symbian OS 9.4 – Nokia X6, Samsung Omnia HD
Once the administrator configures the SonicWALL Aventail appliance, a user with an iPhone or a
Symbian smartphone can configure the device to access email using Exchange ActiveSync.
To do this, the user enters an email account name, server, domain, user name and password. The
user turns on ActiveSync for this account. The results are saved as a new email account on the
device.
With ActiveSync turned on, the device gives the user notice when new mail arrives.
When the user syncs the iPhone or Symbian device to a computer that is connected to the Exchange
server through the SonicWALL Aventail appliance, the mail, contacts and calendar are updated. On
Symbian, Tasks and Out Of Office settings are also supported.
Enabling Exchange ActiveSync access on the appliance
The administrator can enable Exchange ActiveSync access for a community of iPhone or Symbian
device users. This involves the following tasks:
z
Create a realm that uses an Active Directory authentication server. Realms that use chained
authentication are not supported for Exchange ActiveSync.
z
Create a resource for Exchange ActiveSync using the “Exchange ActiveSync options” section of
the Resources Add/Edit page for a URL resource.
The Exchange ActiveSync options section allows the administrator to specify a custom FQDN,
IP address, SSL certificate, and realm to use for providing Exchange ActiveSync access.
The custom FQDN, IP address, and SSL certificate options function in the same way as those
for Workplace sites that use these options. The custom FQDN provides a host/domain name
through which ActiveSync connections or sessions can be established.
The IP address is a virtual IP address hosted by the appliance, and must be on the same
subnet as the external interface (or the internal if single-homed) of the SonicWALL Aventail
appliance so that it is reachable via the public interface of the appliance.
The SSL certificate can be a wildcard certificate or you can configure a server certificate that
matches the host name.
The only realms that will appear in the Realm drop-down list are those that use an Active
Directory authentication server. Realms that use chained authentication will not appear in the
list. When a realm is used for Exchange ActiveSync, that realm cannot be changed to provide
chained authentication or to use an authentication server other than Active Directory.
z
Define a Device Profile for end point control of Exchange ActiveSync devices from the EPC page
in AMC. You can select Exchange ActiveSync as the device profile type.
The only attribute that can be configured for this device profile is “Equipment ID”. The device
serial number is used as the identifier.
The Exchange ActiveSync device profile can be included in any zone for evaluation.
z
View the Network Settings page to see all custom IP addresses used for virtual hosting, the
FQDNs that listen on these addresses, and the associated Resources or WorkPlace Sites.
The Resources and WorkPlace Site items are links to the configuration page for easy
navigation and editing.
z
View the User Sessions page, which displays Exchange ActiveSync sessions as belonging to the
“Exchange ActiveSync” Access Agent. “Exchange ActiveSync” is an option in the Agent list
under Filters.
326
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
Exchange ActiveSync sessions
Initial connections to the ActiveSync custom FQDN name cause a username and password challenge
by the appliance.
If the user successfully authenticates, the ActiveSync session is established with the Exchange
server without further user interaction.
For users connecting to Exchange 2007, the device IMEI serial number is parsed out of the
ActiveSync stream during session initialization. The administrator of the Exchange system might
need to make configuration changes that result in the device identifier being sent.
Authentication methods from the appliance to the Exchange server use basic authentication.
Notes for Exchange ActiveSync device profiles
z
The profiles only work with an ActiveSync stream because that is the only way to obtain the
device value.
z
The profiles only work on ActiveSync streams that are interacting with Exchange 2007 servers.
z
Only ActiveSync for Exchange is supported in this release.
Client Installation Packages
You can make the Connect Tunnel client and Connect Mobile client components available for users
to download and install from another network location (such as a Web server, FTP server, or file
server) without requiring them to log in to Aventail WorkPlace. You can also push the Connect
Tunnel client installation package to users through an application such as Tivoli or SMS, or create a
master image of a client install and copy it to user systems using a third-party disk-image copying
utility.
The client setup packages are available for you to download from AMC. With the Windows-based
packages—Connect Tunnel for Windows and Connect Mobile—you also have the option of
configuring various client settings in an .ini configuration file before distributing the client to users.
Notes
z
Users running the Windows Vista operating system must upgrade to version 8.9.0 or later of
the client in order to connect to the appliance. The easiest way to ensure that users are running
the latest version is to make client updates automatic; see “Windows Tunnel Client Automatic
Client Updating” on page 173 for more information.
Downloading the SonicWALL Client Installation Packages
This section describes how to download the installation packages for the Connect Tunnel client or
Connect Mobile client to your local workstation.
X
To download a client installation package
1. From the main navigation menu, click Agent Configuration.
2. In the Aventail access agents area, under Client installation packages, click Download.
The Client Installation Packages page appears.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
327
3. Select the language for the installation packages. Each package includes translated user
interface elements and online help.
328
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
4. Download the client installation files for the platforms you plan to support (<xx> represents
the language you selected):
Download link
Installation package
Windows
ngsetup_<xx>.exe
Linux x86
AventailConnect-Linux.tar
Mac OS X 10.5.x
AventailConnect-OSX.dmg
Windows Mobile
cmsetup.exe
Windows service
(Connect Tunnel Service)
ctssetup_<xx>.exe
5. The Download Client Package page appears, and a File Download dialog box prompts you
to save the file to your local computer.
6. Click Save, browse to the appropriate directory, and then click Save again.
7. Click OK on the Download Client Package page to return to the Client Installation
Packages page.
Customizing the Configuration for the Connect Tunnel Client
The Connect Tunnel client setup package that you download from the appliance is not configured.
You can customize the Connect Tunnel configuration file (an .ini file) before deploying the setup
package to users. This allows you to speed things up for users by preconfiguring the client with the
host name or IP address of the appliance, the realm name used during log in, and other client
options. If you skip this step, the package uses the default appliance settings.
X
To customize the Connect Tunnel configuration file
1. Download the Connect Tunnel installation file onto a Windows computer as described in
“Downloading the SonicWALL Client Installation Packages” on page 326.
2. Open a Windows command prompt by typing cmd in the Start > Run box.
3. Browse to the directory where you saved ngsetup_<xx>.exe, and then extract the installation
files by typing the following command. The destination for the unpacked files will be the
current working directory unless you specify a <path> with the expand parameter:
ngsetup_<xx>.exe -expand=<path>
4. Open the ngsetup.ini file in a text editor and specify the appropriate configuration settings.
5. Save and then close the modified ngsetup.ini file. The .ini customizations you made will be
incorporated during setup if the file is copied to the same directory in which you saved
ngsetup_<xx>.exe. To specify a different location for the .ini file, use the following command:
ngsetup_<xx>.exe -f=<path>\<configuration file name>
You can also log installation data to a file named ngmsi.log in the
%ALLUSERSPROFILE%\Documents and Settings\All Users\Application Data\Aventail folders.
Type the following for a list of all the possible parameters:
ngsetup_<xx>.exe -?
6. The following table describes the configuration options, followed by a sample .ini file. Some of
these options are available only when Connect Tunnel is installed from WorkPlace. For any
optional components that you do not specify, default values are used.
Option
Description
[Connectoid number] section
This controls the basic settings for accessing the
appliance. To enable the user to access multiple
appliances, copy this configuration block and increment
the number ([Connectoid 1], [Connectoid 2], and so
on). This section is required.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
329
Option
Description
ConnectionName=name
The name for the connection as it will appear in the client
user interface. If you do not specify a value, the default
connection name is used (Aventail VPN Connection).
This setting is optional.
VpnServer=host name | IP address
The host name or IP address of the appliance. If you do
not specify a value, users must manually type the host
name or IP address of the appliance. This setting is
optional.
StartMenuIcon=[0 | 1]
Determines whether to add a shortcut named Aventail
VPN Connection to the Aventail Start menu folder. The
default value is 1 (add a shortcut). This setting is
optional.
DesktopIcon=[0 | 1]
Determines whether to add a shortcut to the desktop.
The default value is 1 (add a shortcut). This setting is
optional.
UserRealm=name
Determines the default realm that users will log in to.
Type the realm name exactly as it appears in AMC. This
setting is optional.
DefaultAuthType=
[ADUNPW | LDAPUNPW | RADIUSUNPW |
RADIUSCRAM | UNIX]
(Obsolete) This setting determines which type of user
authentication to perform. It applies only when accessing
a SonicWALL appliance that predates v8.7.0.
StatusDlg=[0 | 1]
Determines whether to display a status dialog box when
connecting to the appliance. The default value is 1
(status display enabled). This setting is optional.
Taskbar=[0 | 1]
Determines whether to display an icon in the taskbar
notification area when connected to the appliance. The
default value is 1 (icon display enabled). This setting is
optional.
RunAtStartup=[0 | 1]
Determines whether to automatically start the
connection at Windows startup. The default value is 1
(enable automatic startup). This setting is optional.
[Install Settings] section
This section contains information about the type of MSI
installation to perform. Each .ini file can include only one
[Install Settings] section. This section is optional.
UILevel=[FULL | REDUCED | BASIC |
NONE]
Determines the level of user interface to include during
installation. The default value is NONE. This setting is
optional.
ProductCode=key
These settings are preconfigured and required. They
should not be modified.
PackageCode=key
FileSize=bytecount
ProductVersion=x.yy.zzz
330
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
Sample ngsetup.ini file
[Install Settings]
UILevel=FULL
ProductCode={A814B50B-B392-458A-8C31-51697E1EBB7A}
PackageCode={A77CB50B-0384-5D8A-DE3D-61099E9EB37C}
[Connectoid 1]
ConnectionName="XYZ Company Network"
VpnServer=64.94.142.134
[Connectoid 2]
ConnectionName="Test Network"
VpnServer=64.94.142.134
StartMenuIcon=1
DesktopIcon=1
UserRealm="employees"
StatusDlg=1
Taskbar=1
RunAtStartup=1
Notes
z
On a computer running the Windows operating system, there is a registry key that enables you
to launch programs once, after which the reference is deleted so that the program is not run
again. After Connect Tunnel is installed, any program that is listed in
HKEY_Local_Machine\Software\Microsoft\Windows\CurrentVersion\RunOnce is executed.
z
The file cannot include certain items—such as authentication type and custom prompts—until a
connection has been made to the VPN appliance. This means that first-time users are presented
with dimmed authentication prompts. There are a few workarounds:
{
Have users install from WorkPlace.
{
Have users click Properties in the Connect dialog box and select a realm.
{
Refer to SonicWALL knowledgebase article 2831 for an explanation of how to obtain a
complete configuration file from a WorkPlace installation and modify it for your users.
Command Line Access to Connect Tunnel with NGDIAL
The NGDIAL command-line utility establishes a connection to a remote network using Connect
Tunnel, much like the Windows RASDIAL utility does with other network connections.
The NGDIAL command-line utility can also create, delete, and modify network connection phone
book entries. Issuing the NGDIAL command without any parameters will list all RAS connections.
For more information about using the Windows Remote Access Service (RAS) to develop client
applications that access network resources secured by an Aventail appliance through the Aventail
Connect Tunnel client, see the Connect Tunnel Extensibility Toolkit on MySonicWALL.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
331
Command Syntax
ngdial <connection name> <public> [<private>|* [<auth type>]]
[-phonebook=<phonebook>]
[-server=<server name>|<server IP>]
[-login=<login group>]
[-proxycredential=<username>[,<password>|*]]
[-status[=enable|disable]] [-icon[=enable|disable]] [-gui]
ngdial <connection name> -disconnect|-d
ngdial <connection name> -prompt
[-phonebook=<phonebook>]
ngdial <connection name> -create
[-phonebook=<phonebook>]
[-server=<server name>|<server IP>]
[-login=<login group>]
[-status[=enable|disable]] [-icon[=enable|disable]]
ngdial -help | -?
Option
Description
<connection name>
The name of the network connection; if the name includes a
space, enclose it in quotes.
<public>
The user’s public credential (username) for authentication; if
the name includes a space, enclose it in quotes. For example:
ngdial report_server "Jen Bates"
The public and <private> portions of the credentials must
correspond correctly with the authentication type specified by
the authentication realm on the Aventail appliance.
[<private>|* [<auth type>]] The private credentials (password) and authentication type to
be used when authenticating the user (the <auth type>
parameter is required only for logging in to a pre-v8.7.0
appliance).
If the <private> portion of the credential is omitted or an
asterisk (*) is specified, the NGDIAL command prompts the user
to enter the password.
If you do not specify an <auth type> when logging in to a prev8.7.0 appliance, the default authentication type for the realm
is used. Values for <auth type> are:
z
NULL: No authentication required
z
LDAPUNPW: LDAP username/password credential
z
LDAPCERTIFICATE: LDAP certificate credential
z
RADIUSCRAM: RADIUS token/securID credential
z
RADIUSUNPW: RADIUS username/password credential
z
UNIX: UNIX username/password credential
z
TEAM: Aventail TEAM credential
z
ADUNPW: Active Directory username/password credential
332
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
Option
Description
-create
Generates a new network connection, or updates an existing
network connection, with the information passed on the
command line.
-delete
Deletes the specified network connection entry from the
specified phone book. You must have system administrator
privileges to perform this operation.
-disconnect | -d
Causes the VPN to disconnect from the <connection name>
remote network.
-gui
If additional information is necessary to establish the VPN
network connection, use this parameter to allow RAS to prompt
the user with a graphical user interface (GUI).
For example, the user could be prompted to accept the
appliance's server certificate if there are any problems with the
certificate, or the user might need to be notified regarding
password expiration or required changes. If the -gui option is
not specified in such a case, the NGDIAL utility fails and returns
an error code to the caller.
-help | -?
Displays the command-line syntax for the NGDIAL command.
When combined with the -gui option, displays the online Help.
[-icon[=enable|disable]]
Controls the display of an icon in the taskbar notification area
that allows the user to manage the VPN network connection and
receive connection notifications. See Notes.
-login=<login group>
The name of the login group (authentication realm) used to
authenticate the user. If a login is specified without specifying an
<auth type> for the credentials (in a connection to a pre-v8.7.0
appliance), NGDIAL uses an <auth type> of ADUNPW.
-phonebook=<phonebook>
Specifies the file name of the phone book where the
<connection name> is defined. The file name must include the
fully qualified path to the phone book file. If a path is not
specified, NGDIAL looks in the directory that contains the system
phone book (rasphone.pbk) for the specified phone book file.
-prompt
Causes the NGDIAL command to prompt the user to connect to
the <connection name> remote network.
-proxycredential=
<username> [,<password>|*]
If a proxy server is required for access to the appliance, use this
option to specify the username and password credentials for it.
If the password is omitted, or entered as an asterisk (*), the
NGDIAL command prompts the user for a proxy password.
-server=<server name>|
<server IP>
Specifies the appliance name or IP address. If a server is
specified, and it is different from the server defined in the phone
book entry, the server and login group (if specified) are saved to
the phone book entry.
[-status[=enable|disable]]
Controls the display of a connection status dialog box when the
VPN network connection takes more than two seconds to
connect.
Examples:
NGDIAL "ACME Corp" -create -server=remote.acme.com -icon -status
NGDIAL "ACME Corp" "Jen Bates" * -login="Business Partners" -icon -gui
NGDIAL "ACME Corp" jdoe password
NGDIAL "ACME Corp" -disconnect
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
333
Notes:
Although the ngdial -help usage statement indicates that the -icon=disable flag is an option without
the -create flag, in some cases the -create flag is necessary to disable the icon.
To disable the icon so that it does not appear on the taskbar, you can use either of the following two
methods:
z
Set taskbar=0 in the ngsetup.ini file and then type a command such as:
ngdial "Aventail VPN Connection" -server=<server IP address> -login="Realm name"
username password -icon=disable -gui
z
Type a command using the -create option with the -icon=disable option to store the icon
parameter, and then type the command to connect, such as:
ngdial "Aventail VPN Connection" -create -server=<server IP address>
-icon=disable -gui
ngdial "Aventail VPN Connection" -server=<server IP address> -login="Realm name"
username password -icon=disable -gui
Customizing the Configuration for the Connect Mobile Client
The Connect Mobile client setup package that you download from the appliance is not configured.
To simplify things for users you can preconfigure a few options in cmsetup.ini (such as the host
name or IP address of the appliance and the realm name) before deploying the setup package to
users. If you don’t customize the .ini file the default appliance settings are used.
X
To customize the Connect Mobile configuration file
1. Download the Connect Mobile installation file onto a Windows computer as described in
“Downloading the SonicWALL Client Installation Packages” on page 326. This computer must
have Microsoft ActiveSync installed so that the cmsetup.ini configuration file can be extracted
and customized.
2. Go to a command prompt: Click Start > Run, and then type cmd in the Open box; if you are
using Windows Vista, Click Start, and then type cmd in the Start Search box.
3. Browse to the directory where you saved the cmsetup.exe file, and then extract the
installation files by typing the following command. The destination for the unpacked files will
be the current working directory unless you specify a <path>:
cmsetup.exe -extract=<path>
4. Open the cmsetup.ini file in a text editor and specify the appropriate configuration settings.
5. Save and then close the modified cmsetup.ini file, ensuring that it is still located in the same
directory in which you saved the cmsetup.exe file.
6. Save and then close the modified cmsetup.ini file. The .ini customizations you made will be
incorporated during setup if the file is copied to the same directory in which you saved
cmsetup.exe. To specify a different location for the .ini file, use the following command:
cmsetup.exe -install=<path>\cmsetup.ini
The following table describes the configuration options. For any optional components that you do
not specify, default values are used.
Option
Description
[Connectoid number] section
This section controls the basic settings for accessing the
appliance. Only one section can be specified (you cannot
configure multiple connection icons for Connect Mobile on a
handheld device). This section is required.
ConnectionName=name
The name for the connection as it will appear in the client user
interface. If you do not specify a value, the default connection
name of Aventail Connect Mobile is used. This setting is
optional.
334
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
Option
Description
VpnServer=host name | IP
address
The host name or IP address of the appliance. If you do not
specify a value, users must manually type the host name or
IP address of the appliance. This setting is optional.
LogonGroup=name
The name of the realm to log in to.
Locale=[AUTOMATIC |
English | Japanese |
Korean]
When set to AUTOMATIC (the default), the client application
determines which language to display based on the device's
locale configuration. Specifying a language overrides that
detection.
If the value for Locale is not supported or not recognized,
English is used. The value is not case sensitive.
AutoStart=[0 | 1]
Determines whether to automatically start the connection at
startup. The default value is 0 (automatic startup disabled).
This setting is optional.
Logging=[0 | 1]
Determines whether client logging is enabled. The default
value is 0 (logging disabled). This setting is optional.
ReAuthPrompt=[0 | 1]
Determines whether to automatically reprompt the user for
credentials if the session times out. The default value is 1
(enabled).
SilentIcon=[0 | 1]
In silent operation, determines whether an icon is displayed
in the taskbar notification area of the device’s Today page.
The default value is 0 (disabled). It is recommended that you
use this setting only after consulting SonicWALL Technical
Support.
SilentTrust=[0 | 1]
In silent operation, determines whether valid but untrusted
certificates are accepted. The default value is 0 (disabled). It
is recommended that you use this setting only after
consulting SonicWALL Technical Support.
LogonRetries=number
In silent operation, determines how many logon retry
attempts will be made before failure. Specify -1 to continue
retrying indefinitely. The default value is 3. It is recommended
that you use this setting only after consulting SonicWALL
Technical Support.
LogonRetrySeconds=number
In silent operation, determines how long (in seconds) to wait
between logon retry attempts. The default value is 5. It is
recommended that you use this setting only after consulting
SonicWALL Technical Support.
Sample cmsetup.ini file
[Connectoid 1]
ConnectionName="XYZ Company Network"
VpnServer=64.94.142.134
LogonGroup=Partners
Locale=AUTOMATIC
AutoStart=0
Logging=0
SilentIcon=0
SilentTrust=0
ReAuthPrompt=1
LogonRetries=3
LogonRetrySeconds=5
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
335
Running Connect as a Service
The Connect Tunnel client is a Windows client component of SonicWALL’s VPN solution that enables
secure, authorized access to Web-based and client/server applications, and to Windows file shares.
In a server environment, you can install and configure an add-on component—Connect Tunnel
Service—so that the VPN connection starts automatically without user intervention: no user login
is required, and no user interface or icons are displayed. For example, you may want to synchronize
data between a remote system in the field and a file server secured behind the VPN at corporate
headquarters. On the remote system (running the Windows Server platform), Connect Tunnel
Service is configured to run at a specific time, connect to the corporate file server, and synchronize
its database with the master database at headquarters.
Notes
z
Connect Tunnel has the capability to establish a dial-up connection before it makes a connection
to a SonicWALL appliance. The Connect Tunnel Service, on the other hand, does not support
this option; it requires an always-on, non-dialup network connection.
Installing Connect Tunnel Service
Using the Connect Tunnel Service involves installing both Connect Tunnel and Connect Tunnel
Service.
X
To install and configure Connect Tunnel Service
1. On the Client Installation Packages page in AMC (Agent Configuration > Download),
select a language and then download the installation packages for both the Connect Tunnel
(ngsetup_<xx>.exe) and Connect Tunnel Service (ctssetup_<xx>.exe).
2. Install Connect Tunnel first (ngsetup_<xx>.exe). A shortcut named Aventail VPN Connection
will be created on desktop.
3. Install Connect Tunnel Service (ctssetup_<xx>.exe). A shortcut named Aventail VPN Service
Options will be created on desktop.
4. On the desktop, double-click the Aventail VPN Service Options shortcut. Alternatively, doubleclick Aventail VPN Service Options in the Control Panel. The Aventail VPN Service
Properties dialog box appears.
336
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
5. On the VPN tab, configure the following settings:
Setting
Description
VPN Connection Name
Type the name of the Connect client connection object exactly as
it appears in the Windows Network Connections window
(Start|Connect To|Show All Connections). By default, this is
Aventail VPN Connection.
Hostname or IP address
Type the host name or IP address of the SonicWALL appliance to
log in to.
Login group
Type the name of the realm to log in to.
Username and Password
Type the credentials for a user in this Login group (realm).
6. On the Service tab, configure the following settings:
Setting
Description
Number of attempts to
restart a failed connection
Specify how many times to attempt restarting if an initial
connection attempt fails.
Time interval between
restart attempts
Specify the amount of time (in minutes) to wait between
restart attempts.
Click the Start and Stop buttons to control the service.
7. To verify that Connect Tunnel started, open the Aventail VPN Connection shortcut on the
desktop. You should see the established connection. Alternatively, you can issue the ipconfig
command on the command line to verify that you have a virtual IP address for the VPN
connection.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
337
Windows Services and Scripting Options
You can use Windows Services to manage Connect Tunnel Service on a local or remote computer.
X
How to use Windows Services to configure and run Connect Tunnel Service
1. On the computer running the Windows Server platform and Connect Tunnel Service, run
Windows Services, and then open the Aventail VPN Service Properties dialog box (Control
Panel > Administrative Tools > Services > Aventail VPN Service).
2. Use these settings to control the service (start, stop, pause, resume, or disable it), set up
recovery actions in case of service failure, or disable the service for a particular hardware
profile.
Using a Command or Script to Run Connect Tunnel Service
You can use the Windows sc.exe utility to communicate with Service Controller (services.exe) from
the command prompt or in a batch file. This enables you, for example, to automate the startup and
shutdown of the VPN service. Or, in an environment where you want users to be able to start the
VPN connection by clicking on a shortcut (and without being aware of the credentials), you could
also create a shortcut on the desktop that launches a command or batch file.
For example, start and stop the service on a remote computer with the following commands:
sc \\SERVERNAME start ctssrv
sc \\SERVERNAME stop ctssrv
To start or stop the Connect Tunnel Service from the command line or a third-party application,
invoke these commands:
%windir%\system32\sc.exe start ctssrv
%windir%\system32\sc.exe stop ctssrv
338
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
Troubleshooting
Use the Windows Event Viewer (Control Panel > Administrative Tools > Event Viewer>
Application > CTS) to view any information, warning, or error messages related to running
Connect Tunnel Service. For more detailed messages, look in the service log. The default location
is here:
%ALLUSERSPROFILE%\Application Data\Aventail
Notes
z
If your environment includes an outbound HTTP proxy for access to the Internet, you must use
one that does not require authentication, otherwise you will see the following error message in
the log file for Connect Tunnel Service (ctssrv.log): “Direct internet access is not available.” You
must also configure Connect Tunnel Service to run under a Windows user account with
administrative privileges.
Distributing SonicWALL Client Setup Packages
You can deploy the Connect Tunnel client and Connect Mobile setup packages to users from a
network location (such as a Web server, FTP server, or file server) without requiring them to log in
to Aventail WorkPlace.
For the Connect Tunnel client, you can also push an installation package to users through a
configuration management application such as Microsoft Systems Management Server (SMS) or
IBM Tivoli Configuration Manager, or distribute a disk image that includes a preconfigured Connect
Tunnel installation.
If you configured the client’s .ini file, you should distribute it along with the setup program (if you
distribute the setup program by itself the client will use the default settings).
Deploying Client Installation Packages for Connect Tunnel
The Connect Tunnel client can be installed as an .exe file, deployed using a Microsoft Installer (.msi)
file, or distributed as part of a disk image.
X
To deploy the Connect Tunnel client as an .exe file
Distribute the ngsetup_<xx>.exe file to users (<xx> represents the language you selected). If
you modified the ngsetup.ini file (as described in “Customizing the Configuration for the
Connect Tunnel Client” on page 328), distribute this file as well. To invoke the .ini file, pass it
as a command-line parameter to the setup program by typing the following command:
ngsetup_<xx>.exe -f=<path>\<configuration file name>
To simplify the user experience, you might write a batch file that calls the setup program with
this parameter.
X
To deploy the Connect Tunnel client using an .msi file
Set up your configuration management software program (such as Microsoft SMS or IBM
Tivoli) to deploy the .msi installation package and the modified ngsetup.ini file (if you created
one).
If you install the Connect Tunnel client this way (rather than running ngsetup_<xx>.exe.),
you must set the Windows Installer to do a per-machine, rather than a per-user, installation.
(A per-user installation does not make the registry entries that are necessary for later
updates.)
To specify a per-machine installation so that subsequent MSI updates will be supported, follow
these steps:
a. Download ngsetup_<xx>.exe from the Client Installation Packages page in AMC, and
then extract the installation files by typing the following command. The destination for the
unpacked files will be the current working directory unless you specify a <path> with the
expand parameter:
ngsetup_<xx>.exe -expand=<path>
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
339
b. Modify the ngsetup.ini file (as described in “Customizing the Configuration for the Connect
Tunnel Client” on page 328) as needed.
c. To run Windows Installer, type the following:
msiexec.exe /i ngvpn.msi ALLUSERS=1 NGSETUP=1 CONFIGURATIONFILE=<path>\<.ini
file name>
X
To deploy the Connect Tunnel client as a disk image
Disk cloning is a common method for distributing Windows operating systems and
applications. If you decide to use this distribution method for Connect Tunnel, you must run
the Windows System Preparation Tool (Sysprep.exe) to prepare the disk image for duplication.
Without Sysprep, the computer’s security ID (SID) remains unchanged and Connect Tunnel’s
unique identifier is then duplicated, resulting in IP address conflicts. Here is a broad outline of
how to prepare and distribute disk images:
a. Install Connect Tunnel for Windows on a reference system and configure it as needed.
b. Run the Windows System Preparation Tool and shut down the computer.
c. Duplicate the master disk using a third-party application or disk duplicator.
d. When the disk is inserted into the destination computers, Mini-Setup will prompt the user
for information (for example, the computer name). You can automate this step by creating
an “answer file” (sysprep.inf). For more information about using System Preparation Tool,
refer to the Microsoft Web site:
http://support.microsoft.com/kb/302577
Deploying Client Installation Packages for Connect Mobile
The Connect Mobile client runs on Windows Mobile-powered devices. To install the client, use
ActiveSync to synchronize the mobile device to a Windows desktop computer through a serial, USB,
or network connection. With ActiveSync installed and the mobile device cradled, the desktop
installation program copies the application files and configures the initial settings. After installation,
the mobile device can be uncradled and connected to its Internet service provider for VPN usage.
X
To deploy Connect Mobile as an .exe file
Distribute the cmsetup.exe file to users. If you modified the cmsetup.ini file (as described in
“Customizing the Configuration for the Connect Mobile Client” on page 333), you should
distribute it as well. To invoke the .ini file, put it in the same folder as the .exe file program
and have users run the executable. If the .ini file is stored in a different folder, pass it as a
command line parameter to the setup program, as follows:
cmsetup.exe -install=z:\yourcompany.com\sonicwall_apps\ini\cmsetup.ini
Notes
z
The ActiveSync installer normally gives you the option of installing programs on an external
storage card. Do not choose this option for Connect Mobile: installing onto an external storage
card causes file system access errors at device startup.
The OnDemand Proxy Agent
The OnDemand Proxy Agent is a secure, lightweight agent that provides access to TCP/IP resources.
It uses local loopback proxying to redirect communication to protected network resources according
to routing directives defined in AMC (it does not support UDP applications).
Note that the OnDemand Proxy Agent does not scale as effectively as the OnDemand Tunnel agent.
The OnDemand Proxy Agent is not recommended for usage as a broad VPN agent, but instead
should be targeted for access to specific applications through WorkPlace. In situations where you
want to provide broad access to applications through the WorkPlace portal for more than 500
concurrent users at a time, we recommend that you deploy the OnDemand Tunnel agent instead.
340
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
Note that you can use OnDemand Proxy as a fallback for OnDemand Tunnel in case OnDemand
Tunnel cannot be installed (perhaps due to issues around administrative rights). In that scenario,
you would configure both OnDemand Tunnel and OnDemand Proxy within a community.
This section provides an overview of OnDemand and describes how to configure and deploy it.
Overview: OnDemand Proxy
OnDemand Proxy is a loopback-based proxy solution that secures communication between a client
application and an application server.
The following diagram illustrates the connection sequence:
1. OnDemand starts automatically when the user logs in to WorkPlace.
2. OnDemand runs within the WorkPlace window.
3. OnDemand waits for application requests on the local loopback address (127.0.0.1) and
redirects the traffic to the Web proxy service.
4. The Web proxy service proxies the traffic to an application server using the application’s
required port(s).
5. The application server sends application traffic to the Web proxy service.
6. The Web proxy service sends the application traffic to OnDemand, which then passes it to the
client application.
OnDemand supports TCP applications that use one or multiple ports, including applications that
dynamically define ports (it does not support UDP-based applications). Here are applications that
are typically accessed using OnDemand:
Application
Examples
Resident client/server
Internet email applications:
Typically, these client applications
are installed locally on the client
computer
z
Microsoft Outlook
z
Outlook Express
z
Lotus Notes
z
Netscape Mail
z
Eudora
Terminal emulation applications:
z
WRQ Reflection
z
NetManage RUMBA PC-to-Host
Remote office connectivity applications:
z
Citrix ICA/MetaFrame
z
Microsoft Windows Terminal Services
By default, OnDemand is configured to run automatically when the user connects to WorkPlace. For
optimum performance, OnDemand is installed on the user’s computer the first time it is accessed,
minimizing download time for returning users.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
341
OnDemand Mapped Mode
By default, OnDemand starts automatically when users log in to WorkPlace. Mapped mode enables
users to click a shortcut that is configured for a specific application. Optionally, you can configure
OnDemand to automatically launch a specified Web URL when users click a shortcut. This is useful
for starting an application (such as a thin-client application) when OnDemand runs. You must
manually create any shortcuts to specific applications. Mapped mode is supported on Windows,
Macintosh, and Linux platforms.
On Windows PCs, when a user logs in to WorkPlace for the first time, WorkPlace automatically
downloads, installs, and launches OnDemand on the user’s computer (assuming the community the
user belongs to is configured to do so). On subsequent WorkPlace logins, WorkPlace automatically
starts OnDemand.
Activating OnDemand
By default, when OnDemand is enabled, it starts automatically when users log in to WorkPlace and
runs within the WorkPlace window. Users must keep the WorkPlace window open while working with
OnDemand in this embedded mode.
Notes
z
Users cannot start an application from the OnDemand window. Unless you configure a URL to
launch automatically when users start OnDemand, users must manually start applications as
they would normally.
z
Users may need to configure their personal firewalls to allow OnDemand traffic.
How OnDemand Redirects Network Traffic
OnDemand uses the local loopback address to redirect and secure traffic through the appliance. This
section provides an overview of loopback proxying and describes the various redirection methods.
Overview: Loopback Proxying
OnDemand uses local loopback proxying to securely submit application traffic through the Web
proxy service. For example, suppose a Windows user wants to connect to the appliance and run a
Citrix application:
1. The user logs in to WorkPlace, and OnDemand automatically starts.
2. OnDemand dynamically maps the local loopback address to the host name for the Citrix
server.
3. The user runs the Citrix application, which attempts to connect to citrix.example.com.
OnDemand resolves the Citrix host name to 127.0.0.1 and routes the traffic to the Web proxy
service.
4. OnDemand encrypts the Citrix traffic using SSL and securely routes it to the SonicWALL
appliance, which in turn forwards it to the Citrix server.
5. The Citrix server responds, sending data back through the SonicWALL appliance.
6. The appliance forwards the response to OnDemand over SSL.
7. OnDemand forwards the information to the Citrix application.
Hosts File Redirection
To redirect traffic to destination servers, modify the hosts file on the user’s computer. This
redirection method is supported on Windows, Macintosh, and Linux platforms, provided the user
has administrator privileges on the local computer.
Modifying the hosts file on a user’s system maps a destination server to a local loopback address.
When an application attempts to resolve a host name, traffic is redirected to the loopback address
on which OnDemand is listening.
342
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
The following example shows a typical hosts file, with host names mapped to IP addresses, followed
by a hosts file modified for use by OnDemand. Notice that the OnDemand host names are mapped
to the local loopback address, not the host’s IP address. For application-specific configurations,
these loopback addresses would match the addresses you specify when configuring OnDemand in
AMC; for more information, see “Configuring OnDemand to Access Specific Applications” on
page 342.
Typical Hosts File
192.168.1.135 telnet.example.com telnet
192.168.1.140 mailhost.example.com mail
192.168.1.143 citrix.example.com citrix
OnDemand Hosts File
127.0.0.1 telnet.example.com telnet
127.0.0.1 mailhost.example.com mail
127.0.0.1 citrix.example.com citrix
Configuring OnDemand to Access Specific Applications
If you are deploying OnDemand to users on non-Windows platforms, or want to automatically use
the launch URL feature to start a thin-client application when users run OnDemand, you must define
an application-specific configuration in AMC. This involves mapping the port numbers for the client
and server, a process called “port mapping.”
Overview: Port Mapping
To configure OnDemand to redirect traffic for a specific application, you need to know the port
numbers the application uses for the client and server, and then map those ports in AMC.
OnDemand listens for incoming requests on specific ports on the client and then proxies them to
the appliance, which forwards the information to an IP address and port on the application server.
For example, you might configure an IP address and port on the client (such as 127.0.1.1:23) to
the host or IP address and port on the destination server, such as telneta.example.com:23.
Some applications—such as email—use multiple ports for different protocols. In this case, you must
configure OnDemand to listen on several different ports. This configuration can also be useful for
configuring OnDemand to work with several different applications. The following example shows
OnDemand configured to work with three applications over five different ports.
In this example OnDemand is configured to listen on port 23 for telnet and port 1494 for Citrix. For
email requests it is listening on port 25 (SMTP), port 110 (POP3), and port 143 (IMAP).
Configuring an Application for Use with OnDemand
To configure an application, you need to know the protocols it uses for each service and map the
source address and ports on the client to those on the destination host. You also have the option of
specifying a URL to open a Web page, which is useful for automatically starting an application, when
the user runs OnDemand.
X
To configure an application for use with OnDemand
1. On the main navigation menu of AMC, click Agent Configuration.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
343
2. In the Aventail OnDemand area under Aventail access agents, click Edit. The Configure
OnDemand page appears.
3. In the Mapped mode area, click New.
4. In the Application name box, type the name to use for the application. This name is
displayed to the user in Aventail WorkPlace. Use a short, descriptive name.
5. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the application.
6. Configure each service used by the application in the Add mapping area.
a. Click the Edit button beside the Destination resource box, select the network resource
you want to configure, and then click Save. Alternatively, you can create a new network
resource by clicking the New Resource button in the Resources dialog box.
b. If the IP address/port combination of the service conflicts with that of another service, you
can modify the IP address displayed in the Local host box, or you can map the ports as
described below. You can change the Local host value to any IP address in the 127.x.y.z
address space.
c. In the Service type list, select the type of service used by the application. This populates
the Destination/local ports boxes with the well-known port for that service. If the
service uses a destination port that differs from that of the local port, map the ports to
each other by editing the information in the Destination/local ports boxes as needed.
d. Click Add to Current Mapping. This adds the mapping to the Current mapping list.
7. If the application uses multiple services, repeat step six to configure each one. Most
applications use only one service, but some (like email) use multiple protocols, which requires
multiple services.
344
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
8. Select the Create shortcut on Aventail WorkPlace check box.
{
If you want OnDemand to open a Web page automatically (which is useful for
automatically starting a thin-client application), type the URL of the appropriate page in
the Start an application by launching this URL box. You must specify either an http://
or an https:// protocol identifier. The URL you specify automatically opens in a new
browser window after OnDemand loads.
{
In WorkPlace you can set up groups to organize resources for your users, or have
shortcuts appear singly. In the Add this shortcut to group list, select a new or existing
group to which to add your shortcut, or select Standalone shortcuts if you want it to
appear on its own. (The order in which shortcuts appear can be changed on the Configure
WorkPlace Layout page; see “Creating or Editing a WorkPlace Layout” on page 304 for
more information.)
Notes
z
After you initially configure the Create shortcut on Aventail WorkPlace option, you can view
its setting only on the Mapped Mode page; you cannot edit it on this page. After initially
configuring this setting, shortcuts are managed from the Shortcuts page in AMC. For more
information, see “Working with WorkPlace Shortcuts” on page 292.
Configuring Advanced OnDemand Options
This section describes how to access the appliance using its external IP address and add debug
messages to the OnDemand logs.
Accessing the Appliance Using Its External IP Address
By default, OnDemand accesses the appliance using the FQDN contained in the appliance’s SSL
certificate. This works in a production environment—where the FQDN is added to public DNS—but
may be an issue in a test environment for one of two reasons:
z
You have not added the FQDN for the appliance to DNS.
z
The external IP address does not match the external network address on the appliance because
your environment uses Network Address Translation (NAT).
In either case, you will need to configure OnDemand to use the IP address for the external network
interface.
X
To configure OnDemand to use the appliance’s external IP address
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Agent Configuration.
2. In the Aventail access agents area, to the right of Aventail OnDemand, click Edit. The
Configure OnDemand page appears.
3. Click to expand the Advanced area and then, in the Appliance FQDN or IP address box,
type the IP address for the external network interface.
Before moving the appliance into production, make sure this value contains the FQDN from the
appliance’s SSL certificate. Whenever you update the appliance’s SSL certificate, AMC automatically
inserts the FQDN in this field (overwriting any value you’ve previously specified).
The first time a user starts OnDemand, the Web browser displays a security warning asking the user
to grant permissions to run OnDemand. For information on configuring the browser, see
“Suppressing the Java Security Warning” on page 345.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
345
Adding Debug Messages to the OnDemand Logs
Normally, the OnDemand logs show just information and warning messages. You can also log debug
messages, but this should be done only when you are troubleshooting (otherwise the log file
becomes too large).
X
To add debug messages to the OnDemand logs
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Agent Configuration.
2. In the Aventail access agents area, to the right of Aventail OnDemand, click Edit. The
Configure OnDemand page appears.
3. Click to expand the Advanced area, and then select the Enable debug OnDemand log
messages check box.
Client Configuration
This section explains client-side configuration that may be useful for working with OnDemand.
Suppressing the Java Security Warning
When OnDemand starts, the Web browser displays a security warning asking the user to grant
permission to run OnDemand. This warning varies, depending on the operating system and browser.
The user must accept this certificate to run OnDemand.
OnDemand includes a Java code-signing certificate that ensures the validity of the applet. For
Windows and Mac OS X, the certificate includes a Class 3 Digital ID from Thawte, which is widely
used by commercial software publishers.
To prevent the security prompt from appearing each time OnDemand is started, users can configure
their systems to trust the SonicWALL certificate. Once this is done, the browser trusts all
subsequent software downloads from SonicWALL.
Configuring a Proxy Server in the Web Browser
When passing an outbound connection over a proxy server, OnDemand uses the Web browser’s
settings to determine the proxy server address and port. This configuration requires the user to
configure his or her Web browser, either by specifying the outbound proxy server address and port
or by enabling automatic proxy detection.
If a user enables both automatic proxy detection and manual proxy identification, OnDemand
checks for proxy server settings in this order:
1. If the Automatically detect settings option is enabled, OnDemand attempts to
automatically detect the proxy server settings.
2. If OnDemand is unable to automatically detect the proxy server settings, it checks to see if the
Use automatic configuration script option is enabled.
3. If OnDemand is unable to detect the proxy server settings through a configuration script, it
uses the proxy server settings that the user manually specified.
X
To configure automatic proxy detection in Internet Explorer for Windows
1. On the Tools menu, click Internet Options.
2. On the Connections tab, click LAN Settings.
3. Under Automatic Configuration, enable one or both of the options:
{
To automatically detect proxy-server settings, select the Automatically detect settings
check box. (This option is supported only for users running Internet Explorer with the
Microsoft Virtual Machine.)
{
To use configuration information contained in a configuration file, select the Use
automatic configuration script check box and then, in the Address box, type the URL
or path for the configuration file.
346
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
X
To manually specify proxy server settings in Internet Explorer for Windows
1. On the Tools menu, click Internet Options.
2. On the Connections tab, click LAN Settings.
3. Under Proxy Server, select the Use a proxy server check box, and specify the IP address
and port for it.
If a different proxy server is used for different protocols, click Advanced and specify the
necessary information; be sure to specify proxy servers for both HTTP and Secure.
!
CAUTION Enabling either of the automatic settings in the LAN Settings dialog box
(Automatically detect settings or Use automatic configuration script) may override the
proxy server settings; clear these two check boxes to ensure that proxy detection works
correctly.
Managing the SonicWALL Access Services
This section provides an overview of the SonicWALL access services, and describes how to start,
stop, and configure the services.
Overview: Access Services
Users can access VPN resources secured by the SonicWALL appliance using three primary methods,
or access services. This section describes each of the access services and the types of resources
they provide access to.
z
The network tunnel service is a network routing technology that provides secure network
tunnel access to a wide range of client/server applications, including those that use non-TCP
protocols such as VoIP and ICMP, reverse-connection protocols, and bi-directional protocols,
such as those used by remote Help Desk applications. It works in conjunction with the Connect
Tunnel client and the OnDemand Tunnel agent to provide authenticated and encrypted access.
The network tunnel service can traverse firewalls, NAT devices, and other proxy servers that
can interfere with traditional VPN devices.
When Web resource filtering is enabled for the network tunnel service, policies for tunnel
sessions can use URL-based rules in addition to IP-based rules.
z
The Web proxy service provides users with secure access to Web-based applications, Web
servers, and network file servers from a Web browser, or Web-based applications and Web
servers from a Windows Mobile-powered device using the Connect Mobile client. The Web proxy
service is a secure HTTP reverse proxy that brokers and encrypts access to Web-based
resources.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
z
|
347
The Aventail WorkPlace service controls access to network file shares accessed from a Web
browser. The Aventail WorkPlace service communicates with Windows file servers and network
shares (including Microsoft Distributed file system, or Dfs, resources) using the Server Message
Block (SMB) file-sharing protocol. For information about configuring the Aventail WorkPlace
service, see “Configuring WorkPlace General Settings” on page 291.
Access Services
Web browser
OnDemand proxy agent
(HTTP protocol)
Web proxy
OnDemand Tunnel agent
Connect Tunnel client
(IP protocol)
Network
tunnel
Aventail Connect
Mobile client
(TCP protocol)
Network
proxy
Back-end
Resources
The table below illustrates the relationships between the SonicWALL access services and the user
access components that they control.
Service
Network tunnel service
Web proxy service
Aventail WorkPlace service
User access components
z
OnDemand Tunnel agent
z
Connect Tunnel client
z
Connect Mobile client
z
Web proxy agent
z
Translated Web access
z
Custom port mapped
Web access
z
Custom FQDN mapped
Web access
z
WorkPlace portal
Description
z
Manages TCP/IP and non-TCP
(such as VoIP and ICMP)
connections from the network
tunnel clients.
z
Provides network-level access to
all resources, effectively making
the user’s computer a node on
your network.
z
Includes support for mapped
network drives, native email
clients, and applications that make
reverse connections, such as VoIP.
z
Manages HTTP and TCP/IP
connections from Web browsers
and the Connect Mobile client.
z
Provides a Web-based portal that
is available from any Web browser.
z
Provides access to file-system
resources.
z
Provisions and deploys all user
access components.
Stopping and Starting the SonicWALL Access Services
You may occasionally want to temporarily stop one of the SonicWALL services.
348
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
!
X
CAUTION SonicWALL recommends stopping the services only during scheduled maintenance
periods or during off hours. Also, you should give your users advance warning that the service
will be going down.
To start or stop a service
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services.
2. Under Access Services, click the appropriate link:
{
Click Stop to stop the service. All existing user connections will be terminated.
{
Click Start to start the service.
Configuring the Network Tunnel Service
The network tunnel service controls access from the Connect Tunnel client and the OnDemand
Tunnel agent. In order to deploy the network tunnel clients to users, you must first make one or
more IP address pools available to the community. Configuring the network tunnel service requires
setting up IP address pools that are used to allocate IP addresses to the clients; these IP addresses
become the clients’ end points on VPN connections.
Network tunnel service configuration also allows you to enable Web resource filtering so that you
can enforce the same URL-based rules that administrators define for ExtraWeb in tunnel sessions.
Web resource filtering also allows you to leverage single sign-on functionality when accessing Web
applications.
You can also set up fallback servers to give network tunnel clients a list of servers to contact in the
event of a connection failure.
X
To configure the network tunnel service
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
349
2. Under Access services, in the Network tunnel service area, click Configure. The
Configure Network Tunnel Service page appears.
3. In the IP address pools area, create one or more IP address pools. For more information,
see “Configuring IP Address Pools” on page 349.
4. To enable and configure Web resource filtering, click Edit in the Web resource filtering
area. For more information, see “Configuring Web Resource Filtering” on page 355.
5. To configure fallback servers that network tunnel clients can contact in the event of a
connection failure, click the New button in the Fallback servers area. For more information,
see “Configuring Fallback Servers” on page 356.
Configuring IP Address Pools
IP address pools are used to allocate IP addresses to the network tunnel clients. When a user makes
a connection using the Connect Tunnel client or the OnDemand Tunnel agent, the SonicWALL
appliance assigns the client an IP address from one of its configured address pools. Only pools
allowed for the client’s community are considered. For more information about how IP addresses
are allocated to a community, see “IP Address Allocation” on page 170.
For information about editing and deleting IP address pools, see “Adding, Editing, Copying, and
Deleting Objects in AMC” on page 43.
Address Pool Allocation Methods
You can configure IP address allocation in the following ways:
Translated Address Pools (Source NAT)
With translated address pools, the appliance assigns non-routable IP addresses to clients and uses
source network address translation (Source NAT) to translate them to a single address you
configure for back-end traffic. The appliance uses the name servers you specify in AMC to define
350
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
the DNS and WINS settings on the client. Source NAT translates the client’s non-routable source
address to a single configured address from a fixed, non-routable sequence (2.0.0.2 through
2.255.254.254) on the internal network.
The advantages of using translated address pools are:
z
Source NAT address pools require only a single back-end address, which is shared by all remote
connections.
z
Fewer IP addresses are required for the tunnel clients.
The constraints of this type of pool are:
z
All network activity must be initiated by the client; therefore, this method of IP address
allocation does not support applications that make reverse connections or cross-connections
(such as SMS, VoIP, or FTP).
z
Windows domain browsing is not supported; if users try to browse a Windows domain through
Network Explorer or Network Neighborhood, an error message indicates that they are not
authorized to access the resources.
z
Client-to-client cross-connections are not supported.
Routed Address Pools (DHCP)
With a routed address pool, IP addresses are dynamically allocated to the tunnel clients from a
DHCP server. DHCP address pools have these characteristics:
z
They require an external server that has enough spare addressing capacity to support the new
remote clients. These pools are easy to set up and maintain, and impose few restrictions on
client activity.
z
Reverse connections and cross-connections are supported, but client IP addresses must be
known. If necessary, you can associate a fixed DHCP address with a particular client by
configuring the DHCP client ID on the DHCP server. Client IDs are generated during client
configuration; consult the DHCP server logs to find particular IDs.
RADIUS-Assigned Address Pools
Some applications require a one-to-one relationship between an assigned IP address and a user.
This is best supported by a RADIUS server, where IP address allocation happens during the
authorization process, as part of authentication.
This strict one-to-one correlation may have some unintended consequences:
z
For example, if an employee is logged in to the appliance at work and forgets to log out, logging
in from home will fail: the IP address is still attached to the original tunnel connection at the
office. Optionally, you can configure the community and realm in AMC that is referencing the
RADIUS server to use other IP address pools if the RADIUS pool is exhausted.
z
If you have two appliances authenticating against the same RADIUS server and both are using
RADIUS pools, duplicate address assignments will be made, resulting in multiple network
conflicts.
Static Address Pools
With static address pools, you specify one or more static IP address pools from which IP addresses
will be allocated to the tunnel clients. You can configure static IP address pools as subnets or
address ranges. Static address pools have these characteristics:
z
Static address pools require no configuration work outside of the appliance, and they support
reverse connections and cross-connections.
z
Static pools require identification of one back-end address per simultaneous remote connection.
If enough addresses are available to cover all possible remote clients (not just simultaneous
connections) and no address conflicts occur, this method tends to be the most stable because
the same address is typically assigned to the same client.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
351
z
Static pools leave an IP address assigned as long as the tunnel remains up. If the tunnel goes
down, there is a two-minute period during which the address is available, but only for
reassignment to the same client. After that two minute period expires, the address is available
to any client; address reassignment is performed using an LRU (Least Recently Used) scheme.
z
Windows domain browsing is supported.
Best Practices for Configuring IP Address Pools
Here are some best practices to keep in mind when configuring IP address pools:
z
z
Don’t duplicate addresses:
{
When configuring static IP address pools, do not specify IP addresses that are already
assigned to other network resources.
{
Be aware that any IP addresses you configure for use by the network tunnel clients may
conflict with IP addresses already in use on the client networks. Whenever possible, avoid
configuring IP addresses that you know to be in use on your users’ networks.
{
When configuring translated (Source NAT) IP address pools, be sure to specify an unused
address on the subnet of the internal interface.
{
If you are using RADIUS pools on more than one appliance, and the appliances are
authenticating against the same RADIUS server, duplicate address assignments will be
made.
When configuring dynamic DHCP or static IP address pools, ensure that you have enough IP
addresses to accommodate your maximum number of concurrent users. For example, if your
maximum concurrent user count is 100, you should make at least 100 IP addresses available.
Adding Translated IP Address Pools
This section describes how to create a translated IP address pool using secure network address
translation (Source NAT).
X
To add a translated IP address pool
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services.
2. Under Access services, in the Network tunnel service area, click Configure. The
Configure Network Tunnel Service page appears.
3. In the IP address pools area, click New. The Configure IP Address Pool page appears.
4. In the Name box, type a name for the address pool.
5. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the address pool.
6. Click Translated address pool (Source NAT).
7. In the IP address box, type the Source NAT address that will appear to back-end servers as
the source of all client traffic. Ensure that this IP address is not in use elsewhere.
8. Click Save.
Adding Dynamic IP Address Pools
This section describes how to create a dynamic IP address pool.
352
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
X
To add a dynamic IP address pool
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services.
2. Under Access services, in the Network tunnel service area, click Configure. The
Configure Network Tunnel Service page appears.
3. In the IP address pools area, click New. The Configure IP Address Pool page appears.
4. In the Name box, type a name for the address pool.
5. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the address pool.
6. Click Routed address pool - dynamic.
7. By default the DHCP server box is blank; the appliance sends broadcast requests to locate
DHCP servers and uses them to allocate addresses. Leave this box blank unless you need to
configure a specific DHCP server.
8. Click Save. (DHCP address pools ignore the Advanced settings on this AMC page.)
Adding RADIUS-Assigned IP Address Pools
This section describes how to create a dynamic, RADIUS-assigned IP address pool.
X
To add a RADIUS-assigned IP address pool
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services.
2. Under Access services, in the Network tunnel service area, click Configure. The
Configure Network Tunnel Service page appears.
3. In the IP address pools area, click New. The Configure IP Address Pool page appears.
4. In the Name box, type a name for the address pool.
5. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the address pool.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
353
6. Click RADIUS-assigned - dynamic to configure a pool in which IP address allocation is made
during the authorization process, as part of authentication. You would choose this setting if, for
example, you have an application that requires a one-to-one relationship between an assigned
IP address and a user.
7. (Optional) To change the virtual interface settings for configuring the client interface, click to
expand the Advanced area. The Virtual interface settings are preconfigured with the DNS
server, WINS server, and Search domains as defined on the Network Settings page.
(For more information, see “Configuring Basic Network Settings” on page 56.) To change
these settings, select the Customize default settings check box and then specify custom
values for any settings that you want to change.
8. Click Save.
Adding Static IP Address Pools
This section describes how to create a static IP address pool.
X
To add a static IP address pool
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services.
2. Under Access services, in the Network tunnel service area, click Configure.
354
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
3. In the IP address pools area, click New. The Configure IP Address Pool page appears.
4. In the Name box, type a name for the address pool.
5. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the address pool.
6. Click Routed address pool - static, and then click New.
7. Specify the IP address or addresses to make available to the tunnel clients. Type IP addresses
and subnet masks using dotted decimal form (n.n.n.n).
{
To define a single host, type an IP address and a Subnet mask of 255.255.255.255.
{
To specify a range of IP addresses, type the beginning address in the IP address box and
the ending address in the IP range end box, and specify a Subnet mask.
{
To define an entire subnet, type the network address in the IP address box and fill in the
Subnet mask box. The subnet mask is converted to a range and values are filled in as
appropriate. If the IP address of the subnet is entered, it is converted to the first usable
address in the network, but addresses in the middle of the subnet are used as is. The
ending address is filled in with the highest usable address in the subnet.
8. Click OK. The pool is added to the list of available IP address pools.
9. (Optional) To change the virtual interface settings for configuring the client interface, click to
expand the Advanced area. The Virtual interface settings are preconfigured with the DNS
server, WINS server, and Search domains as defined on the Network Settings page.
(For more information, see “Configuring Basic Network Settings” on page 56.) To change
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
355
these settings, select the Customize default settings check box and then specify custom
values for any settings that you want to change.
10. Click Save.
Configuring Web Resource Filtering
Web resource filtering enables extra processing for defined IP addresses and ports to detect HTTP
traffic. When HTTP requests are found, policy and single sign-on logic are applied to the Web server
connections.
Web resource filtering allows you to enforce the same URL-based rules in tunnel sessions that
administrators define for ExtraWeb. It also allows you to leverage single sign-on functionality when
accessing Web applications.
When Web resource filtering is not enabled, the available policies for Web access and tunnel access
are not equivalent. The Web access cases can evaluate URL policy for all translated access and HTTP
access for Web proxy and port map clients. For users connected via a tunnel, the IP layer redirection
only permits policies based on IP address. In deployments where multiple Web addresses or
namespaces are hosted on a single Web server, all of the Web content is reachable at a single IP
address or pool of addresses. Basing policy on just the IP layer does not permit the administrator
to enforce policy distinctions between the multiple namespaces. Enabling Web resource filtering
allows policies to use URL-based rules in addition to IP-based rules for tunnel sessions.
X
To configure Web resource filtering
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services.
2. In the Access services area, click Configure under Network tunnel service.
3. In the Web resource filtering area, click Edit. The Configure Tunnel Web Policy page
appears.
4. Select the Enable web resource filtering checkbox to cause the tunnel service to check all
client traffic at ports that may contain Web network traffic.
5. Click Save.
356
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
Configuring Fallback Servers
Fallback servers give network tunnel clients a list of servers to contact in the event of a connection
failure.
X
To configure fallback servers
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services.
2. In the Access services area, click Configure under Network tunnel service.
3. In the Fallback servers area, click New to add a fallback server. The Fallback servers table
displays editable fields for the server and realm.
4. Type the IP address of the fallback server into the Server field.
5. To specify a realm to use on the fallback server, type the realm name into the Realm field.
Specifying the realm is optional. If none is specified, the primary realm will be used.
6. Click OK.
7. When more than one fallback server is listed, to change the order of the servers, select the
checkbox next to one server and then click either Move Up or Move Down. The list is
updated with the new order.
8. To delete a fallback server, select the checkbox next to it and then click Delete.
Configuring the Web Proxy Service
This section describes how to configure the service that manages access to Web resources. The Web
proxy service provides Web proxy access, translated Web access, custom port mapped Web access,
and custom FQDN mapped Web access.
X
To configure the Web proxy service
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
357
2. In the Access services area, click Configure under Web proxy service.
3. On the General tab, select Enable HTTP compression if you want to compress HTML, XML,
and CSS files before they are sent from the appliance to the client. This reduces the download
size of Web pages accessed through the appliance, but may also affect system performance.
Enabling compression may affect system performance.
4. Configure Downstream Web resources:
{
If you want the Web proxy service to check the validity of certificates presented by backend Web servers, select Validate SSL server certificates. If enabled, the appliance will
make sure the CN in the certificate matches the host name and that the certificate is valid.
SonicWALL recommends enabling this feature if you are using downstream HTTPS.
{
To view details about the appliance’s root certificate listing CAs that issued certificates to
back-end Web servers, or to import a certificate, click the SSL Settings link. For more
information about managing CA certificates, see “CA Certificates” on page 73.
Notes
z
For information about configuring Web application profiles, see “Adding Web Application
Profiles” on page 140.
Terminal Server Access
The SonicWALL appliance supports native Web-based access to individual Windows Terminal
Services or Citrix servers, and to Citrix server farms. The Native Access Module requires a separate
license; contact your channel partner or SonicWALL sales representative for information on
purchasing one.
Providing Access to Terminal Server Resources
The Web-based graphical terminal agents provide access to a terminal server using native
application protocols. For example, when accessing a Citrix server, the client sends traffic from the
client to the server using the proprietary (non-HTTP) Citrix protocol. Accordingly, to provide access
to a terminal server resource, you must configure WorkPlace to provision one of the SonicWALL
access methods (the Web proxy agent or one of the tunnel clients). If you configure WorkPlace to
provide only Translated Web access, terminal resources will be unavailable because the client
computer will not have the network transport required to access a proprietary application protocol.
For information about configuring access methods, see “Selecting Access Methods for a
Community” on page 166.
You can enable single sign-on for applications hosted on Windows Terminal Services or a Citrix
server; this passes the user’s WorkPlace login credentials to all published applications on the server.
If you disable single sign-on, an additional login page is displayed and the user must supply the
required credentials before accessing any applications that are hosted on the terminal server.
358
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
Enabling access to terminal server resources consists of the following basic steps:
Step 1: Define the terminal server resources and access policy
First define individual Windows Terminal Services or Citrix servers, or Citrix server farms, and then
add these resources to access control rules:
z
You must define each host or Citrix server farm object as a resource in AMC. If your network
includes a set of Citrix servers that have similar names, you can save time by using wildcard
characters to define one resource object that includes multiple servers.
If you are configuring a Citrix server farm, you must also define each individual Citrix server
that is hosting applications as a resource. For information about defining Citrix server farms,
see “Adding Citrix Server Farm Resources” on page 359.
z
Reference the resources in access control rules as you would any other resource. For
information about providing terminal server access to individual Windows Terminal Services or
Citrix servers, and see “Defining an Access Control Rule and Resource for Terminal Server
Access” on page 360.
Step 2: Install or update the appropriate graphical terminal agent
When a user initiates a connection to a Citrix or Windows Terminal Services resource through
Aventail WorkPlace, the appliance determines whether the version of the applicable agent that is
available on the appliance is already installed on the user’s computer, and automatically installs or
updates the agent as needed. You must ensure that the correct graphical terminal agents are
configured in AMC; for information about managing the agents, see “Managing Graphical Terminal
Agents” on page 361.
Step 3: Create a WorkPlace shortcut that references the terminal server resource
The Windows Terminal Services or Citrix host is accessed from a Web-based agent that is deployed
when users click a shortcut in Aventail WorkPlace. For information about configuring graphical
terminal WorkPlace shortcuts, see “Graphical Terminal Shortcuts” on page 362.
Citrix Server Resources
For Citrix deployments, the SonicWALL appliance enables you to specify individual Citrix servers, or
one or more load-balanced Citrix server farms.
To enable users to access Citrix resources, first configure the appliance with two Citrix agents: an
ActiveX control that runs on Windows, and a cross-platform Java applet. Once the agent files are
uploaded to the appliance, the appropriate Citrix client is automatically provisioned to users the first
time they access a Citrix resource from Aventail WorkPlace. For details, see “Managing Graphical
Terminal Agents” on page 361. The appliance supports all desktop operating systems and
applications that are supported by the Citrix clients. Small form factor devices are not supported.
For individual Citrix servers, you can specify a custom ICA file; these files contain additional
configuration settings for the Citrix host.
Citrix server farms must meet the following system requirements:
z
Citrix MetaFrame XP, or Citrix MetaFrame 1.8 with a license for Service Pack 2 and Feature
Release 1 (SP2/FR1)
z
Citrix XML service must be running
When a user clicks a WorkPlace shortcut that points to a Citrix server farm, a separate WorkPlace
window appears and displays the resources that are hosted on the server. The WorkPlace Web
interface provides the services that users need to browse and work with applications that are hosted
on Citrix servers in the farm. There is no need to deploy an additional Web interface. The user can
browse these resources and click links to automatically launch applications. The Citrix applications
appear in the Citrix client window.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
359
Adding Citrix Server Farm Resources
This section describes how to define a Citrix server farm as a resource. For information about
providing terminal server access to Citrix servers, see “Defining an Access Control Rule and
Resource for Terminal Server Access” on page 360.
X
To add a Citrix server farm resource
1. On the main navigation menu in AMC, click Resources.
2. On the Resources page, click New and then select Citrix server farm from the list. The Add
Resource - Citrix Server Farm page appears.
3. In the Name box, type a name for the server farm.
4. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the server farm. This step is
optional, but a description can be helpful later when viewing your list of resources.
5. To create a shortcut to the server farm on WorkPlace, select the Create shortcut on
Aventail WorkPlace check box. The Name and Description that you specify for this
resource will appear as the shortcut link text and description text on the Aventail WorkPlace
home page. For information about managing WorkPlace shortcuts, see “Working with
WorkPlace Shortcuts” on page 292.
6. Under Citrix XML servers, click New and then specify the servers that are included in the
server farm. Each server farm must include at least one Citrix MetaFrame server.
360
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
a. In the Host or IP address box, type the host name or IP address for the Citrix
MetaFrame server.
b. In the Port box, type the number of the port through which the appliance connects to the
XML browser service on the Citrix MetaFrame server. The default port number is 80.
c. Click OK. The server is added to the list of servers in the farm.
7. Click Save. The Citrix server farm resource is added to the list of defined resources on the
Resources page.
Defining an Access Control Rule and Resource for Terminal Server Access
This section describes how to provide terminal sever access to your users by defining an access
control rule and creating a terminal server resource. For more information see, “Access Control
Rules” on page 144 and “Adding Resources” on page 119.
X
To define a terminal server resource
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Access Control.
2. Click New. The Add/Edit Access Rule page appears.
3. In the Number box, type a number to specify the rule’s position in the access rule list.
4. Use the Action buttons to specify Permit.
5. Complete the information under Basic settings:
a. Leave User selected (so that the rule applies to users trying to access a resource).
b. The From box specifies the users to whom the rule applies. For this example, leave the
value as Any user.
c. In the To box, click Edit to specify the target resource for this rule. A Resources window
appears.
d. Click New and then select Host name or IP from the list. If you have more than one
terminal server on the same IP subnet, you can select IP range or Subnet. The Add/Edit
Resource page appears.
e. Type a name for the resource. For example, terminal server.
f. In the Host name or IP address box, type the host name or IP address for the terminal
server.
g. Click Save. The Add/Edit Resource window closes.
6. Click Finish.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
361
Managing Graphical Terminal Agents
This section describes how to configure the graphical terminal agents that give users access to
terminal server resources through the SonicWALL appliance. For information about providing access
to terminal servers through Aventail WorkPlace, see “Graphical Terminal Shortcuts” on page 362.
Managing the Windows Terminal Services Agent
For the Windows Terminal Services agent, the SonicWALL appliance automatically uses either the
native RDP client that is installed on the Windows client machine, or a cross-platform Java-based
Windows Terminal Services agent that is pre-installed on the appliance. The cross-platform agent
has been customized for use on the appliance and cannot be updated. The native Windows RDP
client is updated on the client machine by Microsoft automatic updating.
Managing the Citrix Agent
To enable users to access Citrix resources, you must configure the appliance with two Citrix agents:
an ActiveX control that runs on Windows, and a cross-platform Java applet.
To configure the appliance for each Citrix agent, upload the agent file to the appliance. The
SonicWALL appliance provisions the Citrix agents to users the first time they access a Citrix resource
from Aventail WorkPlace.
X
To install the Citrix agents
1. From the main navigation menu in AMC, click Agent Configuration.
2. In the Other agents area, under Graphical terminal agents, click Configure. The
Configure Graphical Terminal Agents page appears.
3. To specify the ActiveX agent, configure the Windows (ActiveX control) settings under
Citrix agents:
a. In the Agent file box, type the path for the agent file, or click Browse to locate it.
b. Click Save to transfer the file to the SonicWALL appliance.
4. To specify the Java agent, configure the Cross-platform (Java applet) area under Citrix
agents:
a. In the Agent file box, type the path for the agent file, or click Browse to locate it.
b. Click Save to transfer the file to the SonicWALL appliance.
362
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
Graphical Terminal Shortcuts
Graphical terminal shortcuts provide your users with Web-based access to resources that are
available through Windows Terminal Services or Citrix hosts. Before you can create a shortcut to a
terminal resource, you must first define the resource (for more information, see “Adding Resources”
on page 119 and “Adding Citrix Server Farm Resources” on page 359). You must also ensure that
the correct graphical terminal agents are configured in AMC; for more information see “Managing
Graphical Terminal Agents” on page 361.
This section describes how to configure graphical terminal shortcuts to individual Citrix or Windows
Terminal Services hosts, and Citrix server farms.
Adding Graphical Terminal Shortcuts to Individual Hosts
This section describes how to configure a graphical terminal shortcut to an individual Windows
Terminal Services or Citrix host. For information about configuring graphical terminal shortcuts to
Citrix server farms, see “Adding Graphical Terminal Shortcuts to Citrix Server Farms” on page 364.
X
To add a graphical terminal shortcut to an individual host
1. From the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace.
2. On the Shortcuts tab, click New and then select Graphical terminal shortcut from the list. The
General tab of the Add Graphical Terminal Shortcut page appears.
3. In the Position box, specify the shortcut’s position in the list.
4. In the Resource list, select the host or IP address resource to which this shortcut will be
linked. This list contains the available defined resources. (URL and Network share resources do
not appear because they cannot have graphical terminal shortcuts associated with them.)
5. Enter the hyperlink that users will click to access the resource and (optionally) a description of
the link that will appear next to it. These entries can include variables:
a. In the Link text box, type the text for the hyperlink users will see. For example, if the
resource you selected was the Windows domain for users’ home directories, enter Home
directory. Using a variable you can have the link be followed by the actual path: click
{variable}, and then select {URL_REF_VALUE} from the list. Click Insert to add the
variable to the link text, and then close the list by clicking {variable} again.
b. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the shortcut. Although
optional, a description helps users understand what the resource is. You can, for example,
use a variable to be specific about the user’s identity. Here’s a sample entry for
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
363
Description, followed by the explanatory text the user (in this case LGeorge) sees in
WorkPlace:
{Session.userName}’s user directory —> LGeorge’s user directory
6. Click Finish to save the shortcut with the current settings, or click Next to display additional
configuration settings. The Advanced tab of the Add Graphical Terminal Shortcut page
appears.
7. Under Session type, specify the type of session to initiate:
{
Click Windows Terminal Services to initiate a connection to a Windows Terminal
Services host. In the Port box, type the port number for the Windows Terminal Services
connection. Select the Automatically reconnect if session is interrupted check box
for seamless reconnection attempts.
364
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
{
Click Citrix to initiate a connection to an individual Citrix host. In the Port box, type the
port number for the connection. Optionally, you can specify a Custom ICA file by typing
its path or clicking Browse to locate it. Custom ICA files contain additional configuration
settings for the Citrix host.
8. Under Single sign-on, specify how you want user credentials forwarded to the host.
Forwarding user credentials prevents the user from needing to log in multiple times (once to
get to the appliance, and again to access the host).
{
Click None to disable single sign-on and instead prompt the user for credentials.
{
Click Forward user’s session credentials to pass the username and password for
authentication in WorkPlace along to the host.
{
Click Forward static credentials to forward the same username and password for all
users. Type the static Username, Password, and Domain to be forwarded for all users.
9. Specify Startup options if you want to automatically start an application when users click the
graphical terminal shortcut.
{
In the Start application box, type the path to the application.
{
If the application requires a working directory, type its path in the Working directory
box.
10. Specify Display properties:
{
In the Screen resolution list, select the appropriate resolution for the application. The
default resolution is 1024 x 768 pixels. To set a custom resolution, select Custom..., and
then type the desired pixel values (width x height) into the fields that appear to the right.
The minimum supported resolution is 640x480 and the maximum is 4096x2048 pixels.
{
For Terminal Services shortcuts, select the Allow users to select a different resolution
check box to give users control over their screen resolution. Users will be able to select
their own resolution from a list box on the shortcut itself in Workplace. This check box is
disabled for Citrix shortcuts.
{
In the Color depth list, select the color depth. The default setting is Lowest (8-bit). Note
that higher color depth settings can affect performance.
11. Specify Resource redirection settings as needed:
{
Select the Allow access to local drives check box to enable users to access local drives
during the session.
{
Select the Allow access to local printers check box to enable users to access local
printers during the session.
{
Select the Bring remote audio to local computer check box to enable users to access
remote audio during the session. Note that audio redirection is network intensive and can
affect performance. The default is off.
{
Select the Share clipboard between local and remote computers check box to enable
clipboard copy/paste in both directions for the user. The default is to allow this feature.
12. Click Finish.
Notes
z
Enabling single sign-on for shortcuts to Citrix hosts causes users’ authentication credentials to
be forwarded to the client, which can potentially compromise security.
z
The Java open-source version of the Windows Terminal Services agent does not support any
Resource redirection options.
z
Enabling clipboard sharing is not appropriate for shortcut that provides read-only access to
applications and sets of data.
Adding Graphical Terminal Shortcuts to Citrix Server Farms
This section describes how to configure a graphical terminal shortcut to a Citrix server farm. For
information about configuring graphical terminal shortcuts to individual Citrix or Windows Terminal
Services hosts, see “Adding Graphical Terminal Shortcuts to Individual Hosts” on page 362.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
X
|
365
To add a graphical terminal shortcut to a Citrix server farm
1. From the main navigation menu, click Aventail WorkPlace.
2. Click New and then select Graphical terminal shortcut from the list. The General tab of the
Add Graphical Terminal Shortcut page appears.
3. In the Position box, specify the shortcut’s position in the list.
4. In the Resource list, select the resource to which this shortcut will be linked. This list contains
the available defined resources. (URL and Network share resources do not appear because
they cannot have graphical terminal shortcuts associated with them.)
5. In the Link text box, type the hyperlink text that users will click to access the graphical
terminal resource.
6. Enter the hyperlink that users will click to access the resource and (optionally) a description of
the link that will appear next to it. These entries can include variables:
a. In the Link text box, type the text for the hyperlink users will see.
b. In the Description box, type a descriptive comment about the shortcut. Although
optional, a description helps users understand what the resource is. You can, for example,
use a variable to be specific about the user’s identity. Here’s a sample entry for
Description, followed by the explanatory text the user (in this case LGeorge) sees in
WorkPlace:
{Session.userName}’s user directory —> LGeorge’s user directory
7. In WorkPlace you can set up groups to organize resources for your users, or have shortcuts
appear singly. In the Shortcut group area, add your new shortcut to a new or existing group,
or have it appear on its own in WorkPlace by adding it to the Standalone shortcuts group. (The
order in which shortcuts appear can be changed on the Configure WorkPlace Layout page;
see “Creating or Editing a WorkPlace Layout” on page 304 for more information.)
366
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
8. Click Finish to save the shortcut with the current settings, or click Next to display additional
configuration settings. The Advanced tab of the Add Graphical Terminal Shortcut page
appears.
9. If necessary, you can specify a different Port for sending ICA traffic between the Citrix client
and Aventail WorkPlace. The default port is 1494.
10. Under Single sign-on, specify how you want user credentials forwarded to the host.
Forwarding user credentials prevents the user from needing to log in multiple times (once to
get to the appliance, and again to access the host).
{
Click None to disable single sign-on and instead prompt the user for credentials.
{
Click Forward user’s session credentials to pass the username and password used for
authentication in WorkPlace along to the host.
{
Click Forward static credentials to forward the same username and password for all
users. Type the static Username, Password, and Domain to be forwarded for all users.
11. Select the Enable SSO to Citrix applications check box to forward the user’s WorkPlace
login credentials to all published applications that are hosted on the Citrix server farm.
Enabling single sign-on to Citrix applications provides more convenience for the user; however,
it can potentially compromise security, as users’ passwords are temporarily stored in cleartext
on the client computer.
12. Specify Display properties:
{
In the Screen resolution list, select the appropriate resolution for the application. The
default setting is Use MetaFrame server value, the Citrix MetaFrame server screenresolution setting.
{
In the Color depth list, select the color depth. The default setting is Use MetaFrame
server value, which causes the Citrix MetaFrame server color-depth setting to be used.
Note that higher color depth settings can affect download speed.
13. Click Save.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
367
Notes
z
Enabling single sign-on for shortcuts to Citrix hosts causes users’ authentication credentials to
be forwarded to the client, which can potentially compromise security.
Aventail Connect for Android
Aventail Connect for Android provides secure network access to client/server applications that are
available for Android devices such as smartphones. The Android client provides application layer
proxy redirection similar to OnDemand Mapped mode.
The Android client supports creation of multiple VPN profiles, import of client certificates, all
available authentication methods and basic End Point Control (EPC). After successful
authentication, the client attempts to load and start any pre-defined port maps specified by the
administrator. The end-user can also define port maps, though access is still based on policy
evaluation at the appliance. Typical port map uses are for RDP, VNC, or SSH access to backend
servers protected by the SonicWALL Aventail appliance in the company’s network.
Installing Aventail Connect for Android
The Aventail Connect Android client can be downloaded and installed from the Android Market free
of charge.
Aventail Connect for Android is supported on Android devices running 2.1 and higher.
Configuring and Using Aventail Connect for Android
This section describes profile management, authentication, port map creation and management,
notifications, preferences, and the certificate store.
Profile Management
On the first launch, the application will not have any VPN profiles.
To create a VPN profile, perform the following steps:
1. Select Add VPN on the main screen or press the MENU key on the device and select Add in
the options menu.
2. In the VPN Configurations screen, leave the VPN Configuration Name field blank to allow it
to be automatically populated after selecting values for the other fields. Optionally, you can
type a descriptive name for the VPN profile in the VPN Configuration Name field.
368
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
3. Type the hostname or IP address of the VPN in the Host name or IP address of your VPN
field.
4. Press the Change button to load the login groups/realms, and then select the desired realm.
5. After selecting a realm from the dialog, the Login Group field is populated with the selected
realm and the VPN Configuration Name is set to “[email protected]” if no name is already
entered. Save the VPN profile by pressing the Save button.
Once a VPN profile is added, it is displayed in the home screen. The home screen displays all
configured VPN profiles.
6. On the home screen, manage the VPN profiles by long-pressing (pressing and holding) any
profile in the list or by selecting Edit in the options menu.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
369
After long-pressing the profile, a dialog box displays which allows you to directly edit or delete
the profile.
7. Select Delete VPN Configuration to delete the profile.
8. Select Edit VPN Configuration to edit the profile.
You can manage multiple profiles at the same time by using the options menu.
370
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
Authentication
After selecting a VPN profile to login to on the home screen, a login screen is displayed. The type
of login screen depends on the authentication method that was configured by the administrator. The
login screen may request username and password authentication, or it may use certificate
authentication. You can import any certificates (*.pfx) stored on the SD card for authentication
purposes.
Once you provide the credentials and press Connect, you may see a certificate dialog prompt if
there are any issues with the SSL certificate. Press Show Certificate to read the details.
Press Accept to accept the certificate and continue the login process. Press Reject if there appears
to be any problem with the certificate.
If the provided credentials are invalid, a re-authentication screen is displayed.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
371
If the authentication server is using Active Directory, a password change notification screen may be
displayed.
If stacked authentication is configured by the administrator, an additional screen is displayed for
entering the secondary authentication credentials.
Managing Port Maps
After successful authentication, you will see a list of services port maps, or shortcuts, defined by
the administrator, plus any user-defined port maps to services.
Note: You will only see administrator created application port maps when connected to
a realm with OnDemand enabled.
372
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
You can long-press on any item in the list to see the service details and to copy the address onto
the clipboard.
Select View Portmap to see the details, and select Copy Portmap to copy the address.
Users can create port maps in addition to administrator defined port maps. To create a new port
map, press the “Plus” button next to Services.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
373
At any time, you can remove the port maps you have defined.
All user defined port maps are stored on the device at the end of the VPN session for re-use later.
The user defined port maps will work subject to the Access Control Lists (ACLs) defined by the
administrator. If you do not have access to a particular resource, then the port map will not work
even though it is displayed.
Notification Area
At any time, you can press the Home button to cause the VPN session to run in the background.
The notification bar and pull-down screen display an Aventail Connect notification once the VPN
session is established.
374
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
To view session details in the VPN status screen, select the notification.
Preferences and Certificate Store
From the Home screen, you can navigate to the Preferences screen and to the certificate store.
In the Preferences screen, you can enable debug logs and can copy the logs to an external SD card
for sending to SonicWALL Support, if needed.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
375
The Preferences screen also allows you to navigate to the certificate store which displays both the
user certificates and the public certificates stored by the application or user. You can import the user
certificate(s) given to you by the SonicWALL Aventail appliance administrator into the certificate
store for logging in to a realm configured with certificate authentication.
376
|
Chapter 10 - User Access Components and Services
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
377
Chapter 11
Virtual Assist
SonicWALL Virtual Assist is a remote support tool that enables an administrator or help desk
technician to assume control of a user’s PC or laptop in order to provide remote technical assistance.
With the user’s permission, the technician gains instant access to the computer using a Web
browser and can then diagnose and fix a problem remotely.
Virtual Assist does not require the installation of any external software. For computers that do not
support Java, Virtual Assist can be manually installed by downloading an executable file that is
available in the SonicWALL Aventail Management Console. It also gives technicians the ability to
transfer files from a user’s computer (such as log files), and to chat online with the user.
To initiate a Virtual Assist session, a technician can send email invitations to users that contain a
direct URL link to initiate a Virtual Assist session. Or, an end user can request assistance directly by
logging into the WorkPlace portal that runs on the SSL VPN appliance.
What is Virtual Assist?
This section provides an introduction to the Virtual Assist feature.
Virtual Assist is an easy to use tool that allows SonicWALL SSL VPN users to remotely support
customers by taking control of their computers while the customer observes. Providing support to
customers is traditionally a costly and time consuming aspect of business. Virtual Assist creates a
simple to deploy, easy to use remote support solution.
Virtual Assist provides the following benefits:
z
Simplified and effective customer support - Support staff can use Virtual Assist to directly
access customers computers to troubleshoot and fix problems. This eliminates the need for
customers to try to explain their problems and their computer’s behavior over the phone.
z
Time and cost savings - Virtual Assist eliminates the need for support staff to visit customers
to troubleshoot problems and reduces the average time-to-resolution of support calls.
z
Educational tool - Trainers and support staff can use Virtual Assist to remotely show
customers how to use programs and tools.
z
Seamless integration with existing authentication system - Ensures that the customers
are who they say they are. Alternatively, the local database of the SSL VPN appliance and
tokenless two-factor authentication can be utilized.
z
Secure connections - 256-bit AES SSL encryption of the data by the SSL VPN appliance
provides a secure environment for the data and assists in the effort to be compliant with
regulations like Sarbanes-Oxley and HIPAA.
How Does Virtual Assist Work?
There are two sides to a Virtual Assist session: the client view and the technician view. The client
is the person requesting assistance on their computer. The technician is the person providing
assistance. Technicians install the stand-alone Virtual Assist application from the appliance
management console.
378
|
Chapter 11 - Virtual Assist
A Virtual Assist session consists of the following sequence of events:
1. The technician downloads the Virtual Assist Console application from the SonicWALL SSL VPN
Management Console and installs it on his or her computer.
2. The technician launches the Virtual Assist Console application.
3. The technician monitors the Assistance Queue for customers requesting assistance.
4. The customer requests assistance by one of these methods:
{
Clicks on the Assistance link in the SSL VPN WorkPlace and requests assistance.
{
Receives an email invitation from the technician and clicks on the link to launch Virtual
Assist.
To use the Virtual Assist email invitation option, email settings need to be configured in
AMC on the SSL VPN appliance.
5. The customer appears in the Virtual Assist Queue.
6. The technician clicks on the customer’s user name and launches a Virtual Assist session.
7. The technician’s Virtual Assist window now displays the customer’s entire display. The
technician has control of the customer’s computer. The customer sees all of the actions that
the technician performs, and the customer can still control the computer, as well.
8. Either the client or the technician can end the session.
9. When the session ends, the customer resumes sole control of the computer.
Configuring Virtual Assist
The following sections describe how to configure Virtual Assist on SonicWALL Aventail SSL VPN
security appliances.
Enabling Virtual Assist Service
1. Log in to the appliance management console and click Virtual Assist from the main
navigation page.
2. Click on the Configure button.
Click on the Enable the Virtual Assist service checkbox. In order to enable Virtual Assist
service, you must also enable either user requests, technician invitations, or both.
Configuring Virtual Assist Ticket Queue
The Ticket Queue section of the page configures the ticketing queue for Virtual Assist requests.
Help tickets are created when a client requests help or responds to an invitation for a Virtual Assist
session.
1. In the To Address field, enter the email address (or addresses) to which Virtual Assist
requests are to be sent. Separate multiple email addresses with commas.
2. In the Maximum Queue Size field, enter the maximum number of simultaneous Virtual
Assist requests that the appliance will accept. The default is 10.
3. In the Queue full message field, enter the message that is displayed to clients who request
Virtual Assist, when the queue is full.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
379
4. In the Time limit field, enter the duration of time that a Virtual Assist request will remain in
the queue before being dropped. The default is 60 minutes and the minimum is 1 minute.
Configuring Virtual Assist Requests
The Requests section of the page configures the ability for authenticated clients to request Virtual
Assist through WorkPlace.
1. Enable the Allow users to request assistance checkbox, if desired.
2. Optionally, in the provided field, enter an Assistance code that customers must enter before
being able to request help through Virtual Assist. The code can be a maximum of 8 characters.
.
Clients can request help in WorkPlace by selecting the Assistance button. In WorkPlace, a client’s
layout must have the option enabled to show the Assistance button.
Enabling Virtual Assist on a Layout
1. Navigate to User Access > Aventail WorkPlace page, and click on the Appearance tab.
2. Scroll down to the Layouts section and click on the name of the layout you want to edit. The
Configure WorkPlace Layout page displays.
380
|
Chapter 11 - Virtual Assist
3. Click on the General tab.
4. Select the Display the Virtual Assist button checkbox.
5. Click Save. Clients will now see the Assistance button in the top left of the WorkPlace.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
381
Configuring Virtual Assist Invitations
The Invitations section configures the ability for technicians to send email invitations to clients
and to customize the invitation’s content.
Note: To send email invitations, an SMTP server must be configured for the SSL VPN
appliance on the Services > SMTP page.
1. Select the Allow technicians to send invitations for Virtual Assist checkbox.
2. In the From address field, enter the email address that the Virtual Assist invitation will be
sent from.
3. In the Subject field, enter the subject line for the invitation email.
4. In the Body field, enter the body text of the invitation email. The following variables can be
used:
Variable
Description
{ticket.InvitationURL}
Creates a link to allow users to access Virtual Assist.
{ticket.description}
Includes the text that the technician enters in the Description
field of the invitation form on the technician view of the Virtual
Assist console.
5. In the Time Limit field, enter the number of minutes for which invitations will be viable. The
minimum time limit is 15 minutes.
6. Click Save to confirm settings.
Using the Virtual Assist Ticket Queue
All open tickets, active sessions, and pending invitations can be viewed on the Tickets tab of the
Virtual Assist page.
382
|
Chapter 11 - Virtual Assist
The Tickets tab displays a table with the following columns:
Column
Description
Status
The status of the virtual assist session.
User
The username of the customer or invitation recipient.
Technician
The name of the technician working on the session.
Opened
The time and date when the ticket was opened.
Closed
The time and date when the ticket was closed.
Elapsed
The amount of time elapsed since the ticket was opened.
The various filters and viewing options allow you to customize and refresh which tickets and
invitations are displayed
View: Use the drop-down menus to select the number of tickets to view at one time: 25, 50, 100,
250, 500, or 1000, and which type of tickets to view: All, Open, or Closed.
Filters:
{
Status - Filter the tickets to see All, Invited, In Service, or Pending
{
User - Filter tickets by the user/client
{
Technician - Filter tickets by the technician to which they are assigned
{
Notes - Filter tickets by selected notes
To delete an invitation, select the checkbox next to the entry in the table and click the Cancel
Invitation button.
To export the visible ticket queue screen as a .csv file, click the Export button.
Using Virtual Assist from the Technician View
Technicians can connect to the SSL VPN appliance through two methods:
z
If you are on the same LAN as the appliance, you can connect directly using the appliance’s
internal IP address.
z
If you are not on the same LAN as the appliance, connect through OnDemand Tunnel, and then
point your browser to the appliance.
The following sections describe how to install the Virtual Assist Console and how to use it to assist
clients.
Installing the Virtual Assist Technician Console
To launch a Virtual Assist session as a technician, perform the following steps.
1. Log in to the appliance management console and click Virtual Assist from the main
navigation page.
2. Under the Downloads heading, click the Download link for the technician application.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
383
3. A file opening dialog box appears for the VASAC.exe file. Click Save File.
4. An Open File - Security Warning pop-up window displays for the application. Click Run.
5. The Virtual Assist Login screen displays.
6. Fill in the required information for the correct Server IP address, Username, Password and,
optionally, Domain.
7. Click Login. The Virtual Assist Console will display.
384
|
Chapter 11 - Virtual Assist
Managing the Virtual Assist Queue
Technicians use the Virtual Assist Queue to manage requests for Virtual Assist sessions.
The queue displays a table of all of the active Virtual Assist requests and active sessions. It contains
the following columns:
Column
Description
Customer
The username of the client requesting assistance.
Technician
The username of the technician will display once the VA session
has begun with the customer.
Status
The status of the client’s VA session.
Time Elapsed
The duration of time that an assistance session has lasted, or the
amount of time that a client has been waiting in the queue.
To begin a session with a client, click on the client’s username in the Customer column. Once a
session is initiated, the information in the queue will be updated.
Emailing an Invitation to a Client
Technicians can send an email invitation for a Virtual Assist session to clients.
Note: To send email invitations, an SMTP server must be configured for the SSL VPN
appliance on the Services > SMTP page.
Technicians can send email invitations from the Virtual Assist console using the following steps:
1. Enter the correct email address in the Customer E-mail field.
2. Enter your email address in the Technician E-mail field.
3. Optionally, enter a customized message in the Additional Message field.
4. Click Invite to send the invitation to the customer.
The queue will be updated to reflect this outstanding session invitation.
Assisting a Client
1. To assist a client, click on their username in the queue.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
385
2. A dialog box will open in the console, as a connection to the customer is established.
3. The customer’s screen should now appear in the black section of the console.
Virtual Assist Technician Console Tools
Once a session is fully established with the customer, technicians have various tools at their disposal
to provide assistance. There are three drop-down menus in the upper left of the console screen:
View Menu
z
Request Screen Refresh - Allows the technician to refresh the customer’s screen on the
console.
z
Scaling - Allows the technician to adjust scaling between Full Screen, Auto-Scale, or
Normal.
z
Color Depth - Allows the technician to adjust color display to Full or 256 colors.
z
Layout - Allows the technician to Hide or Show the top and side bars on the console.
386
|
Chapter 11 - Virtual Assist
Tools Menu
z
File Transfer - Allows the technician to transfer a file(s) to the customer’s system. The server
connected to the appliance must be configured to support file transfers.
z
Chat - If the chat window is not already open in the side bar, the command activates the chat
window for the technician to use to communicate.
z
Reboot - Allows the technician to reboot the customer’s system.
Commands Menu
z
Get PC Control - Allows the technician to request control of the customer’s desktop.
z
Request Full Control - Allows the technician to request full control of the customer’s system,
including the ability to transfer files and reboot the system.
z
Switch Customer Screen - Allows the technician to switch to a customer’s secondary monitor,
if the customer has an additional monitor configured on their system.
z
System Info - Displays detailed information about the customer’s system.
z
Task Manager - Brings up the Task Manager on the customer’s system.
z
Start Menu - Brings up the Start Menu on the customer’s system.
z
Alt+Tab - Allows the technician to exit full-screen mode and select a different application.
z
Ctrl Key Up, Ctrl Key Down, Alt Key Up, and Alt Key Down - Allows a technician to send
these key commands to the customer’s system.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
387
Using Chat in Virtual Assist
Using the chat tool, technicians can communicate back and forth with a customer in a Virtual Assist
session. The chat window can be found on the side bar of the technician’s console.
The upper section of the chat window displays the running conversation between the technician and
the customer. Type replies into the lower section of the chat window, and click Send to post it to
the conversation.
388
|
Chapter 11 - Virtual Assist
Using Virtual Assist from the Customer View
Customers can use Virtual Assist on either Windows or Mac computers. This section provides
instructions for both.
Using Virtual Assist from the Customer View (Windows)
To launch a Virtual Assist session to request help on your Windows computer, perform the following
steps:
1. Log in to the SSL VPN WorkPlace. The WorkPlace main page will display.
2. Click the Assistance button at the top right of the main page. If the Assistance button is not
displayed, contact your administrator to enable Assistance on your WorkPlace layout.
3. A file opening dialog box appears for the VASAC file. Click Save File.
4. An Open File - Security Warning pop-up window displays for the application. Click Run.
5. The Virtual Assist Login screen displays.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
389
6. Fill in the required information for the correct Server IP address, Name, Portal (optional),
and an Issue Description (optional). Click Login.
7. You may be prompted to supply a Assistance Code to complete your request for assistance.
Once you have received this code from your administrator, fill in the provided field and click
OK.
8. You will now be placed into the virtual assistance queue. A dialog box will display to inform you
of this status.
9. When a technician is ready to service your request, the Waiting dialog box will disappear, and
a pop-up tool taskbar will appear on your desktop. The technician will now be able to control
your desktop.
10. The technician may Request Full Control of your system, which allows the technician to
transfer files and reboot your system, if needed. If the the technician makes this request, a
dialog box will display. Click OK to grant permission.
390
|
Chapter 11 - Virtual Assist
Virtual Assist Client Console Tools
Once a session is fully established with the technician, customers can still control aspects of the
session using the menu available in the pop-up taskbar. If the taskbar does not appear onscreen,
right-click on the Virtual Assist icon in the desktop taskbar to access the menu.
The taskbar contains the following tools and session information:
z
Status - Informs the customer as to the status of their session being Trusted (limited prompts
before technician actions), Active (technician has control of desktop, with more prompts before
taking actions), or Pending (technician has view-only desktop access). Click on the Status icon
to change the session status.
z
Open Chat Dialog - Allows the customer to open a chat window on their desktop to
communicate with the technician.
z
Exit Virtual Assist - Allows the customer to end a virtual assist session at anytime. This option
also ends a technician’s control over the customer’s system.
z
Ctrl+Alt+T - This command allows the session to be conducted in Trusted Status. In this
mode, the customer will not receive dialog box requests asking permission for the technician to
perform actions on the customer’s system.
Using Virtual Assist from the Customer View (Mac)
Virtual Assist is available for Mac users running Mac OS X 10.5 or later, with either the
Safari or Firefox browser. Both Java and JavaScript must be enabled.
If your administrator has enabled Virtual Assist to be used through WorkPlace, follow these steps
to request a Virtual Assist session:
1. Log in to WorkPlace.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
391
2. The WorkPlace main page will display.
3. Click the Assistance button at the top right of the main page. If the Assistance button is not
displayed, contact your administrator to enable Assistance on your WorkPlace layout.
4. You may now enter a ticket to request a Virtual Assistance session.
5. Complete the available fields with your Name, Assistance Code (if required), and a
Summary of the issue for which you are seeking assistance. Click the Request Assistance
392
|
Chapter 11 - Virtual Assist
button to submit the ticket. Contact your administrator for an assistance code, if
needed.
6. You will now be placed in the queue for assistance from a technician. Your current wait time is
reflected onscreen.
7. Once a technician accepts your ticket for assistance, your system will launch the Virtual Assist
applet. A dialog box message may ask you to accept the applet to run it on your system.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
393
8. Once the Virtual Assist session is established, the technician will now have remote control of
your desktop. You can minimize your browser window, if desired.
Chat functionality is not available as part of the Virtual Assist Mac client.
9. Users maintain control of their system throughout a Virtual Assist session with a technician. At
any time you wish to terminate the session, click the End Virtual Assist button within the
browser window.
10. The page refreshes to reflect you have successfully logged out of a Virtual Assist session.
394
|
Chapter 11 - Virtual Assist
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
395
Chapter 12
Administering a High-Availability Cluster
Several of the SonicWALL appliances include support for clustering two identical appliances behind
one virtual IP address: the EX7000, EX6000, EX-2500, and EX-1600. A SonicWALL cluster provides
high availability by including integrated load balancing, stateful user authentication, failover, and
centralized administration. This system redundancy ensures that an appliance is available even if
one of the nodes fails.
This section explains the capabilities of a SonicWALL Aventail cluster and describes the required
procedures for installing, configuring, and maintaining a cluster. Other topics related to multiple
appliances are covered here:
z
To increase capacity and support more users, you can cluster up to eight appliances using an
external load balancer. For more information, see “Configuring a High-Capacity Cluster” on
page 461.
z
You can distribute settings to multiple SonicWALL appliances, whether they are separated
geographically, or clustered behind an external load balancer. See “Replicating Configuration
Data” on page 227 for more information.
Overview: High-Availability Cluster
A high-availability cluster is designed to prevent a single point of failure. When you deploy a cluster,
you can distribute applications over more than one computer, which improves response time and
avoids unnecessary downtime if a failure occurs. The two-node cluster appears as a single system
to users, applications, and the network, while providing internal load-balancing and a single point
of control for administrators.
The SonicWALL EX7000 and EX-2500 appliances support a two-node cluster for up to 5,000 users
in a high-availability configuration; a pair of SonicWALL EX6000 or EX-1600 appliances can handle
up to 250 users. These clusters support an Active/Active configuration, meaning both nodes in the
cluster are actively sharing the user load at any given time.
Cluster Architecture
There are two configurations in which you can deploy a SonicWALL Aventail cluster—a dual-homed
configuration or a single-homed configuration (see “Network Architecture” on page 17 for details
on these configurations). When deploying a cluster in either configuration, the two appliances must
be connected to one another over the cluster network (the backplane). Connecting the cluster
interface of one appliance with the cluster interface of the other creates a private network over
which the two cluster nodes can communicate (for state synchronization, credential sharing, and
load balancing).
Regardless of the deployment scenario, the following connectivity requirements apply:
z
To provide load-balancing redundancy, both nodes in the cluster must serve as load-balancing
nodes. They must therefore be connected to the network switch facing the Internet.
396
|
Chapter 12 - Administering a High-Availability Cluster
z
To communicate with internal resources, both nodes in the cluster must be connected to the
network switch facing the intranet (this would be the same as the external switch in a singlehomed configuration).
z
Both cluster nodes must be connected to each other using the cluster interface.
In a dual-homed configuration, the cluster architecture would look like this:
Node 1
Internal
External
Internet
Corporate
network
Cluster
Switch
Internal
Switch
Firewall
Firewall
External
Node 2
In a single-homed configuration, the cluster architecture would look like this:
Node 1
Internal
Cluster
Switch
Corporate
network
Internet
Internal
Firewall
Firewall
Node 2
Notes
z
The network tunnel service is not available on a single-interface configuration.
The Load Balancing Service
The SonicWALL cluster contains integrated load balancing, eliminating the need for an external load
balancer. This internal load-balancing service is responsible for two key functions:
z
It distributes connections across the two nodes by sending an incoming request to the node that
currently has the least number of connections.
z
It contains an internal monitoring service that detects node failure and performs the failover of
that node’s remote connections to the other node in the cluster. In the event of node failure, it
directs all incoming requests to the other node until the failed node returns to service. It then
continues distributing connections between the two nodes.
The load-balancing functionality exists on only one node at a time—the active load-balancing node.
The other node serves as a redundant load balancer and takes over the load balancing
responsibilities if the active load balancer goes down. This redundant node thus becomes the active
load balancer, and remains so even after the failed node returns to service. The active load
balancing node communicates with the standby load-balancing node over the private cluster
network (see “Cluster Architecture” on page 395).
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
397
Stateful Failover
The cluster provides stateful user authentication failover (authentication credentials are shared in
real time in a memory cache shared by all nodes). Because both nodes are synchronized, they are
capable of handling the failover of connections initiated by the active load-balancing node without
requiring the user to reauthenticate.
The cluster does not provide stateful application session failover. Disruption to users depends on
the TCP/IP disconnect tolerance of the applications that they are using at the time the failover
occurs.
Synchronized Cluster Administration
You administer both nodes of a SonicWALL Aventail cluster from one master AMC. During initial
setup of an appliance (using the LCD screen and controls on the front of the appliance), you
assigned one of the appliance to be the master node (node 1) and the other the slave node (node
2).
After installing the software on both nodes, you log in to AMC on the master node. From that point
on, this node controls the propagation and synchronization of policy and configuration across both
nodes. If you log in to AMC on the slave node, its Node Administration page appears, displaying
a message telling you that it is not the master node (it also displays status information about the
services on the slave node).
Each node in the cluster hosts configuration and policy data stores. The master node, which
communicates with the slave node through the cluster interface, synchronizes this data as follows:
z
When you add a second node to a cluster, the master node provisions the new node with
configuration data, after which the new node starts up its access services.
z
When you apply a configuration change on the master node, AMC propagates the change to the
slave node. This remains true even if you are using replication to distribute configuration across
a number of appliances. The HA cluster is identified in logs and in AMC UI by its cluster name.
The slave node provides a redundant AMC, but it is not automatically assigned as master if the
master node fails. Instead, you must log in to the slave node’s AMC and manually assign it to be
the master. When the original master node comes back online, it detects that the other node is now
the master and it demotes itself to a slave node.
398
|
Chapter 12 - Administering a High-Availability Cluster
!
CAUTION If you are upgrading the software on the master node, do not designate the slave
node as the master while the original master node is down. Doing so prevents the upgraded
node from running: it would be rejected by the other node because of a version mismatch.
Restoring the full cluster requires downtime for your users while you upgrade the second node.
For a step-by-step description of what happens when a master node fails, see “Master (AMC) Node
Fails” on page 405. For detailed procedures on how to manage the cluster using the master AMC,
see “Managing the Cluster” on page 400.
Notes
z
Administering a high-availability cluster differs from replication, where you define a “collection”
of appliances that will have settings in common and that will operate in peer-to-peer mode. See
“Replicating Configuration Data” on page 227 for more information.
Installing and Configuring a Cluster
Installing a SonicWALL Aventail cluster requires the following steps:
z
Rack-mount both appliances
z
Connect the cluster interface between the two appliances
z
Run Setup Tool on each appliance
z
Configure the cluster’s virtual IP address (VIP)
The following diagram illustrates the work flow:
Connect the
nodes
Plug the crossover
cable into the cluster
interface on each of
your two appliances
Run Setup Tool
on each node
Specify the master
node as “1” and the
slave as “2”
Configure the
cluster settings
Configure the VIP
and enable external
interfaces (optional)
Final steps: Configure the remaining network settings,
and retrieve and upload licenses
Before installing and configuring your SonicWALL Aventail cluster, it is helpful to gather the following
information:
IP Addresses for a Dual-Homed Installation
z
Four IP addresses on the same subnet, one for each node’s internal and external. The internal
and external addresses should be on separate subnets.
z
One virtual IP address (VIP) for the cluster. This VIP serves as the single external address for
the entire cluster and must be on the same subnet as the external interface.
z
If you are using the network tunnel service in a clustered environment, you need an internal IP
address for the network tunnel service. This serves as a back-connect address for the entire
cluster and must be on the same subnet as the internal interface.
IP Addresses for a Single-Homed Installation
z
Two IP addresses on the same subnet, one for each node’s internal interface.
z
One virtual IP address (VIP) for the cluster. The VIP serves as the single external address for
the entire cluster and must be on the same subnet as the internal interface.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
399
Step 1: Connect the Cluster Network
Before running Setup Tool, you must connect the cluster network between the two nodes of the
cluster.
X
To connect the cluster network
1. Find the network crossover cable supplied with the appliance.
2. Use this cable to connect the cluster interface on one appliance with the cluster interface on
the other appliance. See “Connecting the Appliance” on page 29.
!
CAUTION The two nodes of the cluster network must be connected using the crossover cable
provided with the appliance. Do not substitute any other cabling. Do not place any other
network hardware devices—such as a router or a switch—between the two nodes.
Step 2: Run Setup Tool on All Nodes of the Cluster
Setup Tool is a command-line utility that performs the initial network setup for an appliance. Details
about running this tool in a single-node environment are explained in “Next Steps” on page 36.
When installing a cluster, you should run Setup Tool on one appliance, and then repeat the process
on the second appliance; review “Tips for Working with Setup Tool” on page 408 before continuing.
X
To run Setup Tool in a clustered environment
1. Make a serial connection to one appliance in the cluster, confirm that the cluster network
between the two nodes is connected, and then turn on one appliance using the power button
on the front panel. Setup Tool automatically runs on the appliance (you can also invoke it by
typing setup_tool).
2. When you’re prompted to log in, type “root” for the username.
3. You’re prompted to type an IP address, subnet mask, and (optionally) a gateway for the
internal interface. You’ll use this interface to connect to the appliance from a Web browser and
continue setup using AMC.
a. Type an IP address for the internal interface connected to your internal (or private)
network and then press Enter.
b. Type a subnet mask for the internal network interface and then press Enter.
c. If the computer from which you’ll access AMC is on a different network than the appliance,
you must specify a gateway. Type the IP address of the gateway used to route traffic to
the appliance and then press Enter.
If you’re accessing AMC from the same network on which the appliance is located, simply
press Enter.
4. You’re prompted to review the information you provided. Press Enter to accept the current
value, or type a new value.
5. You are prompted to indicate whether this node will be part of a cluster. Type y and then press
Enter to continue.
6. Specify whether the current appliance is the master node (“1”) or slave node (“2”), and then
press Enter.
The cluster subnet and IP address are automatically assigned.
7. You’re prompted to review the information you provided. Press Enter to accept the current
value, or type a new value.
8. You’re prompted to save and apply your changes. Press Enter to save your changes.
Setup Tool saves your changes and restarts the necessary services. It also generates Secure
Shell (SSH) keys using the information you provided. During this time you will receive minimal
feedback; be patient and do not assume that Setup Tool is not responding.
When the changes are complete, a message appears indicating that the initial setup is
complete.
9. After running Setup Tool on the first node, repeat the process for the second node.
400
|
Chapter 12 - Administering a High-Availability Cluster
Step 3: Configure the Cluster’s External Virtual IP Address
The cluster’s virtual IP address serves as the single external address for the entire cluster.
X
To configure the cluster’s virtual IP address
1. Log in to AMC on the node that you want to be the master.
2. From the main navigation page, click Network Settings.
3. Click the Edit link in the Basic area. The Configure Basic Network Settings page appears.
4. In the Cluster configuration area, type the cluster’s Virtual IP address. This must be on
the same subnet as the IP address for the interface connected to the Internet (internal
interface in a single-homed configuration, external interface in a dual-homed configuration).
5. If you are using the network tunnel service in a clustered environment, type the virtual IP
address in the Network tunnel service virtual IP address box.
This serves as the single internal address of the network tunnel service for the entire cluster.
This VIP must be on the same subnet as the internal interface. This setting applies only to a
dual-homed cluster.
Final Steps: Network Configuration and Licensing
When the software is installed on both nodes and one AMC is serving as the master management
console, you are ready to complete the remaining configuration tasks. There is little difference
between configuring a single-node appliance and a cluster. The following are the primary differences
when configuring a cluster:
z
Both nodes of the cluster appear on the Network Settings page of AMC. In a single-node
environment, only one node appears here.
z
The Cluster interface settings area that you used in the previous step is displayed. This area
is not present in a single-node deployment.
z
On the Network Interface Configuration page, you cannot edit the name of the appliance,
which is actually the node ID. In a single-node deployment you can edit the appliance name.
z
If you plan to enable the external interfaces, you must enable them for both nodes at the same
time. AMC prevents you from applying the configuration change until you have enabled the
interface for both nodes.
Continue with your cluster configuration:
1. Refer to “Managing Licenses” on page 246 for information on retrieving your license file from
mySonicWALL.com and importing it to the appliance. You must download a separate license
for each appliance.
2. Refer to “Network and Authentication Configuration” on page 55 for information on specifying
network interfaces, routing modes, gateways, and so on.
Managing the Cluster
You can perform most cluster management tasks from a single AMC (the one that has been
designated as the master). The procedures in this section provide details on how to manage your
cluster.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
401
Viewing and Configuring Network Information for Each Node
From the master AMC, you can view and configure network interface settings for both nodes in the
cluster.
X
To view network interface configuration settings
1. From the main navigation page, click Network Settings. The Basic area gives you an
overview of the cluster: the node names, default domain, and addresses.
2. Click the Edit link in the Basic area. The Configure Basic Network Settings page appears
3. The table in the Cluster nodes area displays information about each of the two nodes, which
you can edit on this page. For details on these network settings, see “Configuring Network
Interfaces” on page 57.
Powering up a Cluster
When powering up both nodes in a cluster, it does not matter which node you power up first.
Starting and Stopping Services
You use the master node to start and stop services in a cluster environment. For details on how to
do this, see “Stopping and Starting the SonicWALL Access Services” on page 348. You cannot
control a service on a single node of the cluster, however. When you start or stop a service, the
service starts or stops on both nodes of the cluster. To stop services on a single node of the cluster,
you have to power down the appliance itself.
Notes
z
The Status column on the master Services page indicates the status of the services on the
master node only. See “Monitoring a Cluster” on page 401 for more information on monitoring
a slave node.
Monitoring a Cluster
From the master node, you can monitor only the services running on the master node.
X
To view the status of services on the master node
1. From the main navigation menu, click Services.
2. In the Access services area, view the Status indicators for each service. The Stop/Start
value shows the status of the service on the master node.
To view the status of services on the slave node, you must log in to AMC on that node.
402
|
Chapter 12 - Administering a High-Availability Cluster
X
To view the status of services on the slave node
1. Log in to AMC. The Slave Node Administration page appears.
2. In the Node status area, view Services, System information, and Current connections.
This page also provides the timestamp of the last cluster synchronization.
3. To see the most current statistics, click the Refresh button.
4. From the Slave Node Administration page you can access the following AMC pages from the
main navigation menu:
{
System Status
{
View Logs
{
Maintenance
5. If you need to manage the cluster, click the link for the master under Cluster Management
on the AMC home page.
Notes
z
In a clustered environment, the active user count displayed on the AMC home page and on the
System Status page is limited to users on the current node, while the count shown on the User
Sessions page includes active users in the entire cluster.
Backing up a Cluster
To back up configuration data for a cluster, run Backup Tool on just the master node; this backs up
configuration data for both nodes. For details on running Backup Tool, see “Saving and Restoring
Configuration Data” on page 409.
Performing Maintenance on a Cluster
To perform maintenance on one or both nodes of a cluster, stop services on both nodes. You should
plan all maintenance activities during a time that is least disruptive to users. See “Starting and
Stopping Services” on page 401 for details.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
403
Upgrading a Cluster
You can use AMC to install version upgrades and hotfixes. To update the SonicWALL Aventail
software in a cluster environment, you must install the system upgrade or hotfix and import the
license file to each node of the cluster. The order in which you update the nodes in the cluster is
very important: begin the process with the master node, and then proceed to the slave node. There
may be some disruption to service when performing the update, so schedule it during a
maintenance window.
Before you perform an upgrade, make a backup of your current configuration data. See “Managing
Configuration Data” on page 224 for details.
X
To upgrade a cluster
1. Disable both nodes during the upgrade process.
2. Log in to AMC on both the slave and master nodes. You can do this from one computer and
have both AMC windows open at the same time, side by side.
3. Log in to AMC on the first node and then, from the main navigation menu in AMC, click
Maintenance. Install your upgrade following the steps described in “Installing System
Updates” on page 235.
4. Install the upgrade on the second node following the same installation steps.
5. Make sure that the update succeeded by verifying that the version number is correct in AMC
on both nodes.
Notes
z
After performing an upgrade, users may need to reauthenticate; new connections are not
affected.
z
If you want to roll back a cluster version, you must begin with the master node and follow the
steps in “Rolling Back to a Previous Version” on page 237.
Upgrading a Single Appliance to a Cluster Configuration
If you have an appliance running as a single node and you want to upgrade it to be part of a cluster,
you must run Cluster Tool. This tool allows you to reconfigure the appliance so that it is clusteraware. Running the tool does not interrupt existing connections.
X
To run Cluster Tool
1. On the command line of the appliance, type cluster_tool.
2. You are prompted for the appliance’s node number. Type 1 (master node) or 2 (slave node),
and then press Enter.
3. You are prompted for the IP address and subnet mask of the cluster interface. This interface is
used for communication between the two nodes of the cluster.
a. Type the cluster interface IP address for this appliance and then press Enter.
b. Type the cluster interface subnet mask for this appliance and then press Enter.
CAUTION: The cluster interface IP address of each cluster node must be unique.
4. You’re prompted to review the information you provided. Press Enter to accept the current
value, or type a new value and then press Enter.
5. You’re prompted to save and apply your changes. Press Enter.
Cluster Tool saves your changes and automatically reboots the appliance. When the changes are
complete, a message appears indicating that the appliance has been configured to be part of a
cluster.
Troubleshooting a Cluster
This section explains how to troubleshoot various cluster environment situations.
404
|
Chapter 12 - Administering a High-Availability Cluster
Avoiding Delays in Service if a Failover Occurs
When a node transitions from STANDBY to ACTIVE or vice versa, its interfaces are briefly disabled
as the switch checks to see if its ports are connected to another switch. You can configure your
switch to skip these checks by enabling spanning-tree fast port negotiation. On Cisco switches, this
functionality is known as PortFast.
Cluster Error Messages
When configuring a cluster, one or more of the following messages may appear in AMC:
Error message
Description
You are trying to cluster too many nodes (your
system supports a maximum of two nodes).
A cluster can contain only two nodes. If you are
configuring multiple clusters, confirm that the
cluster names are unique.
Invalid configuration. Each node in the cluster
must use the same number of network
interfaces.
Both nodes in the cluster must be configured
identically. If one node is dual-homed and the
other node is single-homed, this message is
displayed on the Network Settings page. See
“Cluster Architecture” on page 395 for a
comparison of dual- and single-homed nodes.
If you try to apply changes without fixing this
problem, the same message is displayed on the
Apply Changes page and the button for
applying changes is disabled.
You have specified a duplicate cluster IP
address. Re-run Setup Tool and assign a
different one.
The IP address of a node’s cluster interface must
be unique.
The version of the software running on this
node is incompatible with the master.
Compare the version numbers and upgrade
the appropriate node.
For the cluster to function properly, each node
must be running the same version of the
software. See “Upgrading a Cluster” on page 403
for more information.
Cluster Scenarios
This section provides a step-by-step view of how the cluster responds to various situations.
Normal Flow of Traffic
If both nodes are functioning properly, traffic flows through a cluster in the following way:
1. An incoming request is routed to the cluster’s virtual IP address.
2. The active load balancer, which is monitoring the nodes in the cluster, determines that all
nodes are available.
3. The load balancer checks to see which service currently has the least number of connections
and routes the request to that service.
Node Failure
The following scenarios detail what happens if a cluster node fails. In most failure situations, the
appliance will not require users to reauthenticate and existing user connections will continue
operating normally. Service may be interrupted, however, if a particular application requires a user
to reauthenticate.
Active Load Balancer Fails
If the active load balancer fails, the standby load balancer takes over:
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
405
1. The standby load balancer, which is monitoring the cluster network, detects that the active
load balancer has failed.
2. The standby load balancer resumes the active load balancing duties. It also routes all incoming
requests to the single node that is available.
3. When the original active load balancer comes online, it becomes the standby load balancer.
4. The new active load balancer detects that the second node is online and begins distributing
incoming requests to both nodes.
Standby Load Balancer Fails
If the standby load balancer fails, incoming requests are routed to the single, available node:
1. The active load balancer, which is monitoring the cluster network, detects that the standby
load balancer has failed.
2. The active load balancer routes all incoming requests to the single node that is available.
3. When the standby load balancer comes online, the active load balancer begins distributing
incoming requests to both nodes.
Master (AMC) Node Fails
These scenarios describe what happens in AMC when the master node fails. In the first scenario,
the original master remains the master. In the second scenario the slave node becomes the master.
X
Original master remains master
1. The master node fails.
2. The slave node continues functioning normally and the administrator does not assign the slave
node to be the master.
3. The master node comes back online and recognizes that it is the master node.
4. The master synchronizes its state with the slave node’s state.
5. The master continues functioning as the master (with respect to administration, configuration,
and synchronization).
X
Slave node becomes master node
1. The master node fails.
2. The administrator logs in to the AMC on the slave node and assigns it to be the master.
3. The original master comes back online, communicates with the other node, and determines
that the other node is now master. The original master demotes itself to slave.
4. The new master synchronizes its state with the new slave node’s state.
Cluster Network Fails
If the cluster network fails, the two nodes of the cluster are no longer able to communicate with
each other.
1. The active load balancer detects that the cluster network is down. It sends all incoming
requests to the node on which it resides.
2. The master AMC detects that the cluster network is down. It can no longer communicate with
the slave node.
Notes
z
A failed cluster network is the likely problem if the slave node is running but the master node
cannot communicate with it.
406
|
Chapter 12 - Administering a High-Availability Cluster
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
407
Appendix A
Appliance Command-Line Tools
Most of the configuration management tasks that you need to perform—backing up and restoring
your appliance configuration, applying upgrades, and so on—can be done using the Web-based
Aventail Management Console (AMC), on the Maintenance page. This section describes tools on
the appliance that perform these same tasks and some others, for administrators who prefer to
work on the command line.
Tool
Purpose
Setup Tool
(setup_tool)
Configure the appliance by running Setup Tool from a serial
connection using a laptop computer or terminal.
z
See “Configuring a New Appliance Using Setup Tool” on
page 408.
Backup Tool
(config_backup)
Save the current configuration file.
Config Restore Tool
(config_restore)
Restore a saved configuration file.
Config Reset
(config_reset)
To restore the factory default configuration settings.
z
z
z
See “Saving Configuration Data” on page 409.
See “Restoring Configuration Data” on page 410.
See “Restoring Factory Default Configuration Settings” on
page 411.
Update Tool
Install a software update.
(upgrade_<version>.bin) z See “Installing System Upgrades (Command Line Tool)” on
page 412.
Rollback Tool
(rollback_tool)
Roll the system software back to its most recent state prior to an
upgrade.
z
Factory Reset Tool
(factory_reset_tool)
Restore the appliance to its original state when received from the
vendor. Use this tool as a last resort; there is no AMC equivalent for
this feature.
z
Cluster Tool
(cluster_tool)
See “Performing a Factory Reset” on page 413.
Upgrade a single node to be part of a cluster; there is no AMC
equivalent for this functionality.
z
Host Validation Tool
(checkhosts)
See “Reverting to a Previous Version” on page 412.
See “Upgrading a Single Appliance to a Cluster Configuration” on
page 403
Show a list of the hosts referred to in your appliance resources, and
find out if they are accessible and can be resolved in DNS.
z
See “Validating Hosts” on page 413
408
|
Appendix A - Appliance Command-Line Tools
See “Managing Configuration Data” on page 224 and “Upgrading, Rolling Back, or Resetting the
System” on page 233 for a description of configuration data files and how to manage them in AMC.
Configuring a New Appliance Using Setup Tool
The recommended way to set up a new appliance—with the exception of the EX-750—is to use the
LCD controls on the front of the appliance to enter information that will enable a Web browser to
connect to your appliance so that you can connect to the Aventail Management Console and run
Setup Wizard, as described in “Powering Up and Configuring Basic Network Settings” on page 31.
If you prefer using a command-line utility you can configure the appliance by running Setup Tool
from a serial connection using a laptop computer or terminal. In the case of the EX-750, this is the
only way enter to enter the information that will enable a Web browser to connect to your appliance
so that you can run Setup Wizard.
Tips for Working with Setup Tool
Here are some tips for working with Setup Tool:
z
Yes or no questions include a [y] or [n] at the end of the prompt; type the appropriate letter
and then press Enter to display the next question.
z
To delete a character, press Backspace. (On a Windows-based PC, you can also press Delete to
remove a character.)
z
When typing an IP address or netmask, use the standard IP address format of four octets
(w.x.y.z). Setup Tool provides basic error checking (for example, validating that the gateway
you type is on the same subnet as the appliance).
z
Type q to quit Setup Tool and discard your changes.
Using Setup Tool
When you run Setup Tool from the command line, it prompts you to accept the SonicWALL End User
License Agreement (EULA), create a root password, and provide an IP address, subnet mask, and
internal default gateway.
If you are installing a high-availability cluster (a pair of appliances), refer to “Installing and
Configuring a Cluster” on page 398; if you are installing a larger group of appliances, see
“Configuring a High-Capacity Cluster” on page 461 for installation instructions.
X
To run Setup Tool
1. Make a serial connection to the appliance (see “Powering Up and Configuring Basic Network
Settings” on page 31), and then turn on the appliance using the power button.
2. If the appliance has not yet been configured, or if you have just reset it using either Factory
Reset Tool or Config Reset, Setup Tool will run automatically. Otherwise, you can start it by
typing setup_tool and pressing Enter.
3. When you’re prompted to log in, type root for the username; press Enter to move to the next
screen.
4. You’re prompted to type an IP address, subnet mask, and (optionally) a gateway for the
internal interface. You use this interface to connect to the appliance from a Web browser and
continue setup using AMC.
IP address:
{
Type an IP address for the internal interface connected to your internal (or private)
network and then press Enter.
Subnet mask:
{
Type a netmask for the internal network interface and then press Enter.
Gateway:
{
If the computer from which you’ll access AMC is on a different network than the appliance,
you must specify a gateway. Type the IP address of the gateway used to route traffic to
the appliance and then press Enter.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
409
If you’re accessing AMC from the same network on which the appliance is located, simply
press Enter.
5. Next, you’re prompted to review the information you provided. Press Enter to accept the
current value, or type a new value and then press Enter.
6. You are then asked if this node will be part of a cluster (this step does not apply if you are
setting up an EX-750 appliance).
{
Because this is a single-node installation, you should accept the default by pressing Enter.
For details on installing a cluster, see “Installing and Configuring a Cluster” on page 398
and “Configuring a High-Capacity Cluster” on page 461.
7. Finally, you’re prompted to save and apply your changes.
{
Press Enter to save your changes.
At this point, Setup Tool saves your changes and restarts the necessary services. It also generates
SSL keys using the information you provided (SSH requires security keys that it exchanges with
remote SSH clients and servers). Once SSH is configured using Setup Tool, it will display a message
saying that it is generating these keys.
During this time, you will receive minimal feedback; be patient and do not assume that Setup Tool
is not responding. When Setup Tool is finished, a message appears indicating that the initial setup
is complete. This message also includes the URL for accessing AMC.
Saving and Restoring Configuration Data
Included on the appliance are a number of command-line administrative tools for saving and
restoring configuration data:
z
Config Backup Tool—Saves the current configuration file
z
Config Restore Tool—Restores a saved configuration file
The AMC method for saving and restoring configuration data is more convenient, but it imports and
exports a subset of the data that can be saved and restored using the command-line tools. The
following table compares the two methods:
Configuration item
AMC
Command-line tools
Access policy
x
x
Certificates
x
x
Aventail WorkPlace customizations
x
x
Node-specific network settings
x
x
OnDemand configuration files
x
Manual configuration-file edits
x
Saving Configuration Data
Backup files are saved to a compressed tar file (by default, /var/backups/cfgback.tgz). It is a good
practice to back up your system regularly, especially when making many system customizations.
410
|
Appendix A - Appliance Command-Line Tools
X
To back up your configuration using Backup Tool
1. Connect to the appliance using SSH or a serial connection, and log in as “root”.
2. Type config_backup, specifying any of the following optional parameters:
config_backup [-t <tarfile>] [-q] [-d <debuglevel>] [-h]
Parameter
Description
-t <tarfile>
Backs up your configuration to the specified file. This parameter is
required only if you want to back up to a different backup file than the
default file: /var/backups/cfgback.tgz
Setting this parameter is not recommended, because the restore
program normally looks for the default file when restoring.
-q
Turns off the confirmation prompts (making the backup “quiet”).
Normally, you are prompted when you might overwrite an existing
backup file.
-d <debuglevel>
Specifies how much information to display about the backup operation.
Set <debuglevel> to an integer between 0 (no information) and 10
(complete information). The default is 1 (normal information).
-h
Shows help listing available parameters.
When you run Config Backup Tool, it saves your system configuration files to a backup file with the
name and location specified above. If a backup file already exists at that location, you are prompted
to confirm that you want to overwrite it (unless you use the -q parameter).
Notes
z
Your configuration is automatically backed up if you install a new system update using Update
Tool. This will not overwrite manual backups created by an administrator.
z
For additional protection, use a program like SCP to copy the .tgz file from the appliance to a
separate location, such as a drive on your network or removable media.
z
You can automate backups by adding Backup Tool to a script. In this case, use the -q parameter
to suppress confirmation prompts.
Restoring Configuration Data
You might want to restore from a backup file if you make changes that cause configuration
problems. The command-line Config Restore Tool included with the appliance enables you to restore
your entire configuration, or restore a single file.
X
To restore configuration data from a backup file
1. Connect to the appliance using SSH or a serial connection, and log in as “root”.
2. Type config_restore, specifying any of the following optional parameters:
config_restore [-f <filename>] [-t <tarfile>] [-q] [-d <debuglevel>] [-h]
Parameter
Description
-f <filename>
Restores only the file you specify. Use this program if you want to
restore a single file rather than all the configuration files in the backup
file. See /var/backups for a list of backup files.
-t <tarfile>
Restores your configuration from the specified backup file. This
parameter is required only if you need to restore from a different
backup file than the default file: /var/backups/cfgback.tgz
-q
Turns off the confirmation prompts (making the restore “quiet”).
Normally, you are prompted to confirm that you want to restore files.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
411
Parameter
Description
-d <debuglevel>
Specifies how much information to display about the restore operation.
Set <debuglevel> to an integer between 0 (no information) and 10
(complete information). The default is 1 (normal information).
-h
Shows help listing the available parameters.
You are prompted to confirm that you want to restore (unless you use the -q parameter) and Config
Restore Tool copies all the configuration files from the specified backup file (or only the file you
specify, if you use the -f parameter), overwriting any of the same configuration files that exist.
Notes
z
If the backup file is not found, Config Restore Tool reports an error; it requires a backup file to
run. You can manually back up your system as described in “Saving Configuration Data” on
page 409.
Restoring Factory Default Configuration Settings
You may occasionally want to restore factory default configuration settings. For example, if you are
moving an appliance to a different environment and have a large number of configuration changes
to make, it may be more convenient to restore the appliance to its default settings and start over
from scratch. To restore the factory defaults, use a command-line utility named Config Reset Tool.
!
X
CAUTION Running Config Reset Tool will delete all of your existing system configuration data.
If you intend to restore a configuration from backup, make sure you have copied your backup
files to another system before continuing.
To restore factory default configuration settings
1. Make a serial connection to the appliance (see “Powering Up and Configuring Basic Network
Settings” on page 31), and then log in as “root”.
2. Type config_reset to run Config Reset Tool.
3. You are prompted to restore default settings (“Reset the appliance configuration to factory
defaults?”). Type y and then press Enter.
4. You are prompted to reboot or shut down (halt) the appliance. Type r to reboot, or h to halt. If
you reboot the system, a login prompt appears after the system restarts.
!
CAUTION — EX7000 and EX6000 appliances: Remove any USB devices from the
appliance before you reboot it. If a USB device is plugged in to your appliance when it is
rebooted, the appliance tries to use it as a boot device. As a result, the boot information stored
in the BIOS on the appliance is overwritten, and the EX7000 or EX6000 becomes unusable.
5. Run Setup Tool again to configure the network; see “Configuring a New Appliance Using Setup
Tool” on page 408.
Notes
z
Restoring factory default configuration settings on an appliance is different from performing a
factory reset, which should only be used as a last resort. See “Performing a Factory Reset” on
page 413 for more information.
Upgrading or Rolling Back System Software
Use the following tools for updating the appliance system software:
Tool
Purpose
Update Tool
Upgrade to a new version of the system software.
412
|
Appendix A - Appliance Command-Line Tools
Tool
Purpose
Rollback Tool
Roll the system software back to its most recent state prior to
an upgrade.
You cannot use Rollback Tool to remove any hotfixes that you’ve
installed, but you can use AMC to do so; see “Rolling Back to a
Previous Version” on page 237 for more information.
Factory Reset Tool
Restore the appliance to its original state when received from
the vendor. Use this tool as a last resort.
Installing System Upgrades (Command Line Tool)
After you’ve downloaded a system upgrade or hotfix and copied it to the appliance, you can install
it using Aventail Management Console, described in “Installing System Updates” on page 235. If
you prefer to work from the command line, follow the steps below.
For information on updating the software on a cluster, see “Upgrading a Cluster” on page 403.
X
To install a system upgrade
1. Connect to the appliance using SSH or a serial connection, and log in as “root”.
2. Copy the upgrade file to the /upgrade directory on the appliance.
3. Some SCP programs do not maintain the original file permissions after a transfer. Make sure
the upgrade file is executable by typing the following:
chmod +x upgrade_<version>.bin
4. Type /upgrade/upgrade_<version>.bin, specifying the appropriate upgrade version number.
5. Reboot the appliance.
!
CAUTION — EX7000 and EX6000 appliances: Remove any USB devices from the
appliance before you reboot it. If a USB device is plugged in to your appliance when it is
rebooted, the appliance tries to use it as a boot device. As a result, the boot information stored
in the BIOS on the appliance is overwritten, and the EX7000 or EX6000 becomes unusable.
Notes
z
If you receive an “Update failed” error message, check the following log file to find out why:
/var/log/migrate_[VERSION_BEING_MIGRATED_FROM].log
For example, if you have a CA eTrust SiteMinder server configured in v8.9.0 and you upgrade
to v10.0, which doesn’t support that authentication type, the update fails and the reason is
recorded in /var/log/migrate_8_9_0.log.
Reverting to a Previous Version
You can use Rollback Tool to undo up to two installed system updates. If you experience problems
after completing an update, you may want to use this tool to roll back to a known state. Each time
you run Rollback Tool, it removes the most recent system update and restores the version that
existed just prior to the update.
!
X
CAUTION If you have made any configuration changes since updating the system, running
Rollback Tool will erase these changes.
To undo the most recent system update
1. Connect to the appliance using SSH or a serial connection, and log in as “root”.
2. Type rollback_tool.
3. When the command prompt reappears, type reboot to restart the appliance.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
!
|
413
CAUTION — EX7000 and EX6000 appliances: Remove any USB devices from the
appliance before you reboot it. If a USB device is plugged in to your appliance when it is
rebooted, the appliance tries to use it as a boot device. As a result, the boot information stored
in the BIOS on the appliance is overwritten, and the EX7000 or EX6000 becomes unusable.
Notes
z
You cannot use Rollback Tool to remove any hotfixes that you’ve installed, but you can use AMC
to do so; see “Rolling Back to a Previous Version” on page 237 for more information.
Performing a Factory Reset
A factory reset returns the appliance to the state it was in when you first received it. Running
Factory Reset Tool erases any updates, configuration files, log files, and so forth that have been
created or installed on the appliance. There are a couple of scenarios in which this tool may be
appropriate:
z
You want to completely clean the machine and reuse it elsewhere.
z
The appliance is in an unrecoverable state. In this case, you should contact SonicWALL Technical
Support and confirm that there is no other solution to your problem. A factory reset should be
used only as a last resort to restore the appliance to a working condition.
X
To return the appliance to its original factory condition
1. Back up the configuration data on the appliance. You can do this in AMC (see “Exporting the
Current Configuration to a Local Machine” on page 224), or by using Backup Tool (see “Saving
Configuration Data” on page 409).
2. On a serial console, log in to the appliance as “root”.
3. Type factory_reset_tool. A message appears prompting you to reboot the appliance.
!
CAUTION — EX7000 and EX6000 appliances: Remove any USB devices from the
appliance before you reboot it. If a USB device is plugged in to your appliance when it is
rebooted, the appliance tries to use it as a boot device. As a result, the boot information stored
in the BIOS on the appliance is overwritten, and the EX7000 or EX6000 becomes unusable.
4. Type reboot to restart the appliance. When the restart is complete, a prompt similar to the
following appears:
Debian GNU/Linux 3.0 SSL-VPN ttyS1
SSL-VPN login:
5. Log in to the appliance as “root”; Setup Tool will run automatically.
Notes
z
Performing a factory reset on an appliance is different from restoring factory default
configuration settings. See “Restoring Factory Default Configuration Settings” on page 411 for
more information.
Validating Hosts
Many of the access control rules that you create in AMC point to host resources; as each rule is
evaluated, the appliance tries to resolve these hosts in DNS. When resources are added, deleted,
and modified on an appliance, some may become outdated, or completely unreachable. If there are
any hosts that can’t be resolved you may also find that performance slows down.
There is a script you can run from the command line on the appliance (using SSH) called
checkhosts, located in /usr/local/extranet/bin. By reporting on hosts that may no longer be
functional or reachable, this tool can help you update your resources and access control lists so that
policy evaluation is more efficient.
For help with the command syntax, type the following:
<appliance prompt>:/usr/local/extranet/bin/checkhosts -h
414
|
Appendix A - Appliance Command-Line Tools
For more information and examples on how to use checkhosts, see SonicWALL knowledge base
article 3010 on the mySonicWALL.com Web site, in the Support area.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
415
Appendix B
Troubleshooting
This section provides general troubleshooting instructions and discusses the troubleshooting tools
available in the Aventail Management Console (AMC). Failure in core networking services (such as
DHCP, DNS, or WINS) will cause unpredictable failures.
The User Sessions page in AMC can be used to monitor, troubleshoot or terminate sessions on
your appliance or HA pair of appliances. You can sort through the summary of session details and,
if needed, display details on how a device was classified, and why. About 24 hours worth of data is
kept; even items that have been deleted or modified are displayed. See “Viewing User Access and
Policy Details” on page 212.
General Networking Issues
These troubleshooting tips for networking issues are grouped by type of solution. Before using the
ping utility, make sure that Enable ICMP pings is enabled on the Configure Basic Network
Settings page.
Utility
Troubleshooting tip
Ping the external interface
Ping the external interface to verify the network connection. If you
can ping a host's IP address but not its fully qualified domain name,
there is a problem with name resolution. You can issue the ping
command from the command line or from within AMC (see “Ping
Command” on page 433).
Capture network traffic on
the external interface
To verify that traffic is reaching the appliance and being returned,
use the network traffic utility in AMC, which is based on tcpdump.
You can send this network traffic data to Technical Support, or
review it using a network protocol analyzer like Wireshark. See
“Capturing Network Traffic” on page 435 for more information.
Ping the network
gateway(s)
Ping the external gateway and/or internal gateway. You can issue
the ping command from the command line or from within AMC. For
more information, see “Ping Command” on page 433.
416
|
Appendix B - Troubleshooting
Utility
Troubleshooting tip
Use ping to test DNS
If you experience DNS problems, first determine whether client DNS
resolution is working:
1. Make sure that the client machine has Internet access.
2. At a DOS command prompt, type ping google.com. You should
see a response like this:
Pinging google.com [nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn]
If basic DNS functionality is available, the IP address in square
brackets is resolved by DNS lookup, demonstrating that basic
DNS is functioning at the client. If DNS is not available, the ping
program will pause for a few seconds and then indicate that it
could not find the host google.com.
Try to use DNS to resolve
the appliance host name
If you continue to experience DNS problems, determine whether
DNS can resolve the appliance host name. Repeat the ping
procedure described above but replace google.com with the host
name of your appliance.
If ping finds no address for your host name, troubleshoot the DNS
server that should be serving that host name. Try working around
client connection issues by replacing the host name with the IP
address of the appliance’s external interface.
If ping finds an address for your host name, but no replies appear
(“Request timed out”), ICMP echoes may be blocked at any hop
between the client and the appliance.
Clear the ARP
If you’ve recently assigned a new IP address to the appliance, be
sure to clear the local Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) cache from
network devices such as firewalls or routers. This ensures that these
network devices are not using an old IP-to-MAC address mapping.
Hardware
Troubleshooting tip
Cables
Check all network cables to be sure you don't have a bad cable.
Bypass the firewall
If you're using network address translation (NAT), you might be
blocked by a firewall. Temporarily bypass the firewall by connecting
a laptop to the appliance on the physical interface using a crossover
cable, and then verify network connectivity.
If this type of connection is impractical, try placing your laptop on
the same network segment as the external interface of the appliance
(to get as close to the appliance as possible).
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
417
Hardware
Troubleshooting tip
Configure the switch port
If you experience network latency, such as slow scp file copying or
slow performance by the Web proxy or network tunnel service, the
problem may be due to configuration differences between the
appliance interface settings and the switch ports to which the
appliance is connected. It’s possible for a switch to improperly detect
duplex-mode settings (for example, the appliance is configured at
full duplex but the switch detects half duplex). Cisco has
documented such problems with its switches.
To resolve this problem, disable autonegotiation. Instead, configure
the switch port to statically assign settings that match the appliance.
You must check both switch ports and both appliance interface
settings (internal and external, if applicable). If even one
interface/switch port is mismatched, performance suffers.
If you are experiencing network latency but your appliance/switch
ports are configured correctly, the problem lies somewhere else in
the network. It could also be an application-level issue (such as slow
name resolution on the DNS server being accessed by the Web proxy
or network tunnel service).
Third-party solution
Troubleshooting tip
Verify that traffic is not
being filtered out
Review the contents of the log file /var/log/kern.iptables while a
connection attempt is failing. If packets are reaching the appliance
but are being dropped or denied by iptables (a firewall running on
the appliance), review the iptables ruleset by running the following
command:
iptables -L -n -v
Traffic that is filtered by iptables is logged but not forwarded to an
external syslog server.
Verify a Downloaded Upgrade File
You can use AMC to install version upgrades, as described in “Upgrading, Rolling Back, or Resetting
the System” on page 233. To make sure that the update was successfully transferred to your local
computer, compare its checksum against the one in the .md5 file you extracted from the .zip file.
To verify the MD5 checksum on your PC, use a Windows- or Java-based utility. Microsoft, for
example, offers an unsupported command line utility on their site named File Checksum Integrity
Verifier (FCIV):
X
To verify the downloaded file on a PC
1. At the DOS command prompt, type the following, which returns a checksum for the
downloaded file:
fciv <upgrade_filename>.bin
2. Open the associated .md5 file (which you downloaded from the MySonicWALL Web site) using
Notepad or another text editor:
notepad <upgrade_filename>.bin.md5
3. Compare the two checksums. If they match, you can safely continue with your update. If they
differ, try the download again and compare the resulting checksums. If they still don't match,
contact SonicWALL Technical Support.
418
|
Appendix B - Troubleshooting
X
To verify the downloaded file on the appliance
1. Type the following command, which returns a checksum for the downloaded file:
md5sum <upgrade_filename>.bin
2. Open the associated .md5 file:
cat <upgrade_filename>.md5
3. Compare the two checksums.
Troubleshooting Agent Provisioning (Windows)
Aventail Access Manager (AAM) is a component that provisions Windows users with EPC and access
agents when they log in to WorkPlace. If something goes wrong during provisioning, the error is
recorded in a client installation log (identified by username) that you can view in AMC.
Here’s a broad overview of the provisioning process. At steps (2) through (6), information is
appended to a file named epiBoostrapper.log (stored in \Documents and
Settings\<username>\Application Data\Aventail\LogFiles\).
1. Micro-interrogation: JavaScript is used to get basic platform and browser information: Is this a
Microsoft OS? Is ActiveX enabled? If not, is Java enabled? (If neither is available, the user sees
an error message.)
2. Fetch epiBootstrapper.exe, a self-extracting executable in MSI (Microsoft Windows Installer)
format; the executable also includes the macro-interrogator used in step (5).
3. Fetch the list of Advanced EPC agents and install it. At a minimum, OPSWAT.msi is installed.
4. Fetch additional Advanced EPC agents as required by the community.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
419
5. Macro-interrogation: Search for both Advanced EPC and other device profile attributes, such
as a particular file name, or a Windows registry key.
6. Provision agents (for example, data protection, or OnDemand Tunnel).
AMC Issues
One of the most common errors in AMC is to make a configuration change and then forget to apply
it. A Pending changes link appears in the top-right corner in AMC whenever changes have been
made but not applied. Click the link and then click Apply Changes to automatically restart the
services.
Issue
Solution
Can't access AMC
If you can't access AMC, connect a crossover cable to the internal
network interface on the appliance and verify that you can access
AMC without any network. If this type of connection is impractical,
put the laptop on the same network segment as the internal
interface (to get as close to the appliance as possible).
If you still can't access AMC, make sure your URL includes the
https:// protocol identifier. Also verify that you’ve included the port
number 8443 in the URL.
Can’t log in to AMC on the
internal network
If your browser cannot log in to AMC on the internal network, ensure
that traffic from the client to the IP address of the appliance’s
internal interface actually arrives at the internal interface. Using the
network traffic utility in AMC, which is based on tcpdump, you can
capture traffic on the internal interface (eth0). Any client attempts
to reach AMC should show traffic TCP SYN packets from the client’s
IP address directed to port 8443. See “Capturing Network Traffic” on
page 435 for more information.
Can’t log in
If AMC login fails with the error “Invalid Login Credentials,” verify the
spelling of your username and password. Passwords are casesensitive; ensure that Caps Lock and Num Lock are not enabled.
CPU utilization is spiking
If you are using nested group lookup on your LDAP or AD
authentication server, make sure that you are also caching the
lookup results: searching the entire directory tree takes time and
increases the CPU usage on both the appliance and your
authentication server.
420
|
Appendix B - Troubleshooting
Authentication Issues
An authentication server is referenced in a realm.
Issue
Solution
Access to the external
authentication server(s)
Verify that you can access the external authentication server by
using the network traffic utility in AMC, which is based on tcpdump.
You can send this network traffic data to Technical Support, or review
it using a network protocol analyzer like Wireshark. See “Capturing
Network Traffic” on page 435 for more information.
Authentication server
credentials
Verify that AMC contains the proper credentials for access to your
external server. For LDAP, check the Login DN and Password
settings and click Test Connection. For RADIUS, check the Shared
secret setting.
Authentication server logs
Review the authentication server logs. Make sure you're not entering
invalid credentials or having connectivity problems.
User authentication using
an LDAP or AD server takes
too long or times out
If you are using nested group lookup on your LDAP or AD server,
make sure that you are also caching the lookup results, because
searching the entire directory tree takes time. To reduce the load on
your directory and get better performance, cache the attribute group
or static group search results by selecting the Cache group
checking check box.
Using Personal Firewalls with Aventail Agents
Some firewall products display a security alert during the provisioning of Aventail agents or EPC
components. This is because the firewalls are regulating outbound connections by process (in
addition to port and protocol). In most cases, the user can simply “unblock” or “permit” the
outbound connection.
Connect Tunnel users should configure their personal firewalls to allow the SonicWALL VPN service
(ngvpnmgr.exe) and Aventail Access Manager (AventailComponents.exe) to access the Internet
and to add the SonicWALL appliance by host name or IP address as a trusted host or zone. In
addition, Windows Vista users should make an exception for epiVista.exe.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
421
There are a few firewalls, such as one supplied by Trend Micro, that do not permit a user with
restricted rights to override the firewall settings. For corporate systems on which users have limited
access rights, you may need to update the firewall settings before deploying the SonicWALL VPN so
that users won’t have to respond to security dialog prompts.
Consult the documentation for your corporate personal firewall to determine the firewall policy. If a
firewall update proves necessary, a rule that allows all processes to communicate with the appliance
over port 443 is recommended.
Aventail Services Issues
To see a brief summary of which services are running, click Services on the main navigation menu.
Web Proxy Service Issues
z
Temporarily increase the server log level in AMC to Verbose. (Don’t forget to click Pending
changes in the top-right corner of any AMC page, and then click Apply Changes to
automatically restart the service.)
z
To see the Web proxy service log, click Logging in the main navigation menu, and then select
Web proxy audit log from the Log file list. Verify that your connection request appears in the
log.
z
Verify that your DNS server can resolve the Web proxy service Server name setting in AMC to
the IP address of the Web proxy service interface. You can use the lookup tool within AMC (see
“DNS Lookup” on page 434), or you can issue the nslookup or dig commands from a command
prompt.
z
If your network uses NAT to translate IP addresses, make sure that the Web proxy service
Server name setting contains the IP address of the outside (or public) IP address that is being
substituted using NAT.
Web Proxy Agent Issues
The Web proxy agent provides access to URL resources on Windows systems with Internet Explorer
6.0 or later. Aventail WorkPlace indicates that Web proxy mode is active on a client by displaying
“Aventail Web proxy” in the Connection Status area.
422
|
Appendix B - Troubleshooting
To troubleshoot whether the Web proxy agent is running properly on a client machine, follow these
steps:
1. On the client machine, press Ctrl+Alt+Delete and then click Task Manager.
2. Look in Windows Task Manager’s Processes list for the process ewpca.exe. If that file is
present, the standard Web mode access agent is running, although it may not be receiving
network traffic.
3. To confirm that the Web proxy agent is receiving traffic, start Internet Explorer and then select
Tools > Internet Options. On the Connections tab, click LAN Settings or Settings for the
dial-up/VPN connection you are using to connect to the appliance.
4. In the appropriate Settings dialog box for your connection type, verify that the Use
automatic configuration script check box is selected and that the Address box contains
the following address:
http://127.0.0.1:<portnumber>/redirect.pac
Internet Explorer uses the redirect.pac file to determine which connections to send to the Web
proxy agent.
5. To view the resource addresses that are redirected by the redirect.pac file, open the file in a
text editor. The file is located on the client machine in this folder:
\Documents and Settings\<username>\Application Data\Aventail\ewpca
The //Redirection Rules// section of the redirect.pac file lists the addresses defined as
destinations that are sent through the standard Web proxy agent. These addresses come from
the list of network and URL resources defined in AMC.
Tunnel Issues
This section describes how to troubleshoot problems with the network tunnel service and the tunnel
clients.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
423
Installation
Issue
Troubleshooting tips
Connect Tunnel
client does not
install
The provisioned client is delivered to client computers as an installation
package. If the installation procedure fails, the following may explain the
issue or offer a solution:
z
System is not supported: Ensure that the client computer’s system
software is supported by the Connect Tunnel client.
z
Client software doesn’t match system requirements: If users can access
WorkPlace, install the client that is available in WorkPlace.
z
User does not have local administrator rights: Users must have
administrator rights to install the Connect Tunnel client.
z
The Connect Tunnel client installation log file (ngsetup.log) may contain
information that can help troubleshoot installation issues. On Windows
XP, this file is located in the following folder on the user’s computer:
[drive:]\Documents and Settings\All Users\Application
Data\Aventail\ngsetup.log
On Windows Vista, the file is located in the ProgramData folder, which
is hidden by default:
[drive:]\ProgramData\Aventail\ngsetup.log
OnDemand Tunnel
agent does not
install
The OnDemand Tunnel client is automatically installed and activated when
a user browses to WorkPlace after authenticating in an appropriately
configured realm. Typically, the OnDemand Tunnel agent operates without
user intervention, providing secure, tunneled access to configured
resources as long as WorkPlace is running. If the OnDemand Tunnel agent
fails to install or activate, the following may explain the issue or offer a
solution:
z
Installing OnDemand Tunnel requires administrator rights.
z
OnDemand Tunnel not enabled for this Workplace realm: On the main
navigation menu in AMC, click Realms. The Realms page displays a list
of all realms defined for the appliance. To review the settings affecting
the network tunnel service for a particular realm, click the realm name.
On the Communities tab of the Configure Realm page, click Edit in
the Access Methods area. Ensure that the Network tunnel client
check box is selected.
z
System is not supported: Ensure that the client computer’s system
software is supported by the OnDemand Tunnel agent.
z
Browser is not supported: Ensure that the user is running a Web browser
that is supported by the OnDemand Tunnel agent. See “Client
Components” on page 9 for system requirements.
424
|
Appendix B - Troubleshooting
Connectivity
Issue
Troubleshooting tips
Client does not
connect
The OnDemand Tunnel agent starts automatically after users successfully
authenticate to WorkPlace, if the community supports the OnDemand
Tunnel agent.
The provisioned Connect Tunnel client requires you to activate it each time
you want to begin a tunnel session. Tunnel sessions can remain active for
many hours. Interrupting network connectivity for periods of more than a
few seconds causes the tunnel session to end. Interruptions occur, for
example, when a network cable is disconnected, a laptop is set to sleep, or
the network link is so busy that it has high latencies and packet drop rates.
The following describes common failures that can prevent a Connect Tunnel
client or OnDemand Tunnel agent connection from succeeding:
Client connects, but
cannot access a
resource
z
Appliance is unreachable: In the Aventail Connect login dialog box, click
Properties. In the Properties dialog box, under Login group, click
Change. If the appliance is reachable over the network, the Select or
enter your login box will be populated with a list of available realms.
If the appliance is not reachable, after a few moments you will see an
error message that reads “The remote network connection has timed
out.”
z
Incorrect appliance address specified: In the Aventail Connect login
dialog box, click Properties. In the Properties dialog box, ensure that
the Host name or IP address of your VPN is correct. If a host name
is entered instead of an IP address, ensure that the client can resolve
the host name, and that the host name corresponds to the IP address of
the appliance’s external interface.
z
Appliance is not running: Ensure that the appliance is running.
z
Invalid realm for user name: Ensure that a valid realm is configured for
the user.
z
Authentication failure: Ensure that the user has specified the correct
authentication credentials.
z
Client service failure: Retrieve the client log (ngsetup.log), and send the
log file to SonicWALL for analysis along with a description of the
situation.
z
Personal firewall is not permitting tunnel traffic: Ensure that the user’s
firewall is configured to allow connections to the appliance’s FQDN or IP
address.
When a tunnel is established, an icon representing that tunnel appears in
the taskbar notification area. At this point the client computer has access to
all configured resources the appliance can reach and for which the user is
authorized. If the client cannot reach a resource, the following may explain
the issue or offer a solution:
z
Resource not defined: Ensure that the correct resource is defined in
AMC.
z
User not authorized to access resource: In AMC, review access control
rules, and realm and community assignments, to ensure that the user
is allowed to access the resource.
z
Appliance routing cannot reach resource: Ensure that there isn’t a
general networking problem between the appliance and back-end
resources.
z
Server software failure: Note the time of the failure, determine whether
the network tunnel service is functioning properly, and gather further
troubleshooting information if necessary.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
425
Issue
Troubleshooting tips
Client connects, but
disconnects
unexpectedly
Once connected, a Connect Tunnel or OnDemand Tunnel connection should
remain active for many hours. However, the tunnel can end prematurely for
several reasons. If a tunnel connection disconnects unexpectedly, the
following may explain the issue or offer a solution:
z
Tunnel that was left idle timed out: To conserve appliance resources, idle
tunnels can disconnect after an extended period of time.
z
Administrator stopped or restarted the network tunnel service: Normal
configuration operations using AMC should not affect established
tunnels; they continue to operate under the configuration that was in
effect when they were established. However, configuration changes that
affect basic appliance networking will cause existing tunnels to drop or
hang, possibly requiring a disconnect at the client to recover.
With the network tunnel service logs set to Info level or higher, the
message “Reset Internal Interface and Addressing Information”
appears in the log any time the network tunnel service is stopped; in
addition, the message “Internal Interface eth0 Address n.n.n.n
Netmask n.n.n.n BCastAddr n.n.n.n Subnet n.n.n.n” (with appropriate
IP addressing values) appears any time the service is started from a
stopped condition. In the ngutil log, the text “The server is shutting
down” identifies this situation.
z
Internetwork carrying tunnel became unresponsive or unreliable: When
traffic fills the available bandwidth on any hop between the client and
the appliance, packets wait on queues in the end-point TCP stack or in
intermediate routers. When queues fill, packets are dropped.
The network tunnel service carries traffic over a TCP SSL connection.
TCP is designed to accept network unreliability by delivering traffic only
when it is in sequence, it can be verified, and it is available. TCP
implementations can drop connections when ACK responses are not
returned soon enough; this is true of the Windows TCP implementation.
After the connection drops, the tunnel client’s normal behavior is to
attempt to resume the connection transparently for 20 seconds. If
congestion caused the drop, resumption is likely to fail, and the user
sees the tunnel terminate.
z
Cluster failover occurred, and client’s resumption failed: In a cluster
configuration, when an active node fails over to the standby node, client
connections are preserved by the client tunnel resumption mechanism.
Clients will continue tunnel resumption attempts for 20 seconds, and
then give up; if the failover is not complete within this time the tunnel
connection is dropped. On orderly termination the client does not
attempt resumption, so all tunnel connections are dropped.
In addition, a new client connection initiated after failover, but during
the period in which tunnel clients are attempting resumption, might be
assigned an address that an existing client is trying to resume using.
Several characteristics of address assignment make this case unlikely,
but if it occurs the resuming client’s tunnel is dropped.
426
|
Appendix B - Troubleshooting
Issue
Client connects, but
disconnects
unexpectedly
(continued)
Troubleshooting tips
z
Client service failure: Failure of the client service software can cause the
tunnel to drop, and an error dialog box to appear. Retrieve the client log,
send the log file to SonicWALL for analysis along with a description of
the situation, and then restart the service.
z
Server software failure: Failure of the appliance tunnel software
generally causes a spontaneous reboot of the appliance, or possibly an
indefinite hang.
z
In the reboot case, a crash dump appears in a numbered directory in
/var/log/dump; retrieve and analyze this information.
z
If the appliance hangs without rebooting, the crash dump may have
succeeded before the hang; reboot the appliance and check
/var/log/dump for a new crash dump, and then retrieve and analyze this
information. You may need to reproduce the circumstances that led to
the crash.
General server
problems
Tunnel problems typically show up at the client first. Many possible
problems can be identified only by an administrator in AMC or, sometimes,
at an SSH console or the system serial console. For more information, see
“General Networking Issues” on page 415.
Network tunnel
service is not
running
At the serial console or in an SSH session, type:
uscat /var/avt/vpn/status
If the network tunnel service is configured and running, client virtual
address range information will appear. Otherwise, nothing will appear
except another shell prompt. The following items can help you determine
why the network tunnel service is not running.
z
License invalid or expired: If your appliance license is invalid, AMC
displays a license warning at the top- right corner of every AMC page
after login. You may need to contact SonicWALL to resolve licensing
issues.
z
Stopped in AMC or from console prompt: In the Network Tunnel
Service area of the AMC Services page, you can stop the network
tunnel service indefinitely, and you can view information that indicates
whether the service has been stopped.
z
Service unconfigured, or incorrectly configured: The network tunnel
service must be configured with virtual addresses and related
information for assignment to clients. If tunnel service configuration is
incomplete, the service will not run.
z
Server software failure: A failure of a userspace network tunnel service
component will generally cause the failed component to restart. There
may be helpful information in the log or in a corefile in /var/log/core.
Serious failure of a kernel component will likely result in a crash dump.
z
Cluster issues: Clustered appliances must be able to communicate over
their cluster interfaces. If they cannot communicate reliably, both nodes
in the pair may attempt to provide service, resulting in failures, or both
nodes may be on standby, so that neither is providing service.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
427
OnDemand Issues
This section describes how to troubleshoot issues with OnDemand (port-mapped).
General OnDemand Issues
If OnDemand fails to work properly, perform the following diagnostics.
Testing OnDemand
Test OnDemand by connecting to the appropriate URLs to start the applet, and then running the
supported applications.
When testing, make sure that:
z
OnDemand can communicate with required network access services.
z
Web proxy service authentication and access control are working.
z
OnDemand automatically redirects connections properly.
z
OnDemand creates connections for each configured application.
z
OnDemand starts any thin-client applications that are configured to start automatically.
Viewing OnDemand Log Files
For users running Windows, OnDemand creates a log file when it starts that contains
troubleshooting messages. The log files are saved here:
%SystemRoot%\Documents and Settings\AllUsers\Application Data\Aventail\Logfiles\
%SystemRoot%\Documents and Settings\<username>\Application Data\Aventail\Logfiles\
Detecting the JRE Version
If OnDemand is not working properly, ensure that the user is running a version of the Java Runtime
Environment (JRE) that is supported by OnDemand; see “Client Components” on page 9 for system
requirements. In addition, make sure the user has enabled Java in the browser; see “Enabling Java
in the Browser” on page 427.
X
To detect the JRE version running on a client computer
z
Internet Explorer for Windows: Open the browser’s Java Console to view information about your
JRE; see “Viewing the Java Console” on page 427.
z
Browsers for Mac OS X: In the Applications folder, open the Utilities folder, and then open
the Java folder. Run the Java Plugin Settings program, and then click About in the menu to see
information about the version you are running.
Notes
z
Some versions of Windows may not include a JRE; in this case, you see an error message
(“jview.exe must exist in \path or you need to set JAVA_HOME”). If you see this message but
you know that you have a JRE on your Windows computer, set the path to the JRE directory as
JAVA_HOME in the Environment Variables dialog box; see Windows Help for information.
Otherwise, you must either install a JRE on your Windows computer or use a different computer.
Enabling Java in the Browser
Java must be enabled in the user’s browser for the OnDemand applet to run. In Internet Explorer,
Java is enabled by default. If OnDemand doesn’t run, and you suspect the defaults have been
changed, enable them as described in the browser’s documentation.
Viewing the Java Console
If the OnDemand applet doesn’t start, the Java Console might offer an explanation. Have your user
follow the steps appropriate for his or her machine:
428
|
Appendix B - Troubleshooting
X
Viewing the Java console: Windows—Sun JRE users
1. Users who are running the Sun Java Runtime Environment can access the Java Console by
right-clicking the Sun Java icon in the taskbar notification area.
2. Click Open Console.
X
Viewing the Java console: Internet Explorer for Windows
1. Click Tools > Internet Options, and then click the Advanced tab.
2. Under Microsoft VM, select the Java Console enabled and Java logging enabled check
boxes, and then click OK.
3. Close the browser and then reopen it.
4. Click Java Console on the View menu.
X
Viewing the Java console: Mac OS X
1. In the Applications folder, open the Utilities folder.
2. In the Java folder, run the Java Plugin Settings program.
3. In the Java Plug-in Control Panel, click Use Java console on the General page.
Specific OnDemand Issues
This section describes some troubleshooting tips for specific situations you may encounter when
using OnDemand.
Issue
Troubleshooting tip
OnDemand does not start
On the computer you are trying to start OnDemand, verify that
Java or JavaScript is enabled in the Web browser.
If Java is enabled in the browser, also verify that the browser is
using a version of the Java Runtime Environment (JRE) that is
supported by OnDemand; see “Client Components” on page 9 for
system requirements.
If both of these options are enabled, and OnDemand still doesn’t
start, open the Java Console on the user’s computer to see Java
messages. If the problem requires a call to SonicWALL Technical
Support, you’ll be asked about these messages; see “Viewing the
Java Console” on page 427.
An application does not run
correctly over OnDemand
Have the user check the OnDemand Details page and verify
whether the application name is active or inactive. Problems can
occur when more than one application is configured to use the
same local IP address and port. To see more details about the
problem, ask the user to copy the log messages from the
OnDemand Details page and email them to you.
OnDemand is installed but
not activated
If both ActiveX and UAC (User Account Control) are disabled on a
client computer running Vista SP1, OnDemand can be installed but
fails to activate unless Java is configured to keep a cache of
temporary files on the local computer. To select the cache setting,
go to the Control Panel and open the Java Control panel. In the
Temporary Internet Files area, click Settings, and then select
Keep temporary files on my computer.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
429
Issue
Troubleshooting tip
The server-certificate Accept
button is unavailable
Under some circumstances, OnDemand may present the user with
a server certificate that he or she cannot accept. If the Accept
button on the certificate page is unavailable, OnDemand detects a
problem with the server certificate. The most common causes of
this problem are:
z
Date/time mismatches between client computer and server.
Verify that the client computer and the Web proxy service have
the correct date and time.
z
The certificate has expired or is not yet valid.
z
The certificate information does not match the server
information.
z
The certificate chain is invalid.
Client Troubleshooting
Windows Client Troubleshooting
The SonicWALL installer software can be loaded on a user's computer by Java or by ActiveX. If you
want to remove this installer, as well as all the other SonicWALL software components, follow these
steps.
Resetting Browser and Java Settings
Follow these steps to reset browser and Java settings. Where applicable, the instructions for both
Internet Explorer and Firefox Mozilla are given.
Clear Cookies and Cache
To clear browser cookies and cache in Internet Explorer, follow these steps:
1. Click Tools > Internet Options.
2. Click Delete Files and Delete Cookies.
To clear browser cookies and cache in Mozilla Firefox, follow these steps:
1. Click Tools > Clear Private Data.
2. Select at least these three check boxes:
{
Cookies
{
Cache
{
Authenticated Sessions
3. Click Clear Private Data Now.
Reset Security Zones to Defaults
To reset the security level for all Web content zones in Internet Explorer, follow these steps:
1. Click Tools > Internet Options > Security tab.
2. Highlight a Web content zone (for example, Internet), and then click the Default Level
button. Do this for each zone.
Reset Advanced Settings to Defaults
To reset advanced Internet Explorer settings, follow these steps:
1. Click Tools > Internet Options > Advanced tab.
430
|
Appendix B - Troubleshooting
2. Click the Restore Defaults button.
Reset Privacy Settings to Defaults
To reset Internet Explorer privacy settings, follow these steps:
1. Click Tools > Internet Options > Privacy tab.
2. Click the Default button.
Clear your Java Cache
To clear the Java Cache on your Windows system, follow these steps:
1. In the Control Panel, double-click Java.
2. Click the Delete Files button.
3. Make sure that all three types of temporary files are selected for deletion, and then click OK.
Enable your Java Cache
By default, Java is configured to keep a cache of temporary files on the local computer. If you are
using Java for remote access through a SonicWALL Aventail appliance, make sure that this cache is
enabled:
1. In the Windows Control Panel, open Java.
2. In the Java control panel, click Settings in the Temporary Internet Files area.
3. Select Keep temporary files on my computer.
Uninstalling SonicWALL Components
Follow these steps to uninstall all SonicWALL files:
1. Reboot your computer. This ensures that no files are loaded in memory and makes the
uninstall easier.
2. Remove all SonicWALL components:
a. In Windows Explorer, browse to %WINDIR%\Downloaded Program Files\.
b. Right-click the Aventail Installer file, and select Remove.
c. Uninstall the SonicWALL Aventail VPN Software. You are prompted to reboot your
computer, but you don’t need to do so until the final step in this procedure.
d. In the Control Panel, open Add/Remove Programs.
e. Remove each SonicWALL Aventail component.
3. The SonicWALL software may have been installed using either ActiveX or Java (if you’re not
sure, follow both sets of instructions):
ActiveX
If you have already done step 2b above, you can skip to the steps for Java.
a. In Windows Explorer, browse to %WINDIR%\Downloaded Program Files\.
b. Right-click on the Aventail Installer file, select Remove, and then click OK.
c. Uninstall the SonicWALL Aventail VPN Software. You are prompted to reboot your
computer, but you don’t need to do so until the final step in this procedure.
Java
a. In Windows Explorer, browse to %HOMEPATH%\Application Data\SonicWALL\EP\.
b. Double-click uninstall_ep.exe.
c. Uninstall the SonicWALL VPN Software. You are prompted to reboot your computer, but
you don’t need to do so until the final step in this procedure.
4. In Windows Explorer, browse to %HOMEPATH%\Application Data\, right-click on the Aventail
folder, and then select Delete.
SonicWALL Aventail E-Class SRA Installation and Administration Guide
|
431
5. Reboot the computer.
Logging Back In to WorkPlace
Log back in to WorkPlace, install Aventail Access Manager, and let the SonicWALL components load.
If something goes wrong during client or agent installation, the error is recorded in a client
installation log. This log is automatically uploaded to the appliance and listed in AMC if Aventail
Access Manager is installed. Users who do not have Aventail Access Manager are prompted to
upload the log file to the appliance when an installation error occurs.
Follow these steps to obtain additional log files:
1. Browse to %HOMEPATH%\Application Data\.
2. You should see a folder named Aventail: zip the folder contents up, and e-mail it to SonicWALL
Technical Support.
3. Browse to %ALLUSERSPROFILE%\Application Data\.
4. You should see a folder named Aventail: zip the folder contents up, and e-mail it to SonicWALL
Technical Support.
5. Open a DOS box (click Start > Run, type cmd, and then press Enter).
6. In the command prompt window, type ngutil -all > ngutil.txt.
7. E-mail the ngutil.txt file to SonicWALL Technical Support.
8. Click Start > Run, type msinfo32, and then press Enter.
9. Highlight System Summary, and then select File > Export. E-mail the exported file to
SonicWALL Technical Support.
Macintosh and Linux Tunnel Client Troubleshooting
When troubleshooting Macintosh and Linux tunnel client problems, request the system and version
information described in this section from your users. Before gathering this information, users
should uninstall and re-install the software.
Macintosh System and Application Information
Have users specify the following information:
System information
How to find it
Operating system
Select About this Mac from the Apple menu.
Hostfino command
Open the Terminal application (in the Applications > Utilities folder) and
type hostfino. This displays processor and kernel information, along
with the amount of available memory.
OpenSSL
Open the Terminal application (in the Applications > Utilities folder) and
type the following to display information about OpenSSL:
openssl version
Safari browser
Java Virtual Machine
(JVM)
Select About Safari from the Safari menu.
1. In the Applications folder, open the Utilities folder.
2. In the Java folder, run the Java Plugin Settings program.
3. In the Java Plug-in Control Panel, click Use Java console on the
General page.
432
|
Appendix B - Troubleshooting
System information
System Profiler
How to find it
1. Select About this Mac from the Apple menu.
2. Click More Info to open the System Profiler. The profiler displays
detailed information about the computer’s hardware and installed
software. The complete report (if you choose to print it) can easily
be over 100 pages long.
When you start Connect Tunnel, make sure that the log files /var/log/AvConnect.log and
/var/log/AvConnectUI.log are set to collect debugging information. You can enable debug mode in
the Aventail Connect client itself, or go to a command prompt and type the following:
/Applications/Aventail Connect.app/Contents/MacOS/startct.sh -d
Linux System and Application Information
Have your users collect the following information. To have information written to a file, instead of
displayed on screen, append “> filename.txt” (for example, uname -a > sysinfo.txt):
System information
How to find it
Linux kernel version
Determine the version of the Linux kernel by typing uname –a in a
terminal window. The output will look like this:
Linux app41-dsl 2.6.12.3 #2 SMP Thu Aug 3 14:45:51 PDT 2006
i686 GNU/Linux
The information is presented in this order:
Linux distribution
z
Kernel name: Linux
z
Host name: app41-dsl
z
Kernel release: 2.6.12.3
z
Kernel version: #2 SMP Thu Aug 3 14:45:51 PDT 2006 i686
GNU/Linux
Most Linux distributions maintain a release information file in the /etc
directory. Here are the file names of the well known Linux distributions
(the /etc directory will have only one of these files):
z
Novell SUSE: SuSE-release
z
Red Hat: redhat-release, redhat_version
z
Fedora: fedora-release
z
Slackware: slackware-release, slackware-version
z
Debian: debian_release, debian_version
z
Mandrake: mandrake-release
z
Yellow dog: yellowdog-release
z
Sun JDS: sun-release
z
Solaris/Sparc: release
z
Gentoo: gentoo-release
z
UnitedLinux: UnitedLinux-release
z
ubuntu: lsb-release
To display the release informatio